Skip to main content

Painting & Finishing

Black & Decker The Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects

Source: Black & Decker The Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects.pdf

Source file: Black & Decker The Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects.pdf

                                    The Complete Photo Guide to

                             HOME

e.

                            DECORATING
  Photo Guide to
  The Complete

                               PR O J E C T S
 HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

                            DIY Projects to Transform Walls, Windows, Furniture, Floors & More

                                                                                                                          6/23/09 1:14:06 PM

                                                                    Job:05-11999 Title:CPI-HI 0571 CG Outdoor Carpentry
                                                                                    06-AC52210 #175 Dtp:221 Page:PLC

                   THE COMPLETE P H O T O GUIDE TO

                   HOME DECORATING

                    PROJECTS
                      130 Do-it-Yourself Decorating Solutions

                                        MINNEAPOLIS, MINNESOTA
                                           www.creativepub.com

001-057_11989.indd 1 5/21/09 3:33:57 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:1

                                                                                                                                                    Wall Décor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175

         Contents                                                                                                                                   Pictures & Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
                                                                                                                                                    Textiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
                                                                                                                                                    Sticker Art . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
                                                                                                                                                    Wood Shelving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
                                                                                                                                                    Glass Shelving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
         The Complete Photo Guide to                                                                                                                Ceramic Tile Mirror Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
         Home Decorating Projects                                                                                                                   New Towel Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
                                                                                                                                                    Tile Fireplace Surround . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190

                                                                                                                                                    Ceiling Décor . . . . . . . . . . . . . .193
         Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5                    Picture Rail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
                                                                                                                                                    Ceiling Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
                                                                            Chair Rail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
                                                                                                                                                    Acoustical Ceiling Tiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
         Decorating Basics . . . . . . . . . . . .7                         Built-up Chair Rail. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
                                                                                                                                                    Metal Ceilings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
         Planning Your Project. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
                                                                            Wall Opening Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
                                                                                                                                                    Painting a Ceiling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
         Understanding Color & Pattern . . . . . . . . . . . 10
                                                                            Crown Molding. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
                                                                                                                                                    Aluminum Leaf Gilding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
         Selecting Materials. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
                                                                            Built-up Cornices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
                                                                                                                                                    Ceiling Wallcovering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
         Using Décor to Create Atmosphere. . . . . . . . 18
                                                                            Window Casing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
         Discovering Your Style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
                                                                            Arts & Crafts Window Casing. . . . . . . . . . . . 130                  Cabinets & Doors. . . . . . . . . . .211
         Sewing Techniques. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
                                                                            Painting Window Casing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132               Painting Wood Cabinets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
         Painting & Carpentry Techniques. . . . . . . . . . 34
                                                                            Window Shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134        Faux Mahogany . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
         Home Décor Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
                                                                            Basement Window Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136                Antique Stained Finish . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
                                                                                                                                                    Faux Stainless Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
         Wall Panel & Tile . . . . . . . . . . . .59                        Wall Paint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
                                                                                                                                                    Cabinet Molding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
         Decorative Wallboard Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
                                                                            Concrete Block Walls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
                                                                                                                                                    Decorative Brackets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
         Architectural Detail with Wallboard. . . . . . . . 62
                                                                            Double-Rolled Color . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
                                                                                                                                                    Wineglass Rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
         Wainscot Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
                                                                            Stripes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
                                                                                                                                                    Knobs & Pulls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
         Tongue-and-Groove Wainscoting . . . . . . . . . . 68
                                                                            Polka Dots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
                                                                                                                                                    Prehung Interior Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
         Wainscot Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
                                                                            Sponge Painting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
                                                                                                                                                    Bifold Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
         Tile Backsplashes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
                                                                            Rag-rolled Texture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
                                                                                                                                                    Painting Wood Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
         Embellishing a Tiled Wall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
                                                                            Terra-Cotta Finish. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
                                                                                                                                                    Decorative Door Headers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
                                                                            Blended Color Bands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
         Wallcovering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87                                                                                               Door Mirror. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
                                                                            Color Wash Finish. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
         Stripping Wallcovering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
         Hanging Wallcovering. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
                                                                            Stamped Mosaic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160            Flooring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
                                                                            Scumbled Wall Designs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162               Resilient Tile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
         Wallcovering Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
                                                                            Faux Serpentine Finish. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164             Glass Mosaic Tile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
         Wall Upholstery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
                                                                            Faux Grasscloth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166         Carpet Squares. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
         Wall & Window Trim . . . . . . . .105                              Caulk Designs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168        Concrete Floors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
         Base Molding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106   Veneer Plaster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170        Wood Floors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254

                                                                                                                  Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data

                                                                                                                  The complete photo guide to home decorating projects.
                                                                                                                       p. cm.
                                                                                                                    At head of title: Branded by Black & Decker
                                                                                                                    Summary: “Features do-it-yourself information on everything from painting
                                                                                                                  and trimwork to slipcovers and window treatments”--Provided by publisher.
                                                                                                                    ISBN-13: 978-1-58923-484-0 (hard cover)
         Copyright © 2009
                                                                                                                    ISBN-10: 1-58923-484-7 (hard cover)
         Creative Publishing international, Inc.
                                                                                                                   1. Handicraft--Amateurs’ manuals. 2. House furnishings--Amateurs’ manu-
         400 First Avenue North, Suite 300
                                                                                                                  als. 3. Interior decoration--Amateurs’ manuals. I. Black & Decker Corporation
         Minneapolis, Minnesota 55401
                                                                                                                  (Towson, Md.) II. Title: Branded by Black & Decker.
         1-800-328-0590
         www.creativepub.com
                                                                                                                    TT157.C575 2009
         All rights reserved
                                                                                                                    747--dc22

         Printed in China
                                                                                                                  2009019965
         10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
                                                                                                                  President/CEO: Ken Fund
                                                                                                                  VP for Sales & Marketing: Kevin Hamric

001-057_C51711.indd 2 6/3/09 10:46:17 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:2

                Custom Floor Mats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
                Sheet Vinyl . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
                Stencils. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259

                Slipcovers & Upholstery . . . . .261
                Upholstery Basics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
                Stripping Furniture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
                Repairing a Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
                New Cushions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
                Button-tufted Cushions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
                Re-upholstering a Drop-in Seat . . . . . . . . . . 284
                Re-upholstering a Chair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
                Upholstered Ottoman . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
                Upholstered Headboard. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
                Reversible Seat Covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
                Ottoman Slipcover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310
                Chair Slipcover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
                Futon Slipcover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324

                Furniture Refinishing . . . . . . . .327
                Heat Stripping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
                Chemical Stripping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330
                Surface Prep. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
                                                                                        Butterfly Shades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 372      Valance Styles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
                Stain & Top Coat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334
                                                                                        Cloud Shades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374     Buttoned Valance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412
                Painting Furniture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
                                                                                        Balloon Shades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376      Cloud Valance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
                Faux Leather Finish . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
                                                                                        Curtain Styles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378   Upholstered Valance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418
                Photo Montage Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
                                                                                        Hanging Curtains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380       Hanging Shelf Valance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422
                Spray-painting Metal Furniture . . . . . . . . . . 344
                                                                                        Draped Window Treatments . . . . . . . . . . . . 382                 Swag Styles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
                Painting Radiators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346
                                                                                        No-sew Side Panels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386         Scarf Swag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426
                Window Treatments . . . . . . . .349                                    Basic Curtains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388     Bias Swag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428
                Window Treatment Basics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350                 Grommet Curtains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390         Rod-pocket Swag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 430
                Window Treatment Styles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352                 Loop-tab Curtains. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392       Stained Glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 432
                Blinds & Shades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354         Rod-pocket Curtains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394          Frosted Glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434
                Window Shade Styles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360              Tent-flap Curtains. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396      Shoji-style Screen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438
                Roller Shades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362       Tie-top Curtains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
                Roller Shade with Tabbed Hems . . . . . . . . . 364                     Drapery Styles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
                                                                                                                                                             Resources. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .444
                Coach Shades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366         Pinch-pleated Draperies. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402           Photography Credits . . . . . . . .445
                Flat Roman Shades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368             Drapery Lining . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406     Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .446

                Home Improvement Group
                                                                                                                                NOTICE TO READERS
                Publisher: Bryan Trandem                                                                                        For safety, use caution, care, and good judgment when following the
                Managing Editor: Tracy Stanley                                                                                  procedures described in this book. The publisher and Black & Decker
                Senior Editor: Mark Johanson                                                                                    cannot assume responsibility for any damage to property or injury to
                Editor: Jennifer Gehlhar                                                                                        persons as a result of misuse of the information provided.
                                                                                                                                    The techniques shown in this book are general techniques for
                Creative Director: Michele Lanci-Altomare                                                                       various applications. In some instances, additional techniques not
                Senior Design Managers: Jon Simpson, Brad Springer                                                              shown in this book may be required. Always follow manufacturers’
                Design Manager: James Kegley                                                                                    instructions included with products, since deviating from the directions
                Production Managers: Linda Halls, Laura Hokkanen                                                                may void warranties. The projects in this book vary widely as to skill
                                                                                                                                levels required: some may not be appropriate for all do-it-yourselfers,
                Compilation author: Betsy Matheson                                                                              and some may require professional help.
                Page Layout Artist: Danielle Smith                                                                                  Consult your local building department for information on building
                                                                                                                                permits, codes, and other laws as they apply to your project.

                The Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects
                Created by: The Editors of Creative Publishing international, Inc., in coopera-
                tion with Black & Decker. Black & Decker® is a trademark of The Black &                                     Cover photograph credits; middle left courtesy of FLOR / www.flor.com;
                Decker Corporation and is used under license.                                                               middle right and lower middle courtesy of Louvolite / www.louvolite.com.

   001-057_C51711.indd 3                                                                                                                                                                                                     6/3/09 10:46:24 AM

ects ge:2 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:3

001-057_C51711.indd 4 6/3/09 10:46:47 AM (Ray) Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:4

                Introduction
                D    ecorating is the key to transforming a functional living space into a comfortable home that is uniquely yours.
                     The nearly limitless variety of decorating techniques, materials, colors, patterns, and accents that can be
                used in any room in your home provides endless options for customization—and an inherent creative challenge.
                With so many choices, where do you start?
                     The Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects will guide your creative vision and provide the
                know-how to complete nearly any decorating project with professional quality and designer results. Whether
                you plan to reinvent your living room with new upholstery, window treatments, decorative painting, and an
                aluminum-gilded ceiling or you merely want to know the best way to hang artwork and shelving, this volume
                provides clear, step-by-step instructions with large, easy-to-follow photographs to guide each project from start
                to finish.
                     To ensure that you love your completed project, always begin by envisioning the atmosphere and design
                scheme that best suits your room’s needs and your personal style. Also, take stock of the tools, materials, and
                skills needed to be successful. “Decorating Basics,” the first section of this book, is intended for exactly that
                purpose. Focused on principles of good design and on the basic skills and tools needed to achieve high-quality
                results, this section is a must for every decorator. With these resources, you can confidently create a home décor
                that truly reflects your abilities and creative intent.
                     Each of the remaining sections is composed of a set of projects associated with one element of room design,
                such as “Wall Paint,” “Cabinets & Doors,” and “Furniture Refinishing.” Projects are widely varied, encompassing
                both large and small commitments, varied skill levels, and both innovative and time-tested techniques. Let these
                projects help you complete common tasks—such as installing curtains, applying wallcoverings, or installing a tile
                backsplash correctly. Or let them inspire you to take on a more challenging project such as installing wainscot
                frames, sewing a custom-fit slipcover, or applying sophisticated painting techniques to walls, ceilings, and floors.
                     Successfully completing a decorating project will be one of the most creative, most rewarding, most fun
                ways you can invest in your home while also achieving a lasting impact on its value. In addition, the beauty and
                personality you create will become a part of your family’s story for years to come. Add the extensive resources of
                The Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects to your own creative energy and get started on your first
                project today.

                                                                                                                                                  ■      5

   001-057_11989.indd 5                                                                                                                               5/21/09 3:34:8 PM

ects ge:4 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:5

001-057_C51711.indd 6 6/3/09 10:47:23 AM (Ray) Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:6

                                        Decorating
                                        Basics
                                        T   aking on a home decorating project can transform
                                            the spirit of your home. Whether completing
                                        a small task such as updating a window with new
                                        curtains or a major undertaking such as wallcovering
                                        an entire room, each project in this book will
                                        require you to be familiar with a few basic design
                                        considerations, tools, and techniques.
                                             Consider the needs of your room, the interplay
                                        of colors and patterns, the desired atmosphere, and
                                        the impact of your own personal style when selecting
                                        materials and projects for your home. Then, familiarize
                                        yourself with the basic techniques and tools you’ll
                                        need to complete the project—as well as any specific
                                        measuring and planning instructions. Review this
                                        chapter for tips and techniques to ensure your project
                                        is a success from start to finish.

                                        In this chapter:
                                        • Planning Your Project             • Discovering Your Style
                                        • Understanding Color               • Sewing Techniques
                                          & Pattern                         • Painting &
                                        • Selecting Materials                 Carpentry Techniques
                                        • Using Décor to                    • Home Décor Tools
                                          Create Atmosphere

                                                                                                               ■ 7

   001-057_C51711.indd 7                                                                                      6/3/09 10:47:38 AM

ects ge:6 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:7

         Planning Your Project

         T   he first step in planning any decorating project,
             large or small, is to analyze the room in which
         the project will take place. Consider what you like
                                                                   new materials to help you coordinate the old and new.
                                                                   Page through decorating magazines for additional
                                                                   inspiration. Consult salespeople, designers, websites
         best about this room—and what you would like to           and friends for helpful suggestions. The general
         change. Make notes about your initial impressions of      guidelines laid out in this chapter can also help you
         changes you’d like to see, including key words about      make good decisions. Ultimately, however, your own
         how you’d like the room to feel when your project         preferences and sense of style are the most important
         is complete.                                              consideration in any decorating decision. Each
              Remember, there is no right or wrong way to          project in this volume can be customized thousands
         coordinate the décor of a room. Collect samples of any    of different ways to suit your taste, so follow your
         carpeting, fabric, wallpaper, or paint that will remain   instincts to achieve a decorating scheme you’ll love in
         in the room and bring them with you when purchasing       the end.

                                                                                       A well-thought-out combination
                                                                                       of colors, patterns, and texture are
                                                                                       presented here. The color scheme is
                                                                                       related (see page 10), the patterns work
                                                                                       well together (see page 12), and the
                                                                                       wainscot wall ties together the overall
                                                                                       formal feel (see pages 60 and 64).

      8 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 8 5/21/09 3:34:32 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:8

                Use warm tones such as red, orange, brown, or natural to             To create an illusion of more space, paint walls and trim
                create a space that is intimate, cozy, or dramatic.                  white or pale cool colors. Cool colors recede from view, making
                                                                                     walls feel farther away than they really are. Cool colors (see
                                                                                     page 11) are also calming.

                      Planning Considerations ▸
                      Light: Carefully observe the natural light in your project     materials will complement or contrast with the existing
                      room at various times of the day and the artificial light      elements of the room. Research the techniques you'll
                      available at night. Write down where you’d like to create,     need to master to work with new materials.
                      soften, accent, or utilize light to beautify your décor.
                                                                                     Pattern: Rooms with several printed or patterned
                      Color: Decide which colors in the room you want to keep,       surfaces can appear cozy and small, whereas rooms with
                      and decide on new colors to introduce to play up the           many solid surfaces tend to be restful and expansive.
                      strengths of the room. Consider how color contributes to       Consider the needs of your room and how using patterns
                      the overall mood of the room—does the space appear too         with fabrics, decorative painting, ceramic tile, or other
                      bland, or are the colors overwhelming the space? Does          techniques could help you achieve your design goals.
                      your color scheme appear outdated? Notice how the
                      colors play off of one another and consider how to modify      Functionality: Your home should be a livable space.
                      and/or accent this interplay.                                  Always consider the durability and day-to-day functionality
                                                                                     of any design decision during the planning stage. Will your
                      Material selection: Notice the materials currently             floor surface be subjected to daily wear and tear? Will
                      present in the room that make up the floor surface, walls,     children be using this space, and are your design decisions
                      trim, ceiling, fixtures, windows, and furniture. Decide what   child-proof? Select materials and techniques that will fit with
                      materials you like best, and consider how adding new           your day-to-day life as well as with your decorative taste.

                                                                                                                                         Decorating Basics ■ 9

   001-057_11989.indd 9                                                                                                                                      5/21/09 3:34:35 PM

ects ge:8 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:9

         Understanding
         Color & Pattern

         M     ost home decorators have an instinctive sense of
               how to choose effective color combinations, but
         the majority of us could benefit from a little more color
         theory to enhance our color combination decisions.
         Basic color theory is illustrated with a color wheel. The
                                                                            The color wheel illustrates how basic colors are related. Red,
         color wheel shows how colors are related and can help              yellow, and blue are primary colors. Orange, green, and purple
         guide decisions about which colors work best together,             are secondary colors made by combining two primary colors.
         and the effect they have on a room’s overall décor.                Neutral colors are shades of white, gray, or beige (image right).

         ■ Basic Color Theory

         Related colors, sometimes called analogous, are next to            Complementary colors are located opposite one another
         one another on the color wheel. Related colors harmonize           on the color wheel. Taupe and moss (shown here) are
         naturally; many decorators use various shades of two related       complementary colors within a neutral scheme. Decorating
         colors in one room.                                                with complementary colors adds intensity when used within
                                                                            bold color schemes and adds interest in neutral color schemes.

         Monochromatic colors are all within a single family (shown         Neutral colors are shades of white, gray, or beige. Most
         here, green) but are presented in various lightnesses and          neutrals are tinted slightly with another color, which is good
         saturations. This scheme looks clean and elegant, resulting in a   guidance when choosing accessory colors for pillows,
         soothing effect.                                                   curtains, and other accessories. Use the color wheel to choose
                                                                            complementary or related colors based on the tint color of the
                                                                            main shade in the room.

    10 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 10 5/21/09 3:34:43 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:10

                ■ Dimensions of Color
                Color is so much more than what the very
                important, if overly simplistic, color wheel can
                illustrate. Colors also vary in value, temperature,
                and brightness.
                     Value is a color’s lightness or darkness (see
                vertical axis on diagram) and is determined by the
                amount of black or white that is in a color. Using
                a mixture of light, medium, and dark values of the
                same color in one space is called a monochromatic
                scheme. Using color in this way is subtle,
                sophisticated, and calming. Light color combinations
                create bright, spacious rooms and can make rooms
                appear larger and ceilings higher. Light colors reflect
                light well and can brighten and expand small spaces.
                Dark color combinations create intimacy, and can
                make rooms feel small and cozy. Dark colors absorb
                light, can disguise problem areas, and create drama.      The orange rug and brown walls add warmth to an
                Large swaths of dark colors can be very dominant—         otherwise cold, stark loft with steel stairs and concrete
                you may want to break up a dark room with light           floors. The wood stair treads, curvy couch, and oval pendant
                accents for balance.                                      lights all add natural elements and shapes to further soften
                     Saturation describes the brightness of a color       the room, resulting in a blend of industrial loft design and a
                                                                          warm atmosphere.
                and works around the color wheel (see rounded
                arrows in the center of the diagram). Bright colors, on
                the outside of the circle, are intense and undiluted by    Light
                a neutral color. Subdued colors, closer to the center,
                are diluted with a neutral color or a complementary
                hue. Bright colors demand attention and are a
                great choice for active, creative spaces or in rooms
                that receive little natural light. Bright colors are
                often used as accents or can be paired with neutral
                elements; an entirely bright-colored room can be
                bold and energetic. Subdued colors are diluted with
                neutral colors and create restful, relaxing spaces.
                They are clean and modern and can be effectively
                                                                           Value
                accented with one or two bright colors used sparingly.
                     Temperature describes how warm or cool
                                                                                                               Neutral
                a color is, according to its position on the color
                wheel (see horizontal axis on the diagram). Reds,                                             Subdued
                oranges, yellows, and browns are warm colors;                                                  Bright
                greens, blues, and purples are cool colors. Intense
                warm colors create stimulating social spaces,
                perfect for dining rooms or kitchens. Research has
                shown that people actually feel warmer in a room
                painted in a warm color, so that may be a great
                choice for warming up homes in cold climates.
                Cool colors are fresh and tranquil, perfect for
                rooms that receive abundant sunlight. Using cool
                colors in warm climates can make a home feel
                more comfortable year-round.                                Dark
                                                                                   Warm                                                       Cool

                                                                                                                              Decorating Basics ■ 11

   001-057_11989.indd 11                                                                                                                           5/21/09 3:35:3 PM

ects :10 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:11

         ■ Understanding Patterns
         There are six basic categories of patterns in decorating, and any design scheme may use several of them in the
         same room. Start with an overall plan, taking into account the architecture of your home and the ambiance you'd
         like to evoke.

         Solids are used in flooring, carpeting, walls, wallcoverings,    Geometric prints are dominant and stimulating, and help
         and window treatments. Calm and contemporary, solids are a       move the eye around a room. To prevent a room from looking
         classic choice that will never go out of style.                  too busy, balance intense geometric prints with solid-
                                                                          colored accents.

         Stripes can be used to great affect all over the home—in         Combination prints use two or more of the previous
         window treatments, furnishings, and painted on walls and         patterns and work best in large areas. Six or more patterns can
         ceilings. Stripes can expand small spaces and are very elegant   be used effectively in one room if you have a balance of color
         in subdued colors.                                               along with pattern size and scale.

    12 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 12 5/21/09 3:35:9 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:12

                Patterns take up more visual weight than solid expanses of              Overall prints and florals are effectively used on
                color. Contemporary rooms usually forgo bold or aggressive              wallcoverings, large furniture pieces, or flat window
                patterns in favor of solid-color fabrics on large upholstered           treatments, such as window shades or valances. As accents,
                pieces. Traditional rooms require a minimum of pattern for              overall prints add a spark of interest to quiet spaces. As the
                authenticity. When pattern is desired, choose subtle color              dominant decorative element, overall prints create energy and
                combinations such as those featured in tone-on-tone stripes             fun and are a great choice for social or creative spaces.
                or damask patterns, and use sparingly.

                Experiment with pattern scale with sketches or collages of your room. Typically, patterns close together make a room appear
                cozier, while patterns far apart can make a room appear more spacious. Dense patterns allow accents and furniture in the room to
                stand out, making it easy to create focal points even if the pattern is large.

                      Designer Tip: Working with Color and Pattern ▸
                      •    Repeat one strong-patterned print at least once or twice in the room. For example, a strong print in a sofa could
                           be repeated in a valance, or in a cushion across the room.
                      •    Repeat strong accent colors more than once in a room.
                      •    More than four patterns in one room can work, but the effect will be stimulating and eclectic.
                      •    Mini-prints can easily be overdone. Do not use more than two very small prints in the same area.
                      •    Have fun! Do not be afraid to let the prints and colors you choose reflect your personal taste.

                                                                                                                                           Decorating Basics ■ 13

   001-057_11989.indd 13                                                                                                                                       5/21/09 3:35:13 PM

ects :12 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:13

         Selecting Materials                                                 Fabric Terms to Know ▸
                                                                             Fiber is the basic unit of yarn before it is made into
                                                                             fabric. Fiber content affects durability and care.

         C    areful material selection ensures that your project
              will turn out the way you’ve envisioned it in your
         mind’s eye. Research your options and question your                 Blends are the best qualities of two or more fibers
                                                                             combined in one fabric.
         salesperson about differences between materials and
         brands before you make your final selections.
                                                                             Decorator fabrics are designed for decorating
                                                                             projects. They are usually wider than 48" and often

         ■ Selecting Fabric                                                  have special finishes that are desirable for home
                                                                             décor projects.
         Selecting the right fabric for your decorating project can
         affect your success. Always consider how the fabric’s               Fashion fabrics are used primarily for fashion
         durability, formality, weight, and care will affect your            sewing; however, fabrics such as calico, poplin,
         project. Use the chart at right as a basic guide to various         cotton, gingham, sateen, and muslin may also be
         fabric types and uses. Consult a salesperson at your fabric         used for the home.
         store before you purchase fabric to determine whether or
         not the fabric you love will work well for your project.            Repeat is the size (length and width) of the pattern or
              Always carefully calculate the yardage you’ll need to          motif printed on the fabric. You will usually need to buy
         purchase according to your project’s specifications before          one extra repeat for each length of fabric you use. The
         you purchase fabric. It’s usually a good idea to buy                size of the repeat is often printed on the label or selvage.
         slightly more fabric than you think you’ll need to help
         accommodate for small mistakes, or to add decorative                Selvage is the finished lengthwise edge of a
         accents, if possible. Also, remember that fabric bolts              woven fabric.
         often come from different dye lots. To avoid problems of
         slight color variations or differences in pattern printing,         Grain is the direction in which fabric threads run.
         buy all fabric for a large project from only one bolt.

               Working with Decorator Fabric
               Some decorator fabrics should not be pre-washed.
               Many are treated with finishes to protect their beauty
               and resist soiling. Washing may remove this finish,
               alter the fabric, or fade the colors. Check the care
               label on the end of the bolt to learn how best to
               prepare the fabric.
                    Decorator fabrics are often made of natural
               fibers, which include cotton, linen, silk, and wool.
               Natural fibers are breathable, comfortable, and easy
               to sew. If decorating outdoor areas, however, choose
               a fade-resistant, acrylic or polyester decorator fabric
               that looks and feels like a natural fiber fabric. These
               fabrics will resist stains and mildew and will fade
               less quickly.
                                                                         Decorator fabrics are available in countless colors,
                                                                         weaves, and styles. Always carefully choose the right
                                                                         fabric for your project.

    14 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 14 5/21/09 3:35:18 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:14

                      Fabric Selection Guide ▸
                      Fabric          Weight              Formal/Informal   Decorative Uses                                      Durable          Care

                      Antique Satin   Heavy               Formal            Draperies, upholstery, cushions, tablecloths,        Yes              Dry-clean
                                                                            slipcovers

                      Batiste         Light               Formal/informal   Under curtains, casual curtains, balloon shades      No               Machine-wash

                      Broadcloth      Light to medium     Informal          Curtains, soft shades, bed linens, pillows,          Yes              Machine-wash
                                                                            cushions, table linens, shower curtains

                      Brocade         Heavy               Formal            Draperies, bedcovers, pillows, cushions,             Yes              Dry-clean
                                                                            tablecloths, slipcovers

                      Calico          Light to medium     Informal          Curtains, pillows, table linens                      Yes              Machine-wash

                      Chintz          Medium to heavy     Formal/informal   Curtains, draperies, upholsteries, shower            Yes              Dry-clean
                                                                            curtains, cushions, Roman shades, slipcovers

                      Damask          Medium              Formal            Draperies, upholsteries, bedcovers,                  Yes              Machine-wash
                                                                            tablecloths, slipcovers                                               or dry-clean

                      Dimity          Light               Formal            Under curtains, soft shades                          No               Machine-wash

                      Duck            Heavy               Informal          Draperies, slipcovers, Roman shades                  Yes              Machine-wash
                                                                                                                                                  or dry-clean

                      Gingham         Light               Informal          Curtains, soft shades, tablecloths, napkins          Yes              Machine-wash

                      Lawn            Light               Formal            Curtains, under curtains, pillows, napkins           Yes              Machine-wash

                      Lace            Light               Formal            Curtains, tablecloths                                Varies           Machine-wash
                                                                                                                                                  or dry-clean

                      Matelasse       Heavy               Formal            Draperies, upholsteries, slipcovers                  Yes              Dry-clean

                      Moiré           Light to medium     Formal            Draperies, curtains, tablecloths                     Yes              Machine-wash
                                                                                                                                                  or dry-clean

                      Muslin          Light               Informal          Curtains, table linens, linings                      No               Machine-wash

                      Organdy         Light               Formal/informal   Curtains, under curtains                             No               Machine-wash

                      Percale         Medium              Informal          Curtains, bed linens, table linens                   Yes              Machine-wash

                      Sateen          Light to medium     Formal            Curtains, bed linens, table linens, draperies        Yes              Machine-wash

                      Satin           Medium to heavy     Formal            Draperies, curtains, pillows, bed linens, Roman      Yes              Machine-wash
                                                                            shades, upholsteries, slipcovers                                      or dry-clean

                      Shantung        Light to medium     Formal            Draperies, curtains                                  Yes              Dry-clean

                      Suede cloth     Heavy               Formal/informal   Cushions, draperies, upholsteries, slipcovers        Yes              Dry-clean

                      Taffeta         Light to medium     Formal            Draperies                                            Yes              Machine-wash
                                                                                                                                                  or dry-clean

                      Velvet          Medium to heavy     Formal            Draperies, upholsteries                              No               Dry-clean

                      Voile           Light               Informal          Curtains, under curtains, balloon shades             No               Machine-wash

                                                                                                                                               Decorating Basics ■ 15

   001-057_11989.indd 15                                                                                                                                           5/21/09 3:35:20 PM

ects :14 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:15

         ■ Selecting Paint
         Interior paints are either water based (latex) or oil                                            Always purchase a good primer to coat surfaces
         based. Latex paint is easy to apply and clean up and                                        before painting. Primer is designed to bond well to a
         suitable for nearly every interior application. Oil                                         bare surface and creates a durable base that keeps the
         based paints sometimes create a smoother finished                                           finish coat from cracking or peeling. When using deep
         surface but also require longer drying times and                                            colors, use a tinted primer to reduce the number of
         harsh solvents for clean up. For small projects such                                        coats necessary for good coverage. Ask your retailer to
         as stenciling or detailing and for some faux finishes,                                      help you find the best tint for your project.
         you may also use specialty craft paints, which are
         generally water based.
              Choosing a quality paint will save you time in
         extra coats now and in repairs and repainting in the
         future. Because quality paint is more durable and
         washable, the pigments will remain bright, even when
         scrubbed or washed repeatedly. Paint coverage for
         quality paints should be about 400 square feet per
         gallon. Bargain paints may required two or even three
         coats to cover the same area as quality paints. Paint
         prices are usually an accurate reflection of quality.
         As a general rule, buy the best paint your budget
         can afford.

               Estimating How Much
               Paint to Buy ▸

               1) Length of wall or ceiling (feet)
               2) Height of wall, or width of ceiling                 ×
               3) Surface area                                        =
               4) Coverage per gallon of chosen paint                 ÷
               5) Gallons of paint needed                             =
                                                                                                     Quality paint lasts longer, covers beautifully, and will usually
                                                                                                     end up costing less than bargain paints in the long run.

               Types of Paint ▸

               Paint                           Characteristics & Applications

               Flat latex                      No sheen; for walls and ceilings
               Satin latex                     Low sheen; for walls, ceilings, trim
               Semigloss latex                 Slightly glossy sheen; for walls and trim; durable
               High-gloss latex                Reflective sheen; for doors, cabinets, trim; washable; durable
               Satin-enamel latex              Low sheen; smooth, hard finish; for trim and furniture
               Gloss-enamel latex              Very glossy; smooth, hard finish; for trim and furniture
               Oil-based enamels               Very glossy sheen; smooth, hard finish; for trim and furniture

    16 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 16 5/21/09 3:35:20 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:16

                ■ Selecting Trim
                Before you design your new trim project, choose
                the style of molding that is most appropriate for
                your overall home decor. Balance and scale, existing
                furnishings, and the applied finish will all change
                the effect your project has on the room. To narrow
                                                                                                                       Crown molding
                down your style options, focus on the overall result
                you’d like to achieve in the room—is your style
                simple and modern, formal and decorative, or classic
                                                                                             Picture rail
                and streamlined?
                    Scale, the size of an object in relation to its
                surroundings, is a very important consideration in trim
                selection. Moldings that are too large or small might
                not impact a room the way you had planned. Moldings
                that are well balanced create a sense of stability and
                proportionality. For example, if you have tall base
                moldings, the crown or cornice treatment should be
                similar in scale or the room will feel imbalanced.

                      Playing with Scale ▸
                                                                                                   Casing

                                                                                            Chair rail

                                                                                        Baseboard

                      Generally, our eyes do not like surprises when it                                  Base shoe
                      comes to scale. However, it is possible to create
                      effective illusions by violating the normal rules of
                      proportional scale. For example, the elaborate crown
                      detail shown here makes this standard-height room
                      appear to have a taller ceiling. But use caution—if
                      not handled graciously, the trick can backfire and     The style of trim in this example is well balanced. The
                      make your room feel cluttered.                         individual elements are similar in color and molding profile and
                                                                             do not overpower each other with strong differences in size.

                                                                                                                                Decorating Basics ■ 17

   001-057_11989.indd 17                                                                                                                            5/21/09 3:35:26 PM

ects :16 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:17

         Using Décor to Create Atmosphere

         A    good way to define parameters for color, pattern,
              and material decisions is to establish the
         atmosphere or mood you’d like your room to take on. A
                                                                            clean, crisp, and cheery will look very different from
                                                                            a kitchen described as rich, warm, mellow, cozy,
                                                                            and traditional.
         good way to start is to list five words that describe how               Return to your chosen descriptive words
         you’d like your newly decorated room to look and feel.             throughout your decorating process, as you decide on
         These words can evoke instincts about color, fabric                projects, materials, finishes, fabrics, and techniques.
         patterns, texture, furniture styles, and woodwork. For             Remember that each decision in the design process is
         example, a kitchen that is described as sunny, bright,             completely up to you—so have fun and express yourself!

         This neutral, related scheme of blues, grays, and tans is warmed up by adding a subtle yellow tone: notice the warmed wall
         color, brown throw pillows, and yellow hues in the dresser. Neutral schemes and cool colors are known for being restful and good
         choices for bedrooms. The white accents allude to a fresh and clean space. All of this surely results in sweet dreams!

    18 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 18 5/21/09 3:35:32 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:18

                ■ Decorating Schemes

                Bold schemes are created with high-contrast tones, such           Subtle schemes are restful and open, often using subdued
                as whites and blacks, and complementary colors. Hard-             complementary colors. They often include a careful balance of
                edged geometric patterns and dark walls also contribute to        warm- and cool-toned elements. Subtle schemes are always a
                these striking designs. Bold schemes work especially well in      safe choice and are appropriate for any room in your home.
                entryways and foyers and can also be appropriate in kitchens
                and living rooms.

                Cheerful schemes are created by using light, saturated colors     Tranquil schemes use cool related colors with low contrast.
                that make the room seem larger. To maintain an open feeling,      To unify the room, use coordinating patterns that repeat the
                use low-contrast, pastel furnishings and minimal window           color scheme in draperies, artwork, rugs, and other accents.
                treatments for maximum sunlight. Multiple patterns can be         Use a tranquil scheme in rooms that serve as relaxing retreats,
                combined to great success in a cheerful scheme; this style        such as bedrooms, bathrooms, sunrooms, or living areas.
                works well in any frequently used room and in children’s rooms.

                                                                                                                                              (continued)

                                                                                                                                     Decorating Basics ■ 19

   001-057_C51711.indd 19                                                                                                                                 6/3/09 10:48:8 AM

ects :18 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:19

         Formal schemes use rich fabrics and classically detailed furniture and window treatments. To create a more intimate atmosphere,
         choose a rich, dark color for the walls. Guest bedrooms, dining rooms, powder rooms, and parlors are all well suited for a formal
         decorating scheme.

         Natural schemes use neutral colors and fabrics, well-chosen accents and earthy textures. Often, the warmth of brown tones is
         balanced with light cool colors, such as blue and gray. Libraries, family rooms, and bedrooms often feature a natural scheme.

    20 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_C51711.indd 20 6/3/09 10:48:30 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:20

                      Guidelines for Creating a Décor Scheme ▸
                      Atmosphere             Suggested Colors              Fabrics & Textures                          Projects to Consider
                      Key Words

                      Cheerful               Bright, clear colors: pink,   Bold florals, geometric                     Tiling backsplash, painting polka dots, applying
                                             yellow, blue, green,          or combination patterns,                    sticker art, button-tufting cushion, making
                                             orange                        lightweight cotton blends,                  tab curtains
                                                                           sateens, laces

                      Comfortable,           Autumn colors: rust,          Smooth to lightly textured                  Installing wood shelves, installing carpet
                      casual                 tan, gold                     finishes, sheers, polished                  squares, making chair slipcovers, making
                                                                           cottons, sateens, casements                 draped window treatments

                      Conservative,          Light colors, warm tones:     Woven fabrics, nubby                        Installing wainscot panels, trimming
                      clean & neat,          white, mauve, peach,          textures, all-over prints,                  wall openings, applying faux grasscloth,
                      tidy, crisp            ecru, maize                   sheer linens, cottons,                      making an upholstered ottoman, making
                                                                           suede cloths                                upholstered valances

                      Contemporary           Neutral tones: beige, gray,   Textured or smooth fabrics:                 Applying veneer plaster, hanging glass
                                             ivory, cream                  simple designs, solids,                     shelves, applying a faux stainless steel finish,
                                                                           casements                                   making a photo montage table, making
                                                                                                                       tent-flap curtains

                      Cozy, restful          Soft to medium shades:        Softly padded or quilted                    Applying color-blended bands, upholstering
                                             blue, mauve, green            fabrics, inviting prints:                   walls, paneling a ceiling, making an
                                                                           sheers, percales,                           upholstered headboard, making a scarf swag
                                                                           sateens, broadcloths

                      Elegant, refined       Dark, rich colors: taupe,     Shiny fabrics or fabrics with               Installing crown molding, applying a
                                             gold metallic, ecru—and       sheen: silks, antique satins,               wallcovering panel, applying faux-serpentine
                                             clean neutral accents         moirés, decorative trims                    finish, aluminum roll gilding, wood graining
                                                                                                                       mahogany, making a cloud shade

                      Practical              Multi-colors, medium          Washable or stain-resistant                 Installing a basement window casing, hanging
                                             shades: red, blue, orange     fabrics, over-all prints:                   pictures and mirrors, installing a bifold door,
                                                                           sheetings, cotton blends                    painting wood floors, painting a furniture piece,
                                                                                                                       making rod-pocket curtains

                      Romantic               Fresh colors: pastel          Sensory fabrics with texture                Installing decorative wallboard panels, installing
                                             pink, blue, green, ivory;     or elegant prints, florals,                 a built-up cornice, installing two-color meshing,
                                             clean white                   laces, eyelets                              stenciling a floor, making a butterfly shade,
                                                                                                                       making tietop curtains

                      Tailored, masculine    Earth tones, rich colors:     Geometrics, plaids, stirpes:                Creating architectural detail with wallboard,
                                             rust, brown, intense blue     upholstery fabrics, tapestries              applying veneer plaster, installing a tiled
                                             and green                                                                 fireplace surround, installing a decorative
                                                                                                                       door header, creating a faux leather tabletop,
                                                                                                                       making a buttoned valance

                      Traditional, classic   Reliable colors: green,       Timeless fabrics: antique                   Installing wainscot frames, installing a chair
                                             white, blue, burgundy         satins, jacquards,                          rail, painting stripes, applying built-up cabinet
                                                                           matelasses, linens, velvets                 molding, making reversible seat slipcovers,
                                                                                                                       painting radiators, making roller shades,
                                                                                                                       making bias swags

                                                                                                                                                       Decorating Basics ■ 21

   001-057_11989.indd 21                                                                                                                                                    5/21/09 3:36:21 PM

ects :20 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:21

         Discovering Your Style

         E   ven after you’ve assessed the needs of your room,
             planned out your projects, and established the
         atmosphere you’d like to create, the most important
                                                                           flip through the pages, ask yourself the same type
                                                                           of questions you asked at the furniture stores and
                                                                           websites. Take note of your responses and look for
         factor in your home décor may still be a mystery—your             common threads.
         personal decorating style. Focusing on one general                     Creating a collage is one of the best exercises to
         decorating style throughout your home will unify your             kick off a decorating project. Just find some decorating
         décor from room to room and will help guide many                  magazines and cut out images that appeal to you—it
         steps in the decision-making process.                             doesn’t matter what they are or why you like them.
              There are several ways to discover your style.               The only criteria is that the images strongly appeal to
         The first and least expensive is to go to furniture               you. Once you’ve collected several images, paste them
         stores—both online and brick-and-mortar. What                     together in a collage (poster board works well as a
         rooms attract you? What repels you? Do you prefer                 base). When making your collage, don’t think or plan
         florals and ruffles or glass and chrome? What do                  too much. Discovering the information hidden inside
         the rooms you like have in common? The rooms                      the images you’ve selected is what you’re after and
         you dislike? As you look around, take notes and                   that only happens when you leave structured thought
         make sketches.                                                    behind and play with the possibilities. Eventually,
              Looking at magazines and decorating books                    patterns will emerge, revealing your favorite colors,
         is another great way to discover your style. As you               shapes, and textures.

         Collect design magazines, color swatches, photographs that inspire you, travel books, favorite fabrics, and photographs of
         treasured furniture pieces or decorative accents to kick off your design challenge.

    22 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 22 5/21/09 3:36:22 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:22

                      What’s Your Decorating Style? ▸
                                          To take this quiz, check the answers that appeal to you most, then count the number of As,
                                          Bs, Cs, and Ds you have. Finally, consult pages 24 and 25 to find out what decorating style
                                          best suits you.

                                          1.   What words best describe the exterior        7.      Which of these do you prefer?
                                               of your home?                                        A.   Streamlined shapes with
                                               A.   Angular and dramatic                                 simple details
                            Minimalist
                                               B.   Traditional and elegant                         B.   Button-tufting, nail-head
                                               C.   Simple and adaptable                                 trim, fringe
                                               D.   Reflects its setting                            C.   The more details the better
                                          2.   Which of these descriptions most                     D.   Homespun or
                                               closely matches the interior of                           handcrafted accessories
                                               your home?                                   8.      When it comes to art, what would you
                                               A.   Streamlined rooms filled with                   choose first?
                                                    straight lines and angles                       A.   Modern or contemporary art
                                               B.   Cozy rooms accented with                        B.   Botanicals, landscapes, and still-
                             Romantic               detailed moldings and trim                           life paintings
                                               C.   Rooms filled with a wide variety of             C.   Mementos and items of
                                                    colors and shapes                                    personal interest
                                               D.   The style is closely tied to the                D.   Wildlife art or pieces with themes
                                                    exterior architecture                                related to nature
                                          3.   What textures appeal to you most?            9.      What type of materials would you
                                               A.   Flat matte or shiny surfaces                    most like to live with?
                                               B.   Smooth surfaces with rich patinas               A.   Metal, stone, and glass
                                               C.   Some of everything                              B.   Painted and stained wood,
                                               D.   Natural textures such as rough-                      burnished metal, such as polished
                           Contemporary             hewn wood, sisal, or terra cotta                     brass or nickel
                                          4.   What type of fabrics do you prefer?                  C.   Distressed paint and patina
                                               A.   Textured fabrics in solid colors                     on metals
                                               B.   Chintzes and brocades                           D.   Terra cotta, rough plaster,
                                               C.   A little of everything                               and natural materials, such
                                               D.   Hand woven with dramatic colors                      as bamboo
                                          5.   What color combinations do you prefer?       10. The perfect window treatment is:
                                               A.   Muted or monochromatic with                     A.   Nothing at all or the simplest
                                                    dramatic accents                                     possible shades or blinds
                                               B.   The colors of a garden                          B.   Formal draperies with valances
                              Theme
                                               C.   Anything goes                                        and swags
                                               D.   Bright, cheerful colors                         C.   Layers of fabric with details galore
                                          6.   What details draw you to an                          D.   Simple shutters or flat
                                               upholstered piece?                                        fabric panels
                                               A.   Clean, spare lines
                                               B.   Luxurious fabrics and                   Total
                                                    elaborate trim                                  A=
                                               C.   You never can tell what might                   B=
                                                    strike my fancy                                 C=
                              Formal           D.   A dominant theme or motif                       D=

                                                                                                                                 Decorating Basics ■ 23

   001-057_11989.indd 23                                                                                                                             5/21/09 3:36:29 PM

ects :22 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:23

         ■ Decorating Style Quiz Results
         IF YOU CHECKED MOSTLY As, YOUR STYLE
         IS LIKELY TO BE CONTEMPORARY.
         Contemporary styles are based on furnishings
         developed from 1900 to the present. Contemporary-
         style homes embrace the Arts and Crafts, Art Deco,
         and Art Nouveau movements, as well as Asian, retro,
         and modern influences. Upholstered pieces have
         minimal seams and no adornments (such as tufting or
         buttons) for a streamlined look. Rooms are filled with
         straight lines and simple angles and typically include
         natural materials, such as wood, stone, metal, and
         glass. Color schemes tend to be muted or neutral. A
         limited amount of bright color is used as an accent. A
         few vintage pieces or natural elements, such as plants
         or trees, soften the angles and often strengthen the
         overall impact of the decor.

         IF YOU CHECKED MOSTLY Bs, ROMANTIC
         STYLES ARE YOUR CUP OF TEA.
         Romantic-style homes focus on the types of
         furnishings and accessories developed before 1900.
         This style includes Traditional, Victorian, and Country.
         Furnishings in these homes tend to include pieces
         upholstered with luxurious fabrics and elaborate trim.
         Rolled arms and kick pleats abound. So do the colors
         of a garden, detail-painted millwork, and carefully
         selected accessories. Window treatments typically
         include layers of fabrics and lots of details.

    24 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_C51711.indd 24 6/3/09 10:49:24 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:24

                IF YOU CHECKED MOSTLY Cs, OR YOUR
                ANSWERS ARE EVENLY DIVIDED AMONG
                THE CHOICES, ECLECTIC MAY BE THE WAY
                TO GO.
                Eclectic homes are the style equivalent of wearing
                your heart on your sleeve. They’re a mix of period
                styles and personal mementoes. Many people refer
                to this style as Bohemian. Eclectic does not mean
                hodgepodge or Grandmother’s attic. Every piece needs
                to be deliberately selected and carefully displayed
                to contribute to the whole. Although eclectic types
                generally follow no style rules but their own, they
                understand the value of editing their choices to
                create the best possible mix of styles, shapes, colors,
                and textures.

                IF YOU CHECKED MOSTLY Ds, A THEMED
                STYLE IS LIKELY TO SUIT YOU.
                Themed-style homes reflect a specific aspect of their
                environment or architecture. Southwestern, tropical,
                and rustic homes are examples of environmental
                theme styles. For example, an adobe house with a red
                tile roof calls out to be filled with rough textures, earth
                tones, handwoven fabrics, and the colors of the desert.
                Architectural themes are most successful if derived
                from the era in which your home was built. Some
                styles include Vintage, Antique, and the Old West.
                Every detail should relate back to this era—from trim
                moldings to rugs and sofas to lighting. It’s important
                that the interiors of themed-style homes complement
                the exteriors and vice versa.

                                                                                                                     Decorating Basics ■ 25

   001-057_11989.indd 25                                                                                                                 5/21/09 3:36:45 PM

ects :24 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:25

         Sewing Techniques

         H   ome décor sewing requires many techniques,
             from matching and cutting fabric to stitching
         seams, ruffles, welting, and hems—both by hand
                                                                              and with a sewing machine. Before you get started,
                                                                              familiarize yourself with these simple techniques, and
                                                                              gather the supplies shown on page 52.

         ■ Preparing Fabric
         Before you begin, pre shrink your fabric, lining,                    3. Press dried fabric to eliminate wrinkles.
         zippers, and trims so the finished project won’t shrink              4. If fabric can’t be laundered, steam to preshrink it
         later. Launder everything as you intend to launder the                  or have it dry-cleaned. To preshrink with steam,
         finished item.                                                          first steam-press a small scrap to test for damage.
         1. Check care instructions printed on the end of the                    Dampen the fabric and press on the wrong side
              fabric bolt before you launder. Machine-washing                    until the water evaporates.
              may remove sizing and other finishes that enhance               5. If fabric is identical on both sides, choose one side
              the fabric’s beauty and performance. Many                          as the right side and mark the wrong side so you
              upholstery fabrics should not be laundered.                        won’t confuse the sides when sewing.
         2. If care instructions aren’t available, launder a 6"               6. Trim selvages before or after seaming or before
              square. Remove it from the dryer, press, and measure.              hemming sides. Do not use the selvage as an edge.
              Is it still a 6" square? Did it fade, ravel, or visibly lose    7. Find the straight grain and straighten the cut
              its finish? If the results are good, preshrink the entire          ends, using a carpenter’s square or T-square. Align
              length of fabric the same way. If fabric ravels, zigzag-           one side of the ruler with the selvage and mark
              stitch the cut edges before laundering.                            the perpendicular side with tailor’s chalk.

         ■ Cutting & Matching Fabric
         Work on a large, flat surface so you can lay the fabric              the top of the fabric and place all pattern pieces or
         straight and smooth. For most home décor projects,                   cut all measured pieces in the same direction. For
         the fabric is cut in a single layer, with the right                  professional results, always match the pattern of
         side up. This layout makes it easy to position and                   a fabric at the seam lines. Extra yardage is usually
         match design motifs. If fabric is directional, mark                  needed in order to match the pattern.

                                                                C

                                                         B

                              A

         To calculate the amount of fabric you’ll need, multiply              To match patterned fabric, position fabric widths right sides
         the cut length by the number of fabric widths required for your      together, matching selvages. Fold selvage back at one end until
         project, and then add one pattern repeat. The pattern repeat         pattern matches. Press the foldline, and then pin and stitch on
         is the lengthwise distance of one distinctive point on the           the foldline. Trim fabric to finished length (inset).
         pattern. This will be the total length in inches. Divide by 36" to
         determine the number of yards required.

    26 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_C51711.indd 26 6/3/09 10:50:3 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:26

                ■ Machine Stitching
                Most home decorating sewing can be done entirely                    When tension is perfectly balanced, the stitches
                by machine with a straight or zigzag stitch. Although               look even on both sides of the fabric because they
                machines vary in capabilities, each has the same basic              link midway between fabric layers. Too-tight tension
                parts and controls. Consult your machine manual to                  will cause seams to pucker; too loose results in
                review threading procedures and to locate the controls              weak seams.
                that operate the principal parts. Also, select the                       Pressure regulates the even feeding of fabric
                appropriate needle and thread for your project’s fabric             layers. If too heavy, the bottom fabric layer gathers,
                to ensure quality stitching, and test your stitching on             causing unevenness. Too-light pressure may cause
                a scrap of fabric before stitching your project. Learn              skipped stitches or crooked stitching lines.
                more about the sewing machine on page 52. There are                      Stitch length is the length of each stitch, and
                a few machine-stitching terms you should know:                      is measured in different scales depending on your
                     Tension is the balance between the upper and                   machine. For normal stitching, set the regulator at
                bobbin threads as they pass through the machine.                    10 to 12 stitches per inch, or the equivalent.

                Straight stitches should link midway between fabric layers          Zigzag stitching is adjusted correctly when the links interlock
                so stitches are the same length on both sides of the fabric.        at the corner of each stitch. Stitches should lie flat.

                ■ Machine Stitching Terms

                Baste stitching is the longest straight     Gathering stitch is done with two rows            Edge stitching is placed on the edge
                stitch on the machine. Some sewing          of baste stitching placed ½" and ¼" from          of a hem or fold. Use a straight-stitch
                machines have a separate built-in           the fabric edge. Loosen tension, use a            foot and straight-stitch needle for
                baste stitch that makes two stitches        heavier bobbin thread, and pull up bobbin         close control.
                to the inch. Use it for speed-basting       thread to form gathers. For long areas of
                straight seams.                             gathers, zigzag over cord, string, or dental
                                                            floss without catching the cord in the
                                                            stitch. Pull up the cord to gather.

                                                                                                                                         Decorating Basics ■ 27

   001-057_11989.indd 27                                                                                                                                     5/21/09 3:36:52 PM

ects :26 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:27

         ■ Gathering Ruffles

         Use a ruffler attachment to make a test strip. Adjust ruffler            Use a shirring foot, designed to lock fullness into every
         to desired fullness. Before ruffling lightweight fabrics, zigzag 3⁄8"    stitch with evenly spaced shirring. Set stitch length according
         from the edge with the widest zigzag to give the ruffler teeth           to fullness desired; the longer the stitch, the greater
         something to grasp.                                                      the fullness.

         ■ How to Attach a Ruffle with a Heading
            1                                                2                                                3

         Hem both edges of the strip to be                Overlock the edge and press ½" to                Place the wrong side of the ruffle
         ruffled with a narrow double hem or              right side. Or, turn and stitch a double         on the right side of the fabric, with the
         overlock rolled hem. Gather the ruffle           ¼" hem on the right side of the edge.            gathering line on the hemline. Stitch
         strip the desired distance from the                                                               the ruffle in place. Allow extra fullness
         upper edge.                                                                                       at corners.

         ■ How to Apply Ribbon
            1                                                                       2

         Mark the trim location, using a marking pen. Use a glue                  Stitch both sides of the ribbon trim in the same direction to
         stick to hold the trim in position.                                      prevent diagonal wrinkles.

    28 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 28 5/21/09 3:37:0 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:28

                ■ How to Miter Corners
                   1                                          2                                                 3

                Place two lengths of trim right sides       Slip-baste the two pieces together               Stitch on the line of the slip basting
                together and edges even. Fold the top       on the diagonal fold. Unfold the trim.           on the wrong side. Trim the seams, and
                trim at a right angle to form a diagonal                                                     finish the edges.
                at the corner, and then press.

                ■ Hand Stitching
                Almost all home decorating sewing can be done on the machine, but sometimes hand stitching is necessary.
                Closing seam openings on pillows, attaching trims, and finishing hems are tasks that may require delicate
                hand sewing.

                Running stitch is a straight stitch used    Slipstitch is a nearly invisible stitch          Blindstitch makes a hem that is
                for temporary basting, easing, gathering,   for hems, seam openings, linings and             inconspicuous from either side. Work
                or stitching seams. Work from right to      trims. Work from right to left, holding          from right to left with the needle
                left, taking several stitches onto the      the folded edge in the left hand. Bring          pointing left. Take a tiny stitch in the
                needle before pulling it through.           the needle up through the fold and pull          body of the fabric, roll hem edge back
                                                            the thread through. Then, take a tiny            slightly, and take the next stitch in the
                                                            stitch in the body of the fabric, directly       underside of the hem every 1⁄4 to 1⁄2". Do
                                                            opposite the point where the thread              not pull the thread too tightly.
                                                            came out. Stitch every ¼".

                                                                                                                                        Decorating Basics ■ 29

   001-057_11989.indd 29                                                                                                                                    5/21/09 3:37:11 PM

ects :28 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:29

         ■ How to Sew a Simple Casing
         A casing, or rod pocket, is the hem along the upper edge of a curtain or valance. The curtain rod is inserted
         through the casing so that the fullness of the curtain falls into soft gathers.

            1                                            2                                               3

         Determine the rod-pocket depth by             Press under 1⁄2" along the upper cut           Stitch close to the inner folded edge
         loosely pinning a curtain fabric strip        edge of the curtain panel. Fold over           to form the rod pocket, backstitching at
         around the rod. Remove the rod and mea-       again at the rod-pocket depth and press.       both ends. If desired, stitch again close to
         sure the distance from the top of the strip                                                  the upper edge to create a sharp crease
         to the pin. Add 1⁄2" to be turned under.                                                     appropriate for flat or oval curtain rods.

         ■ How to Sew Double-fold Hems
         Double-fold hems are the most common hem for home decorating projects. Insert drapery weights to help
         curtains and draperies hang nicely.

            1                                            2                                               3

         Turn a scant 3" to the wrong side on          Turn a scant 1" to the wrong side for          Press the side hems in place. When
         the lower edge of the curtain. Pin along      the side hems. Pin and press. Fold under       the hems have been pressed, finish
         the cut edge. Press fold. Turn under          another 1". Pin and press. Tack weights        them with straight stitching, machine
         another 3", pin, and press in place.          inside the second fold at the side             blindstitching, or fusible web.
         Finish the lower hem using one of the         corners, if desired.
         methods below.

    30 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_C51711.indd 30 6/3/09 10:50:23 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:30

                ■ Basic Seams
                All seams in home decorating projects are 1⁄2" unless otherwise specified. To secure seams, backstitch at each end.

                Plain seams are suitable for almost     French seams eliminate raw edges in            Interlocking fell seams completely
                every fabric and sewing application     exposed seams. Use whenever a seam             enclose raw edges. Sew on the wrong
                when you plan to enclose the seam       is visible on the wrong side or will be        side of the fabric. Use the narrow
                or cover it with lining.                laundered frequently.                          hemmer attachment (inset) to save time.

                ■ Making Welting
                To make welting, cut fabric strips on the bias for                 The width of the fabric strips will depend on the size
                greater flexibility around curved edges and corners.          of the cording. To determine how wide to cut the strips,
                Strips do not have to be cut on the true bias; strips         wrap a piece of fabric around the cording. Pin it together,
                cut at an angle less than 45° provide the necessary           encasing the cording. Measure this distance and add 1"
                flexibility but require less yardage.                         for seam allowances. Cut fabric strips to this width.

                                                                                                    Seam fabric together as necessary
                                                                                                    for desired length. Fold the fabric strip
                                                                                                    around the cording, wrong sides together,
                                                                                                    matching the raw edges. Using a zipper
                                                                                                    foot, machine-baste close to the cording;
                                                                                                    smooth the cording as you sew, removing
                                                                                                    any twists.

                                                                                                                                  Decorating Basics ■ 31

   001-057_C51711.indd 31                                                                                                                             6/3/09 10:50:52 AM

ects :30 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:31

         ■ Measuring for the Bedroom
         One of the simplest rooms to redecorate is the                        Mattress width and length: Measure across the
         bedroom. Start with fabulous bed linens to set the               top of the bed from edge to edge.
         stage. Easy-care and easy-to-sew fabrics—such as                      Mattress depth: Measure from the top edge to
         polyester/cotton sheeting, sateen, and cotton flannel—           the bottom edge.
         are ideal for bedroom fashions.                                       Full drop: Measure from the top of the mattress
              If you are decorating a guest room, consider luxurious      to ½" above the floor.
         satin, antique linen, and lace fabrics for bed coverings. If          Comforter or duvet drop: Measure from the
         the room has another use—as an office, for example—              top edge of the mattress to 3 to 5" below the bottom
         choose tailored bed linens. Fabrics should be durable,           edge of the mattress.
         machine washable, and crease, wrinkle, and soil resistant.            Dust ruffle: Measure from the top edge of the
              Mattresses have standard sizes, but the depth of the        box spring to ½" above the floor.
         box spring and the mattress and the height of the bed                 Bed pillows: come in standard sizes, but fullness
         frame may vary. Before you begin your project, measure           (loft) varies, so you might want to measure each pillow
         your bed—with the sheets and blankets in place.                  to ensure the best-fitting pillow cover.

                                             Depth
                                                                                                         Full drop
                                                                        Comforter drop

                                                                                            Dust ruffle

               Standard Bed Pillow Sizes ▸
               Name                                                     Size

               Standard                                                 20 × 26"
               Queen                                                    20 × 30"
               King                                                     20 × 40"

    32 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 32 5/21/09 3:37:53 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:32

                ■ Fabric Requirements for Bed Covers
                Bed covers are large, so you usually need to piece         Finished Bed Cover Width = [bed width] + [two
                fabrics—unless you work with sheeting, which is            times desired drop length]
                available in widths of 90 or 120". When piecing, try to
                avoid a center seam. It’s much more attractive to have     Cut Length = [Finished bed cover length] + 4"
                one wide center section with two narrower side sections.
                     Bedspreads and coverlets require only a top fabric.   Cut Width = [Finished bed cover width] + 4"
                Comforter and duvet covers require a top and bottom
                fabric, and comforters also need a layer of batting. The       To determine how many widths of fabric you
                amount of fabric you’ll need depends on the fabric         need, divide the cut width by the fabric width. Round
                width and the size of the bed covering—and on the          up the number.
                pattern repeat, if there is one.
                                                                                To determine the total length of fabric you need
                Finished Bed Cover Length = [bed length] + [desired        to buy, multiply the number of widths you need by the
                drop length] + [12 to 15" for pillow tuck, if desired]     cut length.

                                                                                                                            Decorating Basics ■ 33

   001-057_11989.indd 33                                                                                                                        5/21/09 3:37:54 PM

ects :32 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:33

         Painting & Carpentry Techniques

         B   y mastering a few basic painting and carpentry
             techniques, you can tackle any home decorating
         project in this volume. Whether painting, cutting
                                                                                and attaching trim, or creating snug joints,
                                                                                familiarize yourself with these steps before
                                                                                you begin.

               Paint Safety Tips ▸
               Always wear safety goggles when using chemical strippers or cleaning products, or when painting overhead. Paint fumes
               are often hazardous, so ventilate indoor painting areas by opening doors and windows, and use a fan to move air in and
               out of the room. Wear a respirator to filter vapors if you cannot ventilate a work area adequately. When you’re finished
               with your project, dispose of leftover latex primers and paint safely. Let the container stand uncovered until the paint
               dries completely. In most communities, dried latex paint can be put in the trash, whereas alkyd primers and paint must be
               disposed of as hazardous waste.

               Read label information completely         Pour paint thinner into a clear jar            Make a scaffold to reach ceilings
               before you begin. Chemicals that are      after use. When the solid material             and high spots by running an
               poisonous or flammable are labeled        settles out, pour off the clear thinner        extension plank through the steps
               with warnings and instructions for        and save it to reuse later. Dispose of the     of two stepladders. The plank should
               safe handling.                            sediment as hazardous waste.                   be no more than 12 ft. long. Ladders
                                                                                                        should face away from each other, so
                                                                                                        the steps are on the inside.

               Never stand on the top step, top brace, or utility shelf         Center your weight on the ladder. Move the ladder
               of a stepladder.                                                 often; do not overreach. Keep the ladder in front of you when
                                                                                working. Lean your body against the ladder for balance.

    34 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 34 5/21/09 3:37:58 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:34

                ■ Painting Techniques
                Painting a wall is a simple matter of distributing                      Roll one 2 × 4-foot section at a time, cutting in the
                paint evenly and can be a fun and satisfying                      edges and corners before rolling the main area. Roll the
                process as you watch your room transform before                   area while the areas that have been cut in are still wet,
                your eyes. Try to paint during daylight hours, as                 and start the next section while the edges of the first are
                it’s much easier to see missed areas in natural                   still wet. This technique, called painting to a wet edge,
                light. Use high-quality paint and tools, and work                 keeps lap marks from showing on the finished wall.
                with full brushes and rollers to keep lap marks to
                a minimum.
                     When painting bare drywall or plaster, apply a
                coat of primer to the entire project area and let it                   Tools & Materials ▸
                dry before applying the paint. When applying dark
                or deep colors, (especially reds), ask your dealer to                  Paint
                tint the primer to match the paint; tinted primer                      3" paintbrush
                reduces the number of paint coats required for                         Paint roller and tray
                full coverage.

                Paint surfaces in small sections, working from dry areas back into wet paint to avoid roller marks.

                                                                                                                                     Decorating Basics ■ 35

   001-057_C51711.indd 35                                                                                                                                6/3/09 10:51:15 AM

ects :34 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:35

         ■ How to Paint a Wall
            1                                                                2

         Stir the paint using a variable-speed drill and paint-mixing      Cut in the edges of a 2 × 4-ft. section of the first wall using
         bit. Set the drill on a low speed and keep the head of the bit    the narrow edge of a paintbrush. Press down just enough to
         in the paint until it completely stops turning. Paint separates   flex the bristles. Use long, slow strokes, and paint from dry
         quickly, so stir it thoroughly from time to time.                 areas back into wet paint.

            3                                                                4

         Cut in any corners in the section using the wide edge of          Use a roller loaded with paint to make a diagonal sweep
         the paintbrush or a specialty corner roller.                      about 4 ft. long on the wall. Roll upward on the first stroke to
                                                                           avoid spilling paint. Roll slowly to avoid splattering.

    36 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 36 5/21/09 3:38:8 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:36

                   5                                                                6

                Draw the roller straight down from the top of the diagonal        Roll back and forth across the section to smooth the area.
                sweep. Shift the roller to the beginning of the diagonal stroke   Lightly draw the roller down the section from top to bottom.
                and roll upward to complete the unloading of the roller.          Lift the roller and start again at the top after each stroke.
                                                                                  Finally, slide the roller cover slightly off of the roller frame and
                                                                                  roll the cut-in areas to minimize brush marks.

                   7                                                                   Paint Color Consistency ▸

                                                                                       Paint, especially custom-mixed paint, can vary
                                                                                       a tiny bit from one can to another. If using more than
                                                                                       one bucket for your project, this may result in slight
                                                                                       variations between paint colors from wall to wall. To
                Cut in and roll the section directly next to the first one.            avoid this common problem, mix the cans together
                Continue with adjacent areas, cutting in and rolling the top           in a large pail and stir it thoroughly before you begin.
                sections before the bottom sections. Roll all finish strokes           This technique is called boxing.
                toward the floor.

                                                                                                                                       Decorating Basics ■ 37

   001-057_11989.indd 37                                                                                                                                   5/21/09 3:38:14 PM

ects :36 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:37

         ■ Painting Trim Moldings
         Although you will need to apply a final topcoat after
         trim is installed, always prime and paint trim before                 Tools & Materials ▸
         installation. First, prime your trimwork on both sides
         to seal the piece, balancing the wood movement from                   Paintbrush                       Small paint roller
         humidity and temperature changes. After the primer is                 Paint                            Mineral spirits
         dry, apply two finish coats to the face. After the finish             Cut bucket                         or warm water
         coats are dry, install the molding and fill in gaps in                Paint additive
         joints and fastener holes. The final step is to apply a
         touchup coat to the filler areas.
              Use a high-quality brush to paint trimwork.
         Straightedge brushes around 2" are the tool                           Using Additives ▸
         of choice for many professional painters when
         painting moldings. If bristle marks are a concern,
         consider putting an additive in the paint. Paint
         additives thin the paint without affecting its
         durability or sheen. The end result is a paint that
         flows on smoother and lays out flatter when dry.
         Using an additive may require that you apply at
         least one additional coat.
              After each coat of primer or paint is applied,
         carefully inspect each piece for drips or clots.                                          Cut bucket
         These problems need to be dealt with immediately,
         or they will mirror through the final coat.
         Remember that multiple thin layers of paint look
                                                                               Pour a paint additive into the mix to reduce brush
         better and last longer than one heavy coat. Heavy                     marks on the finished product. A cut bucket like the
         paint layers will also hide any intricate details or                  one above is easier to handle than a gallon pail and
         crisp edging and could possibly make installation                     creates a convenient way to mix the products.
         more difficult.

         This baseboard has a very different appearance when it is painted. The finish you choose will alter the cost of your project
         as well.

    38 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 38 5/21/09 3:38:21 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:38

                ■ Painting Trim Moldings

                Dip the brush into the paint, loading one-third to one-half          Paint moldings with thin, even coats starting along the
                of its bristle length. Tap the bristles against the inside of the    deeper grooves of the trim, and moving on to the smooth
                can to remove excess paint. Do not drag the bristles against         areas. This sequence will minimize drips into the detail of
                the top edge, or rub them against the lip of a one-gallon can.       the molding.

                Use a small paint roller to coat long, straight strips of trim       Clean the brush with mineral spirits when using oil-based
                material. Rollers make for fast work and don’t leave brush           paint, or with warm water when using water-based. Shake out
                marks. If the paint is too thick or you roll too quickly, however,   the brush and let it dry. Always start subsequent coats with a
                the roller can create an orange peel effect that you may not like.   clean, dry brush.

                                                                                                                                         Decorating Basics ■ 39

   001-057_C51711.indd 39                                                                                                                                    6/3/09 10:51:48 AM

ects :38 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:39

         ■ Clear-coating Trim Moldings
         Water-based and oil-based finishes have a few basic
         differences in application and end result that you           Tools & Materials ▸
         should be aware of so that you can make the best
         decision about which product is right for you.               Bristle brush               Drop cloth or cardboard
              Not long ago, oil-based polyurethanes were                 or foam brush            Sawhorses
         regarded as much more durable and capable of                 Latex gloves                Trim material
         providing more even coverage than water-based                Stir sticks                 Polyurethane
         products. Today, this is not always the case. The            Paint can opener            Stain (optional)
         major differences between modern oil and water
         urethanes are not related to finish quality as much
         as to secondary (but important) characteristics such
         as odor, finish appearance, and drying times. The
         durability of water-based products is no longer an
         issue. In fact, the most durable urethanes available
         are water based.
              Oil products emit fumes during drying that
         can linger for weeks. Pregnant women and young
         children should avoid these fumes altogether.
         Water-based products create minimal fumes, and
         are not dangerous under normal conditions with
         adequate ventilation.
              According to most manufacturers, water-based
         products dry faster than oil varieties. This literally
         means less time spent between coats. Water-based
         urethanes also clean up with soap and warm water,
         rather than with mineral spirits. Easy clean-up can
         come in handy for large spills.
              The biggest factor to consider when choosing a
         type of polyurethane is finish appearance. Although
         water-based products offer many more conveniences
         than oil, the end results can be quite different. When
         oil-based urethanes are applied, they add a warm
         amber color to trimwork that creates more visual
         depth and variety.
              Water-based products dry crystal clear. The color
         of the trim before the product is applied is similar
         to the finished product. Only a light color change
         appears. Keep in mind that most of the clear-finished
         trim in an older house is oil based and water-based
         finishes will not match.
              The following examples run through the steps
         of successful clear-coat finishing. These steps are
         a guideline to finishing only. Always follow the
         manufacturer’s specific application directions.
         Drying times will vary, depending on temperature
         and humidity.
                                                                  Arts and Crafts Style trimwork is normally stained rather
                                                                  than painted to show off the grain detail of quartersawn
                                                                  white oak.

    40 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 40 5/21/09 3:38:30 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:40

                ■ How to Apply a Clear Finish to Trim Moldings
                   1                                                                 2

                Set up the work station area with a drop cloth or sheet           Sand each piece as necessary, finishing with a fine-grit
                of cardboard on the floor and two sawhorses. Place the trim       paper. Wipe the moldings with a clean, dry cloth to remove any
                pieces to be finished on the horses. Inspect each piece for       leftover dust.
                large blemishes or flaws, repairing any large splinters.

                   3                                          4                                               5

                Apply a coat of stain, if desired, to       Apply the first thin coat of polyure-          Lightly sand the entire surface with
                the moldings with a foam or bristle         thane with a brush. Stir the polyurethane      220-grit sandpaper after the finish has
                brush. For more even coverage of            frequently before you begin, between           dried. This will ensure a smooth finish
                the stain, apply a pre-stain wood           coats, and during application. Let the         with a strong bond between layers. If
                conditioner. Follow the manufacturer’s      finish dry for four to six hours.              the sandpaper gums up quickly, the
                instructions for stain drying time, and                                                    moldings need more time to dry. Use a
                remove the excess with a clean rag. Let                                                    clean, dry rag to remove dust.
                the stain dry sufficiently.

                                                                                                                                               (continued)

                                                                                                                                      Decorating Basics ■ 41

   001-057_11989.indd 41                                                                                                                                  5/21/09 3:38:51 PM

ects :40 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:41

            6                                                                    7

         Apply a second layer of polyurethane. Check each piece                Lightly sand the entire surface of the moldings with
         for skipped areas and heavy drips of urethane. These areas            220-grit sandpaper after they have dried for four to six hours.
         need to be corrected as soon as possible or they may show
         through the final coat.

            8

         Apply a third and final coat of polyurethane to the moldings. Keep the third coat very thin, using only the tip of the brush to
         apply it. Lightly drag the tip across the molding on the flat areas. If the moldings have deep grooves or intricate details, skip these
         areas; two coats will be sufficient. Try to maintain constant pressure and avoid smashing the brush as this will create air bubbles in
         your finish. Allow the moldings to dry for a minimum of 12 hours (check manufacturer’s recommended drying times).

    42 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 42 5/21/09 3:38:59 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:42

                ■ Removing Old Trim
                Damaged trim moldings are an eyesore and a                                sequence used to install it will greatly affect your ability
                potentially dangerous splinter waiting to happen.                         to remove it without cracks or splits. Regardless of
                Removing trim so that it can be reused is not always                      whether or not your trim can be reused, however, take
                easy, especially if you live in a home with intricate                     your time and work patiently when you remove it so as
                moldings. The age of your trim and the nailing                            not to damage the surrounding walls, floor, or ceiling.

                ■ How to Remove Painted Moldings
                   1                                                                        2

                Before removing painted trim, cut along the top seam                      Work the molding away from the wall from one end to
                of the molding and the wall with a utility knife to free the              the other, prying at the nail locations. Apply pressure to the
                molding from any paint buildup on the wall. Cut squarely on               molding with your other hand to help draw it away from the
                the top edge of the molding, being careful not to cut into the            wall. A wide joint compound or putty knife makes a good guard
                wallboard or plaster behind it.                                           to insert bwteen the tool and the wall.

                ■ How to Remove Clear-finish Moldings
                   1                                                                          Removing Nails from Trim ▸

                Remove the molding starting with the base shoe or the
                thinnest piece of trim. Pry off the trim with a flat bar using leverage
                rather than brute force, working from one end to the other. Tap the
                end of the bar with a hammer if necessary to free the trim.

                   2

                                                                                              Extract nails from the moldings using end nips
                Use large flat scraps of wood to protect finished surfaces                    or side cutters. “Roll” the nails out rather than pulling
                from damage. Insert one bar beneath the trim and work                         them straight out. Or use a nail set to drive the nail
                the other between the base and wall. Force the pry bars in                    through the molding from the front (inset).
                opposing directions to draw the molding away from the wall.

                                                                                                                                             Decorating Basics ■ 43

   001-057_11989.indd 43                                                                                                                                          5/21/09 3:39:4 PM

ects :42 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:43

         ■ Planning Trim Installation
         Before you start your project, plan the order, layout, and type of joint at each end of the trim. Measure the
         corners accurately to ensure a snug fit.

                                                                                                         Plan the order of your trim installation to
                                                                                                         minimize the number of difficult cuts on
                                                    1                                                    individual pieces. Use the longest pieces of
                              Butted to wall
                                                                                                         molding for the most visible walls, saving
                        Coped joint                                                                      the shorter ones for less conspicuous
                                                                                                         areas. When possible, place the joints so
                                                                                                         they point away from the direct line of
                                                                                                         sight from the room’s entrance. If a piece
                                                                                            2
                                                                                                         will be coped on one end and mitered on
                    4                                                                                    the other, such as with 3 (left), cut and fit
                                                              Mitered joint                              the coped end first. Also keep in mind the
                                                                                                         nailing points—mark all framing members
                                                                               3                         you’ll be nailing into before starting the
                                                                                                         installation. At a minimum, all trim should
                                                                                                         be nailed at every wall stud, and every
                                                                 5
                                                                                                         ceiling joist, if applicable. Install door and
                        7                                 6
                                                                                                         window casing before installing horizontal
                                                                                                         molding that will butt into it.

         Miter outside corners, cutting each piece at 45°. Use a                   Use the trim piece as a measuring device, marking the
         pattern with mitered ends to help position your workpieces.               cut line directly off the wall. Eliminating the tape measure
         Fasten the first piece of each joint to within 2 ft. of the corner,       reduces errors and makes it easier to visualize the cut.
         leaving some flexibility for making adjustments when you
         install the adjoining piece.

                                                                                                         Draw a reference line off each wall of
                                                                                                         the corner using a straight 1 × 4. Trace
                                                                                                         along each wall, connecting the traced
                                                                                                         lines at a point out from the tip of the
                                                                                                         corner. To find the angle you need to miter
                                                                                                         your moldings, place a T-bevel with the
                                                                                                         handle flush against one wall and adjust
                                                                                                         the blade so that it intersects with the
                                                                                                         point (inset). Lock the blade in place.
                        Reference line parallel to wall

    44 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 44 5/21/09 3:39:12 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:44

                ■ Coped Cuts
                At first glance, coping molding appears to be difficult
                work, but with patience and the right tools coping                          Tools & Materials ▸
                can be mastered by a DIYer. Coping is essentially
                cutting back the body of a trim piece along its profile.                    Molding                           Metal files or rasp set
                This cutting is done at an angle so that only the                           Tape measure                      Pneumatic finish
                face of the molding makes direct contact with the                           Coping saw                          nail gun
                adjoining piece.                                                            Miter saw                         Coping saw

                ■ How to Make a Coped Cut
                   1                                               2                                                3

                Measure, cut, and install the first             Cut the second piece of molding                  Starting with the most delicate edge
                trim piece. Square-cut the ends, butting        at a 45° angle as if it were an inside           of the molding, cut along the front
                them tightly into the room corners,             miter. The cut edge reveals the profile of       edge of the molding with a coping saw,
                and nail the workpiece at the marked            the cope cut.                                    following the contour exactly. Bevel the
                stud locations.                                                                                  cut at 45° to create a sharp edge along
                                                                                                                 the contour.

                   4                                                                        Tip ▸

                                                                                            Trim components such as this chair rail can be
                                                                                            complex to cope properly. A variety of rasps or metal
                Test-fit the piece (inset photo) and use a metal file to fit the            files with different profiles is the key to fitting these
                joint precisely. When the joint is properly fitted, nail the coped          joints tightly.
                piece in place.

                                                                                                                                            Decorating Basics ■ 45

   001-057_11989.indd 45                                                                                                                                        5/21/09 3:39:18 PM

ects :44 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:45

         ■ Mitered Returns
         Mitered returns are a decorative treatment used to
         hide the end grain of wood and provide a finished                            Tools & Materials ▸
         appearance when molding stops prior to the end of a
         wall. Mitered returns range from tiny pieces of base                         Combination square                Pneumatic finish
         shoe up to very large crown moldings.                                        Utility knife                        nail gun
                                                                                      Power miter saw                   Air compressor
                                                                                      Miter box                         Air hose
                                                                                        and backsaw                     T-bevel
                                                                                      Pencil                            Molding
                                                                                      Tape measure                      Wood glue

         ■ How to Cut Mitered Base Shoe Returns
            1                                                                       2

         Measure and mark the molding to length. Adjust the                       Adjust the blade of the miter saw to the opposite 45°
         miter saw blade to 45° and back-miter the molding, cutting               angle and miter-cut the molding using a slow, steady stroke.
         the front edge to the desired overall length of the trim. Nail the
         back-mitered piece in place using a square to line it up flush
         with the edge of the door casing.

            3                                              4

                                                                              Mitered return
                                                                                                                                  Beveled return

                                Mitered return

         Hold the mitered molding against               Check the fit of the return against the            Option: Beveled returns are a quick
         the baseboard at a right angle above the       baseboard. If it is too small repeat step          and simple alternative to mitered
         installed base shoe. Mark the molding          3, making the piece slightly larger. If            returns. They require finish touchups
         at the depth of the installed base shoe.       the return is too large, trim it to fit with       after the trim is installed.
         Square-cut the molding at the cutoff           a utility knife or sandpaper. Once the
         mark. Because making this cut with a           return fits properly, glue it in place with
         power saw is very dangerous, use a             wood glue.
         miter box and a back saw. The cut-off
         piece will be the mitered return piece.

    46 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 46 5/21/09 3:39:26 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:46

                ■ Scarf Joints
                Scarf joints are mitered joints used to join two pieces
                of trim over a long length. This joint should always                      Tools & Materials ▸
                be laid out over a stud location so it can be properly
                fastened. Position scarf joints so they point away from                   Moldings                          Tape measure
                the main entry to the room, which will hide the joint                     Miter saw                         Pneumatic finish
                from view at a quick glance.                                              Wood fence extension                nail gun
                                                                                          Pencil                            Wood glue

                ■ How to Cut a Scarf Joint
                   1                                                                   2

                                                       Bottom
                                                                                                      Bottom
                       Fence extension for
                      cutting crown molding           Piece 1                                           Piece 2              Fence extension
                                                         Top                                               Top
                                                30°                                                                 30°

                Cut the first piece of molding a couple of inches longer             Measure and cut the second piece of trim to length (so
                than its planned length at a 30° angle. This angle should be         it will fall over a stud when installed), leaving the saw set at
                back-beveled or back-mitered so the molding will fit over the        its original 30° angle. Make sure the second piece of molding
                open-cut end of the second piece. If you are cutting crown           is in the same orientation as the first (bottom edge up in
                molding and the molding is taller than the fence of your power       photos above).
                miter saw, attach a wood fence extension to the fence so you
                can position the molding properly on the saw table (see “How
                to Install Wood Crown Molding,” page 120).

                                                                                                                   Glue
                   3           Top             Open bevel                              4
                                                                                            Piece 1
                              Piece 1                                                                             Piece 2

                           Bottom

                                                      Piece 2

                   Back-cut bevel

                Test-fit the scarf joint on the wall (a helper is a great asset      Tack the piece with the open bevel in position and apply
                here). Have one person hold the piece with the open bevel            wood glue (high-tack trim and molding glue are perfect here)
                (piece 2 above) in position while the other person places the        to the open bevel. Reform the scarf joint and tack the back-cut
                piece with the back-cut bevel over it. Check for a tight joint and   piece in position. Finish nailing around the joint, and then work
                then mark the back-cut piece for trimming to final length (if        your way toward each end with the nailer.
                both ends of the run are inside corners, you’ll have to overlap
                the open-cut piece and mark for cutting to length).

                                                                                                                                         Decorating Basics ■ 47

   001-057_11989.indd 47                                                                                                                                     5/21/09 3:39:35 PM

ects :46 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:47

         Home Décor Tools

         T  he decorating projects in this book will require you
            to work with a wide variety of materials, including
         fabric, wallcovering, paint, wood, trim moldings, stain,
                                                                       even your own photographs. Whatever the project,
                                                                       familiarize yourself with the required tools before
                                                                       you begin project preparations for the highest quality
         wallboard, tile, foam padding and polyester batting—          result and easiest application process.

         ■ Essential Home Decorating Tools

         Specialized presser feet for sewing projects increase         A paint-mixing bit attached to a drill can speed up your
         efficiency and prevent a lot of headache. Shown here is a     preparations for painting projects.
         ruffler attachment, which automatically gathers strips of
         light or mediumweight fabric. Refer to your sewing machine
         manufacturer for attachments that may help with your job.

         A stud finder takes the guesswork out of decorating           Keep multiple cleaning products on hand to prepare
         projects, such as hanging pictures and mirrors or attaching   surfaces for decorating projects.
         trim moldings.

    48 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 48 5/21/09 3:39:41 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:48

                ■ Preparation Materials
                As each project in this book will remind you,                  Trisodium phosphate (F): Cleaning agent used for
                preparation is key to a successful project and a                   washing walls before painting or hanging wallpaper.
                professional-quality finish. Always take the time to           Hole-patching kits (G): Sturdy, self-adhesive mesh
                prepare your work area before beginning.                           and backing materials used to repair large holes
                                                                                   in walls.
                Preparation liquids (A): A latex-bonding agent                 Easy-release painter’s tape (H): Tape designed
                   makes plaster repairs more durable; liquid                      for easy and clean removal (does not leave an
                   deglosser dulls glossy surfaces so paint can                    adhesive residue).
                   adhere properly.                                            Spackle (I): A quick-drying drywall compound. Some
                Wallpaper stripper (B): A chemical agent that loosens              types of spackle are pink when wet and turn white
                   wallpaper adhesive so it can be removed easily.                 as they dry, which makes it easy to tell when the
                Pressure sprayer (C): Used to apply wallpaper                      patch is ready to be sanded.
                   stripper over large areas.                                  Self-adhesive seam tape (J): Used to smooth
                Sponges (D): Used to smooth damp joint compound,                   drywall compound over joints and cracks.
                   which reduces the amount of sanding needed later.           Safety equipment (K): Rubber gloves, safety glasses,
                Wood Filler (E): Compound used to fill holes in                    and dust masks or respirators; these are necessary
                   wood. It can be sanded and painted or stained.                  when using strong or caustic chemicals.

                                                                                                   With the help of these tools and
                                                                           C                       materials, project preparation can be
                                A                    B                                             smooth and easy.

                                 D

                                                         E                 F

                                                                   I

                                                                       J

                                    G
                                           H

                                          L                    K

                                                                                                                                 Decorating Basics ■ 49

   001-057_11989.indd 49                                                                                                                             5/21/09 3:39:51 PM

ects :48 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:49

         ■ Sewing Tools

                                        A                                                                                     D

                              B

                                                                      C

                                                                                                               E

         Hand-sewing supplies: A pincushion and pins (A) are an absolute must for any sewing project; a thimble (B) protects your finger
         while hand sewing; a needle threader (C) makes threading machine or hand needles a breeze; select thread (D) appropriate for the
         fabric and sewing method you'll be using; beeswax (E) strengthens thread and prevents tangling.

                     A                                                                               Measuring and marking supplies:
                                                                                    E                A transparent ruler (A), yardstick (B),
                                                                                                     and tape measure (C) are each essential
                                                                                                     tools for various sewing projects; a seam
                               B                D                         F                          gauge (D) helps make quick, accurate
                                                                                                     measurements; a transparent T-square (E)
                                       C
                                                                                                     is used to locate grainlines and measure
                                                                                                     90° angles; marking chalk (F), fabric
                                                                                                     marking pens (G), and narrow masking
                                                                                                     tape (H) can each be used for marking
                                                                                                     fabrics during decorating projects.

                                                                                        G

                                                                              H

    50 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_C51711.indd 50 6/3/09 12:13:10 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:50

                                                                           C

                                                                                                                D

                                              B

                                                                                                                              E

                                              A

                Cutting tools: Bent-handled dressmaker's shears (A) are ideal for cutting fabric shapes; sewing scissors (B) are used for clipping
                threads and seam allowances; seam rippers (C) are used to remove stitches and open buttonholes; rotary cutters (D) are perfect
                for cutting straight lines; pinking shears and pinking rotary cutters (E) cut fabric in zigzag or scalloped patterns and are used to
                finish seams.

                                                                                                                                          E
                                                                                                           C              D
                                          B
                                                                                                                                                         F

                           A
                                                                                                                                                G

                                                                                                                    H

                Other sewing supplies: A steam-spray iron (A) with multiple temperatures accommodates all fabrics; a seam roll (B) is used for
                pressing seams; a point turner (C) safely pokes out stitched corners; glues (D) hold trims or decorative motifs in place; liquid fray
                preventer (E) stiffens fabric and prevents fraying; cutting boards (F) protect your work surface; press cloths (G) or a Teflon-coated
                sole plate guards (H) help prevent iron shine on fabrics.

                                                                                                                                          Decorating Basics ■ 51

   001-057_11989.indd 51                                                                                                                                      5/21/09 3:40:18 PM

ects :50 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:51

         Understanding your sewing machine well will                       who sells your brand—or download one from the
         make fabric decorating projects quick and easy to                 manufacturer’s website.
         complete. The principle parts common to all modern                     If you are buying a new machine, consider how
         sewing machines are shown in the diagrams at                      much and what kind of sewing you expect to do. Talk
         right. The parts may look different on your model,                to friends who sew and to sales personnel. Ask for
         and they may have slightly different locations, so                demonstrations, and sew on a demo machine before you
         refer to your manual as well. If you do not have                  buy. Many dealers also offer free sewing lessons with
         an owner’s manual for your machine, you should                    purchase of a machine as well, which will be geared to
         be able to get one from a sewing machine dealer                   your particular brand and model of sewing machine.

                                                         Bobbin                     Spool pins              Bobbin winder spindle
                                                         winder
                                                         tension

                                                                 Stitch
                                                                pattern
                                       Tension control          selector                               Winder starting lever

                            Tension indicator

          Thread guide & tension discs

                    Light switch                                                                                  Handwheel

                                                                                                              Stitch width selector
                       Take-up lever

                                                                                                              Needle position selector
                    Thread guide

                                                                                                             Buttonhole knob

                                             See detail below
                     Detachable
                     machine bed                                                                         Stitch length selector

                                                                                              Feed dog control

                           Front view                                       Back view

                                    Thread guide
                                                                                Presser foot lifter

                            Needle clamp
                                                   General-purpose
                                                     presser foot
                                                                                                           Thread cutter

                             Bobbin/                                        Throat plate
                           bobbin case
                                                                                                               Feed dogs

    52 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_11989.indd 52 5/21/09 3:40:24 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:52

                                                                                                            The bobbin holds the lower thread that
                               Built-in bobbin case                        Removable bobbin case            locks with the upper thread. Always use
                                                                                                            bobbins in the correct style and size for
                                                                                                            your machine. Bobbin thread tension is
                                                                                                            controlled by a spring on the bobbin case,
                                                                                                            which may be built in or removable.

                                                                                                   B

                                   A                          B                                                     C
                                                                                                                                                         D

                                                                                        B

                A general-purpose foot (A), probably the one you will use the most often, has a wide opening to accommodate the side-to-side
                movement of the needle in all types of utility (nondecorative) stitches. It is also suitable for most straight stitching. A zipper foot
                (B) is used to insert zippers or to stitch any seam that has more bulk on one side than the other. A special-purpose or embroidery
                foot (C) has a grooved bottom that allows the foot to ride smoothly over decorative stitches or raised cords. Some styles are clear
                plastic, allowing you to see your work more clearly. A walking foot (D) feeds top and bottom layers at equal rates, allowing you to
                more easily match patterns or stitch bulky layers, as in quilted projects.

                                                                                                            Sewing machine needles come in a
                                                                                                            variety of styles and sizes. The correct
                                                                                                            needle choice depends mostly on the
                                                                                                            fabric you have selected. Sharp points
                                                                                                            (A), used for woven fabrics, are designed
                                  Shank
                                                                                                            to pierce the fabric. Ballpoints (B) are
                                                                                                            designed to slip between the loops of
                Flat side                                                                                   knit fabric rather than pierce and possibly
                                                                                                            damage the fabric. Universal points (C)
                                Round side
                                                                                                            are designed to work on both woven
                                                                                                            and knit fabrics. The size of the needle is
                                   Shaft                                                                    designated by a number, generally given
                                                                                                            in both American (9, 11, 12, 14, 16, 18)
                                  Groove                                                                    and European (60, 70, 80, 90, 100, 110)
                                                                                                            numbering systems. Use size 11/70 or
                     Scarf                                                                                  12/80 needles for medium-weight fabrics.
                                                                                                            A large number means the needle is
                                                  Eye
                                                                                                            thicker, and that it is appropriate for use
                                   Point                                                                    with heavier fabrics and threads.

                                                                     A             B           C

                                                                                                                                          Decorating Basics ■ 53

   001-057_11989.indd 53                                                                                                                                      5/21/09 3:40:27 PM

ects :52 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:53

         ■ Painting Tools
         When it comes to painting tools, some people                        allow you to paint corners without cutting in the
         prefer disposable tools while other value traditional               edges. Good-quality roller covers create an attractive
         versions. The difference between the two are cost                   finish without leaving fibers in the paint.
         and quality.                                                             Special containers: Large and small containers
              Paintbrushes: All-purpose brushes are made                     simplify large projects. For large projects, some paint
         from a blend of polyester and nylon. Brushes                        manufacturers sell their paint in 5-gallon containers,
         blended with hog or ox bristles should be used only                 so you can paint straight from the container. If the
         with oil-based paints. Your kit should include a 3"                 paint you choose doesn’t come in a container like this,
         straightedged wall brush, 2" straightedged trim                     you may want to buy one. For cutting-in and touchups,
         brush, and tapered sash brush. A good-quality brush                 small, easy-to-hold containers are a good idea.
         has a shaped handle, non-corrosive metal ferrule,                        Paint-mixing bit and drill: Stirring paint
         and several spacer plugs between bristles. Split                    is extremely important. The best way to stir large
         (flagged) and tapered (chiseled) bristle ends make                  amounts of paint is with a drill and special paint-
         clean edges.                                                        mixing bit. These bits are easy to use and clean
              Roller trays: Sturdy trays are a must. Disposable              up quickly.
         pan liners minimize cleanup, but they are not                            Lead test kit: If your home was built before
         substitutes for roller trays.                                       1978, it’s critical that you test paint before cleaning,
              Standard roller frames: Choose a well-                         sanding, or repainting it. Easy-to-use lead test kits are
         balanced frame with nylon bearings and a comfortable                available at home centers, hardware stores, and paint
         handle. Extensions are available for painting ceilings.             retailers everywhere. If the test indicates the presence
              Standard roller covers: Most jobs can be done                  of lead, consult a lead abatement specialist before
         with 3⁄8" synthetic rollers. Special corner roller covers           starting any project.

               Choosing a Paintbrush ▸

                                               Chiseled end

                                               Flagged bristles

                 Spacer plugs

                                                          Hardwood
                                                          handle

                     Reinforced
                     ferrule                            Cutaway view

               A quality brush (left), has a shaped hardwood handle          A 3" straight-edged brush (top) is a good choice for
               and a sturdy reinforced ferrule made of noncorrosive          cutting paint lines at ceilings and in corners. For painting
               metal. Multiple spacer plugs separate the bristles. A         woodwork, a 2" trim brush (middle) works well. Choose
               quality brush has flagged (split) bristles and a chiseled     brushes with chiseled tips for painting in corners. A
               end for precise edging. A cheaper brush (right) will have a   tapered sash brush (bottom) can help when painting
               blunt end, unflagged bristles, and a cardboard spacer plug    corners on window sashes.
               that may soften when wet.

    54 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_C51711.indd 54 6/3/09 2:01:32 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:54

                                                                  Light
                    Roller tray & disposable liner

                                                                         Standard roller cover

                   Standard roller

                                                                                                                                     Specialty container
                                                                              Dual-roller cover
                                                                                                                          Paint & primer

                                                         Detail roller                           Specialty brushes

                                                                                                                                    Stir sticks

                                                                                        Lead-test kit                 Paint-mixing bit & drill
                                                      Paintbrushes

                            Roller frame extension

                Painting tools like these are available at every home improvement center, paint store, and hardware store.

                                                                                                                                          Decorating Basics ■ 55

   001-057_C51711.indd 55                                                                                                                                     6/3/09 12:19:16 PM

ects :54 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:55

         ■ Decorating Tools
         Basic decorating tools like the ones shown here are a                Power sander: Sanders smooth surfaces to be
         must for any burgeoning decorator. Before you begin             painted or decorated.
         your project, check to make sure that you have all the               Screwdriver: Standard screwdrivers—both
         tools you’ll need on hand.                                      slotted and Phillips—are essential. Choose quality
              Carpenter’s or laser level: A carpenter’s level            screwdrivers with hardened-steel blades and easy-
         contains two or more bubble gauges used to check                to-grip handles. Insulated handles protect you from
         the level of work surfaces. A laser level creates level,        electric shock, and oxide-coated tips provide a strong
         square lines on any surface.                                    hold on screw heads.
              Hammer: Designed for driving, setting, and                      Tape measure: A high-quality, retractable steel
         pulling nails, hammers are essential. A 16-ounce,               tape measure will last for decades. Choose a tape that
         curved claw hammer with a high-carbon steel head                has a locking mechanism and a belt clip. Make sure
         and a handle made of hickory, fiberglass, or solid steel        the tape you choose has a standout of at least 7 feet.
         is a practical choice for typical home repairs.                      Stud finder: A stud finder has an indicator that
              Drill: Variable-speed reversing drills are handy           lights up when it passes over a stud.
         for driving and removing screws, nuts, and bolts,                    Awl: An awl is a tool that has a metal shaft with a
         as well as for drilling holes and stirring paint.               sharpened end. It is used to poke holes in drywall and
         For most decorating projects, a medium-voltage                  other surfaces when drilling a pilot hole isn’t necessary.
         cordless drill is a good choice. Look for features                   Nail set: This is a metal shaft with a rounded end
         such as a keyless chuck, adjustable clutch, and                 that is used to drive finish nails below a work surface.
         electronic level.                                                    Drywall knives (putty knives): These knives
              Cordless screwdriver: For small projects,                  have a thin, somewhat flexible blade attached to a
         cordless power screwdrivers are a great alternative             sturdy handle. They are used to spread spackle and
         to standard screwdrivers. These tools come with a               drywall compound and can also be used to scrape
         universal 1⁄4" drive as well as a slotted bit and a #2          away debris before cleaning walls or filling holes.
         Phillips bit. Other bits, such as Torx and square drive,             Razor knife: A razor knife is a sharp, retractable,
         are also available.                                             disposable blade in a sturdy handle.

         ■ How to Use Self-drilling Metal Anchors
            1                                         2                                                3

         Drive the anchor into the wall in          Insert a screw through a rail and               As you drive the screw into the
         between studs. As the threads touch        into the anchor.                                anchor, the metal flange pulls tight
         drywall, slowly tighten the toggle until                                                   against the inside of the wall.
         it’s nearly flush to the wall.

    56 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

001-057_C51711.indd 56 6/3/09 12:20:35 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:56

                                  A   B C     D      E   F G     H                                                  O
                                                                                                                                   P

                                                                                                                                        Q
                                              I      J     K L M N

                  * NOT ACTUAL SIZE                                                           * NOT ACTUAL SIZE

                                                                                                                                Finish sander

                                               Palm sander

                                                                             Stud finder

                                                                                                   Detail sander
                                                                     Tape measures

                           Cordless screwdriver

                                                                                                                   Putty knives
                                                                                              Razor knife
                                             Drill
                                                               Drill bits
                                                                                              Hammer

                                                                                                    Awl

                                                                                          Nail                                                     Level
                                                                                          set
                                                     Drywall knife
                                                                                                                                            Screwdrivers

                These tools are available at every home improvement center, paint store, and hardware store. Scour your garage and closets
                before you buy new tools—you may have many of them in your home already. (Top left): Standard hardware for decorating include
                (A) 10d finish nail, (B) 8d finish nail, (C) 6d finish nail, (D) 4d finish nail, (E) 11⁄4" drywall screw, (F) 3⁄4" drywall screw, (G) 15⁄8" drywall
                screw, (H) 21⁄2" drywall screw, (I/J) toggle bolts, (K) 3⁄4" panhead screw, (L/M) wood screws, (N) 11⁄4" panhead screw. (Top right): (O)
                Toggler SanToggle 1⁄4–20, (P) self-drilling anchor, (Q) self-drilling toggle.

                                                                                                                                                  Decorating Basics ■ 57

   001-057_11989.indd 57                                                                                                                                              5/21/09 3:40:48 PM

ects :56 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:57

058-103_C51711.indd 58 6/3/09 12:42:56 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:58

                                         Wall Panel
                                         & Tile
                                         D    ecorating with substantial materials such as
                                              paneling, tile, or glass block results in both a
                                         luxuriously appealing finish and lasting durability.
                                         As you beautify your rooms, you are also protecting
                                         your walls! By using innovative design plans and
                                         thoughtfully selecting materials, you can increase
                                         the value of your home while you make it your own.
                                         Be sure to select your project thoughtfully—and
                                         experiment with innovative designs while using time-
                                         tested, traditional techniques. Each wall treatment
                                         project in this chapter significantly contributes to the
                                         overall mood of the space—it helps distinguish the
                                         space and reflect personality. The treatments can be
                                         mixed and matched in endless ways and are suitable
                                         for an entire room as well as specifically chosen
                                         accent walls.
                                              Use decorative wallboard, traditional wainscot
                                         paneling, and colorful tile backsplashes to define your
                                         hallways, add color and usability to your kitchen, and
                                         cleanly divide separate living spaces. Each one of
                                         these projects will set your room, your home, and your
                                         style apart from the rest.

                                         In this chapter:
                                         • Decorative                         • Tongue-and-Groove
                                           Wallboard Panels                     Wainscoting
                                         • Architectural Detail               • Wainscot Frames
                                           with Wallboard                     • Tile Backsplashes
                                         • Wainscot Panels                    • Embellishing a Tiled Wall

                                                                                                                 ■ 59

   058-103_C51711.indd 59                                                                                       6/3/09 12:43:14 PM

ects :58 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:59

         Decorative Wallboard Panels

         D    esigner wallboard panels add detail and polish
              to any room. Decorative wallboard replicates
         the professional look (and time-consuming work)
         of raised panel walls and ceilings with detailed
         trimwork, but it is installed as a single pre-designed
         piece. The panels can be used to add a wainscot,
         bring interest to upper walls, or create a coffered
         ceiling; they work equally well used on accent walls
         or on all the walls of a room, depending on the effect
         you wish to achieve.
              To install raised panels, plan the layout carefully
         to ensure the panels are in alignment across the
         entire surface. In our project, standard wallboard is
         used to fill strips between or around decorative panels
         and all seams are finished using standard techniques.
         While you’re finishing your project, be careful not
         to smudge compound in the raised panel area of
         wallboard since it is difficult to remove once dry. If
         you do smudge the panels, carefully clean off the
         compound immediately with a clean wallboard knife
         and a damp towel. If you prefer to add decorative
         wallboard directly on top of your existing walls,                     Decorative wallboard adds a refined finish and the antique
         consider products or easy-to-install kits specifically                character of formal estates, established residences, and
         for this purpose.                                                     country cottages.

         ■ Planning Your Wallboard Installation
                                                                                                                          4" gap

                                                                Aligned raised panels

                                                 4" gap

                                                                                                                        4" gap

         When planning your designer wallboard installation, the key to a good layout is symmetry. Panels should be installed so
         the raised areas break at equal distances from the corners. Standard wallboard can be used to fill in between panels to create a
         workable layout. Treat both inside and outside corners similarly, so that the raised areas fall the same distance from the corner on
         each side of the wall. Panels also can be installed to “wrap” inside corners if necessary (inside corners, opposite page). Take careful
         measurements of your walls and ceilings and make accurate sketches to guide your project.

    60 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_C51711.indd 60 6/3/09 12:43:29 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:60

                ■ How to Install Decorative Wallboard Panels
                   1                                                                    Tools & Materials ▸
                                                                                        Wallboard panels
                                                                                        Tape measure
                                                                                        Screwgun or 3⁄8" drill
                                                                                        Chalk line
                                                                                        Wallboard screws
                                                                                        T-square
                                                                                        Utility knife
                                                                                        Construction adhesive

                                                                                        Inside Corners ▸
                Measure and mark the location of the first panel on the
                framing. At one end of the wall, measure and mark the top               To wrap an inside corner, score the back of a panel
                edge of the panel’s raised area. Drive a nail and run a level           using a T-square and sharp utility knife, being careful
                mason’s line across the wall 1" from the framing. Install the           not to pierce the front face. Gently snap back the
                first panel with wallboard screws, so the top edge of the
                                                                                        panel, leaving the face paper intact. Fill the void with
                raised area is level with the mason’s line. Note: if your wall is
                already covered with wallboard, consult a licensed remodeling           a bead of adhesive to reinforce the panel, then install
                carpenter to remove the existing wall or consider easy-to-              it immediately.
                install decorative wall kits.

                   2                                                                  3

                Install subsequent panels not only so the raised top                Finish the rest of the wall and fill gaps with standard
                edge is level with the mason’s line, but also with an equal         wallboard of the same thickness. The designer panels can be
                distance between the sides of the raised areas of each panel.       taped and finished in the same manner as standard wallboard.
                At corners, make sure to account for panel overlap when
                making cuts.

                                                                                                                                       Wall Panel & Tile ■ 61

   058-103_11989.indd 61                                                                                                                                   5/21/09 4:59:30 PM

ects :60 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:61

         Architectural Detail with Wallboard

         W      allboard can be installed in creative ways to
                bring a variety of architectural detail to a room.
         From a simple series of tiers wrapping the perimeter
                                                                                  Use a sharp utility knife and a rasp for cutting, as
                                                                             panel edges must be clean for finishing. Use adhesive
                                                                             to create strong bonds between layers, and type-G
         of the room to curved soffits or raised panels on                   screws to hold panels together while the adhesive sets
         walls, you can use traditional wallboard to replicate               up. Use L-bead to create sharp, clean panel ends.
         designs in high-end homes or bring your own creation                Finish all seams and beads with joint tape and at least
         to life.                                                            three coats of compound.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Wallboard                     Tape measure                    Utility knife                      Chalk line
               Wallboard screws              T-square                        Wallboard rasp                     Screwgun or 3⁄8" drill
               L-bead

         A decorative ceiling finish like this requires wallboard and trim finish carpentry skills. By combining built-up wallboard step
         soffits flanked by trim, a stunning layered effect is created.

    62 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_C51711.indd 62 6/3/09 12:43:38 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:62

                ■ How to Add Decorative Tiers to a Ceiling
                   1                                                                    2

                Measure and mark the width of the first tier on the ceiling           Install the wallboard with screws following traditional
                along each wall, then snap chalk lines to mark the perimeter.         wallboard spacing recommendations. Snap chalk lines on the
                Cut pieces of wallboard to size and apply 3⁄8" beads of adhesive      first tier for the second tier perimeter.
                to the backside.

                   3                                                                    4

                Cut and install the wallboard as in step 2. Stagger all               Install L-bead on all exposed edges of each tier, then finish
                seams at corners and along tier runs.                                 with three coats of joint compound. Edges can also be finished
                                                                                      with flexible corner tape.

                      Variation: Built-up Wallboard ▸
                      For a more substantial step soffit, build a 2× framework as a base for the wallboard. As you lay out the placement of the
                      new framing, make sure to account for the thickness of the wallboard in all final dimensions.

                                                                                                                                          Wall Panel & Tile ■ 63

   058-103_11989.indd 63                                                                                                                                      5/21/09 4:59:41 PM

ects :62 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:63

         Wainscot Panels

         A     wainscot is a wall treatment covering the lower
               portion of a wall and is not only decorative, but
         also protects your wall against wear and tear in high-
         traffic areas such as hallways and mudrooms. In most
         applications, the wainscot is covered along the bottom
         by a baseboard and along the top by a cap molding,
         rail, or shelf.
               There are two basic methods for installing wainscot
         panels: sheets and thinner boards (up to 3⁄8") can be
         attached to drywall with construction adhesive and
         nails, or with nails alone. Most wainscot is 30" or 36",
         but the exact height of the wainscoting is up to each
         designer. When installed to the height of the furniture
         in the room, wainscoting provides visual symmetry. It
         also allows the cap rail to double as a chair rail.
               Most paneling is available in 4 × 8, 4 × 9, and 4 × 10
         sheets. Before you start, measure the length of each
         wall in your room and plan the layout of the paneling
         sheets. The last sheet on each wall should be at least 3"
         wide, so you may have to trim the first sheet in order to
         make the last sheet wide enough. Specific installation
         instructions may vary according to the type of paneling
         you purchase—be sure to check the manufacturer’s
         instructions for the product you choose before installation.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Stud finder
               Caulk gun
               Tape Measure
               Circular saw
               Sheet paneling
               Compass
               Construction adhesive
               Chalk line
               10d, 6d and 2d finish nails
               1 × 6 and 1 × 3 clear pine lumber
               Power miter saw
               Router with roundover bit
               Chamfer bit
               Wood glue
               Drill
               Cove molding
               Baseboard                                                Solid and veneer wood wainscot panels can be stained
               Nail set                                                 or painted, depending on the look of your room. Synthetic
                                                                        paneling comes in hundreds of colors and styles as well.

    64 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_11989.indd 64 5/21/09 4:59:51 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:64

                      Types of Paneling ▸
                      Solid and veneer wood paneling is durable and
                      easy to clean—and brings a warm, rich tone to
                      any room.
                                                                                      Wood
                      FRP (fiberglass reinforced plastic), extruded plastic,
                      and vinyl panels contain solid material throughout,
                      creating a low-maintenance, water-resistant wall surface.
                      These materials are great for garages, workshops, and
                      commercial applications.
                      Laminate panels are available in hundreds of colors and         Vinyl

                      patterns, providing a more durable alternative to paint
                      or wallcoverings.
                      Tileboard is moisture-resistant hardboard coated with           Laminate
                      melamine—a durable, easy-to-clean plastic finish that
                      replicates the appearance of ceramic tile.
                                                                                      Tileboard
                      Bamboo (not pictured) is unique and green-friendly. Its
                      unusual construction—strips of bamboo laminated to a
                                                                                                         Plywood-faced
                      fabric backing—allows it to conform to any type of shape                              laminate
                      or surface.

                ■ How to Scribe the First Panel
                   1                                                                  2

                Starting in the corner farthest from the entry, use a stud          Position the first sheet of paneling against the wall so the
                finder to locate the stud closest to but less than 48" from the     cut edge is 1" from the corner and the opposite, finished edge
                corner. Snap a plumb chalk line down the wall at this location.     is plumb. Temporarily tack the top of the paneling to the wall.
                Measure the distance from the corner to this plumb mark and         Spread the compass to 1¼" and run down the full height of
                add 1". Use a circular saw to cut your first sheet of paneling to   the wall to scribe the cut line onto the face of the paneling.
                this measurement.                                                   Remove the paneling from the wall and cut to fit.

                                                                                                                                         Wall Panel & Tile ■ 65

   058-103_11989.indd 65                                                                                                                                     5/21/09 4:59:55 PM

ects :64 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:65

         ■ How to Install a Wainscot with Sheet Paneling
            1                                                                  2

         Measure up from the floor and snap a chalk line 3⁄4" below          Apply construction adhesive with a caulk gun to the back
         the height you’ve determined for your wainscot. Use a pencil        of the first panel. Apply the sheet to the wall so its top edge
         to mark the stud locations approximately 1" above the chalk         is flush with the chalk line and its scribed edge is set into the
         line. Scribe and cut your first panel to fit into the corner (see   corner. Press the sheet firmly to bond it to the wall.
         page 65). Measure the distance from this line to 1" above the
         floor and use a circular saw to cut the first sheet of paneling
         to length.

            3                                                                  4

         Drive 6d finish nails at the stud locations, spacing them           Install the remaining sheets in the wall section. If you are
         every 16" or so. Use only as many nails as needed to hold the       paneling an adjacent wall, check the paneled wall for plumb,
         sheet flat and keep it in place.                                    and trim the first sheet, if necessary. Install the sheet butted
                                                                             against the end sheet on the paneled wall.

    66 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_C51729.indd 66 6/10/09 2:46:34 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51729) #175 Dtp:119 Page:66

                   5                                                                  6

                Install the 1 × 6 rail with its top edge flush with the chalk       Mill the 1 × 3 top cap material using a router and
                line, fastening it to each stud with two 10d finish nails driven    roundover bit. Work on test pieces to find the desired amount
                through pilot holes. Butt together rail pieces at inside corners,   of roundover, then rout your workpieces on both front corners.
                and miter them at outside corners. Preparation tip: Before you      Sand the cap smooth. Option: Create a waterfall edge by
                install the rail, sand the front face and bottom edge smooth.       rounding over only the top edge of the cap (top inset), or
                                                                                    chamfer the front edges with a chamfer bit (bottom inset).

                   7                                                                  8

                                                                                                                            Cove molding

                                                                                                                            Baseboard

                Install the cap with wood glue and finish nails. Glue along         Add cove molding to the joint between the cap and rail,
                the top edge of the rail and drive a 10d finish nail, angled at     fastening it to the rail with 2d finish nails. Install the baseboard
                45° through the cap and into each stud (drill pilot holes for the   along the bottom of the wainscot. Recess all nails with a
                nails). Miter the rail at corners.                                  nail set.

                                                                                                                                        Wall Panel & Tile ■ 67

   058-103_C51711.indd 67                                                                                                                                   6/3/09 12:43:48 PM

ects :66 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:67

         Tongue-and-Groove Wainscoting

         T   ypical tongue-and-groove boards for wainscoting
             are made of pine, fir, or other softwoods, and are
         ¼ to ¾" thick. Each board has a tongue on one edge,
                                                                             consistent blocking between the studs to substitute
                                                                             for this backing. However, this is usually difficult to
                                                                             confirm unless the walls were framed with tongue-
         a groove on the other, and usually a decorative bevel               and-groove wainscoting in mind.
         or bead on each edge. Boards are cut to length and                       If you plan to stain your tongue-and-groove
         then attached with nails driven through the tongues of              wainscoting, use oil-based stains before or after
         the boards.                                                         installation, since most of the stain will be absorbed
              If installed over finished wallboard, tongue-                  into the wood and won’t interfere with the tongue-
         and-groove wainscoting will require that nailers be                 and-groove joints. If painting, choose a latex-based
         fastened to the wall studs to provide a reliable backing            paint, which will resist cracking as the joints expand
         for nailing. You can skip this step if you know there is            and contract with changes in the weather.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Circuit tester             Level                    Pry bar                                 Tongue-and-groove boards
               Circular saw               Miter box                Tape measure                            Spacers
               Compass                    Miter saw                Fine-tooth                              Cap rail
               Drill                      Nail set                    woodcutting blade                    Cove molding
               Hammer                     Pencil                   Receptacle box                            or quarter round
               Jigsaw                     Plane                       extenders, as required               4d and 6d finish nails

         Tongue-and-groove wainscoting boards are milled with smooth faces or contoured to add additional texture to your walls.
         For staining, choose a wood species with a pronounced grain. For painting, poplar is a good choice, since it has few knots and a
         consistent, closed grain that accepts paint evenly.

    68 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_C51711.indd 68 6/3/09 12:44:3 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:68

                ■ How to Prepare for a Tongue-and-Groove Wainscoting Project
                   1                                                                  2

                Measure to make a plan drawing of each wall in your                 Condition the planking by stacking it in the room where it
                project. Indicate the locations of fixtures, receptacles, and       will be installed. Place spacers between the planks to let air
                windows. Use a level to make sure the corners are plumb. If         circulate around each board, allowing the wood to adjust to
                not, mark plumb lines on the walls to use as reference points.      the room’s temperature and humidity. Wait 72 hours before
                                                                                    staining or sealing the front, back, and edges of each plank.

                   3                                                                  4

                Remove the baseboard moldings, along with any                       Mark the walls with level lines to indicate the top of the
                receptacle cover plates, vent covers, or other wall fixtures        wainscoting. Mark a line 1⁄4" from the floor to provide a small
                within the area you plan to cover. Before you begin, turn off the   gap for expansion at the floor.
                electricity to the circuits in the area.

                                                                                                                                        Wall Panel & Tile ■ 69

   058-103_11989.indd 69                                                                                                                                    5/21/09 5:00:27 PM

ects :68 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:69

               Planning Your Project ▸
                                                                                            Begin installation at the corners.
                                                                                            Install any outside corners (A) first,
                                                                                            working your way toward the inside
                                                                                            corners. In sections of a room that have
                                                                                            no outside corners, start at the inside
                                                                                            corners (B), and work your way toward the
                                                                                            door and window casings. Calculate the
                                                                                            number of boards required for each wall,
                                                                                            using the measurements on the drawing
                                   A                          A
                                                                                            you created earlier (length of wall divided
                                                                                            by width of one plank). When making this
                                                                                            calculation, remember that the tongues
                                                                                            are removed from the corner boards. If the
                                                                                            total number of boards for a wall includes
                                                                                            a fraction of less than 1⁄2 of a board, plan
                                                                                            to trim the first and last boards to avoid
                                                                                            ending with a board cut to less than half
                                                                                            its original width.
                        B                                                     B

         ■ How  to Install Tongue-and-Groove Wainscoting
           at Outside Corners

            1                                       2                                                   3

         Cut a pair of boards to the widths       Position the boards at the corner,                 Position a piece of corner trim and
         indicated in the calculations you        butting them to create a plumb corner.             nail it in place, using 6d finish nails.
         developed during the planning process.   Facenail the boards in place, then nail            Install the remaining boards (opposite,
                                                  the joint, using 6d finish nails. Drive            steps 5 and 6).
                                                  the nails to within 1⁄8" of the face of the
                                                  boards, then finish with a nail set.

    70 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_C51711.indd 70 6/3/09 12:44:14 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:70

                ■ How   to Install Tongue-and-Groove Wainscoting
                  at Inside Corners

                   1                                            2                                               3

                Hold a level against the first board and      Cut along the scribed line with a              Hold the first board in the corner,
                hold the board flush with the corner. If      circular saw. Subsequent boards may            leaving a 1⁄4" gap for expansion, and
                the wall is out of plumb, trim the board      require minor tapering with a plane to         facenail into the center of the board
                to compensate: hold the board plumb,          adjust for plumb.                              at each nailer location, using 6d finish
                position a compass at the inside corner                                                      nails. Drive the top nails roughly 1⁄2" from
                of the wall, and use it to scribe a line                                                     the edge so they’ll be hidden from view
                down the board.                                                                              once the cap rail is attached.

                   4                                            5                                               6

                Install a second board at the corner          Position subsequent boards. Leave              Mark and cut the final board to fit. If
                by butting it against the first one, then     a 1⁄16" gap at each joint to allow for         you’re at a door casing, cut the board to
                facenailing in at least two locations. Nail   seasonal expansion. Use a level to             fit flush with the casing (trim off at least
                to within 1⁄8" of the face of the board,      check every third board for plumb.             the tongue). If you’re at an inside corner,
                then use a nail set to finish.                If the wainscoting is out of plumb,            make sure it is plumb. If not, scribe and
                                                              adjust the fourth board, as necessary,         trim the board to fit.
                                                              to compensate.

                                                                                                                                        Wall Panel & Tile ■ 71

   058-103_11989.indd 71                                                                                                                                    5/21/09 5:00:51 PM

ects :70 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:71

         ■ How to Make a Cutout
            1                                                                     2

         Test the receptacle (inset) to make sure the power is off. If          Create a cutting outline by pressing the back of the board
         tester lights, determine the correct circuit and shut it off before    that will be installed over the receptacle directly against the
         continuing. Then, unscrew and remove the receptacle from the           electrical box.
         box. Coat the edges of the electrical box with bright colored chalk.

            3                                               4                                                  Tip ▸

                                                                                                               When paneling around a
                                                                                                               receptacle with thick stock,
                                                                                                               you will need to attach a
         Lay the board face down and drill               Facenail the wainscoting to the wall,                 receptacle box extender to
         a large pilot hole near one corner of           then reattach the receptacle with the                 the inside of the box, then
         the outline. Use a jigsaw fitted with a         tabs overlapping the wainscoting so the               reconnect the receptacle so
         fine-tooth woodcutting blade to make            receptacle is flush with the opening. You             it is flush with the opening in
         the cutout. Be careful not to cut outside       may need longer screws.                               the paneling.
         the lines.

    72 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_C51729.indd 72 6/10/09 2:51:39 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51729) #175 Dtp:119 Page:72

                ■ How to Install Tongue-and-Groove Wainscoting
                  Around a Window

                   1                                                                 2

                On casement windows, install wainscoting up to the casings        On double-hung windows, remove any window trim and
                on the sides and below the window. Install 1⁄2" cove molding,     install wainscoting up to the jambs on the sides and below the
                quarter round, or other trim to finish the edges.                 window. Cut the stool to fit over the wainscoting, then reinstall
                                                                                  the apron.

                ■ How to Finish a Wainscoting Project
                   1                                          2                                                3

                Cut baseboard moldings to fit over         Cut the cap rail to fit. At doors and            Attach the cap rail by nailing 4d finish
                the wainscoting, and attach them by        windows, install the cap rail so its edge        nails through the flats of the moldings at
                nailing 6d finishing nails at the stud     is flush with the side casings.                  the stud locations so that the nails enter
                locations. If you plan to install a base                                                    both the studs and the wainscoting. Set
                shoe, leave a small gap at the floor.                                                       the nails with a nail set.

                                                                                                                                       Wall Panel & Tile ■ 73

   058-103_11989.indd 73                                                                                                                                   5/21/09 5:01:13 PM

ects :72 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:73

         Wainscot Frames

         F    rame-and-panel wainscot adds depth and variety
              to living spaces and can be constructed to match
         any specifications you determine. Use paint-grade
                                                                                 Tools & Materials ▸
         materials, such as MDF, or build with hardwoods and
                                                                                 3
                                                                                  ⁄4" MDF sheet stock              Straightedge guide
         finish-grade plywood if you prefer a clear-coat finish.                 11⁄16" cove molding               Power miter saw
         It’s best to prime all of the wainscot parts prior to
                                                                                 1
                                                                                  ⁄2 × 3⁄4" base shoe              Clamps
         installing them.
                                                                                 9
                                                                                  ⁄16 × 11⁄8" cap                  Drill with bits
               Installing wainscot frames can be done piece by                        molding (10 feet             Carpenter’s square
         piece, but it is often easier to assemble the main frame                     per panel)                   Pocket hole jig
         parts in your shop. Not only does working in the shop                   Panel adhesive                       with screws
         allow you to join the frame parts together using pocket                 Paint                             Pry bar
         screws driven in the backs of the rails and stiles, it also             Primer                            Hammer
         generally results in a more professional look.                          Laser level                       Pneumatic finish
               Once the main frames have been assembled,                         Pencil                               nail gun with
         attach them to the wall at stud locations. If you                       Tape measure                         compressor
         prefer to site-build the wainscot piece by piece,                       Router                            Caulking gun
         you may need to replace the wallcovering material                       Circular saw
         with plywood to create nailing surfaces for the                              or table saw
         individual pieces.

         Wainscot frames fit in well with contemporary room design, adding a traditional class and craftsmanship to the design. Inset: The
         wainscot panels shown here, as well as the wall sections within the frames, were painted a lighter contrasting color from the wall
         for added depth.

    74 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_C51729.indd 74 6/10/09 2:53:17 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51729) #175 Dtp:119 Page:74

                ■ How to Install Wainscot Frames
                   1                                                                       2

                Use a laser level and a pencil to mark the height of the                 Test your layout plan by drawing lines on the wall to
                wainscot installation directly onto all walls in the project area.       verify that your design will work in your room. Try to use a
                Also mark the height of the top rail (3⁄4" below the overall             panel width that can be divided evenly into all project wall
                height), since the cap rail will be installed after the rest of the      lengths. In some cases, you may need to make the panel
                wainscot is installed. Mark stud locations, using an electronic          widths slightly different from wall to wall, but make sure to
                stud finder.                                                             maintain a consistent width within each wall’s run.

                   3                                                                       4

                Based on your plan, rip a sheet of MDF into strips to make all           Dry-assemble the cut top rails, base rails, and stiles into
                of the wainscot parts except the trim moldings. In our case, that        ladder frames on a flat surface based on your layout. Plan the
                included the cap rail (2" wide), the top rail and stiles (31⁄2" wide),   layouts so wall sections longer than 8 ft. are cut with scarf
                and the base rail (71⁄4" wide). Note: These are standard lumber          joints in the rails meeting at a stud location.
                dimensions. You can use 1 × 4 and 1 × 4 dimensional lumber for
                the rails and stiles (use 1 × 2 or rip stock for the cap rail).

                                                                                                                                                      (continued)

                                                                                                                                             Wall Panel & Tile ■ 75

   058-103_11989.indd 75                                                                                                                                         5/21/09 5:01:36 PM

ects :74 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:75

            5                                                                6

         Assemble the frames using glue and pocket screws or               Mount a 3⁄4" roundover bit in your router or router table
         biscuits. Clamp the parts together first and check with a         and shape a bullnose profile on the front edge of your cap
         carpenter’s square to make sure the stiles are perpendicular to   rail stock.
         both rails.

            7                                                                8

         Prime all parts on both sides, including the milled moldings      Position the frames against the wall and shim underneath
         and uncut cap rail stock.                                         the bottom rails as necessary to bring them flush with the
                                                                           top rail marks on the wall (3⁄4" below the overall height lines).
                                                                           Attach the wainscot sections by driving 3" drywall screws,
                                                                           countersunk, through the top and bottom rail at each stud
                                                                           location. If you are using scarf joints, be sure to install the open
                                                                           half first. Cut the cap rail.

    76 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_11989.indd 76 5/21/09 5:01:42 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:76

                   9                                                                   10

                Attach the cap rail to the top rail with panel adhesive and          Install cove molding in the crotch where the cap rail and
                finish nails. Drive a 3" drywall screw through the cap rail and      top rail meet using glue and a brad nailer. Then, nail the base
                into the wall toenail-style at each location. Be sure to carefully   shoe to conceal any gaps between the bottoms, rails, and floor.
                drill pilot holes and countersink holes for each screw. Miter-cut    Miter all corners.
                the cap rails at the corners.

                   11                                                                  12

                Cut and install mitered frames out of cap molding to fit             Mask the wall above the cap rail, and then prime and
                around the inside perimeter of each panel frame.                     paint the wainscot frames. Generally, a lighter color contrasting
                                                                                     the wall color above is most effective visually.

                                                                                                                                         Wall Panel & Tile ■ 77

   058-103_11989.indd 77                                                                                                                                     5/21/09 5:01:50 PM

ects :76 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:77

         Tile Backsplashes

         T   here are few spaces in your home with as much
             potential for creativity and visual impact as
         the space between your kitchen countertop and
         cupboards. A well-designed backsplash can transform
         the ordinary into the extraordinary.
              Tiles for the backsplash can be attached directly
         to wallboard or plaster and do not require backerboard.
         When purchasing the tile, order 10 percent extra to cover
         breakage and cutting. Remove switch and receptacle
         cover plates and install box extenders to make up for the
         extra thickness of the tile. Protect the countertop from
         scratches by covering it with a drop cloth.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Level                       Straight 1 × 2
               Tape measure                Wall tile
               Pencil                      Tile spacers
               Tile cutter                    (if needed)
               Rod saw                     Bullnose trim tile
               Notched trowel              Mastic tile adhesive
               Rubber grout float          Masking tape
               Beating block               Grout
               Rubber mallet               Caulk
               Sponge                      Drop cloth                      A tiled backsplash normally extends all the way from
               Bucket                      Grout sealer                    countertop to the bottoms of the wall cabinets. The tile pattern
                                                                           also can be extended to the wall underneath your range hood.

               Tips for Planning Tile Layouts ▸

               Gather planning brochures and          Break tiles into fragments and             Add painted mural tiles to create
               design catalogs to help you create     make a mosaic backsplash. Always           a focal point. Mixing various tile
               decorative patterns and borders for    use a sanded grout for joints wider        styles adds an appealing contrast.
               the backsplash.                        than 1⁄8".

    78 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_11989.indd 78 5/21/09 5:01:58 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:78

                ■ How to Tile a Backsplash
                   1                                                                  2

                Make a story stick by marking a board at least half as long         Starting at the midpoint of the installation area, use
                as the backsplash area to match the tile spacing.                   the story stick to make layout marks along the wall. If an end
                                                                                    piece is too small (less than half a tile), adjust the midpoint to
                                                                                    give you larger, more attractive end pieces. Use a level to mark
                                                                                    this point with a vertical reference line.

                   3

                While it may appear straight, your countertop may not be level and therefore is not a reliable reference line. Run a level
                along the counter to find the lowest point on the countertop. Mark a point two tiles up from the low point and extend a level line
                across the entire work area.

                                                                                                                                                 (continued)

                                                                                                                                        Wall Panel & Tile ■ 79

   058-103_11989.indd 79                                                                                                                                    5/21/09 5:02:10 PM

ects :78 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:79

                                                                                                                                          Border
                                                                                                        Field

         Variation: Diagonal Layout. Mark vertical and horizontal reference lines, making sure the angle is 90°. To establish diagonal
         layout lines, measure out equal distances from the crosspoint, then connect the points with a line. Additional layout lines
         can be extended from these as needed. To avoid the numerous, unattractive perimeter cuts common to diagonal layouts,
         try using a standard border pattern as shown. Diagonally set a field of full tiles, then cut enough half tiles to fill out the
         perimeter. Finally, border the diagonal field with tiles set square to the field.

            4                                          5                                                  6

         Apply mastic adhesive evenly to the         Starting at the vertical reference line,          Install a whole row along the
         area beneath the horizontal reference       press tiles into the adhesive using a slight      reference line, checking occasionally to
         line, using a notched trowel. Comb          twisting motion. If the tiles are not self-       make sure the tiles are level. Continue
         the adhesive horizontally with the          spacing, use plastic spacers to maintain          installing tiles below the first row,
         notched edge.                               even grout lines. If the tiles do not hang        trimming tiles that butt against the
                                                     in place, use masking tape to hold them           countertop as needed.
                                                     in place until the adhesive sets.

    80 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_11989.indd 80 5/21/09 5:02:19 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:80

                   7                                            8                                               9

                Apply adhesive above the line                 Lay a beating block against the tile           Mix the grout and apply it with
                and continue placing tiles, working from      and tap it lightly with a mallet. Remove       a rubber grout float. Spread it over
                the center to the sides. Install trim tile,   the spacers. Allow the mastic to dry           the tiles, keeping the float at a low
                such as bullnose tile, to the edges of        for at least 24 hours, or as directed by       30° angle, pressing the grout deep
                the rows.                                     the manufacturer.                              into the joints. Note: For grout joints
                                                                                                             1
                                                                                                              ⁄8" and smaller, be sure to use a
                                                                                                             non-sanded grout.

                   10                                                                  11

                Wipe off excess grout, holding the float at a right angle to        Shape the grout joints by making slow, short passes with
                the tile, working diagonally so as not to remove grout from         the sponge, shaving down any high spots; rinse the sponge
                the joints. Clean any remaining grout from the tiles with a         frequently. Use your finger to fill any voids with grout. When
                damp sponge, working in a circular motion. Rinse the sponge         the grout has dried to a haze, buff the tile clean with a soft
                thoroughly and often.                                               cloth. Apply a bead of caulk between the countertop and tiles.
                                                                                    Reinstall any electrical fixtures you removed. After the grout
                                                                                    has completely cured, apply grout sealer.

                                                                                                                                        Wall Panel & Tile ■ 81

   058-103_11989.indd 81                                                                                                                                    5/21/09 5:02:45 PM

ects :80 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:81

         Embellishing a Tiled Wall

         M      any of us live with tile we don’t particularly like.
                It’s easy to see why: builders and remodelers
         often install simple, neutral tile in an effort not to
         put anyone off. Older homes sometimes have tile
         that’s not quite vintage but certainly no longer stylish.
         Because tile is so long-lasting, new styles and trends
         often make it look dated. Here’s a bit of good news:
         there’s a choice beyond simply living with it or tearing
         out perfectly good tile to start over.
              Removing a section of boring tile and replacing
         it with some decorative accent tile can transform a
         plain-Jane wall into one that makes a unique design
         statement. Because this project involves breaking the
         seal of the wall surface, it’s a better choice for a tiled wall
         that gets little exposure to water (as opposed to a shower
         wall or tub deck).

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Tape measure                 1
                                             ⁄4" notched trowel        Grease pencil                 Thinset mortar
               Grout saw                    Grout float                Masking tape                  Mosaic medallion or decorative tile
               Grout scraper                Grout sponge               Safety glasses                Tile spacers
               Flat head screwdriver        Buff rag                   Drywall screws                Grout
               Straightedge                 Foam brush                 Cementboard                   Latex additive
               Utility knife                Needlenose pliers          Construction adhesive         Grout sealer
               Drill                        Drop cloth                 Drywall screws                Dust mask

         ■ How to Embellish a Tiled Wall
            1                                                                     2

         Measure the decorative tiles and draw a detailed plan                  Using a grease pencil, mark the tiles to be removed
         for your project. Indicate a removal area at least one tile larger     according to the plan drawing. Remove a section of tile that’s
         than the space required. If it will be necessary to cut tile, create   a minimum of one tile all around the project installation area.
         a plan that will result in symmetrical tiles. Protect the floor with   Put masking tape on the edges of the bordering tiles that will
         a drop cloth.                                                          remain to keep them from being damaged by the grout saw.

    82 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_11989.indd 82 5/21/09 5:02:57 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:82

                      Embellished Wall Styles ▸

                      Border tiles, set in a rather random fashion, create a     Decorative tiles can be mixed with plain to produce
                      focal point behind the counter and sink in this colorful   stunning designs like this one. Many manufacturers will
                      bathroom. Don’t limit your use of decorative tiles like    customize tile with photographs that you choose or
                      these to conventional methods. Let your imagination run    provide. Craft stores also offer kits that allow you to add
                      free—you may come up with your own unique take on          your own photographs to tile.
                      their possibilities.

                      Borders liven up walls and break up otherwise boring       Subway tile, simple rectangular tile, blends the shower
                      expanses of solid color.                                   into its surroundings. The room is brightened considerably
                                                                                 by a backsplash of colorful mosaic tile. A niche, cleverly
                                                                                 sized and placed, creates the appearance that the
                                                                                 backsplash continues behind the shower, and the mosaic
                                                                                 floor provides a visual anchor.

                                                                                                                                              (continued)

                                                                                                                                     Wall Panel & Tile ■ 83

   058-103_11989.indd 83                                                                                                                                  5/21/09 5:03:9 PM

ects :82 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:83

            3                                            4                                                 5

         Wearing eye protection and a dust             With a flathead screwdriver, pry up              Draw cutting lines on the drywall that
         mask, use a grout saw to cut grooves in       the edges of the tile at the center of the       are at least 1⁄2" inside the borders of the
         all of the grout lines in the removal area.   removal area. Wiggle the blade toward            area where you removed tiles. Using a
         If the grout lines are soft this will only    the center of the tile and pry up to pop         straightedge and utility knife, carefully
         take one or two passes. If the grout’s        it off.                                          cut out the old drywall. If the tile comes
         hard, it may take several. Using a grout                                                       off very easily and the tile backer is not
         scraper, remove any remaining material                                                         damaged, you may be able to scrape it
         in the joint. Angle the tools toward the                                                       clean and reuse it.
         open area to protect the tile.

            6                                            7                                                 8

         Cut and install cementboard backer            Cut a cementboard patch to fit the               Apply thinset mortar using a notched
         strips that are slightly longer than the      opening in the tile backer. Place the            trowel to spread it evenly.
         width of the opening. Align the strips        patch in the opening and drive drywall
         so the ends are pressed against the           screws through the cementboard and
         back surface of the tile backer. Drive        into the backer strips. Also drive screws
         wallboard screws through the edges of         at any stud locations. Cover the edges
         the old tile backer and into the strips to    with wallboard tape.
         hold them in place.

    84 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_11989.indd 84 5/21/09 5:03:23 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:84

                   9                                          10                                             11

                Gently press the accent tiles into          Remove the protective sheets                  Mix a batch of grout and fill the joints
                the adhesive, smoothing it from the         on the tiles. You may need to use a           between tiles on the entire wall, one
                center toward the edges. Let the mortar     damp sponge to first soak the sheets.         section at a time. Clean the tile with a
                cure as directed.                           Once wet, slide the sheets off and throw      damp sponge. Occasionally rinse the
                                                            them away.                                    sponge in cool water (inset).

                      Design Suggestions ▸

                      Inserts add interest, texture, and color to tile            This stone insert adds a contemporary flair to a simple
                      designs. This piece combines tumbled stone with marble      tile design.
                      in a delicate floral motif.

                                                                                                                                     Wall Panel & Tile ■ 85

   058-103_11989.indd 85                                                                                                                                 5/21/09 5:03:38 PM

ects :84 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:85

058-103_11989.indd 86 5/21/09 5:03:54 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:86

                                        Wallcovering
                                        W      allcovering today is so much more than
                                               coordinating floral prints. Whether you’d like
                                        to add fresh, clean stripes to your bathroom walls or
                                        turn a cool, spacious living room into a quiet hideaway
                                        with soft upholstered walls, wallcovering may be just
                                        what you need to perfect a room’s style and ambience.
                                        A multitude of textures, prints, and colors are readily
                                        available to completely transform your space, or
                                        to perfectly highlight your existing design scheme.
                                        Wallcovering can also disguise imperfect walls, absorb
                                        or reflect sound and light, and help draw attention to
                                        the best features of your room or furnishings.
                                             Choose wallcovering carefully, however.
                                        Each type and application method differs in its
                                        durability, maintenance, and ease of removal. Ask
                                        your salesperson plenty of questions when making
                                        decisions about what kind of wallcovering is best for
                                        your room, and always bring samples home to see
                                        how they look with the light in your room both during
                                        the day and at night. Each wallcovering application
                                        method also requires careful measurements and
                                        planning, but given the time up front, it can be one of
                                        the most rewarding ways to completely alter the look
                                        and feel of your space.
                                             Be bold in your design choices and meticulous in
                                        your application, and you will not be disappointed in
                                        the outcome of any wallcovering project.

                                        In this chapter:
                                        • Stripping Wallcovering            • Wallcovering Panels
                                        • Hanging Wallcovering              • Wall Upholstery

                                                                                                               ■ 87

   058-103_11989.indd 87                                                                                       5/21/09 5:04:5 PM

ects :86 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:87

         Stripping Wallcovering

         S    tripping wallcovering can be quick and easy
              or quite tedious, depending on the type of
         wallcovering to be stripped and how it was applied.
         Newer vinyl wallcoverings are designed to be
         strippable, which means they can be scraped off easily
         when dampened with water. Older wallcoverings,
         however, may require a fair amount of time and effort.
         The best way to find out what’s lurking beneath your
         wallcovering is to grab an edge and gently pull!
               If wallcovering is hung over unsealed drywall,
         it’s nearly impossible to remove it without destroying
         the drywall. You may be able to paint or hang new
         wallcovering directly over the old, but always make
         sure the surface is smooth and prime it with an alkyd
         drywall primer.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Putty knife              Rubber gloves
               Hand pump sprayer        Sponge                       Properly applied wallcovering—high-quality coverings that
               Wallpaper remover        Wallpaper                    have been applied with good wallpaper adhesive over primed
               Paint scraper              perforating tool           walls—can be stripped with a few simple materials and a little
                                                                     time and patience.

         ■ How to Strip Wallcoverings
            1                                                          2

         Begin to remove wallpaper by pulling upward. First, use a   Wash the walls, working from the top down. Rinse walls with
         putty knife to pry a corner loose and then pull.            water and let them dry completely. Always dilute wallpaper
                                                                     remover according to the manufacturer’s instructions.

    88 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_C51711.indd 88 6/3/09 12:44:26 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:88

                ■ How to Remove Stubborn Wallcoverings
                   1                                                             2

                Run a perforating tool over the surface of the wallcovering,   Dilute wallpaper remover according to the manufacturer’s
                creating holes that will enable the remover solution to        instructions. Cover the floor with drop cloths and use
                penetrate the surface and loosen the adhesive.                 a pressure sprayer to apply the remover solution. Let
                                                                               the solution soak into the covering according to the
                                                                               manufacturer’s instructions

                   3                                                             4

                Scrape away loosened wallcovering with a wide paint            Rinse adhesive residue from the wall with the remaining
                scraper. Be careful not to damage the wall and be sure to      remover solution. Rinse the wall with clear water and let
                remove any backing paper or other layers.                      walls dry completely. Inspect the walls carefully, making
                                                                               sure they are completely clean before painting or hanging
                                                                               new wallcoverings.

                                                                                                                                      Wallcovering ■ 89

   058-103_11989.indd 89                                                                                                                             5/21/09 5:04:15 PM

ects :88 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:89

         Hanging Wallcovering

         S   uccessful wallcovering projects start with careful
             planning. The materials can be expensive and
         mistakes are immediately obvious. Always measure
         the room and sketch out a hanging plan. Hanging
         should start at a focal point, such as a fireplace or
         large window. Bear in mind that every wallcovering
         project will likely have one mismatch: the point where
         a full strip meets a partial strip. Plan to place the
         mismatch in an inconspicuous area, such as behind
         a door.
              Work during daylight hours whenever possible, as
         the light is better and the adhesive dries more evenly.
         Remember to turn off the power to the circuit in the
         room and remove covers on receptacles and switches
         before starting your project.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Non-corrosive bucket
               High-quality sponges
               Bubble stick
               Wallpaper paste
               Smoothing brush
               Razor knife
               Smoothing tool
               Wide drywall knife
               Wallcovering scissors
               Water tray                                                     Hanging wallcovering requires careful planning and
               Seam roller                                                    attention to detail. The work is not difficult, but the only way to
                                                                              avoid problems is to plan meticulously.

               Other Considerations ▸
               Removability: Strippable wallcoverings can be pulled away from the wall by hand, leaving very little residue. Peelable
               wallcoverings can be removed, but may leave a thin paper layer on the wall. Check the back of the sample for its
               strippability rating.
               Washability: Washable wallcoverings can be cleaned with mild soap and water. Scrubbable wallcoverings are durable
               enough to be scrubbed with a soft brush.
               Application Ease: Prepasted wallcoverings are factory coated with water-based adhesive that is activated when wetted
               in a water tray. Unpasted wallcoverings must be coated with adhesive before hanging.
               Patterns: Large patterns are more difficult to match and will produce more waste. Covering a room with a large pattern
               or a pattern that repeats rarely can be more expensive and more time-consuming.

    90 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_11989.indd 90 5/21/09 5:04:23 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:90

                      Applying the Rule of Scale ▸
                      You'll often hear that vertical prints add height to a room     print, the shade, the density (or repeat of the print), and
                      and large prints pull a room together, making it appear         the way that the light in the room will further advance
                      smaller (or cozier). This is only somewhat true. With all       (highly reflective prints, such as foil) or broaden (warm,
                      prints you must also consider the scale and depth of the        dark, mute tones) the perceptual space.

                      Pastel verticals (left) typically broaden a room and make it seem larger both in height and width, but here the wide and
                      large vertical repeat advances the pattern and pulls the room in. This disagreement adds energy to the space, which is
                      also in opposition to the typical calming effect of pastels. A very small, dense vertical pattern (right) does elongate the
                      wall, adding perceived height to the room. Sparse vertical prints with more white space maintain the illusion of height but
                      also give a room an airy and bright feel, which perceptively adds overall space to the room.

                      Dark vertical prints typically add          Bold repeat prints visually take           Light shades of repeat prints,
                      height to a room with low ceilings,         up a lot of space. This can become         even when large (as shown
                      but as seen here a very large-scale         disorienting if used too much, so          here), visually recede. This makes
                      repeat vertical print with dark colors      these prints have the best effect          a room appear larger while
                      and large floras adds drama to a            when used on accent walls and in           maintaining interest.
                      room and makes the room look                moderation, as was done in this fun
                      more square.                                and inviting hallway.

                                                                                                                                               Wallcovering ■ 91

   058-103_C51711.indd 91                                                                                                                                     6/3/09 12:44:39 PM

ects :90 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:91

               Types of Wallcovering ▸
               Vinyls are made with a continuous flexible film                room. They are also a good choice for floawed, irregular
               applied over a fabric or paper backing. Some vinyls            walls. Hang them with clear adhesive and be careful never
               successfully duplicate the effect of grasscloth or             to use water to rinse grasscloths.
               fabric wallcoverings, but come with the advantage of           Fabric wallcoverings are made of woven textiles. Fabrics
               pre-applied adhesives. Vinyls are easy to apply, clean,        soften the appearance of a room and absorb sound, but
               and remove.                                                    they may be difficult to clean.
               Foils or mylars are coated with a thin, flexible metallic      Embossed wallcoverings are stamped with a relief
               film. These highly reflective wallcoverings add brightness     pattern for an elegant, formal appearance. Remember not
               to a room, but they require careful handling during            to use a seam roller if applying embossed wallcoverings,
               application. Foils also reflect all wall flaws, so surface     as they can easily be damaged.
               preparation must be perfect.                                   Flocked paper has a raised fuzzy pattern that resembles
               Grasscloths are made of natural plant fibers. Grasscloths      velvet. It hides wall imperfections well. It is best used
               reflect very little light and soften the appearance of a       sparingly because it is very ornate.

                                                                                              Spot foils add brightness and interest
                                                                                              to a room. A simple design like the one
                                                                                              shown here will still take up a considerable
                                                                                              amount of visual space in the room, so
                                                                                              decorate to complement the wallpaper.

               Creating a Hanging Plan ▸
               Measure the room and create a sketch of the hanging
               plan. Center a plumb line on a focal point, such as a
               fireplace or window. If the room doesn’t have an obvious
                                                                                                                   Door
               focal point, start at the corner farthest from the entry.
                                                                                             Seams           Mismatch over door
               Measure a distance equal to the width of the wallcovering
               and mark a point. Work in both directions, marking the
               points where seams will fall.                                                                  Or start here
                                                                                            Window
                    Adjust the hanging plan for corners that fall exactly
                                                                                                                      Fireplace
               on seam lines. Wallcovering should overlap at least 1⁄2" on
               inside corners and 1" on outside corners. Similarly, adjust                  Start here
               for seams that fall in difficult locations, such as near the                   Far corner
               edges of windows or doors. Always leave workable widths
               of wallcovering around obstacles.

    92 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_11989.indd 92 5/21/09 5:05:20 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:92

                ■ How to Prepare Wallcovering Strips
                   1                                                                    2

                Hold the wallcovering against the wall so there is a                 Fill a water tray half full of lukewarm water. Roll the cut
                full pattern at the ceiling line and the strip overlaps both the     strip loosely with the pattern side in. Soak the roll in the tray
                ceiling and the baseboard by at least 2". Cut the strip to length    as directed by the manufacturer, usually about one minute, to
                using scissors.                                                      activate the prepasted adhesive.

                ■ How to Apply Wallcoverings
                   1                                             2                                               3

                From the starting point shown in               Position the top portion of the first          At the corner fold line, snip the top
                your hanging plan, measure a distance          prepared strip against the plumb line          of the strip so the wallcovering wraps
                equal to the width of the wallcovering         so the strip extends beyond the ceiling        around the corner without wrinkling.
                minus 1⁄2" and mark a point. Draw a            joint by about 2".                             Using your open palms, slide the strip
                vertical plumb line from the ceiling to                                                       into position with the edge butted
                the floor using a bubblestick or level.                                                       against the plumb line. Smooth the strip
                                                                                                              with a smoothing brush.

                                                                                                                                                  (continued)

                                                                                                                                              Wallcovering ■ 93

   058-103_11989.indd 93                                                                                                                                     5/21/09 5:05:32 PM

ects :92 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:93

            4                                                                5

         Position the bottom of the strip against the plumb line           Trim the excess wallcovering at the ceiling and baseboard,
         with your open palms. Smooth the strip with a smoothing           using a drywall knife and a utility knife. With clean water
         brush, carefully pressing out any bubbles.                        and a sponge, rinse any adhesive from the surface of
                                                                           the wallcovering.

            6                                                                7

         Hang additional strips, sliding strips into place so the          Where wallcovering covers receptacle or switch boxes,
         pattern matches exactly. Let the strips stand for about half an   use a razor knife to make small diagonal cuts to expose the
         hour, then roll the seams with a seam roller. (On embossed or     box. Finally, trim the paper to the edges of the box. Note: Turn
         fabric wallcoverings, set the seams with a smoothing brush.)      off power to the circuit and remove switch and receptacle
                                                                           covers before starting the project.

    94 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_11989.indd 94 5/21/09 5:05:44 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:94

                ■ How to Hang Wallcovering Around Doors & Windows
                   1                                                               2

                Position the strip on the wall, running the wallcovering         Use scissors to make diagonal cuts at the corners of the
                over the window or door. Smooth, pressing the strip tightly      casings. Trim away excess to about 1". Inset: Hold a drywall
                against the molding.                                             knife against the molding and use a razor knife to trim the strip.

                   3                                                               4

                Cut and position the next short strip to hang above (and         Match the pattern at the seam on the bottom half of the
                below, if this is a window) the opening. Smooth it into place.   next full strip. Trim the excess as you did in step 2. Rinse the
                Snip the corner diagonally and trim away excess as described     wallcovering and casings using a damp sponge.
                in step 2. Continue around the opening.

                                                                                                                                          Wallcovering ■ 95

   058-103_C51711.indd 95                                                                                                                                 6/3/09 12:45:9 PM

ects :94 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:95

         ■ How to Hang Wallcovering Around a Wall-mounted Sink
            1                                                                    2

         Cut and position the strip, brushing it up to the edge                Trim the wallcovering around the sink, leaving a slight
         of the sink. Cut slits in the wallcovering, leaving a 1⁄4" overlap    overlap. Smooth the strip, tucking the overlap into a gap
         around the edges of the sink.                                         around the sink, if possible. Or, neatly trim the overlap.

         ■ How to Hang Wallcovering Around a Pipe
            1                                                                    2

         Pull the escutcheon plate out from the wall. Hold the strip           Cut a hole at the end of the slit to fit around the pipe. Butt the
         against the wall so the pattern matches the previous strip.           edges of the slit together and brush them smooth.
         From the closest edge of the strip, cut the slit to reach the
         pipe. Press the strip flat up to the pipe with a smoothing brush.

               Lot Numbers ▸
               Make sure all of your wallpaper rolls have the same lot number. Color may vary between lots. Also, file away the lot
               number in case you need to purchase more later.

    96 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_C51711.indd 96 6/3/09 12:45:26 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:96

                ■ How to Hang Wallcover Borders
                   1                                                                     2

                If you are positioning the border somewhere other than                 Begin at the least conspicuous corner, overlapping the
                along the ceiling or baseboard, create a level line in the desired     border onto the adjacent wall by ½". Have a helper hold the
                position using a laser level, or draw a light pencil line around the   border while you apply it against the line. Smooth with the
                room using a carpenter’s level. Cut and prepare the first border       smoothing brush as you go along. At inside corners, create a 1⁄4"
                strip following the methods for preparing wallcovering (page 93).      tuck from the overhang.

                   3                                                                     4

                Apply the adjoining strip and trim it with a razor knife. Peel         Where a seam falls in the middle of a wall, overlap strips
                back the tucked strip and smooth the strip around the corner,          so the patterns match. Cut through both layers, using a razor
                overlapping the border on the adjacent wall. Press the border          knife and a wide drywall knife. Peel back the strips and remove
                flat. Apply seam adhesive to the lapped seam, if necessary.            the cut ends. Press the strips flat. Roll the seam after 30 minutes
                                                                                       and rinse with a sponge.

                      Mitering Corners ▸
                      Apply the horizontal border strip, extending it past the
                      corner a distance greater than the width of the border.
                      Apply the vertical strip over the horizontal one.
                           Then, hold a straightedge along points where the
                      strips intersect and cut through both layers. Peel back the
                      strips and remove the cut ends, then press the strips back
                      into place. Roll the seams after 30 minutes and rinse any
                      adhesive from the area with a damp sponge.

                                                                                                                                                Wallcovering ■ 97

   058-103_11989.indd 97                                                                                                                                       5/21/09 5:06:15 PM

ects :96 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:97

         Wallcovering Panels

         C    ombine wallcovering and coordinating borders
              to create decorative wall panels that add smart
         design elegance to painted walls. Panels can be
         identical in size, or alternate wide panels with
         narrow ones. Whatever your approach, carefully
         space the panels evenly on the wall to maintain the
         balance of the room, leaving slightly more space
         below the panel than above. To plan the placement
         of panels, it may help to sketch the room, taking
         into account the position of windows, doors,
         and furnishings.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Butcher paper               Framing square
               Tape                        Smoothing brush
               Pencil                      Seam roller
               Carpenter’s level           Sponge                          Wallcovering panels divide up walls in large rooms, and can
                                                                           add color and variety to accent your color scheme.

         ■ How to Make Wallcovering Panels
            1                                                                2

         Determine the size and position of the wallcovering panels        Cut a strip of wallcovering for the center of each panel
         by cutting and taping butcher paper to the wall. Using a pencil   to size, using a framing square to ensure 90° angles at the
         and a carpenter’s level, mark the outline of the panels on the    corners. Prepare the strip following the instructions on
         wall. Measure and record the dimensions of each panel.            page 93.

    98 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_11989.indd 98 5/21/09 5:06:23 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:98

                   3                                                                     4

                Unfold and press the top portion of the booked strip lightly           Unfold the bottom half of the strip. Use flat palms to
                onto the wall, aligning the edges with the marked lines. Use flat      position the strip against the marked lines. Press the strip flat
                palms to slide the strip into place. Press the top of the strip flat   with a smoothing brush, checking for bubbles.
                with a smoothing brush, and check for bubbles.

                   5                                                                     6

                Cut and apply any remaining strips, matching the pattern               Apply the border strips in a clockwise direction, starting
                and butting the seams. Roll the seam after 30 minutes. Rinse           at the least conspicuous corner. Butt the inner edges of the
                any adhesive from the wallcovering and wall with a damp                border to the panel edges. Miter the corners (page 97). Smooth
                sponge. Prepare the border according to the instructions on            the first corner only lightly until the final strip is applied. Roll
                page 93.                                                               the outer edges of the border and seams after 30 minutes.

                                                                                                                                                Wallcovering ■ 99

   058-103_11989.indd 99                                                                                                                                       5/21/09 5:06:39 PM

ects :98 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:99

         Wall Upholstery

         U    pholstered walls help create an inviting
              atmosphere. The fabric covers any imperfections
         on the walls, and the batting used as padding helps
         insulate the room and absorbs sound. Avoid using
         fabrics in plaids or strips, because they call attention
         to walls that are not squared. Stapling the fabric to
         drywall or paneled walls is easy; however, staples
         will not penetrate metal corner pieces. For plaster
         walls, check to see if staples will penetrate the wall
         and hold. Before starting, remove switch plates and
         outlet covers. Do not remove moldings or baseboards,
         because double welting will cover the fabric edges.
              Cut fabric lengths as figured in the chart, next
         page; do not trim the selvages unless they show
         through the fabric. Measure around doors and
         windows and along the ceiling and baseboard; also
         measure from the floor to the ceiling at each corner.
         For the double welting, cut fabric strips, 3" wide,
         equal to the total of these measurements.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Decorator fabric               Single-edged
               Polyester                         razor blades
                   upholstery batting         Hot glue gun and
               Staple gun                        glue sticks                 Upholstered walls add texture to a room. Soft fabrics are
               3
                ⁄8 to 1⁄2" staples            Thick craft glue               ideal for quiet rooms, such as a bedroom or an office. Coarse
               Pushpins                       Cording                        fabrics and vinyl are good for social spaces, such as a living
                                                                             room or a den.

               Finishing Tip ▸
               For an elegant finish, cover your outlet covers and switch
               plates with coordinating or matching fabric. Apply fabric,
               securing it well with diluted craft glue, and then clip and
               trim around openings. Turn raw edges to back of plate and
               glue in place.

  100 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_C51711.indd 100 6/3/09 3:04:47 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:100

                      Determine How Much Fabric to Purchase ▸
                      Before you get started, take measurements in your project room. Measure around all doors and windows, along the
                      ceiling and baseboard, and from the floor to the ceiling at each corner. Then, use these measurements and the chart
                      below to determine how much fabric you’ll need to complete this project before you head to the store.

                            Worksheet for Calculating Fabric

                            Cut Length                                                                                                             in.

                            Measurement from floor to ceiling plus 3"*                                                                             =

                            Cut Width

                            Width of fabric minus selvages                                                                                         =

                            Number of Fabric Widths Needed for Each Wall

                            Width of wall                                                                                                          =
                            Divided by cut width of fabric                                                                                         ÷

                            Number of fabric widths for wall**                                                                                     =

                            Amount of Fabric Needed for Double Welting

                            Total welting length (see cutting directions)                                                                          =
                            Divided by cut width of fabric                                                                                         ÷

                            Number of strips**                                                                                                     =
                            Multiplied by 3"                                                                                                       ×
                            Fabric needed for double welting                                                                                       =

                            Total Fabric Needed

                            Cut length (figured above)                                                                                             =
                            Number of fabric widths (figured above) for all walls                                                                  ×
                            Fabric needed for all walls                                                                                            =
                            Fabric needed for double welting                                                                                       +
                            Total length needed                                                                                                    =
                            Divided by 36"                                                                                                         ÷

                            Number of yd. needed                                                                                                   =                    yd.

                            * Allow extra for pattern repeat; do not subtract for windows and doors unless they cover most of the wall.
                            ** Round up to the nearest whole number.

                                                                                                                                                                      Wallcovering ■ 101

   058-103_11989.indd 101                                                                                                                                                            5/21/09 5:07:28 PM

ects 100 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:101

         ■ How to Upholster a Wall
            1                                                                2

         Staple batting to the wall every 6", leaving a 1" gap             Stitch the fabric panels together for each wall separately,
         between batting and the edge of the ceiling, corners,             matching the pattern, if necessary. Plan seam placement
         baseboards, and moldings. Butt edges between widths of            to avoid seams next to windows and doors. Make double
         batting. Cut out batting around switch and outlet openings.       welting (opposite).

            3                                                                4

         Start hanging fabric from the top, turning under 1⁄2" and         Anchor fabric in the corners, pulling taut and stapling
         stapling every 3 to 4". Begin at a corner where matching is not   close to the corner so the staples will be covered with double
         critical. Do not cut around the windows and doors.                welting. Trim excess fabric. Start next panel at the corner.

  102 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

058-103_11989.indd 102 5/21/09 5:07:28 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:102

                   5                                          6                                               7

                Staple along the baseboard, pulling         Mark outside corners of windows                Apply hot glue to the back of the
                and smoothing fabric taut to remove         and doors with pushpins. Cut out               double welting, about 5" at a time;
                any wrinkles. Trim the excess fabric        openings with diagonal cuts into               secure the double welting to the upper
                along baseboard using a single-edged        corners. Turn under the raw edges, and         and lower edges of the wall and around
                razor blade.                                staple around the molding.                     window and door frames. Carefully push
                                                                                                           the double welting in place to cover
                                                                                                           the staples.

                ■ How to Make Double Welting
                   1                                          2                                               3

                Place the cording on wrong side of          Place the second cord next to the              Stitch between the two cords on
                the 3" fabric strip. Fold fabric over the   first cord. Bring the fabric over the          the previous stitching line. Trim off
                cording, with an additional 1⁄2" seam       second length of cording.                      excess fabric next to the stitching; the
                allowance. Stitch with the zipper foot                                                     raw edge is on the back of the finished
                next to the cording.                                                                       double welting.

                                                                                                                                           Wallcovering ■ 103

   058-103_11989.indd 103                                                                                                                                 5/21/09 5:07:35 PM

ects 102 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:103

104-139_C51711.indd 104 6/3/09 12:40:28 PM (Ray) Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:104

                                          Wall &
                                          Window Trim
                                          D    ecorative baseboards, moldings, and window
                                               casings are the best way to establish your rooms
                                          as refined, complete living spaces. Although beautiful
                                          trim is not usually the first thing many people notice
                                          about a room, it not only contributes to the entire
                                          aesthetic of a space, but also highlights the design
                                          choices that make your home stand apart.
                                               Crown moldings, built-up baseboards, and artistic
                                          chair rails can add grace and elegance to flat walls
                                          without overwhelming the space. Framing a room-to-
                                          room transition or basement window can complete an
                                          element that you hadn’t considered incomplete before.
                                          Stylistic trim can also serve a practical function, such
                                          as showcasing art and collectibles or protecting your
                                          walls from damage.
                                               With a few common tools and an imaginative
                                          eye, transform your bare walls into unique, charming
                                          frames for day-to-day living with one of these projects.

                                          In this chapter:
                                          • Base Molding                       • Window Casing
                                          • Picture Rail                       • Arts & Crafts
                                          • Chair Rail                           Window Casing
                                          • Built-up Chair Rail                • Painting Window Casing
                                          • Wall Opening Trim                  • Window Shelf
                                          • Crown Molding                      • Basement Window Trim
                                          • Built-up Cornices

                                                                                                                  ■ 105

   104-139_C51711.indd 105                                                                                       6/3/09 12:40:39 PM

ects 104 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:105

         Base Molding

         B    aseboard trim is installed to conceal the joint
              between the finished floor and the wallcovering.
         It also serves to protect the wallboard at the floor.
                                                                                 Tools & Materials ▸
         Installing plain, one-piece baseboard such as ranch-style               Pencil                           Framing square
         base or cove base is a straightforward project. Outside                 Tape measure                     Table saw
         corner joints are mitered, inside corners are coped, and                Power miter saw                      or circular saw
         long runs are joined with scarf cuts (see page 47 to 49).               T-bevel                          Base shoes
              The biggest challenge to installing base is dealing                Coping saw                       Cap rails
         with out-of-plumb and nonsquare corners. However, a                     Metal file set                   2" finish nails
         T-bevel makes these obstacles easy to overcome.                         Pneumatic finish                 Wood glue
              Plan the order of your installation prior to cutting                  nail gun                      11⁄4" brad nails
         any pieces and lay out a specific piece for each length                    & compressor                  Brad nailer
         of wall. It may be helpful to mark the type of cut on                   Moldings                         18 gauge,
         the back of each piece so you don’t have any confusion                  Pneumatic fasteners                  5
                                                                                                                       ⁄8" brad nails
         during the install.                                                     Carpenter’s glue                 Nail set
              Locate all studs and mark them with painter’s                      Finishing putty                  Putty
         tape, 6 inches higher than your molding height. If you
         need to make a scarf joint along a wall, make sure it
         falls on the center of a stud. Before you begin nailing
         trim in place, take the time to pre-finish the moldings.
         Doing so will minimize the cleanup afterward.

         ■ How to Install One-piece Base Molding
            1                                                                 2

                1

         Measure, cut, and install the first piece of baseboard (1).        Cut the second piece (2) of molding oversized by 6 to 10"
         Butt both ends into the corners tightly. For longer lengths, it    and cope cut the adjoining end to the first piece. Fine-tune the
         is a good idea to cut the piece slightly oversized (up to 1⁄16"    cope with a metal file and sandpaper. Dry-fit the joint, adjusting
         on strips over 10 ft. long) and “spring” it into place. Nail the   it as necessary to produce a tight-fitting joint.
         molding in place with two nails at every stud location.

  106 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 106 5/21/09 6:22:56 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:106

                   3                                                                 4
                                                                                                                         2
                                                                                                                                 3

                                                                                                                 2
                                               2

                     1

                Check the corner for square with a framing square. If              Adjust the miter angle of your saw to cut the adjoining
                necessary, adjust the miter cut of your saw. Use a T-bevel to      outside corner piece (3, inset). Test fit the cut to ensure a tight
                transfer the proper angle. Cut the second piece (coped) to         joint (inset photo). Remove the mating piece of trim and fasten
                length, and install it with two nails at each stud location.       the first piece for the outside corner joint.

                   5                                                                 6

                                                                                                                         4
                                                                                                 3

                                                3

                Lay out any scarf joints by placing the piece in position so       Nail the third piece in place, making sure the outside
                that the previous joint is tight, and then marking the center of   corner joint is tight. Cut the end of the fourth piece (4) to
                a stud location nearest the opposite end. Set your saw to a 30°    match the scarf joint angle and nail it in place with two nails
                angle and cut the molding at the marked location.                  at each stud location. Add the remaining pieces of molding, fill
                                                                                   the nail holes with putty, and apply a final coat of finish.

                                                                                                                                     Wall & Window Trim ■ 107

   104-139_11989.indd 107                                                                                                                                  5/21/09 6:22:58 PM

ects 106 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:107

         ■ How to Install Built-up Base Molding
            1                                                                 2
                                                               Cap rail
                                                                                             Attach
                                                                                         baseboard to                           Attach cap
                                                                                           wall studs                          to baseboard
                                                                                            with 2"                           with 18-gauge,
                                                                                                                                 5
                                                                                          finish nails                             ⁄ 8" brads

                                                                                                                                    Attach
                                                                                                                                  base shoe
                                                                                                                                 to subfloor
                                                                                                                                   with 1 1⁄ 2"
                                                                                                                                 finish nails

                                                               Quarter
                                                                round

         Dress up simple baseboard stock with cap moldings and              Built-up baseboard requires more attention to the nailing
         base shoes or quarter rounds. The baseboard can be made            schedule than simple one-piece baseboards. The most important
         of solid wood, as shown above, or from strips of veneered          consideration (other than making sure your nails are all driven
         plywood, as shown on the opposite page.                            into studs or other solid wood) is that the base shoe must be
                                                                            attached to the floor, while the baseboard is attached to the wall.
                                                                            This way, as the gap between the wall and floor changes, the
                                                                            parts of the built-up molding can change with them.

            3                                                                 4
                                                                                                   Stud location
                                                                                Open
                                                                               bevel for
                                                                              scarf joint

                                                                                                            Back-cut bevel
                                                                                                            for scarf joint

         Cut the plywood panel into 6" strips with a table saw or a         Install the plywood strips with 2" finish nails driven at stud
         straightedge guide and a circular saw. Lightly sand the strips,    locations. Use scarf joints on continuous runs, driving pairs of
         removing any splinters left from the saw. Then, apply the finish   fasteners into the joints. Cut and install moldings so that all
         of your choice to the moldings and the plywood strips.             scarf joints fall at stud locations.

  108 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 108 5/21/09 6:23:2 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:108

                   5                                                                     6
                                                                                                                                    Nail and glue 45°
                                                                                                                                   outside miter joint
                                                                                                                                    before attaching
                                                                                                                                       baseboard

                Test-fit inside corner butt joints before cutting a                    Miter outside corners squarely at 45°. Use wood glue and
                workpiece. If the walls are not square or straight, angle              11⁄4" brad nails to pull the mitered pieces tight, and then nail
                or bevel the end cut a few degrees to fit the profile of the           the base to the wall at stud locations with 2" finish nails. Small
                adjoining piece. The cap molding will cover any gaps at the top        gaps at the bottom or top of the base molding will be covered
                of the joint.                                                          with cap or base shoe.

                   7                                                                        Finishing Baseboards ▸

                Use a brad nailer with 18-gauge, 5⁄8" brads to install the cap              Prepare the baseboards and wall for painting.
                and base shoe moldings along the edges of the plywood base.                 Apply a light coat of paint starting at the top edge of
                Fit scarf joints on longer lengths, coped joints on inside corners,         the baseboard and working toward the floor. Hold
                and miter joints on outside corners. Stagger the seams so that              a drywall knife or plastic shielding tool beneath the
                they do not line up with the base molding seams, following the              baseboard as you paint and wipe the tool each time
                suggested nailing pattern (previous page, top right). Set any               it is moved.
                protruding nails with a nail set and fill all nail holes with putty.

                                                                                                                                       Wall & Window Trim ■ 109

   104-139_11989.indd 109                                                                                                                                       5/21/09 6:23:5 PM

ects 108 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:109

         Picture Rail

         P    icture rail molding is a specialty molding that was
              installed in many older homes so homeowners could
         hang artwork without making nail holes in the finished
                                                                                Tools & Materials ▸
         walls. Today, picture rail molding is still used as a clean,           Ladder
         functional means to hang art—but it also provides its                  Pencil
         own decorative touch, breaking up the vertical lines                   Stud finder
         from floor to ceiling. Many homeowners choose to                       Tape measure
         install picture rails as a decorative accent alone.                    Power miter saw
              Picture rail molding is easy to install but should be             T-bevel
         reinforced with screws, not brads or nails, especially                 Pneumatic finish nail gun & compressor
         if you will be hanging large, heavy items. Depending                   4-ft. level or laser level
         upon the style of your home, picture rails can be hung                 Drill with bits
         anywhere from 1 ft. to a few inches from the ceiling. If               Painter’s tape
         you already have cornices or crown molding, you may                    Moldings
         want to consider adding a picture rail just below to add               Pneumatic fasteners
         an additional layer of depth. When applied this way, a                 15⁄8" wallboard screws
         picture rail is commonly referred to as a frieze board.                Wood filler

         ■ How to Install Picture Rail Molding
            1                                                                 2

         Measure down the desired distance from the ceiling and             Most corners are close to 90°, but to cut a tight inside
         draw a level reference line around the room using a pencil         corner, the actual angle must be divided exactly in half. Use a
         and a 4-ft. level (or, take advantage of modern technology and     T-bevel to measure the angle of the corner, tightening the lock
         use a laser level). While you are up there, use a stud finder to   nut with the blade and the handle on the reference line.
         locate the framing members, and mark the locations on the
         walls with blue painter’s tape.

  110 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 110 5/21/09 6:23:9 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:110

                   3                                                                     4

                Place the T-bevel on the table of your power miter saw                 Read the angle from the miter saw table, divide the
                and adjust the miter blade so that it matches the angle. With          number by 2, and add or subtract that number from 45° to find
                the T-bevel tight to the fence, read the angle the saw is set to       the proper cutting angle for each corner. Cut each molding
                when it aligns with the T-bevel. If the blade is angled to the         slightly longer than the measured length.
                right of 0° the angle is larger than 90°; to the left, it’s smaller.

                   5                                                                     6

                Nail the molding at the stud locations, covering the level             Fill nail holes with wood filler. Let the filler dry and sand it
                line around the room (if you’re using a laser level, you simply        smooth. Then apply a final coat of paint over the molding face.
                keep it in position and turned on to cast a reference line you
                can follow). After each molding is completely nailed in place,
                go back to each stud location and drive 15⁄8" wallboard screws
                into the molding through counter-bored pilot holes.

                                                                                                                                       Wall & Window Trim ■ 111

   104-139_11989.indd 111                                                                                                                                      5/21/09 6:23:41 PM

ects 110 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:111

         Chair Rail

         C    hair rails were originally installed to protect walls
              from collisions with chair backs, but today, a
         chair rail is primarily a stylistic decorative element
                                                                      Tools & Materials ▸
         that helps to divide a wall visually. Chair rails may cap    Pencil                         Painter’s tape
         wainscoting, serve as a border for wallcoverings, or         Stud finder                    Carpenter’s glue
         divide two different paint colors on a wall.                 Tape measure                   Finishing putty
              A chair rail typically runs horizontally along walls    Power miter saw                Finishing materials
         at a height of around 36" (the rule of thumb is to           4-ft. level                    Coping saw
         install it one-third of the way up the wall). When           Air compressor                 180-grit sandpaper
         determining the height of your chair rail, keep in mind      Finish nail gun
         the height of your existing furnishings. It would be         Metal file set
         disappointing to discover that the new molding has a         Moldings
         bad visual effect with your couch or chair backs when        Pneumatic fasteners
         the project is completed.

         ■ How to Install a Chair Rail
                                                                                     On the starting wall of your installation,
            1                                                                        measure up to the height at which you
                                                                                     plan to install the chair rail, minus the
                                                                                     width of the molding. Mark a level line
                                                                                     at this height around the room. Locate
                                                                                     all studs along the walls and mark their
                                                                                     locations with painter’s tape below
                                                                                     the line.
                                           Wall stud locations

                                                                                     Measure, cut, and install the first piece
            2                                                                        of chair rail with the ends cut squarely,
                                                                                     butting into both walls (in a wall run with
                                                                                     two inside corners). Nail the molding in
                                                                                     place with two 2" finish nails at each
                                                                                     stud location.

  112 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 112 5/21/09 6:23:44 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:112

                   3                                              4
                                                                                     Coped joint

                                                                                            Coped piece

                                                                       Butted piece

                Miter-cut the second piece of                   When the coped joint fits tightly, measure, mark, and cut the opposing end of
                molding with a power miter saw and              the second piece of trim squarely with a miter saw. Nail the second piece in place
                then cope the end with a coping saw.            with two nails at each stud location. Follow the level line with the bottom edge of
                Clean up the edge of the cope cut with a        the molding.
                metal file to ensure a tight fit. Dry-fit the
                piece to check for any gaps in the joint.

                   5

                Install the third piece of the chair rail with a cope cut at one end. Use a butt joint         Option: Cut a mitered return for the
                where the molding runs into door and window casings. Fill all nail holes with putty            chair rail in areas where it will end
                and apply a final coat of finish to the molding.                                               without joining into another molding.
                                                                                                               Cut the return with a miter saw and glue
                                                                                                               it in place using painter’s tape to hold it
                                                                                                               until the glue dries.

                                                                                                                                      Wall & Window Trim ■ 113

   104-139_C51711.indd 113                                                                                                                                    6/3/09 12:40:15 PM

ects 112 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:113

         Built-up Chair Rail

         B    y combining stock chair rail moldings and multiple
              pieces of assorted trim that are available at most
         lumberyards and home centers, you can easily create
         intricate and elaborate chair rails on your own. When
         developing your design, bear in mind the style of your
         existing moldings so that the new chair rail will not
         look out of place. To maintain balance in the room,
         your chair rail should always be smaller than the
         crown molding and/or baseboards.
              To accentuate your built-up chair rail, consider two-
         tone painted walls or adding a wainscot or wallcoverings
         to further emphasize the division of the wall.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Painter’s tape                Coping saw
               Moldings                      Pneumatic finish
               Pneumatic fasteners               nail gun
               15⁄8" wallboard screws            & compressor
               Hole filler                   4 ft. level
               Pencil                            or laser level
               Stud finder                   Combination square                  A built-up chair rail is made up of several styles of moldings,
               Tape measure                  21⁄2" finish nails                  so the design options are unlimited. Experiment with molding
               Power miter saw               15⁄8" brad nails                    samples when finalizing your design. See inset for a cutaway
                                                                                 view of the molding pictured here.

         ■ How to Install a Built-up Chair Rail
            1                                            2                                                    3

         Mark the desired height of the                Install the filler strip so that the top            Install the upper piece of cove
         1 × 4 filler strip, or the first chair rail   edge follows the level line around the              molding around the room, nailing it flush
         component you will install. Mark a            room. Fasten with two 2½” finish nails              to the top edge of the filler strip. Drive
         level line around the room at this            at every stud location. Butt the ends               one nail at every stud location and one
         height, noting the location of studs with     of the filler strip together. Joints will be        nail between each stud into the filler
         painter’s tape.                               covered with additional moldings.                   strip. Install the lower piece of cove
                                                                                                           molding flush with the bottom edge of
                                                                                                           the filler strip.

  114 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_C51729.indd 114 6/10/09 2:59:39 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51729) #175 Dtp:119 Page:114

                   4                                                                   5

                                                                                        Screen molding will
                                                                                        conceal gap between
                                                                                         stop molding strips

                Install the upper piece of stop molding, driving two finish          Set a combination square to 13⁄8". Rest the body of the
                nails at each stud location. Install the lower piece of stop         square on the top edge of the upper stop molding and use the
                molding keeping the edge flush with the bottom edge of the           blade as a guide to mark a reference line for the top edge of
                filler strip. Stagger the seams of the stop molding so that they     the screen molding.
                do not line up with the joints of the cove moldings.

                   6                                                                     Chair Rail Return ▸
                                                                                         Before you begin installing the molding pieces of the
                                                                                         built-up chair rail, decide what type of return you
                                                                                         will use. Returns are finish details that occur in areas
                                                                                         where different moldings meet at perpendicular
                                                                                         angles, or quit in the middle of a wall. A beveled
                                                                                         return (below left) is a bit difficult to produce, but has
                                                                                         a clean look. On some built-up chair rails, you can
                                                                                         take advantage of the depth of molding by butting the
                                                                                         back moldings up to the obstructions, but running the
                                                                                         cap moldings onto the surface (below right).

                Fine-tune the cope cuts of the screen molding with a
                round metal file. Nail the molding in place with 15⁄8" brad nails,
                keeping the top edge flush with the reference line. Set nail
                heads, fill nail holes and any gaps in the joinery. When dry, sand
                with 180-grit sandpaper and wipe clean with a dry cloth (inset).

                                                                                                                                    Wall & Window Trim ■ 115

   104-139_11989.indd 115                                                                                                                                    5/21/09 6:24:2 PM

ects 114 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:115

         Wall Opening Trim

         T   ransitions between rooms are an often-overlooked
             opportunity to add polished refinement to your
         home. Trimming out a wallboard opening frames the
                                                                         Storing Trim ▸
         entrance for the room and protects the wallboard
         from damage. Choose either paint-grade materials,
         or utilize a clear finish, which showcases the wood
         grain and adds warm, natural detail to your interior.
         Trimming a wall opening draws attention to your
         home’s structural detail, and invites old-world charm
         into contemporary spaces.
              Bear in mind that finished wallboard corners
         are likely irregular, which will cause some minor
         differences in wall thickness along the jambs of the            To avoid problems due to potential shrinkage after
         opening. When these irregularities are minute (less             installation, stack the trim in the room where it will
         than 3⁄16"), it is best to cut the jamb materials at the        be installed and allow it to acclimate for several days.
                                                                         Apply a coat of primer or sealer to all sides of each
         widest jamb measurement and let the casing bridge               piece and let it dry thoroughly before installing it. You
         the difference. When wall thickness varies a lot (3⁄16"         may choose to paint or stain the trim before installing it,
         or more), it is better to cut tapered jambs to cover            although this can be completed once installed as well.
         the difference.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Jamb material (lumber or plywood)    Wood glue       Side cutters       Circular saw and straightedge guide
               Case moldings                        Shims           Pencil             Pneumatic finish nail gun
               Base moldings                        Scrap 2 × 4     Tape measure       Power miter saw
               21⁄2" finish nails                   Pry bar         4 ft. level        Framing square

                                                                                          Pass-through openings between rooms
                                                                                          are often left naked by the builders,
                                                                                          especially in modern homes. Give your
                                                                                          living spaces a distinguished finish by
                                                                                          adding trim and transforming openings
                                                                                          into framed transitions between rooms.
          Before

  116 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 116 5/21/09 6:24:7 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:116

                ■ How to Trim a Wall Opening
                   1                                                             2

                Remove the existing base molding with a pry bar and            Measure the width and length of the head jamb and
                hammer. Be careful not to mar the surface of the moldings as   the width of each side jamb. Measure each jamb at both
                you remove them. Pull the nails out of the moldings through    ends as well as in the middle of each run. Take note of the
                the back face with an end nippers or side cutters.             measurements. If a jamb differs in width by more than 3⁄16",
                                                                               install a tapered length (see Tip, below).

                      Tip: Cutting Tapered Jambs ▸                               3

                                                            Guide

                                                W
                                               sa idth
                                                 w
                                                    fo of
                                                      ot

                       Width at top
                        left corner
                                                                                                    Cutting guide
                               1× lumber

                                      Width at top
                                      right corner

                                                                                                      Jamb stock
                      Jambs that do not taper can be cut on a table
                      saw, but if you have enough variation in your jamb
                      widths that a taper is called for, make a simple
                      cutting jig and taper-cut the jambs to width with a      Clamp a straightedge guide to the head jamb on the
                      circular saw. Then, lay out the dimensions on the        reference line from the measurements of step 2, and cut
                      head jamb using the measurements from step 2. The        the piece to width with a circular saw. Keep the base plate
                      head jamb should run the full length of the opening.     tight against the fence and move the saw smoothly through
                                                                               the board. Reposition the clamp when you near the end of
                                                                               the board.
                                                                                                                                            (continued)

                                                                                                                               Wall & Window Trim ■ 117

   104-139_11989.indd 117                                                                                                                             5/22/09 12:37:21 PM

ects 116 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:117

            4                                                                 5

         Position the head jamb at the top of the opening, flush with       Place a T-bevel on the floor at the bottom of each side jamb
         the edges, and nail it in place starting in the middle. Before     to check for any angled cuts necessary to follow the pitch of
         nailing the ends of the head jamb, check it for square with the    the floor. The handle of the bevel should rest against the outer
         walls of the opening, adjusting with shims if necessary. Drive a   face of the wall, with the blade across the floor.
         pair of 2" finish nails every 16".

            6                                                                 7

         Transfer the angle from the T-bevel in step 5 to a power           Nail the side jambs in place using pairs of 2" finish nails
         miter saw, and cut the side jambs to length. The top end of the    driven every 16" along the jamb. Check the edges of the jamb
         jamb should be cut square (90°). Each jamb should butt against     pieces as you go to make sure they are flush with the surface
         the head jamb and fit tightly to the finished flooring.            of the wall.

  118 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 118 5/21/09 6:24:14 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:118

                   8                                                                 9

                Install casing around the opening. Maintain a consistent           Measure, cut, and reinstall the existing baseboard so that
                3
                 ⁄16 to 1⁄4" reveal around the opening.                            the ends butt into the sides of the casing.

                      Tips for a Good Installation ▸

                                      15 ga. × 2 1⁄ 2" finish nails

                                       15 ga. × 2" finish nails

                      Attach wood trim with finish nails, which have small         After the trim is installed and the nails are set, fill
                      nail heads that you drive below the surface using a nail     nail holes with wood putty and touch up areas with paint
                      set. Nails for most trim are size 6d or smaller, depending   or stain.
                      on the thickness of the trim and the wall surface. At a
                      minimum, nails should be long enough to penetrate the
                      framing by at least ¾"; heavier trim requires nails with
                      more holding power. Use finish screws for securing trim to
                      steel studs.

                                                                                                                                  Wall & Window Trim ■ 119

   104-139_11989.indd 119                                                                                                                                 5/21/09 6:24:17 PM

ects 118 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:119

         Crown Molding

         C    rown molding is angled trim that bridges the joint
              between the ceiling and the wall and helps soften
         the transition between walls and ceilings. Crown
                                                                                Tools & Materials ▸
         molding comes in a variety of materials and finishes,                  Pencil                           2 × 4 material
         from hardwood finished with a clear topcoat to paint-                  Tape measure                        for backing
         grade materials such as polymer.                                       Circular saw                     Carpenter’s glue
              If working with wood crown, inside corner joints of               Straightedge guide               Crown molding
         crown molding should be cope cut, not mitered, except in               Drill with bits                  2", 11⁄2" finish nails
         the case of very intricate profile crown that is impossible            Coping saw                       Fine-grit sandpaper
         to cope (and therefore must be mitered). While mitering                Power miter saw                  Hole filler
         inside corners may appear to save time and produce                     Pneumatic finish                 Paint and brushes
         adequate results, after a few changing seasons the joints                 nail gun                      Sandpaper
         will open up and be even more difficult to conceal.                    Framing square                   Mineral spirits
              Polymer crown, on the other hand, is just as easy                    or combination                Polymer adhesive
         to cut as wood, but won’t shrink and can be repaired                      square                        Vinyl spackling
         with vinyl spackling compound. Most polymers come                      Nail set                            compound
         in 12-ft. lengths and some have corner blocks that                     Hammer                           Paintable latex caulk
         eliminate the need for corner cutting. If you’d like to                Metal files                      Caulk gun
         apply crown to curved walls, flexible moldings are also                3" wallboard screws              Putty knife
         available in polymer.

         ■ How to Install Wood Crown Molding
            1                                 Test cope cuts
                                            against this profile
                                                                              2

         Cut a piece of crown molding about 1 ft. long with square          Place the first piece of molding upside down and sprung
         ends. Temporarily install the piece in the corner of the last      against the fence of the miter saw. Mark a reference line on
         installation wall with two screws driven into the blocking. This   the fence for placement of future moldings, and cut the first
         piece serves as a template for the first cope cut on the first     coped end with an inside miter cut to reveal the profile of
         piece of molding.                                                  the piece.

  120 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 120 5/21/09 6:24:22 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:120

                   3                                            4
                                                                                     Temporary scrap

                Cope cut the end of the first piece          Measure, cut to length, and install the first piece of crown molding, leaving
                with a coping saw. Carefully cut along       the end near the temporary scrap loose for final fitting of the last piece. Nail the
                the profile, angling the saw as you cut to   molding at the top and bottom of each stud location.
                back-bevel the cope. Test-fit the coped
                cut against the temporary scrap from
                step 1. Fine-tune the cut with files and
                fine-grit sandpaper.

                   5                Test pieces                                       6

                Cut two test pieces to check the fit of outside corners. Start     Position the actual stock so a cut end is flush against the
                with each molding cut at 45°, adjusting the angles larger or       wall at one end. At the other end, mark the outside corner on
                smaller until the joints are tight. Make sure the test moldings    the back edge of the molding. Miter cut the piece at the mark,
                are properly aligned and are flush with the ceiling and walls.     according to the angles you noted on the test pieces.
                Make a note of your saw settings once the joint fits tightly.
                                                                                                                                                (continued)

                                                                                                                                   Wall & Window Trim ■ 121

   104-139_11989.indd 121                                                                                                                                  5/21/09 6:24:45 PM

ects 120 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:121

            7                                             8                                                 9

         Measure and cut the third piece                To fit the final piece, cope the                 Fill all nail holes. Use a putty knife or
         with an outside corner miter to match          end and cut it to length. Remove the             your finger to force spackling compound
         the angle of your test pieces. Cut the         temporary scrap piece from step 3 and            or tinted wood putty into loose joints.
         other end squarely, butting it into the        slide the last molding into position. Nail       Caulk gaps 1⁄8" or smaller between the
         corner. Install the piece with nails driven    the last piece at the stud locations when        molding and the wall or ceiling with
         at stud locations. Install the subsequent      the joints fit well, and finish nailing the      flexible, paintable latex caulk. Lightly
         pieces of crown molding, coping the            first piece.                                     sand the nail holes and joint gaps.
         front end and butting the other as you
         work around the room.

         ■ How to Install Polymer Crown Molding
            1                                                                     2

         Plan the layout of the molding pieces by measuring the                 Hold a section of the molding in the finished position. Make
         walls of the room and making light pencil marks at the joint           a light pencil mark on the wall every 12" along the bottom
         locations. For each piece that starts or ends at a corner, add         edge. Remove the molding and tack a finish nail at each mark.
         12" to 24" to compensate for waste. If possible, avoid pieces          The nails will hold the molding in place while the adhesive
         shorter than 36", because short pieces are more difficult to fit.      dries. To make the miter cuts for the first corner, position the
                                                                                molding in a miter box with the ceiling side against the table
                                                                                and the wall side against the fence (inset). Make the cut at 45°.

  122 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 122 5/21/09 6:24:48 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:122

                   3                                              4                                             5

                Check the uncut ends of each                   Run a small bead of polymer adhesive          Drive 2" drywall screws through
                molding piece before installing it. Make       along the edges where the molding will        countersunk pilot holes through the
                sure mating pieces will butt together          contact the wall and ceiling. Set the         flats and into the ceiling and wall at
                squarely in a tight joint. Cut all square      molding in place with the mitered end         each end of the piece.
                ends at 90°. Lightly sand the backs of the     tight to the corner and the bottom edge
                molding where it will contact the wall         resting on the nails. Press to create a
                and ceiling. Slightly dampen a rag with        good bond.
                mineral spirits and wipe away the dust.

                   6                                                                     Finishing Crown Molding ▸

                                                                                         Crown molding can be painted the same color
                Apply a bead of adhesive to the end where the installed                  as the ceiling or with highly elaborate details.
                molding will meet the next piece. Prepare and install the                Finish wood crown with a clear topcoat for an
                remaining pieces, making sure the ends are joined properly.              appealing natural look. For deeply patterned crown
                Allow adhesive to dry completely, and then carefully remove              molding surfaces, use a stiff-bristled brush, such
                the finish nails. Fill nail holes with spackling compound and fill       as a stenciling brush. Use small, circular strokes to
                screw holes and any gaps in the joints with latex caulk (see             penetrate recesses.
                inset). Wipe away excess and smooth the caulk over the holes.

                                                                                                                                    Wall & Window Trim ■ 123

   104-139_11989.indd 123                                                                                                                                   5/21/09 6:24:54 PM

ects 122 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:123

         Built-up Cornices

         D    esigning your own cornice molding is a creative
              and fun process that allows you to custom-
         design molding to fit the style of your room. A
                                                                                  Tools & Materials ▸
         cornice is, by definition, an elaborate crown molding,                   Molding                           Chalk line
         bridging the space where the wall meets the ceiling.                     2" and 11⁄4" finish nails         Power miter saw
         Although traditionally cornices have been made                           Carpenter’s glue                  Pneumatic
         of one continuous plaster piece, built-up types are                      Construction adhesive               finish nailer
         much cheaper to purchase and easier to install.                          Pencil                            Nail set
         And, they enable you to dictate every aspect of the                      Tape measure                      Hammer
         cornice design.
              First, go to the lumberyard and bring home
         samples of several types of moldings: baseboard, stop,
         crown, and bed moldings, as well as smaller trims                   not to overwhelm the room with a large, complicated
         like quarter rounds and coves. Bring the samples                    molding. A good rule of thumb is to try to match the
         home and arrange them in different combinations                     size of the cornice to the overall size of your baseboard
         and positions. As you design your cornice, be careful               for proportionate balance and an appealing finish.

         Built-up cornices are made of smaller pieces of trim, installed in layers. Cornice design is 100 percent customizable, and can
         significantly add to the formal finish of any living space.

  124 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 124 5/21/09 6:24:58 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:124

                      Cornice Variations ▸

                                                                                                                                              Quarter
                                                                Stop molding                                                                   round

                                                          Crown molding

                                                                                                        2×2

                                                                                                                                          1×2
                                                     Band

                                                       Picture rail

                                                                                                                       Crown molding

                      Use picture rail (page 110) to enhance a cornice               Install blocking to provide a nailing surface and added
                      molding. Standard height for picture rail is about 10 to 12"   bulk to a built-up cornice. In this simple arrangement, a
                      below the ceiling, but you can place it at any level. For a    2 × 2 block, or nailing strip, is screwed to the wall studs.
                      simple variation of the project shown, use a square-edged      A facing made from 1 × 2 finish lumber is nailed to the
                      stock for the band (since the bottom edge will mostly be       blocking and is trimmed along the ceiling with quarter-
                      hidden), and add picture rail just below the band.             round. The crown molding is nailed to the wall studs along
                                                                                     the bottom and to the nailer along the top.

                      This highly detailed Victorian-style built-up cornice          This Arts and Crafts variation is made up of flat solid
                      is made up of several pieces of stock trim and solid           stock ripped down to specific dimensions. Two pieces of
                      stock ripped down to different widths. The right-angle         1 × 2 stock are fastened together to form an L-shaped
                      component of this cornice may be screwed directly to           angle. The angle is then screwed to the wall at the stud
                      the wall to serve both as a decorative function as well as     locations. An additional piece of 1"-wide stock is nailed
                      a nailer for the other trim elements. The screw holes are      in place so the top edge is flush with the installed angle.
                      covered when the crown molding is installed.                   This configuration creates a step cornice with a simpler
                                                                                     appearance than the traditional sprung moldings. Notice
                                                                                     that the L angle is nailed together with a slight gap at the
                                                                                     back edge. This is done to compensate for irregularities in
                                                                                     the corner joint.

                                                                                                                                     Wall & Window Trim ■ 125

   104-139_11989.indd 125                                                                                                                                   5/22/09 12:59:35 PM

ects 124 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:125

         ■ How to Create a Built-up Cornice
            1                                                                   2

         Cut a 4- to 6"-long piece from each type of molding. Glue or         Locate and mark all of the wall studs and ceiling joists,
         nail the pieces together in the desired arrangement to create a      marking in areas that will be hidden by the crown molding.
         marking template. Position the template flush with the wall and
         ceiling and mark along the outside edges of the ceiling and
         wall moldings. Mark at both ends of each wall.

            3                                                                   4

         Snap chalk lines between the template marks you made in              Install the ceiling trim, aligning its outside edge with
         step 2 (you can also mark with a pencil and level). If the ceiling   the ceiling pencil line. Nail into the joists with 2" (6d) finish
         has a deep texture, scrape off the texture just behind the chalk     nails, and miter the joints at the inside and outside corners.
         lines, using a drywall taping knife.                                 Wherever possible, place the nails where they’ll be hidden by
                                                                              the crown molding.

  126 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_C51711.indd 126 6/3/09 12:39:43 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:126

                   5                                                                  6

                Where walls run parallel to the ceiling joists, and there           Cope the molding at inside corners by first cutting a 45°
                are no joists to nail into, apply a bead of construction adhesive   angle on the piece. Then cope cut the angle with a coping saw.
                to the trim and nail it in place with pairs of nails driven at      Cut along the front edge of the molding, following the contour.
                opposing angles. If you’re hand nailing, drill oversized pilot      Test-fit the cut and fine-tune it with a metal file if necessary.
                holes and secure the trim with coarse-thread drywall screws.        We chose to stain the pieces now, before installation.
                Let the adhesive dry before starting the next step.

                   7                                                                  8

                Align and install the wall trim with the pencil lines,              Add the crown molding, fastening it to the ceiling trim and
                nailing into each stud with two 2" nails. Miter the band at         wall band with 11⁄4" (3d) nails. Miter the molding at outside
                outside corners.                                                    corners, and miter or cope the inside corners. Use a nail set to
                                                                                    set all nails that aren’t countersunk.

                                                                                                                                    Wall & Window Trim ■ 127

   104-139_C51711.indd 127                                                                                                                                   6/3/09 12:41:1 PM

ects 126 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:127

         Window Casing

         D    oor and window casings provide an attractive
              border around doors and windows. They also
         cover the gaps between door or window jambs and the
                                                                              Tools & Materials ▸
         surfaces of surrounding walls.                                       Tape measure                    Hammer or
             Install door and window casings with a consistent                Pencil                             pneumatic nailer
         reveal between the inside edges of the jambs and                     Combination square              Casing material
         casings, making sure the casings are level and plumb.                Nail set                        Plinths and corner
             In order to fit casings properly, the jambs and                  Level                              blocks (optional)
         wallcoverings must lie in the same plane. If either one              Straightedge                    4d and 6d finish nails
         protrudes, the casings will not lie flush. To solve this             Power miter saw                 Wood putty
         problem, you’ll need to remove some material from
         whichever surface is protruding.
             Use a block plane to shave protruding jambs or a            facing paper to support the wallboard. If the paper
         surface forming rasp to shave a protruding wallboard            around the screws is damaged, drive additional screws
         edge. Wallboard screws rely on the strength of untorn           nearby where the paper is still intact.

         Case molding is installed around windows and doors to conceal the gaps between jambs and the wall. Venturing beyond the very
         common ranch-style casing offers some high design payback.

  128 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 128 5/21/09 6:25:16 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:128

                ■ How to Install Mitered Casing on Doors & Windows
                   1                                           2                                                  3

                On each jamb, mark a reveal line 1⁄8"        Place a length of casing along one                Make 45° miter cuts on the ends
                from the inside edge. The casings will be    side jamb, flush with the reveal line.            of the moldings. Measure and cut the
                installed flush with these lines. Note: On   At the top and bottom of the molding,             other vertical molding piece, using the
                double-hung windows, the casings are         mark the points where horizontal                  same method.
                usually installed flush with the edge of     and vertical reveal lines meet. (When
                the jambs, so no reveal line is needed.      working with doors, mark the molding
                                                             at the top only).

                   4                                           5                                                  6

                First drill pilot holes spaced every         Measure the distance between the                  Locknail the corner joints by drilling
                12" to prevent splitting, and then attach    side casings, and cut top and bottom              pilot holes and driving 4d finish nails
                the vertical casings with 4d finish nails    casings to fit, with ends mitered at              through each corner, as shown. Drive
                driven through the casings and into the      45°. If the window or door unit is not            all nail heads below the wood surface,
                jambs. Drive 6d finish nails into framing    perfectly square, make test cuts on               using a nail set, then fill the nail holes
                members near the outside edge of             scrap pieces to find the correct angle of         with wood putty.
                the casings.                                 the joints. Drill pilot holes and attach the
                                                             casings with 4d and 6d finish nails.

                                                                                                                                      Wall & Window Trim ■ 129

   104-139_11989.indd 129                                                                                                                                     5/21/09 6:25:23 PM

ects 128 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:129

         Arts & Crafts Window Casing

         T   raditional Arts and Crafts casings are made of
             simple, flat materials with little to no decorative
         molding trimmed out of the stock. Add non-mitered
                                                                    milling method of the material. Quartersawn oak is
                                                                    easily distinguishable from plainsawn oak by its tight
                                                                    grain pattern laced with rays of lighter color, known
         corners and this casing becomes as sleek and stylized      as rifts. Quartersawn oak is more expensive than
         as intended. The back band installed on the perimeter      plain oak, and may only be available at lumberyards
         of this project is optional, but it adds depth to the      or hardwood supply stores. Although quartersawn oak
         window treatment while maintaining simple style.           is the traditional material, plainsawn oak will finish
              Traditionally, the wood used for this style of trim   nicely as well.
         is quartersawn oak. The term quartersawn refers to the

               Tools & Materials ▸
               1 × 4 finish lumber                Finishing putty    Hand saw                              Pneumatic nailer
               Back band trim                     Tape measure       Circular saw or jigsaw                Combination square
               Wood shims                         Straightedge       Plane or rasp                         Compass
               4d, 6d, and 8d finish nails        Power miter saw    Drill hammer                          Nail set

                                                                                        The Arts and Crafts style is similar
                                                                                        to the overall look and feel of Mission
                                                                                        furniture, as can be seen in this relatively
                                                                                        simple oak window casing.

  130 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 130 5/21/09 6:25:30 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:130

                ■ How to Install Arts & Crafts Casing
                   1                                                                 2

                Install the stool and jamb extensions according to                 To find the length of the head casing and apron,
                traditional stool and apron trim methods. Set a combination        measure the distance between the reveal lines on the side
                square to 3⁄16" or ¼" and mark a reveal line on the top and        jambs and add twice the width of the side casings. Cut the
                side jambs.                                                        head casing and the apron to length. Install the head casing
                                                                                   flush with the top reveal line. Use a scrap piece of trim to line
                                                                                   up the head casing horizontally.

                   3                                                                 4                               Back band

                Measure and cut the side casings to length. Install them           Measure, cut, and install the back band around the
                flush with the reveal lines. Make sure the joints at the top and   perimeter of the window casings, mitering the joints at the
                bottom are tight. Measure the distance to the end of the stool     corners. Continue the back band around the edge of the apron,
                from the outer edge of the side casing. Install the apron tight    mitering the corners. Nail the back band in place with 4d
                to the bottom of the stool at the same dimension from the end      finish nails.
                of the stool.

                                                                                                                                   Wall & Window Trim ■ 131

   104-139_C51711.indd 131                                                                                                                                 6/3/09 12:41:28 PM

ects 130 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:131

         Painting Window Casing

         W      indows are on the frontline of the daily bump
                and grind, and a fresh coat of paint can freshen
         their appearance and make your room décor bright
         and lasting. Always begin with the inside edges and
         work your way toward the walls. On windows, this
         means you should start with the sashes and finish with
         the case molding. To achieve a smooth, even finish,
         make sure all nail holes and dents are filled with latex
         wood filler and that the surface is sanded, primed, and
         sanded again before you begin.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Primer and paint
               Painter’s tape
               11⁄2" tapered sash brush
               Corner masks
               Drill
               Ladder or sawhorses
               Sandpaper                                                  A fresh coat of paint can both refresh the appearance and
                                                                          prolong the life of window casings.

         ■ How to Paint Window Casings
            1                                                               2

         Prepare the window to be painted. Remove hardware,               Remove double-hung window sashes from their frames
         apply tape or corner masks to glass, and apply tape around the   when possible. To release a spring-mounted, double-hung
         outside edges of the case molding.                               window sash, press against the frame and pull the sash
                                                                          toward you.

  132 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 132 5/21/09 6:27:18 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:132

                   3                                                                4

                Using a tapered sash brush, begin by painting the wood            Paint the case moldings, sill, and apron. Let the paint dry
                next to the glass. Use the narrow edge of the brush. Then,        completely. Sand lightly and apply a second coat. When dry,
                paint the flat portions of the sash. Use slow brush strokes and   remove the tape and replace the sashes.
                smooth the paint carefully. Do not paint the sides or bottom of
                the window sash.

                      Casement Windows ▸                                              Painting Sashes ▸
                                                                                      To paint sashes that have been removed, drill
                                                                                      holes and drive 3" nails into the legs of a wooden
                                                                                      stepladder. Set the window on the nails as though on
                                                                                      an easel. Windows can also be placed flat on a bench
                                                                                      or on sawhorses.

                      Remove the hardware and apply tape and
                      corner masks. Paint the wood next to the glass,
                      then the flat portions of the sash, followed by the
                      case moldings and sills. Move the sash in and out to
                      comfortably reach all areas. Do not paint the sides,
                      top, or bottom of the sash.

                                                                                                                                 Wall & Window Trim ■ 133

   104-139_11989.indd 133                                                                                                                                5/21/09 6:27:25 PM

ects 132 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:133

         Window Shelf

         S   helves above windows are a delightful addition
             to bright rooms, and allow you to showcase
         plants, artistic collections, or dried flowers and herbs.
         They can be used alone or with brackets installed
         underneath for hanging items or window treatments.
              Although the end pieces act as supports for the
         shelf, it’s also a good idea to secure the shelf to a
         horizontal support piece. Then, attach the whole unit
         to the wall with wood screws. If you know what will
         be displayed on the shelf, plan your project around
         those objects. If you’d like to display heavy items,
         add strength by drilling more pilot holes for the wood
         screws to be closer together. If the objects are large,               Window shelves are a great place to showcase treasured
         adjust the depth of the shelf to accommodate them.                    decorative items and design your own decorative end pieces.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               1 × 8 and 1 × 2                 6d casing nails                 Drill and bits                      Router
                  lumber                       Paint or stain                  Circular saw                        Sander
               2" wood screws                  Hammer                          Jigsaw                              Nail set

               Additional Shelf Ideas ▸
               Window shelves are a great way to combine functionality with bold design choices. Add large, decorative supports to
               accommodate a dowel for hanging objects such as dried flowers or herbs. Add a coordinating backsplash to add to the
               presentation of items, or attach hooks to the underside for smart storage of essentials.

  134 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 134 5/21/09 6:27:31 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:134

                ■ How to Build a Window Shelf
                   1                                                                 2

                Attach the 1 × 8 shelf board and the 1 × 2 horizontal              Cut out the two end pieces from 1 × 8 lumber. If the design
                support piece at a 90° angle after you’ve cut them both to the     has only straight lines, use a circular saw. If it includes curves,
                same length as the total width of the window unit (including       use a jigsaw. If desired, use a router to add a design to the
                the outer casing). Use 2" wood screws, spaced every 6 to 10".      end supports. Sand the faces and edges that will be exposed
                                                                                   until smooth.

                   3                                                                 4

                Attach end supports to the shelf unit using wood glue and          Drill pilot holes in the support piece every 6 to 10", avoiding
                6d casing nails. Use a nail set to recess the nail heads. Finish   the screws that attach the shelf to the horizontal support.
                the unit by staining or painting.                                  Attach the shelf unit to the wall just above the window casing
                                                                                   using 2" wood screws driven through the pilot holes. Plug and
                                                                                   finish screw holes, if desired.

                                                                                                                                   Wall & Window Trim ■ 135

   104-139_C51729.indd 135                                                                                                                                  6/10/09 3:02:5 PM

ects 134 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51729) #175 Dtp:119 Page:135

         Basement Window Trim

         B    asement windows invite much-needed sunlight
              into dark areas, but they present multiple trimming
         challenges. Most basement foundation walls are at
                                                                                Tools & Materials ▸
         least 8" thick, in addition to a furred-out wall. In many              Finish-grade 3⁄4"                  2-ft. level
         cases the window starts to look more like a tunnel with                    oak plywood                    Framing square
         a pane of glass at the end. But with some well-designed                Spray-foam insulation              Utility knife
         and well-executed trim carpentry, you can turn the                     Shims                              Straightedge
         depth disadvantage into an attractive trim shelf, great                11⁄4" and 2" finish nails
         for potted plants, objects—even sunning cats.                          15⁄8" drywall screws
              Basement window openings may be finished with                     Carpenter’s glue
         wallboard, but the easiest way to trim one is by making                Pencil
         extra-wide custom jambs that extend from the inside                    Tape measure
         face of the window frame to the interior wall surface.                 Table saw
         Because of the extra width, plywood stock is a good                    Drill with bits
         choice for the custom jambs.

         Set into thick foundation walls, basement windows present a bit of a trimming challenge but finish beautifully with creative
         trim work.

  136 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 136 5/21/09 6:27:46 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:136

                ■ How to Trim a Basement Window
                   1                                                             2

                Check to make sure the window frame and surrounding            Set your table saw to make a rip cut to the width arrived at
                area are dry and free of rot, mold, or damage. At all four     in step 1. If you don’t have a table saw, set up a circular saw
                corners of the basement window, measure from the inside        and a straightedge cutting guide to cut strips to this length.
                edges of the window frame to the wall surface. Add 1" to the   With a fine-tooth panel-cutting blade, rip enough plywood
                longest of these measurements.                                 strips to make the four jamb frame components.

                   3                                                             4

                                                                                                      3
                                                                                                          ⁄ 8 × 3⁄ 4" rabbet

                              Miter gauge

                Cross-cut the plywood strips to correct lengths. In our        Cut 3⁄8"-deep × 3⁄4"-wide rabbets at each end of the head
                case, we designed the jamb frame to be the exact same          jamb and the sill jamb. A router table is the best tool for this
                outside dimensions as the window frame, since there was        job, but you may use a table saw or hand saws and chisels.
                some space between the jamb frame and the rough opening.       Inspect the jambs first and cut the rabbets in whichever face
                                                                               is in better condition. To ensure uniformity, we ganged the two
                                                                               jambs together (they’re the same length). It’s also a good idea
                                                                               to include backer boards to prevent tear-out.

                                                                                                                                            (continued)

                                                                                                                               Wall & Window Trim ■ 137

   104-139_11989.indd 137                                                                                                                              5/21/09 6:27:49 PM

ects 136 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:137

            5                                                               6

         Glue and clamp the frame parts together, making sure to          Before the glue sets, drill carefully three perpendicular pilot
         clamp near each end from both directions. Set a carpenter’s      holes countersunk through the rabbeted workpieces and into
         square inside the frame and check it to make sure it’s square.   the side jambs at each corner. Space the pilot holes evenly,
                                                                          keeping the ones at the ends at least ¾" in from the end. Drive
                                                                          a 15⁄8" drywall screw into each pilot hole, taking care not to
                                                                          overdrive. Double check each corner for square as you work,
                                                                          adjusting the clamps if needed. Let the glue dry for at least one
                                                                          hour, overnight is best.

            7                                                               8

         Remove the clamps and set the frame in the window                Taking care not to disturb the frame’s position (rest a
         opening. Adjust the frame so it is centered and level in the     heavy tool on the sill to hold it in place if you wish), press a
         opening and the exterior-side edges fit flush against the        steel rule against the wall surface and use a pencil to mark
         window frame.                                                    trimming points at the point where the rule meets the jambs at
                                                                          each side of all four frame corners.

  138 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

104-139_11989.indd 138 5/21/09 6:27:55 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:138

                   9                                                                                             10

                                                              Scribe line

                Remove the frame and clamp it on a flat work surface. Use a straightedge to                   Replace the frame in the window
                connect the scribe marks at the ends of each jamb frame side. Set the cutting depth           opening and install shims until it is level
                of your circular saw to just a small fraction over 3⁄4". Clamp a straightedge guide to        and centered in the opening. Drive a few
                the frame so the saw blade will follow the cutting line and trim each frame side in           finish nails (hand or pneumatic) through
                succession. (The advantage to using a circular saw here is that any tear-out from the         the side jambs into the rough frame. Also
                blade will be on the nonvisible faces of the frame).                                          drive a few nails through the sill jamb.

                   11                                                                  12

                Insulate between the jamb frame and the rough frame                  Remove the masking tape, clean up the remaining foam,
                with spray-in polyurethane foam. Look for minimal-expanding          and install case molding. We used picture-frame techniques to
                foam for “windows and doors” and don’t spray in too much.            install fairly simple oak casing.
                Let the foam dry for a half hour or so and then trim off the
                excess with a utility knife. Tip: Protect the wood surfaces near
                the edges with wide strips of masking tape.

                                                                                                                                     Wall & Window Trim ■ 139

   104-139_C51711.indd 139                                                                                                                                   6/3/09 12:42:22 PM

ects 138 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:139

140-191_C51711.indd 140 6/3/09 12:47:5 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:140

                                          Wall Paint
                                          A    rguably, no one element can have as large an
                                               immediate impact on your design scheme
                                          than the paint applied to your walls. However, too
                                          many decorators make the mistake of concentrating
                                          carefully on their color choice and then giving little
                                          or no thought to their technique and application
                                          method. As you will see in the following pages,
                                          painting techniques and faux finishes are a high-
                                          impact, low-commitment way to vastly improve your
                                          interior painting.
                                               Each painting technique in this chapter has the
                                          potential to greatly affect the texture, tone, depth, and
                                          overall appeal of the colors you so carefully choose
                                          for your walls. Combine multiple colors using double-
                                          rolling or sponging techniques, carefully blend from
                                          one color to another, apply a flat geometric pattern or
                                          trowel classic veneer plaster to your wallboard. Use
                                          technique to cleverly highlight the rich boldness of
                                          your color choices or to blend in and accent your light,
                                          natural aesthetic.

                                          In this chapter:
                                          • Concrete Block Walls              • Color Wash Finish
                                          • Double-Rolled Color               • Stamped Mosaic
                                          • Stripes                           • Scumbled Wall Designs
                                          • Polka Dots                        • Faux Serpentine Finish
                                          • Sponge Painting                   • Faux Grasscloth
                                          • Rag-rolled Texture                • Caulk Designs
                                          • Terra-cotta Finish                • Veneer Plaster
                                          • Blended Color Bands

                                                                                                                 ■ 141

   140-191_C51711.indd 141                                                                                      6/3/09 12:47:20 PM

ects 140 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:141

         Concrete Block Walls

         P   ainting a concrete block wall adds a long-lasting,
             durable finish to the porous block surface that will
         not only greatly improve the appearance of the blocks,
         but also increases their water resistance. All concrete
         walls must be cured for at least 30 days before being
         painted. They must also be free of mildew, dust, dirt,
         and efflorescence (a white, crystalline mineral deposit
         sometimes found on masonry surfaces). Keep in mind
         that the products used to prepare and paint concrete
         blocks will likely emit irritating fumes. Make sure your
         work area is well ventilated or wear a respirator when
         working with them.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Masonry chisel              Etcher and
                 or bottle opener            rust remover
               Wire brush                  Heavy-duty
               Hand vacuum                   rubber gloves
               Hydraulic cement            Sponge
               Putty knife                 Masking tape
               Concrete cleaner            Drill with paint-
                 and degreaser               mixing bit                    Concrete block walls need not look as industrial and
               Safety glasses                                              dull as they often do—dress them up with bold colors or
                                                                           clean neutrals.

               Prepare Your Concrete Block Walls for Painting ▸

               Use a masonry chisel or a bottle opener and wire brush      To patch holes, apply hydraulic cement in layers no
               to remove any debris or dirt from holes and cracks. Clean   more than 1⁄2" thick until the patch is slightly higher than
               all dust and debris from the surface with a hand vacuum.    the surrounding area. Feather the patch until the edges
                                                                           are even with the surface. Let the patch dry according to
                                                                           the manufacturer’s directions.

  142 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 142 5/22/09 10:48:56 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:142

                ■ How to Paint a Concrete Block Wall
                   1                                                              2

                Press a piece of masking tape onto the blocks in several        Wearing safety goggles and rubber gloves, clean the
                places, and then pull the tape away. If the tape doesn’t pull   concrete blocks with a cleaner and degreaser (or etcher/
                concrete away from the surface, it can be painted. If loose     rust remover). Thoroughly rinse the blocks with water and let
                concrete comes away with the tape, all loose bits need to be    them dry. Stir the paint using a variable-speed drill and paint-
                scraped away with a wire brush.                                 mixing bit.

                   3                                                              4

                Working in roughly 2 × 4-ft. sections, start at the top and     While the cut-in edges are still wet, roll paint onto the first
                cut in with a paintbrush.                                       section. Work the paint into the surface, making certain paint
                                                                                fills any pores. Repeat with the section immediately beneath
                                                                                the first. When you finish the room, let the paint dry according
                                                                                to the manufacturer’s instructions, then apply a second coat of
                                                                                paint to the entire area.

                                                                                                                                            Wall Paint ■ 143

   140-191_11989.indd 143                                                                                                                               5/22/09 10:49:1 AM

ects 142 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:143

         Double-Rolled Color

         D    ouble rolling, also called color meshing, produces
              a complex texture with impressive color variations
         in only one step. Two-color meshing is perfect for
                                                                                If you’re new to using creative painting techniques,
                                                                            experiment on a piece of scrap drywall or on an incon-
                                                                            spicuous wall (behind the water heater is usually a good
         beginners or anyone who wants to create a painted                  spot) until you’ve perfected your technique.
         surface that has depth and variety without spending
         a lot of time.
              This technique works best with satin-finish,
         standard latex paints and is not compatible with                        Tools & Materials ▸
         glazes. Choose your lightest color first and then
         find a second color that is three, four, or five shades                 Dual roller                      Masking tape
         darker. Colors that are three shades apart will                         Two-compartment                  Two colors of satin-
         produce muted variations, whereas colors that are                          paint tray                      finish latex paint
         five shades apart produce more dramatic textures.                       1" brush                         Drop cloths
         Choose colors that blend rather than contrast for                       Accessory pad
         best results.

         Use a dual roller and two paint colors of varying shades to achieve a simple textured effect.

  144 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_C51729.indd 144 6/10/09 3:08:19 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51729) #175 Dtp:119 Page:144

                ■ How to Apply Meshed Color
                   1                                          2                                               3

                Select two colors of satin-finish latex     Remove any lint from the paint roller          Roll the two-color roller into the
                paint, one color three-to-five shades       by patting it with the sticky side of          paint and run it up and down the
                darker than the other. Stir the paint       masking tape. Change the tape when             textured portion of the tray several
                well, then pour each color into one         it loses its stickiness, and continue          times. Make sure the roller is loaded
                compartment of a divided paint tray.        patting until no more lint comes off the       well, but not so full that it will drip.
                                                            roller. Dampen the roller with water and
                                                            thoroughly wring it out.

                   4                                          5                                               6

                Make a diagonal sweep about two             Draw the roller in a back-and-forth            At the edges and in corners,
                feet long, rolling slowly enough to avoid   motion until the colors are blended to         apply ample splotches of each paint
                splatters. Next, make a diagonal sweep      your satisfaction.                             color using a 1" brush. Immediately
                in the opposite direction and then make                                                    pat the paint with the accessory pad
                a vertical sweep.                                                                          to blend the colors to match the
                                                                                                           surrounding area.

                                                                                                                                              Wall Paint ■ 145

   140-191_11989.indd 145                                                                                                                                5/22/09 10:49:11 AM

ects 144 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:145

         Stripes

         P    ainting stripes is a relatively simple painting
              project that can produce striking results. Stripes
         visually expand a small foyer or perk up a dull hallway
         or landing. In a kitchen, stripes can be an innovative
         treatment above upper cabinets. Wide stripes can relax
         formal furnishings in a living room or guest bedroom.
         If you’re considering stripes, choose your colors and
         the size of your stripe carefully, as these elements will
         greatly impact the energy of your room when finished.
              Begin by measuring the room and planning
         the width of your stripes so they work out evenly
         throughout the room. The challenges of this project
         are keeping your plumb lines straight and eliminating
         seepage under the painter’s tape once you begin.
         A laser level greatly simplifies the line-drawing
         process, and every stripe painter should splurge on
         professional-quality painter’s tape to avoid seepage.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Paint                   Laser level or
               Roller                    carpenter’s level
               Professional-quality    Tape measure
                  painter’s tape       Small roller or                  Painted stripes can be subtle or dramatic—it’s up to you!
               Pencil                    sponge applicator              Coordinate with furniture and woodwork to ensure a classic,
                                                                        elegant final result.

         ■ How to Paint Stripes
            1                                       2                                                3

         Apply a base coat in your chosen        Apply painter’s tape against the                 Measure from the inside edge of the
         color. Allow paint to dry.              plumb line shot with a laser level. Firmly       painter’s tape to the desired width of the
                                                 press the edges of the tape to the wall          stripe and make a pencil mark. Shoot a
                                                 to ensure a good bond.                           parallel boundary with the laser level and
                                                                                                  apply tape on the outside of the plumb
                                                                                                  line. Repeat until all stripes are taped off,
                                                                                                  checking for plumb from time to time.

  146 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_C51711.indd 146 6/3/09 12:47:41 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:146

                   4                                                                      5

                Paint the stripes, using a small roller or sponge applicator.           While paint is still damp, carefully remove the tape. Let
                                                                                        paint dry completely.

                      Additional Stripe Ideas ▸
                      Stripes can be bold and energetic, subtle and elegant, or somewhere in between. Layer contrasting stripes of different
                      widths for bold elegance. Or, add interest to a wall without expanding the color palette by adding evenly spaced stripes of
                      similar colors. Paint glossy stripes over a flat background of the same color to create a quiet accent particularly suitable
                      for formal spaces.

                                                                                                                                                    Wall Paint ■ 147

   140-191_C51711.indd 147                                                                                                                                       6/3/09 12:48:1 PM

ects 146 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:147

         Polka Dots

         A    lively, lighthearted paint technique, polka dots are
              perfect for children’s rooms, craft rooms, laundry
         rooms, bathrooms, and more. Part of the success of
                                                                             brighter colors for lively spaces like children’s
                                                                             playrooms, bedrooms, and bathrooms. If you
                                                                             select complementary colors, use a lighter
         this technique depends on adjusting the spacing of the              value for the background so the dots pop.
         polka dots to suit the size of the room. Don’t worry if             Use subdued colors, perhaps two shades of
         the polka dots are imperfect, as randomness is part of              the same hue, for an elegant, refined result.
         what makes this technique appealing.                                Colorwashing the walls after applying polka dots
              Color choice depends mostly on where the                       will soften the pattern even more for a subtle
         polka dots will be used in your home. Consider                      finished effect.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Painter’s tape            Latex paint for base coat                      Paper plates               Paper towels
               Drop cloths               Latex paint in desired colors for dots         Styrofoam cups             Small foam applicator
               Paint roller and tray

         Polka dots can be large or small—applied in small areas, such as within paneling frames, or on a large accent wall. If you’re
         painting your entire room with polka dots, plan the spacing to appear consistent on all of the walls.

  148 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 148 5/22/09 10:49:30 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:148

                ■ How to Paint Polka Dots
                   1                                                                 2

                Prepare the room for painting—apply painter’s tape and             Pour a puddle of paint onto a paper plate. Dip the open end
                drop cloths. Apply the base coat and let it dry completely. Plan   of a Styrofoam cup into the puddle, and then lightly press the
                the spacing of the polka dots. Place a small piece of painter’s    cup onto several paper towels to remove excess paint.
                tape wherever you would like the dots placed.

                   3                                                                 4

                Press the cup firmly over the tape mark on the wall. Repeat        Using a small foam applicator, fill in each polka dot with its
                to outline each polka dot.                                         paint color.

                                                                                                                                              Wall Paint ■ 149

   140-191_11989.indd 149                                                                                                                                5/22/09 10:49:32 AM

ects 148 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:149

         Sponge Painting

         A    pplying paint with a sponge produces a pebbly,
              mottled finish. The technique is easy to master
         and the effect complements many décor styles
         beautifully. Today, sponging color choices are most
         often subtle and blended, unlike the high contrast
         color combinations that were a fad for a time. The
         sponge you choose will also greatly impact your final
         result. Use a natural sea sponge for small, condensed
         marks or sculpt a synthetic sponge for a larger, more
         defined pattern.
              Semigloss, satin, and flat latex paints are all
         appropriate for sponge painting. For a translucent
         finish, mix a paint glaze by combining paint, paint
         conditioner, and water. Always practice your technique
         on a large piece of wallboard or an inconspicuous
         wall to experiment before you begin to perfect
         the application.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Latex paint                 Roller tray
               Paint conditioner           Natural sea sponge     Sponge painting produces a soft texture; use varying hues of
                                                                  the same color for bold depth.

               Additional Sponging Ideas ▸

               Tape off stripes (see page 146) and apply          For a muted effect, use closely-related shades of the
               sponge painted color to the unmasked areas for a   same hue. For bold texture, choose highly contrasting
               textured pattern.                                  shades or similar shades of colors that are next to each
                                                                  other on the color wheel.

  150 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 150 5/22/09 10:49:39 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:150

                ■ How to Sponge Paint a Wall
                   1                                                                    2

                Mix together equal parts latex paint, latex paint conditioner,        Pour some of the paint into a roller tray, and press a
                and water for the first sponged color, the darker color.              natural sea sponge into the paint. Pat the sponge onto a paper
                Stir thoroughly.                                                      towel to remove excess paint, then dab the paint onto the wall
                                                                                      in a 2 × 4-ft. section.

                   3                                                                    4

                Continue sponging until the section is filled with sponged            Dampen the sponge and wring it out. Press the sponge
                paint but the base coat is still visible. Wash out the sponge and     into the lighter color of paint and remove the excess by
                let the paint dry. Mix the paint for the lighter color as described   blotting it on a paper towel. Sponge the paint evenly over the
                in step 1.                                                            wall. Don’t cover the base coat or dark color. Stand back and
                                                                                      evaluate the effect. Sponge more paint where necessary to
                                                                                      even out the variations.

                                                                                                                                                 Wall Paint ■ 151

   140-191_11989.indd 151                                                                                                                                    5/22/09 10:50:6 AM

ects 150 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:151

         Rag-Rolled Texture

         R   agging is a textural application technique that
             produces a soft, organic texture. Ragging is
         particularly effective in cottage- or country-styled
                                                                              Tools & Materials ▸
         spaces using soft colors that clearly reveal the rag                 Bucket                              Rubber gloves
         imprints. In typical rag-rolled paint designs, a lighter             Latex paint                         Lint-free rag
         color is used as the base coat with a darker color for               Latex paint conditioner             Old towel
         the glaze. However, the reverse can also be quite
         lovely. Experiment with the technique as you test;
         apply the rag marks densely or sparsely, try ragging two
         different glaze colors over the base coat, or experiment         choice will affect the imprints, so test a few rags on a
         with pulling color off with a rag rather than applying it.       scrap before choosing your favorite. Though extremely
              Any clean, lint-free rags can be used, including            versatile, ragging can be quite messy, so prepare your
         gauze, burlap, chamois cloth, or jersey; your fabric             work area thoroughly before beginning.

         Ragging can create rich texture and subtle interest when used with similar or complementary colors and consistent application.

  152 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 152 5/22/09 10:50:11 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:152

                ■ How to Rag-Roll a Wall
                   1                                                               2

                In a clean bucket, mix together equal parts latex paint, latex   Put on rubber gloves, and then dip a lint-free rag into the
                paint conditioner, and water. Stir thoroughly.                   glaze, saturating the entire rag. Wring out the rag thoroughly,
                                                                                 and then wipe the excess glaze from your gloves onto an
                                                                                 old towel.

                   3                                                               4

                Roll up the rag irregularly, then fold it to a length equal to   Roll the rag over the surface of a 2 × 4-ft. section of the
                the width of both your hands.                                    wall, working upward at various angles. Rewet and wring the
                                                                                 rag whenever necessary and continue application until you’re
                                                                                 satisfied with the effect. Move on to subsequent sections until
                                                                                 the project is complete.

                                                                                                                                             Wall Paint ■ 153

   140-191_11989.indd 153                                                                                                                               5/22/09 10:50:20 AM

ects 152 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:153

         Terra-Cotta Finish

         I ntroduce depth and warmth to a room by applying a
           terra-cotta finish to your walls. Although this finish has
         a sophisticated and refined appearance, it’s quite easy to
                                                                              The traditional terra-cotta finish consists of
                                                                          three colors of latex paint, usually shades of deep
                                                                          brown, dark clay, and apricot. For a rosier terra-cotta,
         create. Unlike most other painting techniques included           choose colors with a red base; for an orange overtone,
         here, a terra-cotta finish does not require a preliminary        choose yellow-based colors. If you’re not sure which
         base coat. Instead, use a wool pad to apply and blend            colors will work best to achieve your desired effect,
         several colors of paint to a primed surface. The more you        seek help from a salesperson to put together the
         blend the paints, the more muted the finish becomes.             right combination.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Divided paint tray           Wool paint pad                Brown, clay and                     Paint glaze
               Paint stirrer sticks         Wood finishing tool             apricot latex paint

         The term terra-cotta originally referred to ancient unglazed ceramic clay used to make vessels and plumbing systems. Today,
         terra-cotta refers to a warm orange-brown, subtly textured color scheme.

  154 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_C51711.indd 154 6/3/09 12:48:23 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:154

                ■ How to Produce a Terra-cotta Finish with a Wool Pad
                   1                                          2                                                3

                Pour each shade of paint into a             Dip the wool pad into the brown                 Scrape the pad to remove as much
                separate section of a divided paint tray.   paint and scrape the pad along the              of the brown paint from the pad as
                Add a quarter cup of paint glaze to each    edge of the tray to remove excess paint.        possible. You do not need to wash the
                color, blending it into the paint with a    Working in 4 × 4-ft. sections, apply the        pad before applying the next paint color.
                stir stick. Wet your hand with water and    paint by pressing the pad to the wall in a
                run it over the wool pad to remove lint     random pattern. Cover about 80 percent
                and loose fibers.                           of the wall surface in each section,
                                                            leaving some bare spots visible.

                   4                                          5                                                6

                Dip the wool pad into the clay paint,       Dip the wool pad into the apricot               Once you’ve finished the section,
                and scrape off the excess. Using the        paint, and remove the excess. Using             use a finishing tool to apply paint in the
                same stamping technique you used to         the random stamping technique, lightly          corners and at the edges of the section.
                apply the brown paint, fill in the bare     press the wool pad onto the painted             First, remove lint and loose fibers from
                spots in the section with the clay paint.   section. You will begin to see the paint        the tool (see step 1). Repeat steps 2
                When you are finished, scrape the clay      blend. The more you apply the apricot           through 5, applying the brown, clay, and
                paint from the pad, as before.              paint, the more the paint will blend and        apricot paints, and blending until the
                                                            the lighter the final design will be.           design is complete. When the section is
                                                                                                            complete, move on to the next.

                                                                                                                                               Wall Paint ■ 155

   140-191_11989.indd 155                                                                                                                                 5/22/09 10:50:32 AM

ects 154 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:155

         Blended Color Bands

         T   his blending technique creates the illusion that
             the paint colors are fading into one another, a
         unique and striking effect that draws the eye around
         the room and highlights your artwork and furnishings.
         The success of this technique depends heavily upon
         careful color selection. Choose two paint colors that
         sit next to each other on the color wheel (see page 10).
         You’ll create the third color by mixing together equal
         amounts of each. The resulting midtone will smooth
         the transition between the top and bottom bands and
         enhance the illusion of the blend.
              The key to success with this application is that
         the paint must be wet in order to blend the bands
         properly, so it’s best to work in small sections. If the
         paint gets too dry to blend well, add fresh paint to
         each band and blend it again.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Carpenter’s level            Power drill and paint
                  or laser level              mixing bit
               Tape measure                 Three paint pails
               Straightedge                 Two colors of matte             Blending color bands is a great solution for intimate
               Pencil                         latex paint                   spaces or very small rooms, as it creates the illusion of more
               Five 3" paintbrushes         Wallpaper paste                 space. Use this technique along with simple furnishings and
                                                                            decorations for the best effect.

         ■ How to Create Blended Color Bands
            1                                           2                                               3

         Measure the wall and divide it into         Pour equal amounts of each color into           Paint a 2 to 3-ft. section of the
         three equal sections. Using a laser         a pail and use a drill and paint-mixing         darkest color at the bottom of the wall,
         or carpenter’s level, draw horizontal       bit to blend it thoroughly. In a second         spreading the paint roughly up to the
         lines to act as guidelines for the bands    pail, mix equal amounts of the darkest          first guideline.
         of paint.                                   paint and wallpaper paste. In a third, mix
                                                     equal amounts of the lightest paint and
                                                     wallpaper paste. Label the pails.

  156 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_C51711.indd 156 6/3/09 12:48:55 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:156

                   4                                                                5

                Apply a coat of the blended midtone (created in step 2)           Apply a thick coat of the dark wash to the gap between
                to a 2 to 3-ft. section of the middle band. Leave an inch or so   the first and second bands. Dampen a clean paintbrush and
                between this band and the first one.                              run it along the line between the bands, blending the wash up
                                                                                  and down into each band until the lines have disappeared into
                                                                                  a subtle transition between colors.

                   6                                                                7

                Apply the lightest color to the top band, leaving a gap           Continue painting one section of the wall at a time, running
                between it and the middle band. Apply a thick coat of the         over at the corners. Use the finished corner as a placement
                light wash between the bands, and then use a clean, damp          guide for the newly painted one, blending the edges to make
                paintbrush to blend the colors up and down as before.             sure the color shifts are consistent. Slight variations are
                                                                                  inevitable, but try to keep the blends as consistent as possible.

                                                                                                                                              Wall Paint ■ 157

   140-191_11989.indd 157                                                                                                                                5/22/09 10:50:52 AM

ects 156 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:157

         Color Wash Finish

         C    olor washing gives walls a translucent,
              watercolored appearance, adding the illusion of
         texture to flat surfaces and emphasizing the unique
         eccentricities of textured surfaces. Color wash glaze
         can be either lighter or darker than the base coat,
         but for best results, choose colors that are closely
         related or use a neutral color as one of your selections.
         Washing complementary or contrasting colors will
         result in a muddy, dull finish.
              Color washing can be completed using either a
         sponge or a brush with varying results. The sponge
         application method requires a highly diluted glaze that
         is applied over a base coat of low-luster latex enamel,
         using a natural sea sponge. The result is a subtle
         texture with a soft blending of colors. Color washing
         with a paintbrush requires a heavier glaze to retain the
         fine lines of the brush strokes. As the glaze begins to       A color wash creates a subtle decorative effect, highlighting
         dry, soften the appearance of brush stroke lines further      the texture of your walls, or creating hints of depth on
         by smudging the surface with a dry paintbrush.                flat surfaces.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Flat latex paint             Low-luster latex         Natural sea sponge or two 3 to 4"                Rubber gloves
               Latex paint conditioner        enamel paint             natural bristle paintbrushes                   Pail

               Glaze Selection and Mixing ▸
                                                                                      Select colors for the base coat and glaze
                                                                                      that are closely related or use at least
                                                                                      one neutral color. A dark glaze over a
                                                                                      lighter base coat (left) produces a mottled
                                                                                      effect, whereas a light glaze over a darker
                                                                                      base coat (right) produces a chalky or
                                                                                      watercolored effect.

                                                                                      Sponge Color Wash Glaze
                                                                                      1 part latex or acrylic paint
                                                                                      8 parts water

                                                                                      Brush Color Wash Glaze
                                                                                      1 part flat latex paint
                                                                                      1 part latex paint conditioner
                                                                                      2 parts water

  158 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 158 5/22/09 10:51:0 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:158

                ■ How to Color Wash with a Sponge
                   1                                                                        Color Wash with a Brush ▸

                                                                                            After the base coat dries, mix the color-washing
                                                                                            glaze as instructed on page 158. Dip a paintbrush
                                                                                            into the glaze and apply to the wall in a cross-
                                                                                            hatching manner, beginning in one corner. The more
                                                                                            brushstrokes you create, the softer the texture will
                                                                                            appear. Before the paint has dried completely, brush
                Mask off the surrounding area, using painter’s masking                      over the surface, with a dry natural bristle paintbrush
                tape, and cover the floor with waterproof drop cloths. Apply a              to soften the look. Wipe excess glaze from the brush
                base coat of low-luster latex enamel paint, using a paint roller.           as necessary.
                Allow the paint to dry.

                   2                                              3                                                4

                Mix the glaze as instructed on page            Beginning in a low corner, wipe the              Repeat steps 2 and 3, moving
                158 and immerse the sponge into the            color wash solution onto the wall in short,      upward and outward until the entire
                solution. Squeeze out excess liquid, but       curving strokes. Overlap and change the          wall has been color washed. Allow
                leave the sponge very wet.                     direction of the strokes, quickly covering       the paint to dry. Apply a second coat if
                                                               a 3 × 3-ft. section of wall.                     additional color is desired.

                                                                                                                                                   Wall Paint ■ 159

   140-191_11989.indd 159                                                                                                                                     5/22/09 10:51:14 AM

ects 158 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:159

         Stamped Mosaic

         M      osaic tile is a classic choice for walls, but tile
                can be expensive and time-consuming to install.
         A painted mosaic is inexpensive and easy to do, and it
                                                                                Tools & Materials ▸
         can be changed just as easily as it can be created.                    Craft knife                           High-density
              The effect of a tile mosaic is too dramatic to                    Large paintbrush                        foam rubber
         use it in large spaces. Typically, it’s best to choose                 Roller and roller tray                Low-tack
         a small area or the space below a chair rail for this                  Three 1" paintbrushes                   masking tape
         finish. With its irregular coloration and varied pattern,              Small artist’s brush                    or painter’s tape
         a painted mosaic can cover many flaws, so the                          Ruler                                 Three colors of
         preparation steps for this project don’t have to be quite              Repositionable spray glue               latex paint
         as elaborate as for many other paint projects.

         A stamped mosaic is a creative way to add color and texture to small spaces and works beautifully under a chair rail or
         wallcovering border.

  160 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_C51711.indd 160 6/3/09 12:49:18 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:160

                ■ How to Create a Stamped Mosaic
                   1                                                                      2

                Place some of each paint color into the well of a clean                 To make a paper template for the stamp, draw a series
                roller tray. Using three clean paintbrushes, dab a generous             of tiles divided by 1⁄4" grout lines. Round the corners of the
                amount of each color of paint onto the flat surface of the roller       squares to resemble tile. Spray the back of the paper with
                tray. It’s fine for the colors to blend a little in a few places, but   repositionable spray glue and press the pattern onto the
                don’t deliberately mix them.                                            high-density foam. Cut around each tile, using a craft knife,
                                                                                        and remove the excess pieces. (Try to consistently cut about
                                                                                        halfway into the foam.) When the stamp is complete, press it
                                                                                        into the paint until it’s well coated but not dripping with paint.

                   3

                Start at the top, left-hand corner and press the stamp squarely against the wall, being careful not to let it slip. After a moment,
                peel the stamp away from the wall from one side. Recoat the stamp and position it ¼" from the previous print, to create a grout
                line. Continue stamping in this manner. When you begin the next row, align the pattern lines before pressing the stamp to the wall.
                If the colors bleed together, reestablish the base color between “tiles” with a small artist’s brush (inset).

                                                                                                                                                    Wall Paint ■ 161

   140-191_C51711.indd 161                                                                                                                                      6/3/09 12:49:34 PM

ects 160 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:161

         Scumbled Wall Designs

         S   cumbling is a technique that creates textural
             geometric patterns that mimic the look of
         expensive wallcovering. To scumble, use a large stencil
                                                                                 Scumbling can be a stunning finish over
                                                                             geometric shapes applied to an entire wall, a ceiling
                                                                             border, or as a faux wainscoting. Take care to
         brush to dry-brush paint onto the wall in swirling                  measure each wall and sketch the geometric design
         motions over a base coat. Because very little paint is              on graph paper to help you determine the scale and
         required for dry-brushing, pick up small jars of acrylic            placement of your design. Always experiment on a
         craft paints instead of more traditional latex buckets.             piece of cardboard or an inconspicuous wall, and
         Choose two or three related decorator colors, or use                remember to adequately prepare your work area
         gold and silver metallic paints for a classy shimmer.               before you begin.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Ruler                         Straightedge                    Painter’s tape                     Latex or craft acrylic
               Pencil                        Putty knife                     Latex paint                          paints for scumbling
               Paint roller                  1" stencil brush                   for base coat                   Paper towels
               Carpenter’s level             Graph paper                     Disposable plates

         Scumbling can recreate the classic, refined texture of expensive wallcovering or can be used to partition walls as a border
         or wainscot.

  162 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 162 5/22/09 10:51:57 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:162

                ■ How to Paint a Taped-off Scumbled Design
                   1                                         2                                                3

                Measure the wall and plan the design       Allow the paint to dry. Draw the                Mark the sections that will be masked
                to scale on graph paper. Apply a base      design on the wall with a pencil using a        off. Apply painter’s masking tape to the
                coat of paint using a paint roller.        straightedge as a guide.                        marked sections using a putty knife to
                                                                                                           trim the tape diagonally at the corners.
                                                                                                           Press along all edges of the tape using
                                                                                                           a plastic credit card or your fingernail to
                                                                                                           create a tight seal.

                   4                                         5                                                6

                Pour a small amount of each paint          Brush the paint onto the wall with              Dip the brush into the second color
                color onto a disposable plate. Dip the     vigorous, wide, circular motions. Work          and blot. Apply the paint randomly over
                tip of the stencil brush into the first    in a small area at a time, and change           the same area, building up the color to
                color. Using a circular motion, blot the   the direction of the circular motions           varying intensities throughout the area.
                brush onto a paper towel until the         frequently. Overlap the paint onto the          Repeat with a third color, if desired.
                bristles are almost dry.                   masking tape. Build up the color to the         Repeat this technique to complete the
                                                           desired intensity, but allow the base           wall, working in one small area at a time.
                                                           coat to show through. Use all of the            Remove the tape carefully when the
                                                           paint on bristles before applying more.         paint is dry.

                                                                                                                                              Wall Paint ■ 163

   140-191_11989.indd 163                                                                                                                                 5/22/09 10:52:2 AM

ects 162 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:163

         Faux Serpentine Finish

         S    erpentine is the name given to a variety of green
              marble that contains deposits of the mineral
         serpentine, speckles of black and white rock, and a
         conspicuous network of fine veining. Replicate this
         classic marble with paint to add sophistication and
         elegance to smaller portions of your living spaces, such
         as bathroom walls, beneath a wainscot in a kitchen or
         hallway, or to accent fireplaces and furnishings.
              Because genuine marble is often cut into workable
         pieces for installation, a faux serpentine finish applied
         to a large surface is more realistic if applied in sections
         with narrow grout lines to mimic marble pieces. Mask
         off and complete application in sections, allowing each
         completed section to dry completely before masking
         it off and completing the next section. Always finish a
         faux serpentine project with a high gloss coat applied
         to the entire surface, imitating the lustrous appearance        Faux serpentine adds sophisticated appeal to fireplaces,
         of genuine marble.                                              wainscot paneling, and furnishings.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Low-napped paint                 Spray bottle             Craft acrylic paints in              Water-based
                  roller (for base coat)        Turkey feather             a darker shade than                  clear urethane
               Sponge applicator                Low-luster latex           the latex enamel,                  High-gloss clear finish
                  or paintbrush                   enamel paint             black, and white                     or aerosol clear
               Stippler                         Newspaper                Cheesecloth                            acrylic sealer

         ■ How to Apply a Faux Serpentine Finish
            1                                                              2

         Apply a base coat of low-luster latex enamel. Mix equal         Stipple the glazes in adjoining areas to blend them slightly,
         parts clear urethane, paint, and water for each gloss color.    bouncing a stippler rapidly over the surface.
         Apply colored, black, and white gloss glazes separately in
         random broad, diagonal strokes with a sponge applicator or
         paintbrush. Cover most of the surface, allowing small patches
         of the base coat to show through.

  164 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 164 5/22/09 10:52:11 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:164

                   3                                            4                                               5

                Fold a sheet of newspaper to                  Soften areas of high contrast by               Brush black glaze onto a piece
                several layers and lay it flat in the same    dabbing with wadded cheesecloth. Mist          of newspaper and touch it to the
                diagonal direction as the original paint      the surface with water if necessary, to        surface diagonally in scattered areas,
                strokes. Press the newspaper into the         keep the glazes workable.                      adding drama and depth. Soften with
                glaze and then lift it off, removing some                                                    cheesecloth, if necessary. Repeat the
                of the glaze. Repeat over the entire                                                         process using a white glaze in small,
                surface using the same newspaper.                                                            light areas.
                Occasionally turn the paper in opposite
                directions and add glazes as desired to
                develop the color.

                   6                                            7                                               8

                Dilute a mixture of the white and             Connect adjacent vein lines                    Dilute glazes to the consistency of
                colored glazes with water to the              occasionally to create narrow, oblong,         ink and apply randomly to the surface.
                consistency of light cream. Run the           irregular shapes. Dab veins lightly            Dab with wadded cheesecloth to soften
                edge and tip of the feather through the       with wadded cheesecloth to soften if           the colors. Allow the glazes to dry.
                diluted glaze. Lightly drag the feather       necessary. Allow the surface to dry.           Apply several thin coats of high-gloss
                diagonally over the surface while                                                            clear finish or aerosol clear acrylic
                fidgeting, turning it slightly, and varying                                                  sealer, allowing the surface to dry
                the pressure to create an irregular,                                                         between coats.
                jagged vein. Begin and end veins off
                the edge of the surface. Repeat as
                necessary to create a veining pattern.

                                                                                                                                                Wall Paint ■ 165

   140-191_11989.indd 165                                                                                                                                  5/22/09 10:52:21 AM

ects 164 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:165

         Faux Grasscloth

         W      oven grass wallcoverings are a lovely, if a little
                expensive, way to bring a soft natural appeal to
         your décor. With paint, a squeegee, and a little hard
                                                                                Tools & Materials ▸
         work, however, you can create the same look with                       Painter’s tape                     Window squeegee
         cleverly applied paint! A variation of combing, this                   Drop cloths                        Rubber gloves
         technique manipulates the top coat of paint, removing                  Paint roller and tray              Latex paint
         fine lines of color to expose the base coat. Walls are                 Latex paint for base coat            for top coat
         taped of in sections similar in width to traditional                   Pencil                             Sash brush
         wallcoverings, and the narrow lines of color where                     Long carpenter’s level             Small paint comb
         the sections overlap add to the illusion of traditional                Scissors                           Clean rags
         grasscloth seams.
              For a realistic appearance, select paint colors that         Or, pair grasscloth with rich reds and classic black to
         closely resemble natural grasses, such as sand and                replicate the luxurious elegance of Asian-inspired décor.
         wheat. Because of the earthy nature of the technique,             Bear in mind, however, that this faux finish produces a
         grasscloth walls work well in rooms that depend upon              pronounced texture. If you plan to repaint in the future,
         plants and natural textures for their design aesthetic.           the walls will need to be sanded as well as primed.

                                                                                                                                          Detail

         Faux grasscloth is perfect for contemporary or natural décor—and blends beautifully with neutral or bold decór.

  166 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 166 5/22/09 10:52:32 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:166

                ■ How to Create Faux Grasscloth Wallcoverings
                   1                                                                  2

                Prepare your work area and apply the base coat. Let it dry          Using the scissors, cut the squeegee into a saw-toothed
                completely. Mark off 3 ft. vertical panels around the room with     pattern, with pointed teeth about ¼" apart. Put on rubber
                a pencil. Pencil in the edge lines with the level. Tape off every   gloves and cut in to the top and bottom of the panel with the
                other panel.                                                        top coat paint using a sash brush. Immediately fill in the rest of
                                                                                    the panel with a paint roller.

                   3                                                                  4

                Draw the squeegee across the painted panel horizontally,            Remove the tape before the paint dries. Repeat step 3
                beginning at the top and working downward and overlapping           for each alternating wall section. Allow each section to dry
                the passes. After each pass, wipe excess paint from the             completely, and then mask off painted sections, positioning
                squeegee with the rags. Use a small paint comb for hard-to-         the tape 1⁄8" inside the painted edges. As the paint overlaps
                reach areas like corners and outlets and switches.                  in these thin lines, it will imitate traditional grasscloth seams.
                                                                                    Remove the tape and let the paint dry completely.

                                                                                                                                                Wall Paint ■ 167

   140-191_11989.indd 167                                                                                                                                  5/22/09 10:52:35 AM

ects 166 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:167

         Caulk Designs

         C    aulk designs are drawn on the wall using tub and
              tile caulk. When the caulk designs are dry, the
         wall can be painted any color, and the shadows of the
                                                                                The caulk adheres to the wall best if it is
                                                                           slightly cool when applied. The size of the dots
                                                                           and lines will depend on the size of the opening
         raised dots and lines produce patterns from beneath.              cut in the tip of the caulk tube. For tiny dots
         The technique is simple, but the design options are               and thin lines, cut the tip close to the end; for
         unlimited! Create geometric patterns, swirls, flowers,            more substantial strokes, cut the tip closer to the
         words—whatever inspires you! Draw your designs                    tube. To remove designs later, scrape them off
         freehand, or utilize an LCD or overhead project to                with a paint scraper, patch and prime the walls
         enlarge patterns on the wall for you to trace.                    for repainting.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Painter’s tape                      Latex primer                        Scissors                         Satin latex paint
               Drop cloths                         Pencil                              Paintbrush                         for top coat
               Paint roller and tray               Tub and tile caulk

         Caulked designs can add fanciful flair to children’s bedrooms and other playful spaces, or they can dress up kitchens, bathrooms,
         or living spaces with subtle patterns and designs.

  168 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 168 5/22/09 10:52:42 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:168

                ■ How to Apply Caulked Designs
                   1                                                                   2

                Lightly pencil in the design of your choice onto the wall            Apply the top coat to the entire wall.
                surface. Apply dots and lines of caulk over the marked lines,
                squeezing the tube with even pressure. Stop squeezing and lift
                the top from the surface at the end of each line. Using a wet
                fingertip, smooth down any bumps and tails after 30 minutes.
                Allow 24 hours for the caulk to dry completely.

                      Creating Your Design ▸

                      Use a stencil to trace dynamic designs onto your walls with a pencil. If your designs are complex or if you are applying
                      words, tape a piece of graphite transfer paper to the wall, then place a photocopy or printout of the design over the
                      transfer paper. Trace your design and remove the paper to reveal a penciled outline.

                                                                                                                                                 Wall Paint ■ 169

   140-191_11989.indd 169                                                                                                                                   5/22/09 10:52:46 AM

ects 168 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:169

         Veneer Plaster

         V    eneer plaster application recreates the classic
              look of homes from the 1940s and adds a solid,
         uniform surface that is highly resistant to nail pops,
         cracks, and surface damage. A skim coat of plaster
         is troweled onto a gypsum wallboard base that has a
         distinctive blue color, commonly called blueboard.
         Installed like standard wallboard, blueboard has
         highly absorptive face paper to which the wet-mix
         plaster bonds. Applying veneer plaster effectively does
         take some time to master. The key is to apply the
         plaster with a trowel in quick, short strokes, called
         scratching in, and then to immediately trowel it over
         with a steady, even stroke, smoothing the plaster to a
         consistent thickness (typically 1⁄16 to 1⁄8").
              Finished plaster can be troweled smooth or tooled
         for an appealing texture. Sand and other additives can
         also be used to create coarser textures, which, when                     Veneer plaster adds character and depth to modern
         combined with sophisticated painting techniques,                         homes, evoking the classic look of homes from the early
         produce lovely, old-world decorative charm.                              twentieth century.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Stapler                          Mortar hawk                       Metal corner bead with             Clean potable water
               Hammer                           12" trowel                            mesh flanges                   Dry-mix veneer base
               Heavy-duty 1⁄2" drill            Fine-wire rake or broom           11⁄4" wallboard screws               coat plaster (for two-
                  with mixing paddle               (for base coat)                Non-adhesive fiberglass              coat application)
               16-gal. drum                     Spray water bottle                    mesh tape                      Dry-mix veneer
                                                                                  1
                                                                                   ⁄4" staples                         finish plaster

               Textured Surface Options ▸
               For textured surfaces, skip the final troweling and work the surface to create texture. Use a broom, paint-roller, paintbrush,
               or the trowel itself to achieve creative, eye-catching surfaces.

  170 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 170 5/22/09 10:52:51 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:170

                ■ How to Apply a One-Coat Veneer Plaster System
                   1

                Apply mesh flanges and a thin layer           Variation: Blueboard joints can also be reinforced with paper tape. Embed the tape
                of plaster along all flat seams and           in a thin plaster bed, and then cover with another thin layer to conceal the tape fully.
                corner bead at corners (inset). For inside    Note: Some manufacturers recommend setting-type compound for embedding paper
                corners, apply a thin bed of plaster and      tape; always follow the manufacturer’s directions for the products you use.
                embed the loose tape, then cover with
                another thin layer. Allow all taped seams
                to set.

                   2

                                                                                                                Smooth pass

                                    Scratch pass

                After the seams have set, begin plastering the surface beginning at one corner and moving to the opposite. Start with ceilings
                and then do the walls, completing one entire surface before moving on to the next. To apply the plaster, tightly scratch in the
                material up the wall (photo left), then immediately double-back over it, smoothing over the material to a thickness of 1⁄16 to 3⁄32",
                as specified by the manufacturer. Use tight, quick strokes to apply the plaster during the scratch pass and long, even strokes to
                achieve consistency during the smooth pass.
                                                                                                                                                   (continued)

                                                                                                                                                  Wall Paint ■ 171

   140-191_C51711.indd 171                                                                                                                                    6/3/09 12:53:49 PM

ects 170 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:171

            3                                                              4

         Continue to apply plaster by scratching in and smoothing        Once the plaster begins to firm, trowel the surface to
         over the surface. Don’t worry about uniformity and trowel       fill any voids and remove tooling marks and imperfections,
         ridges at this point. Rather, make sure the entire surface is   integrating the surface into a uniform smoothness.
         completely concealed with a relatively even plaster coat 1⁄16
         to 3⁄32" thick.

            5                                                                One- and Two-Coat Veneer
                                                                             Plaster Systems ▸

                                                                                                              Finish
                                                                               Finish

                                                                                                              Basecoat
                                                                                 Gypsum
                                                                               plaster base                       Gypsum
                                                                                                                plaster base

                                                                             One-coat veneer                 Two-coat veneer
                                                                             plaster systems use a           plaster systems are
                                                                             single 1⁄16 to 3⁄32"-thick      composed of a 1⁄16 to 1⁄8"
                                                                             coat of finish plaster          basecoat plaster applied
                                                                             applied directly to a           to blueboard, followed
                                                                             blueboard base. The coat        by a 1⁄16 to 3⁄32"-thick coat
                                                                             can be troweled smooth          of finish plaster. The
                                                                             or textured, resulting in a     finish coat bonds with
                                                                             hard, monolithic surface.       the scratched basecoat
                                                                                                             surface, forming a more
                                                                                                             uniform and monolithic
         Prior to the plaster setting, make a final pass with the                                            surface than that of a
         trowel to smooth the surface spraying water sparingly. Do not                                       one-coat system.
         overtrowel; stop before the plaster begins to darken and set.

  172 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 172 5/22/09 10:53:11 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:172

                ■ How to Apply Base Coat in a Two-Coat Veneer Plaster System
                   1                                                                 2
                                                                                                                                     Smooth pass

                                                                                         Scratch pass

                Apply a thin layer of basecoat along all flat seams and            After the seams have set, tightly scratch in basecoat, then
                corner bead, feathering out the edges by 6". For inside            immediately double-back over it, smoothing over the material
                corners, apply a thin bed of basecoat and embed the loose          to a thickness of 1⁄16 to 1⁄8", as specified by the manufacturer.
                tape, then cover with another thin layer. Allow all taped seams    Use tight, quick strokes to apply basecoat for the scratch
                to set.                                                            pass and long, even strokes to achieve consistency for the
                                                                                   smooth pass.

                   3                                                                 4

                Once the plaster begins to firm, or take up, trowel the            Approximately two hours after the basecoat has set,
                surface to fill any voids and remove tooling marks and             the finish coat can be applied using the same techniques used
                imperfections, integrating the surface into a reasonably           for a one-coat veneer plaster system (see pages 171 to 172).
                uniform surface—do not overtrowel to a smooth surface.
                Create keys for the final coat using a thin-wire rake to roughen
                the basecoat.

                                                                                                                                               Wall Paint ■ 173

   140-191_11989.indd 173                                                                                                                                 5/22/09 10:53:19 AM

ects 172 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:173

140-191_C51711.indd 174 6/3/09 12:55:21 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:174

                                          Wall Décor
                                          W     all decorations transform a beautifully decorated
                                                space into your beautifully decorated space.
                                          The collections, libraries, and artwork you display
                                          in your home are what make it uniquely your own;
                                          these elements tell the story of your family and are
                                          intimately tied to your decorative choices.
                                              The wall décor projects in this chapter will help
                                          you display your personal belongings professionally
                                          and will provide ways to refresh and accent areas often
                                          neglected by decorators. Update your bathroom with
                                          new fixtures or a creatively tiled mirror—or accent
                                          your fireplace with a tiled surround. Apply a critical
                                          eye to your walls and then utilize these techniques
                                          to add style, polish, and personality to every area of
                                          your home.

                                          In this chapter:
                                          • Pictures & Mirrors                • Ceramic Tile
                                          • Textiles                            Mirror Frame
                                          • Sticker Art                       • New Towel Bar
                                          • Wood Shelving                     • Tile Fireplace Surround
                                          • Glass Shelving

                                                                                                                 ■ 175

   140-191_C51711.indd 175                                                                                      6/3/09 12:55:43 PM

ects 174 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:175

         Pictures & Mirrors

         I f you’ve ever made six holes in a wall to hang one
           picture, you know how frustrating the process can
         be. Most of us have done it, and none of us want to
                                                                                Before getting out your tools, study the size and shape
                                                                           of the room. Designers and decorators often suggest
                                                                           placing the center of a picture or mirror at eye level—57
         repeat the experience. Great news! By following the               to 60" above the floor—but that’s a guideline, not a hard
         steps outlined here and using the right hardware,                 and fast rule. If you’re placing a mirror behind a sideboard
         you can hang a picture without making a single                    or a picture over a mantle, let the style of the room and a
         unnecessary hole.                                                 sense of balance guide its placement.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               D-rings or pictures hooks              Tape measure                Awl                           Self-adhesive felt pads
                 that will support the                Pencil                      Screws                           or silicone caulk
                 weight of your artwork               Drill                       Stud finder                   Painter’s tape

         Hanging pictures and mirrors instantly personalizes a room, and it’s easy to do when you approach it with the right tools and a
         good attitude. We’ll show you how to position a piece properly and hang it securely—the first time.

  176 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 176 5/22/09 10:53:38 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:176

                      Choosing Hardware ▸
                      Frames and mirrors remain level and
                      secure when they’re supported by wall
                      studs and sturdy hardware. Before you
                      choose hardware, find out what the piece
                      weighs. While shopping, check the labels
                      on the hardware you’re considering to                                                                       Stud
                      make sure it will support the weight of the                   D-rings
                      piece you’re going to hang.
                            If a stud is not available, then
                      hardware selection is even more
                                                                                                                        Wood screw
                      important. Take your specifications to a
                      salesperson and find out which kind of
                      self-tapping hollow wall anchor or heavy-
                      duty wall hanger she/he recommends to
                                                                                                                         Drywall
                      both support your artwork sufficiently and
                      protect the integrity of your walls.

                                                                                                                                 Self-tapping
                                                                                                                                    hollow
                                                                                                                                 wall anchor

                ■ How to Hang a Picture
                   1                                                               2

                On each side of the frame, mark 8" down from the top.            Set the D-rings aside, and then use an awl to punch a hole
                Purchase D-rings or picture hooks rated to support the           at each mark on the frame. Reposition the first D-ring and drive
                approximate weight of the picture or mirror (package labels on   a screw into the mark, securely attaching the D-ring to the
                the hardware give the suggested weight ranges).                  frame. Repeat on the other side.

                                                                                                                                              (continued)

                                                                                                                                            Wall Décor ■ 177

   140-191_11989.indd 177                                                                                                                               5/22/09 10:53:41 AM

ects 176 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:177

            3

         Attach a self-adhesive felt pad at each corner of the frame.       Variation: If you do not have felt pads available, put a dot of
                                                                            silicone caulk about the size of a pencil eraser on each corner
                                                                            instead. Continue to hang your artwork when the caulk is
                                                                            completely dry.

            4                                                                 5

         In the area where you want to hang the frame, place a piece        Measure the width of the frame and divide that number
         of tape at the appropriate height, measured from the floor         by 2—this is the center of your frame. On the tape, mark the
         (usually 57 to 60", depending on the room’s dimensions).           proposed center of the frame, and then mark the edge of the
         Following manufacturer’s directions, use a stud finder to locate   frame the calculated distance on each side. If possible, align
         the studs and mark the tape to indicate their positions.           the frame so that the three points are near your stud marks.

  178 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 178 5/22/09 10:53:50 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:178

                   6                                                                7

                                  8"

                Measure down 8" from the frame side marks for the D-ring          Slip the D-rings or picture hooks over the screws on the
                placement. Drill wood screws into the studs.                      wall. Your picture should now be straight and secure with nary
                                                                                  an extra hole to repair.

                      Hanging a Picture When a Stud is Not Available ▸

                      Use an awl to drill a small hole on your placement mark,    Mels Enterprises, Inc. produces a heavy-duty wall
                      then follow package instructions to drive self-tapping      hanger that is remarkably strong and easy to use, and is
                      wall anchors into your wallboard. Drive a screw into each   usable only where a stud is not available. To use, just push
                      anchor as instructed.                                       the chiseled anchor into the wall at your placement mark
                                                                                  and twist until the hook is upright.

                                                                                                                                             Wall Décor ■ 179

   140-191_11989.indd 179                                                                                                                                5/22/09 10:53:56 AM

ects 178 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:179

         Textiles

         F   abric wall hangings dress up walls and are easily
             replaceable as your décor changes. Quilts,
         tapestries, and other textiles make exquisite wall
         decorations, especially in bedrooms and living spaces,
         but are easily damaged when hung improperly.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Cotton twill                Small hooks or screws
                 rug binding               Dowel
               Fabric-marking pen          Narrow board
               Needle and thread           Velcro strip
               Level                       Drill                              Hanging textiles is a creative way to add softness and
               Tape measure                                                   warmth to your home—and to display family heirlooms and
                                                                              textile art.

         ■ How to Hang Textiles
            1                                           2

         Mark a straight line ½ to 3⁄4" from the      Mark a level line where you’d like to            Variation: Position a narrow board
         top edge of the textile. Cut a piece of      hang the piece about 11⁄2" shorter than          along a level line at the desired height.
         cotton twill rug binding about 3" shorter    the width of the textile. Drive one small        Drive screws through the board into
         than the width of the textile. Align the     hook or screw eye into the wall at each          the studs in the wall. Cut a Velcro strip
         binding with the line and pin in place.      end of the line. Insert a dowel or rod (cut      slightly less than the width of the textile
         Stitch the binding to the textile by hand,   11⁄2" wider than the rug binding piece)          and attach the “hook” side to the board.
         using a blind hem (page 31).                 through the textile’s casing and rest the        Hand-stitch the “loop” side along a line
                                                      dowel on the hooks or screws.                    ½" from the top edge of the textile.
                                                                                                       Press the Velcro strips together to hold
                                                                                                       the textile in place.

  180 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 180 5/22/09 10:54:4 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:180

                Sticker Art

                W      all stickers are an excellent decorative alternative
                       to hung wall art—perfect for children’s rooms
                or playful spaces. Stick-on wall art is even available
                as materials suitable to draw on with chalk. Today,
                manufacturers also make contemporary stickers in
                large, bold styles and patterns that are appropriate for
                any room in the home, including formal areas. Stickers
                are simple to use, apply professionally, and are
                available in a variety of styles and colors. Plus, they’re
                easy to move and replace for those who change their
                décor frequently.

                      Tools & Materials ▸
                      Pencil                    Wall stickers                 Wall stickers can enhance decorative motifs in your room, or
                                                                              add a striking contrast to existing elements.

                ■ How to Hang Wall Stickers
                   1                                                            2

                Clean walls then place light pencil marks where you plan to   Peel the backing off each sticker and place it at your marked
                stick each item.                                              locations. Accurate placement is not necessary because wall
                                                                              stickers are easily removed and repositioned. However, bear in
                                                                              mind that continued removal and replacement will weaken the
                                                                              sticker’s adhesive over time.

                                                                                                                                        Wall Décor ■ 181

   140-191_11989.indd 181                                                                                                                           5/22/09 10:54:31 AM

ects 180 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:181

         Wood Shelving

         A    n attractive space to display collections, libraries,
              and mementos is a key element to every family’s
         home décor, which explains why installing shelves
         is one of the first projects many decorators take on.
         Wood shelves fit invisibly into most design schemes,
         and are durable and easy to clean. By following a few
         basic guidelines, your shelves will be a sturdy and
         secure home for your belongings.
              Before you purchase materials for this project,
         decide where you’d like your shelving placed and
         how wide you’d like it to be. It’s also helpful to
         know the approximate weight of the items you’ll be
         displaying—heavier collectibles will require more
         support than lighter items. Wood shelves are typically
         sold with all the hardware you’ll need to install them,
         but always check the packaging to see if you will
         need to purchase hardware separately, and remember               Indispensable to virtually every home, shelves provide
         to purchase self-tapping hollow wall anchors if you              storage and display space for everything from books to your
         cannot install your shelf into wall studs.                       favorite chachkas.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Shelf and brackets         Wood screws or self-tapping        Laser level or                  Painter’s tape
               Pencil                       hollow wall anchors                carpenter’s level

         ■ How to Install Wood Shelving
            1                                                               2

         Measure the shelves and the brackets. Make a quick               Mark the studs on the wall with easy-release painter’s tape
         diagram of the shelves and their placement on the wall,          and plan to use them to support the shelf if possible.
         including spacing between the shelves if there will be more
         than one. Be sure to consider the sizes of the items the shelf
         will hold as you decide how far apart to put the shelves.

  182 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_C51711.indd 182 6/3/09 12:56:28 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:182

                   3                                                                 4

                Position the first bracket and mark its screw holes on the         Use a level to create a line across the wall from the first
                wall. If there is a stud available to support the bracket, drive   bracket to the planned position of the next bracket. Attach the
                pilot holes at the marks and drive screws into the stud. If no     bracket to the wall as you did in step 3.
                stud is available, use an awl to make a small hole and then
                drive self-tapping hollow wall anchors into the holes and wood
                screws into the anchors. Attach the first bracket to the screws
                (see inset).

                   5                                                                 6

                If the project includes more than one shelf, refer to the          Remove the first bracket and use it to measure for the
                measurements from your diagram and use a level to draw a           placement of all additional brackets. If shelves are more than
                line for each of the remaining shelves.                            36" wide or will be supporting heavy items, install a bracket as
                                                                                   a center support as well. Attach the remaining brackets and
                                                                                   position the shelves upon them.

                                                                                                                                              Wall Décor ■ 183

   140-191_11989.indd 183                                                                                                                                 5/22/09 10:54:41 AM

ects 182 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:183

         Glass Shelving

         G    lass shelving is sleek and unobtrusive, so it
              fits well into many rooms and décor styles.
         If you’d like to elegantly showcase items without
                                                                                Tools & Materials ▸
         drawing attention to the shelving as a structural                      Level                            Pencil
         statement, then glass shelves are the best choice                      Drill                            Glass shelves
         for you.
              Glass shelving is typically held in place with
         metal mounts, though the attachment method differs
         from shelf to shelf. The most basic models may have               The directions here are for shelving that uses hidden
         mounts that are screwed directly into the wall with               brackets that attach to the wall. Mounts then slip over
         exposed screws.                                                   the brackets and are secured with setscrews.

         Glass shelves are an excellent choice for bathrooms, kitchens, bedrooms, and living spaces.

  184 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 184 5/22/09 10:54:51 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:184

                ■ How to Install Glass Shelves
                   1                                                                    2

                Assemble the shelf and shelf holders (not the brackets).              Remove the shelves and use the level to extend the mark
                Hold the shelf against the wall in the desired location. On the       into a 3" vertical line. Use the level to mark a horizontal line
                wall, mark the center point of each holder, where the setscrew        across the centers of these lines.
                is. Remove the shelf from the holders and set aside.

                   3                                                                    4

                Center the middle round hole of the bracket over the                  Slide a holder over a bracket, check that the shelf mount
                intersection of the vertical and horizontal lines. Mark the           is level, and tighten the setscrew. Repeat with the other holder.
                center of each of the oblong holes. Put the bracket aside and         Insert the shelf and fix in place. Check the shelf for level. If it’s
                drill a 1⁄4" hole at each mark. Insert the included wall anchors in   not level, remove one holder and loosen the bracket screws.
                the holes. Replace the bracket, insert the screws into the wall       Slide the bracket up or down to make the unit level. Replace
                anchors, and drive the screws. Repeat for the second bracket.         the holder and shelf.

                                                                                                                                                 Wall Décor ■ 185

   140-191_C51729.indd 185                                                                                                                                    6/10/09 3:12:38 PM

ects 184 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51729) #175 Dtp:119 Page:185

         Ceramic Tile Mirror Frame

         F    raming a mirror with ceramic tile can transform
              the object from a flat, modern necessity to a
         beautiful decorative flourish. The process is extremely
         simple; in fact, choosing the tile can be the most
         difficult part of the project. If you’re tiling the rest
         of the room, combine trim pieces that match or
         complement the field tile. If the room has no other
         tile, match your tile to the rest of your décor or create
         an elegant accent piece in bold, standout colors.
               There are two ways to tile a mirror: apply the tile
         directly to the mirror, or tile around the mirror and
         butt up to the edges. We chose to remove the mirror
         and attach the tiles around the perimeter, and then
         rehang the mirror. Before you rehang the mirror, make
         sure the hanger and anchor are designed to support
         the mirror’s new weight, as it will be considerably                 Our tile frame uses three types of trim tile: an outer chair rail tile,
         heavier with the addition of the tiled frame.                       a thin band of mosaic tile, and a thin pencil tile as an inner ring.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Tape measure                         Putty knife              Heavy brown paper                     Wide painter’s tape
               Permanent marker                     Grout float                 or cardboard                       Grout with latex additive
               Wet saw                              Grout sponge             Trim tile                             Grout sealer
               Laser or carpenter’s level           Foam paintbrush          Windshield adhesive

         ■ How to Frame a Bathroom Mirror
            1                                            2                                                  3

         Dry lay the tile around a mirror              Dry lay the outermost row of                      Dry lay the next couple of rows
         template made of heavy brown paper.           chair rail tiles again—this time on               of field tile starting in the left-hand
         Use spacers if the tiles are not self-        the mirror. Check corner miters for               corner. For accurate placement,
         spaced. Mark tiles that must be cut.          proper alignment.                                 include spacers.
         Miter the one end of each corner tile at
         a 45° angle using a wet saw.

  186 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 186 5/22/09 10:55:3 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:186

                   4                                              5                                                  6

                Dry lay the final row of pencil tiles.         Apply adhesive to the back of the                  Repeat until all rows are secured
                Cut tiles, as necessary, to fit onto mirror    tile using a small putty knife. Set tiles on       to the mirror. Prepare a small batch of
                as planned. Once all tiles fit, remove all     the mirror and twist to secure in place.           grout and fill all the tile joints. Clean and
                but the first row of chair tiles.              Start at the top, left-hand corner and             buff the tile.
                                                               work around the entire mirror.

                      Tiled Mirror Designs ▸

                      Tile has been added only to the mirror in this project.           In new construction or major remodeling projects,
                      The mirror is framed by a mosaic of shards and small              place the mirror so the trim tile can be attached to the
                      pieces of glass tile. Mosaic projects are incredibly easy to      wall rather than to the mirror.
                      do and really add a lot to a small room like this one.

                                                                                                                                                    Wall Décor ■ 187

   140-191_11989.indd 187                                                                                                                                       5/22/09 10:55:12 AM

ects 186 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:187

         New Towel Bar

         R    eplacing an out-of-date or damaged towel bar
              can spruce up your bathroom décor in a snap. If
         you’re selecting new accessories, note the finish on
         the existing faucets and handles. Generally, bathroom
         décor looks best when faucets and accessories match,
         or at least coordinate.
              It’s also smart to measure the mounting plates on
         the existing towel bar before you purchase a new one.
         It will be easier to produce professional-looking results
         if the plates on the new bar are the same size or larger
         than the existing plates. In fact, sometimes your new
         accessories can be mounted on the existing plates if
         the hardware is the same size, greatly decreasing the
         time required for this project.
              Most bathroom accessories are installed similarly,
         so these instructions could easily be applied to many
         different accessory installations.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Towel bar with          Level
                  mounting plates      Drill
               Pencil                  Screws
               Stud finder             Screwdriver                      New accessories can have a great impact on your bathroom
                                                                        décor without much time or expense.

               Anatomy of a Towel Bar Mount ▸
                                                                                       Towel bars and other bathroom
                                             Wall plate                                accessories are supported by mounting
                                                                                       plates attached to walls. The mounting
                                                                     Wood screw        plate must be securely supported by wall
                     Rod holder                                                        studs or self-tapping hollow wall anchors
                                                                                       rated for the bar’s weight.

                                                                        Stud

                                                                           Hollow
                                                                            wall
                                                                           anchor

                        Setscrew

  188 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 188 5/22/09 10:55:22 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:188

                ■ How to Install a Towel Bar
                   1                                          2                                               3

                Position the towel bar and make a           Center the mounting plate between              Drill pilot holes, and then hold the
                mark along the outside of the mounting      the marks made in step 1, and then             first mounting plate in place and drive
                trim on each side. (Try to avoid            make marks for the screw locations.            screws to attach it to the wall. Repeat
                positioning the bar so the new holes will   Repeat this process on the other side.         on the other side.
                fall directly over the old ones.) Repeat    Check the marks with a level, and adjust
                for the other side.                         if necessary. Use a stud finder to check
                                                            if the marks are located over studs.

                   4                                                                   Ceramic Tile Walls ▸

                                                                                       Use a ceramic tile bit with a carbide tip to drill the
                                                                                       pilot holes. Before beginning to drill, scratch a dimple
                Settle the towel bar onto the mounting plates. Tighten the             into the tile with an awl or a sharp nail. Starting to
                setscrews that hold the bar to the mounting plates. (These             drill beyond the tile’s glaze helps keep the bit from
                setscrews typically are found on the bottom of the trim.)              dancing around on the tile.

                                                                                                                                             Wall Décor ■ 189

   140-191_11989.indd 189                                                                                                                                5/22/09 10:55:32 AM

ects 188 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:189

         Tile Fireplace Surround

         T    ile dresses a fireplace surround in style—any
              style you like. From simple ceramic to elegant cut
         stone to handmade art tile, anything goes. As long as
                                                                               You can finish the edges of the surround with
                                                                           wood cap rail trim, as shown here, bullnose tile, or
                                                                           other trim tile.
         it’s sturdy enough to withstand significant swings in
         temperature, almost any tile will work.
               Although the project shown here starts with                      Tools & Materials ▸
         unfinished wallboard, you can tile over any level
         surface that’s not glossy. If you’re tiling over old tile or           Level                           Tile spacers
         brick, go over the surface with a grinder, then apply a                Drill                           Latex-reinforced
         thin coat of latex-reinforced thinset mortar to even out               Hammer                             thinset mortar
         any irregularities. To rough up painted surfaces, sand                 Nail set                        Masking tape
         them lightly before beginning the project.                             Notched trowel                  Grout
               The tile shown here is flush with the face of the                Grout float                     Cap rail trim
         firebox, which then supports it during installation. If                2 × 4 lumber                    6d and 4d finish nails
         necessary, tack battens in place to support the weight                 Mantel                          Wood putty
         of your tile during installation. (Make sure the batten                Tile                            Sponge
         is level.)

         A tile surround can dress up home accents, like fireplaces. Choose tile that blends with or complements your other décor.

  190 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

140-191_11989.indd 190 5/22/09 10:55:41 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:190

                ■ How to Tile a Fireplace Surround
                   1                                              2                                                    3

                                                Mantel
                                                support
                                                 cleat

                To install the mantel, measure up               Paint the areas of wallboard that                   Dry-fit the tile around the front of the
                from the floor and mark the height of           won’t be tiled. Finish the mantel as                fireplace. You can lay tile over the black
                the support cleat. Use a level to draw          desired, then fit it over the support cleat         front face, but do not cover the glass or
                a level line through the mark. Mark the         and center it. Drill pilot holes for 6d             any portion of the grills. If you’re using tile
                stud locations just above the level line.       finish nails through the top of the mantel          without spacer lugs, use spacers to set
                Position the cleat on the line, centered        about 3⁄4" from the back edge. Secure the           the gaps (at least 1⁄8" for floor tile). Mark
                between the frame sides and drill a pilot       mantel to the cleat with four nails. Set            the perimeter of the tile area and make
                hole at each stud location. Fasten the          the nails with a nail set, fill the holes with      any other layout marks that will help with
                cleat to the studs with screws provided         wood putty, then touch up the finish.               the installation. Pre-cut tiles, if possible.
                by the manufacturer.

                   4                                              5                                                    6
                                                                                                                                          Cap rail trim

                                                                                                                                            Buildup strip

                Mask off around the tile, then use a            Mix a batch of grout and spread                     Cut pieces of cap rail trim to fit
                V-notched trowel to apply latex mastic          it over the tiles with a rubber grout               around the tile, mitering the ends. If the
                tile adhesive to the wall, spreading it         float. Drag the float across the joints             tile is thicker than the trim recesses,
                evenly just inside the perimeter lines.         diagonally, tilting it at a 45° angle. Make         install buildup strips behind the trim,
                Set the tiles into the adhesive, aligning       another pass to remove excess grout.                using finish nails. Finish the trim to
                them with the layout marks, and press           Wait 10 to 15 minutes, then wipe away               match the mantel. Drill pilot holes and
                firmly to create a good bond. Install           excess grout with a damp sponge,                    nail the trim in place with 4d finish nails.
                spacers as you work, and scrape                 rinsing frequently. Let the grout dry for           Set the nails with a nail set. Fill the holes
                out excess adhesive from the grout              one hour, then polish the tiles with a dry          with wood putty and touch up the finish.
                joints. Install all of the tile, then let the   cloth. Let the grout dry completely.
                adhesive dry completely.

                                                                                                                                                      Wall Décor ■ 191

   140-191_11989.indd 191                                                                                                                                         5/22/09 10:55:58 AM

ects 190 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:191

192-235_11989.indd 192 5/22/09 12:19:45 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:192

                                         Ceiling Décor
                                         T   hough many decorators choose to focus their
                                             time and energy on wall detail, ceiling decoration
                                         can add considerably to the wholeness and energy
                                         of a room. Sometimes the best way to pull a newly
                                         decorated room together can be to paint, wallcover,
                                         panel, or tile a ceiling. These projects can also help to
                                         seal and protect your ceiling wallboard and insulate or
                                         reflect noise and light.
                                              Careful preparation for ceiling projects will ease
                                         the process and cleanup, and most techniques will be
                                         vastly easier with the help of a partner. When planning
                                         your project, bear in mind that the ceiling edge closest
                                         to the entry of any room is the least visible, so always
                                         work from the farthest corner toward the entry. Also,
                                         always repair any ceiling damage before installing a
                                         decorative finish.
                                              Before you decide on the technique that will best
                                         accent your room, consider how the ceiling treatment
                                         will complement or blend with your wall décor and
                                         make a plan for smoothing the transition between the
                                         ceiling and wall.

                                         In this chapter:
                                         • Ceiling Panels                     • Painting a Ceiling
                                         • Acoustical Ceiling Tiles           • Aluminum Leaf Gilding
                                         • Metal Ceilings                     • Ceiling Wallcovering

                                                                                                                 ■ 193

   192-235_11989.indd 193                                                                                      5/22/09 12:19:53 PM

ects 192 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:193

         Ceiling Panels

         I nstalling ceiling paneling in a den, bedroom, or
           attic adds balance and warmth, wrapping the
         room in the cozy natural glow of finished wood.
                                                                                   Tools & Materials ▸
         Tongue-and-groove paneling made of pine is the                            Chalk line                        Tongue-and-groove
         most common type of paneling for this project,                            Compound miter saw                    paneling
         but any tongue-and-groove material can be used.                           Circular saw                      13⁄4" spiral
         These materials are typically 3⁄8 to ¾" thick and are                     Drill                                 flooring nails
         attached directly to ceiling joists and rafters (over                     Nail set                          Trim molding
         faced insulation, when required). If using a thin
         paneling, bear in mind that most codes require you
         to install 3⁄8" wallboard as a fire stop under ceiling
         material thinner than ¼"                                             flaws such as pattern deviations, misaligned walls,
              Tongue-and-groove boards are attached with                      and installation mistakes. Before beginning, measure
         flooring nails driven through the shoulder of the                    to see how many boards will be installed. If the final
         tongue into each rafter. This technique is called                    board will be less than 2" wide, trim the long edge of
         blind-nailing because the nail heads will be covered                 the first board to allow more room.
         by the next board. Nailing through the board face                         If the angle of the ceiling peak is not parallel to
         is only necessary on the first and last course and on                the wall, compensate for the difference by ripping the
         scarf joints. Layout is very important to the success                starter piece at an angle so that the leading edge, and
         of a paneled surface because the lines clearly reveal                every piece thereafter, is parallel to the peak.

         Tongue-and-groove paneling can be installed directly over rafters or joists or over wallboard. In attic installations, it’s important
         to insulate first, adding a separate vapor barrier if required by building codes. Local code may also require that paper-faced
         insulation behind a kneewall be covered with drywall or other material.

  194 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_C51711.indd 194 6/3/09 12:57:59 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:194

                ■ How to Panel a Ceiling
                   1                                                                    2                                     Rafters

                                                           Reveal

                                                                                             Side wall

                To plan your layout, first measure the reveal of the boards.          Use the calculation from step 1 to make a control line for
                Fit two pieces together and measure from the bottom edge              the first row of panels—the starter boards. At both ends of the
                of the upper board to the bottom edge of the lower board.             ceiling, measure down from the peak an equal distance, and
                Calculate the number of boards needed to cover one side of            make a mark to represent the top (tongue) edges of the starter
                the ceiling by dividing the reveal dimension into the overall         boards. Snap a chalk line through the marks.
                distance between the top of the wall and the peak.

                   3                                                                    4

                            Rafters

                                      Joints

                                                                                        1st board        2nd board

                If the boards aren’t long enough to span the entire ceiling,          Rip the first starter board to width by bevel-cutting the
                plan the locations of the joints. Staggering the joints in a three-   bottom (grooved) edge. If the starter row will have joints, cut
                step pattern will make them less conspicuous. Note that each          the board to length using a 30° bevel cut on the joint end only.
                joint must fall over the middle of a rafter. For best appearance,     Two beveled ends joined together form a scarf joint (inset),
                select boards of similar coloring and grain for each row.             which is less noticeable than a butt joint. If the board spans the
                                                                                      ceiling, square-cut both ends.

                                                                                                                                                    (continued)

                                                                                                                                               Ceiling Décor ■ 195

   192-235_11989.indd 195                                                                                                                                      5/22/09 12:20:3 PM

ects 194 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:195

            5                                                                6

         Position the first starter board so the tongue is on the          Cut and install any remaining boards in the starter row
         control line. Leave a 1⁄8" gap between the square board end       one at a time, making sure the scarf joints fit together tightly.
         and the end wall. Fasten the board by nailing through its face    At each scarf joint, drive two nails through the face of the top
         about 1" from the grooved edge and into the rafters. Then,        board, angling the nail to capture the end of the board behind
         blind-nail through the base of the tongue into each rafter,       it. If necessary, predrill the nail holes to prevent splitting.
         angling the nail backward at 45°. Drive the nail heads beneath
         the wood surface, using a nail set.

            7                                                                8

         Cut the first board for the next row, then fit its grooved        As you install successive rows, measure down from
         edge over the tongue of the board in the starter row. Use a       the peak to make sure the rows remain parallel to the peak.
         hammer and a scrap piece of paneling to drive downward on         Correct any misalignment by adjusting the tongue-and-groove
         the tongue edge, seating the grooved edge over the tongue of      joint slightly with each row. You can also snap additional
         the starter board. Fasten the second row with blind-nails only.   control lines to help align the rows.

  196 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 196 5/22/09 12:20:11 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:196

                   9                                                                    10

                                 Ridge
                                 board

                            Panels

                Rip the boards for the last row to width, beveling the top            Install trim molding along walls, at joints around obstacles,
                edges so they fit flush against the ridge board. Facenail the         and along inside and outside corners, if desired. (Select-grade
                boards in place. Install paneling on the other side of the ceiling,   1 × 2 works well as trim along walls.) Where necessary,
                then cut and install the final row of panels to form a closed         bevel the back edges of the trim or miter-cut the ends to
                joint under the ridge board (inset).                                  accommodate the slope of the ceiling.

                      Tips for Paneling an Attic Ceiling ▸

                       Panels

                                       Trim

                                                                                                                           Collar
                                                                                                                            tie

                                                                                                                                               Panel
                                                                                                                                              material

                      Use mitered trim to cover joints where panels meet              Wrap collar ties or exposed beams with custom-
                      at outside corners. Dormers and other roof elements             cut panels. Install the paneling on the ceiling first. Then,
                      create opposing ceiling angles that can be difficult to         rip-cut panels to the desired width. You may want to
                      panel around. It may be easier to butt the panels together      include a tongue-and-groove joint as part of the trim
                      and hide the butt joints with custom-cut trim. The trim         detail. Angle-cut the ends of the trim so it fits tight to the
                      also makes a nice transition between angles.                    ceiling panels.

                                                                                                                                              Ceiling Décor ■ 197

   192-235_11989.indd 197                                                                                                                                    5/22/09 12:20:18 PM

ects 196 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:197

         Acoustical Ceiling Tiles

         E   asy-to-install ceiling tiles can lend character to a
             plain ceiling or help turn an unfinished basement
         or attic into beautiful living space. Made of pressed
                                                                            Tools & Materials ▸
         mineral and fiberboard, ceiling tiles are available                4-ft. level                      Stapler
         in a variety of styles. They also provide moderate                 Stepladder                       1 × 2 furring strips
         noise reduction.                                                   Chalk line                       8d nails or 2" screws
              Ceiling tiles typically can be attached directly to a         Utility knife                    String
         drywall or plaster ceiling with adhesive. If your ceiling          Straightedge                     Ceiling tiles
         is damaged or uneven, or if you have an unfinished                 Hammer or drill                  Staples
         joist ceiling, install 1 × 2 furring strips as a base for          Handsaw                          Trim molding
         the tiles, as shown in this project. Some systems
         include metal tracks for clip-on installation.
              Unless your ceiling measures in even feet, you            to the same width and are at least half the width of a
         won’t be able to install the 12" tiles without some            full tile.
         cutting. To prevent an unattractive installation with               Most ceiling tiles come prefinished, but they can
         small, irregular tiles along two sides, include a course       be painted to match any decor. For best results, apply
         of border tiles along the perimeter of the installation.       two coats of paint using a roller with a 1⁄4" nap. Wait
         Plan so that tiles at opposite ends of the room are cut        24 hours between coats.

         Acoustic tile improves the sound quality inside a home theater and reduces the transmission of sound to the rooms
         surrounding it.

  198 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 198 5/22/09 12:20:22 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:198

                ■ How to Install Ceiling Tile
                   1                                                                                                 2

                Measure the ceiling and devise a layout. If the length (or width) doesn’t measure                 Install the first furring strip flush
                in even feet, use this formula to determine the width of the border tiles: add 12 to              with the wall and perpendicular to the
                the number of inches remaining and divide by 2. The result is the width of the border             joists, fastening with two 8d nails or 2"
                tile. (For example, if the room length is 15 ft., 4", add 12 to the 4, then divide 16 by 2,       screws at each joist. Measure out from
                which results in an 8" border tile.)                                                              the wall a distance equal to the border
                                                                                                                  tile width minus 3⁄4", and snap a chalk
                                                                                                                  line. Install the second furring strip with
                                                                                                                  its wall-side edge on the chalk line.

                   3                                                                                                 4

                Install the remaining strips 12" on-center from the second strip. Measure from the                Check the strips with a 4-ft. level.
                second strip and mark the joist nearest the wall every 12". Repeat along the joist on the         Insert wood shims between the strips
                opposite side of the room, then snap chalk lines between the marks. Install the furring           and joists as necessary to bring the
                strips along the lines. Install the last furring strip flush against the opposite side wall.      strips into a level plane.
                Stagger the butted end joints of strips between rows so they aren’t all on the same joist.

                                                                                                                                                      (continued)

                                                                                                                                                 Ceiling Décor ■ 199

   192-235_C51729.indd 199                                                                                                                                       6/10/09 3:16:25 PM

ects 198 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51729) #175 Dtp:119 Page:199

            5                                                                    6

         Set up taut, perpendicular string lines along two adjacent            Cut the corner border tile to size with a utility knife
         walls to help guide the tile installation. Inset the strings from     and straightedge. Cutting the border tiles 1⁄4" short will ease
         the wall by a distance that equals that wall’s border tile            fitting them. The resulting gap between the tile and wall
         width plus 1⁄2". Use a framing square to make sure the strings        will be covered by trim. Cut only on the edges without the
         are square.                                                           stapling flange.

            7                                             8                                                9

         Position the corner tile with the              Fill in between the border tiles                Install the final row of tiles, saving
         flange edges aligned with the two string       with full-size tiles. Continue working          the far corner tile and its neighbor for
         lines and fasten it to the furring strips      diagonally in this manner, toward the           last. Cut the last tile to size, then remove
         with four 1⁄2" staples. Cut and install two    opposite corner. For the border tiles           the tongue and nailing flange along the
         border tiles along each wall, making           along the far wall, trim off the flange         side edges. Finish the job by installing
         sure the tiles fit snugly together.            edges and staple through the faces of           trim along the edges.
                                                        the tiles, close to the wall.

  200 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_C51729.indd 200 6/10/09 3:19:54 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51729) #175 Dtp:119 Page:200

                Metal Ceilings

                T    oday’s metal ceilings offer the distinctive elegance
                     of 19th-century tin tile in a durable, washable
                ceiling finish. Available at home centers and specialty
                                                                                              Begin your installation by carefully measuring the
                                                                                         ceiling and snapping chalk lines to establish the panel
                                                                                         layout. For most tile patterns, it looks best to cover
                distributors, metal ceiling systems include field panels                 the center of the space with full tiles only, then fill in
                (in 2 × 2-, 2 × 4-, and 2 × 8-ft. sizes), border panels                  along the perimeter with border panels, which are not
                that can be cut to fit your layout, and cornice molding                  patterned. Make sure your layout is square.
                for finishing the edges. The panels come in a variety
                of materials and finishes ready for installation, or they
                can be painted.
                      To simplify installation, the panels have round                         Tools & Materials ▸
                catches called nailing buttons, that fit into one another
                to align the panels where they overlap. The buttons are                       Chalk line                        Field panels
                also the nailing points for attaching the panels. Use                         Level                             Border panels with
                1" decorative conehead nails where nail heads will be                         Tin snips                             molding edge
                exposed, and 1⁄2" wire nails where heads are hidden.                          Drill with 1⁄8"                   Cornice molding
                      Install your metal ceiling over a smooth layer of 3⁄8" or                   metal bit                     Masking tape
                1
                 ⁄2" plywood, which can be fastened directly to the ceiling                   Compass                           1
                                                                                                                                 ⁄2" wire nails
                joists with drywall screws, or installed over an existing                     Metal file                        1" conehead nails
                finish. The plywood provides a flat nailing surface for the                   3
                                                                                               ⁄8" or 1⁄2" plywood              Wood block
                panels. As an alternative, some manufacturers offer a                         2" drywall screws
                track system for clip-on installation.

                Real metal ceilings have traditional embossed patterns with an unmistakable luxurious quality. But, they are expensive and a bit
                unwieldy to install. Acoustic panels with an embossed vinyl pattern layer are much cheaper and easier to install, but are also less authentic.

                                                                                                                                                  Ceiling Décor ■ 201

   192-235_11989.indd 201                                                                                                                                         5/22/09 4:23:47 PM

ects 200 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:201

         ■ How to Install a Metal Tile Ceiling
            1                                                Cornice
                                                                                                         2
                                     Border panel

                                      Field panel

         Measure to find the center of the ceiling, then snap perpendicular chalk lines               Align the first field panel with the
         intersecting the center. On the walls, mark a level reference line representing the          chalk lines at the ceiling’s center, and
         bottom edges of the cornice molding. Where possible, plan to install the panels so           attach it with 1⁄2" wire nails along the
         they overlap toward the room’s entrance, to help conceal the seams.                          edges where another panel will overlap
                                                                                                      it. Drive the nails beside the nailing
                                                                                                      buttons—saving the buttons for nailing
                                                                                                      the overlapping panel.

            3                                                                  4

         Continue to install the field panels, working along the             Cut the border panels to width so they will underlap the
         length of the area first, then overlapping the next row. Make       cornice by at least 1". Use sharp tin snips, and cut from the
         sure the nailing buttons are aligned. Underlap panels by sliding    edge without edge molding. Install the panels so the nailing
         the new panel into position beneath the installed panel, then       buttons on the molding align with those on the field panels.
         fasten through both panels at the nailing buttons, using 1"         Fasten through the buttons with conehead nails, and along the
         conehead nails. Where field panels meet at corners, drill 1⁄8"      cut edge with wire nails. At corners, miter cut the panels, and
         pilot holes for the conehead nails.                                 drive conehead nails every 6" along the seam.

  202 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_C51729.indd 202 6/10/09 3:21:20 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51729) #175 Dtp:119 Page:202

                   5                                             6

                Install each cornice piece with its           At inside corners, install one cornice piece tightly into the corner, then scribe the
                bottom edge on the level line. Drive          mating piece to fit, using masking tape and a compass. Cut along the scribed line
                1" conehead nails through the nailing         with tin snips, and make minor adjustments with a metal file. You may have to cut the
                buttons and into the wall studs. Don’t nail   mating piece several times, so start with plenty of length. If you have several corners,
                the ends until the succeeding piece is in     use this technique to cut templates for the corner pieces.
                place. Fasten the top edges to the ceiling.

                   7                                                                   8

                At outside corners, cut the ends of two scrap pieces at a            Using a hammer and a piece of wood, carefully tap
                33° angle. Fit the pieces together at the corner, then trim and      any loose joints to tighten them. If the cornice will be left
                mark each piece in turn, making minor adjustments until they         unpainted, file the joints for a perfect fit. If you’re painting the
                fit well. Use the scrap pieces as templates for marking the          ceiling, seal the seams with paintable silicone caulk, then apply
                workpieces. Fasten near the corner only when both mating             two coats of paint using a roller with a 1⁄4" nap. Allow the first
                pieces are in place.                                                 coat to dry for 24 hours before applying the second coat.

                                                                                                                                             Ceiling Décor ■ 203

   192-235_11989.indd 203                                                                                                                                    5/22/09 4:23:56 PM

ects 202 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:203

         Painting a Ceiling

         P    ainting a ceiling can greatly enhance the stylistic
              rhythm of your room—whether you choose a clean
         neutral color, an extension of your wall color, or a bold
         accent color. Before painting a ceiling, make sure it
         is clean and that your room is prepared adequately.
         Although it’s best to paint ceilings in sections, set aside
         time to complete the entire room in one sitting, which
         will ensure that the edges of each painted section are
         wet enough to blend seamlessly into one another.
              A roller extension enables you to paint the ceiling
         with your feet firmly planted on the floor, but a ladder
         will still be necessary to cut in around the edges of
         the room. Also, eye protection is an absolute necessity
         when painting overhead. Before you begin, clean the
         ceiling and prime any stained areas.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Paint roller and tray        Painter’s tape                  Painting a ceiling a dark color can absorb light in large
               Roller extension             Ladder                          rooms, making them feel intimate and cozy. Painting a ceiling
               Paint brush                                                  to match the color of your walls draws the room into a
                                                                            cohesive whole.

               Preparing the Room ▸

               If you have hanging light fixtures, shut off the power       Press painter’s tape along the joint between the ceiling
               to the circuit, lower the plate cover and pull a trash bag   and the wall, leaving the bottom half of the tape loose.
               up from the bottom of the fixture. Tie a knot at the top,    Then, slide sheet plastic under the masking tape and
               neatly covering the entire piece.                            press the tape down just enough to hold it in place. Make
                                                                            sure the plastic is long enough to protect the baseboards
                                                                            as well as the walls.

  204 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 204 5/22/09 4:24:3 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:204

                ■ How to Paint a Ceiling
                   1                                                                   2

                Load your brush only about one-third of the length of the            Cut in on the edge of a 3-ft. section of the ceiling starting in
                bristles, and tap the bristles against the side of the can. Do not   the corner furthest from the entry door. Press just hard enough
                drag the brush against the lap of the can as this tactic wears       to flex the bristles, use long, slow strokes, and paint from a dry
                out the bristles.                                                    area back into the wet paint.

                   3                                                                      Painting Large Areas ▸

                                                                                          New roller covers sometimes have lint fibers that
                                                                                          will stick in the paint unless they’re removed. To
                                                                                          clean out lint, wrap masking tape around your hand
                Load the roller and begin rolling the section you just cut                and blot the surface of the cover. When no more
                in. Roll across the area with diagonal strokes and lift the roller        lint comes off the roller cover, wet it, using water
                at the end of each sweep. For the final smoothing strokes, roll           for latex paint or solvent for alkyd. Squeeze out as
                each section toward the wall with the entry door. Reposition              much liquid as possible and slide the cover onto the
                your ladder under the next 3-ft. section and repeat steps 2 and           roller frame.
                3 until the entire ceiling is painted.

                                                                                                                                             Ceiling Décor ■ 205

   192-235_C51711.indd 205                                                                                                                                    6/3/09 12:59:9 PM

ects 204 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:205

         Aluminum Leaf Gilding

         A    n aluminum-leafed ceiling is a spectacular accent
              and looks wonderful in large dining rooms where
         the lights from the chandelier can dance across the
                                                                             As with any gilding process, the final look is only
                                                                         as good as your prep, so make sure that your ceiling
                                                                         surface is smooth and free of any blemishes and
         shiny surface or in intimate spaces that need a little          cracks. The leaf will expose all flaws in your surface
         kick. If you do not want to apply many single sheets            texture. Basecoat the ceiling to be leafed in a pale
         of aluminum leaf to a ceiling over your head in the             warm gray, eggshell-sheen latex paint applied with
         traditional manner, however, there is an easier way:            a foam roller to keep roller stipple to a minimum.
         aluminum leaf comes on a roll! It is made just for this         The eggshell texture will ensure proper sealing of
         type of large, continuous surface application.                  the surface.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Water-based                 7" roller handles              6" spreading knife                   Denatured alcohol
                  gold-leaf size           Aluminum leaf                  Wallpaper blade                      Lint-free rag
               4" paintbrush                  on a roll                   Lamb’s wool pad                      Satin acrylic varnish

         An aluminum leaf ceiling can transport a modern dining room back in time 100 years, evoking the elegance and sophistication
         of formal parlors and dining spaces.

  206 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 206 5/22/09 4:24:25 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:206

                ■ How to Apply Aluminum Leaf Gilding
                   1                                                                    2

                Gilding products include adhesive, the leaf roll, top coat,           With mild tension, pull the roll of leaf at a 45° angle to the
                sealer, and brushes. Brush the size to an area of ceiling that        opposite side of the ceiling, using your free hand to lightly
                you can comfortably gild in one day. Do not leave any skips.          press leaf to ceiling as you go. When you get to the opposite
                Follow the instructions on the size bottle to know how long to        wall, cut the leaf with a sharp wallpaper knife into the corner.
                wait before applying the leaf. Start along the edge where the         Repeat until the ceiling is covered, overlapping each previous
                ceiling meets the wall. Tuck the side of the roll into the edge       row by ¼".
                with the spreading knife, allowing ½" excess to fall onto wall.

                   3                                                                    4

                With a lamb’s wool pad, softly brush over the paper and the           Continue softly cleaning until all excess leaf is removed.
                leaf. This will adhere the leaf to the ceiling. The paper will fall   Dampen a rag with denatured alcohol and gently wipe the entire
                off at this time.                                                     gilded surface down. This removes the wax on the surface of
                                                                                      the leaf and allows your topcoat to be applied. Topcoat cannot
                                                                                      be applied over the wax film. Apply a coat of satin acrylic
                                                                                      varnish to the entire gilded surface with a latex brush.

                                                                                                                                              Ceiling Décor ■ 207

   192-235_11989.indd 207                                                                                                                                     5/22/09 4:24:31 PM

ects 206 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:207

         Ceiling Wallcovering

         A    pplying wallcovering to a ceiling is a tidy way
              to add detail and panache to a room. It works
         particularly well in kitchens and bathrooms. Similar
                                                                    ceiling strips at the far end of the room and work back
                                                                    toward the entryway.
                                                                         If you plan to cover the walls in addition to the
         to most wallcovering projects, applying wallcovering       ceiling, bear in mind that the ceiling pattern can blend
         to a ceiling is a two-person project. When planning a      perfectly into only one wall. Select your “match” wall,
         ceiling project, remember that the pattern on the last     and plan the ceiling project so the strips will blend
         strip may be broken by the ceiling line. Since the least   into it easily. Always cover the ceiling first, and then
         visible edge is usually on the entry wall, begin hanging   cover walls.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Wallcovering                Water tray                Smoothing brush                           Wallboard knife
               Pencil                      Scissors                  Razor knife                               Seam roller
               Straightedge

                                                                                        Wallcovering a ceiling in a room
                                                                                        with wallcovered walls draws the entire
                                                                                        decorating scheme into a cohesive
                                                                                        whole, and creates an intimate,
                                                                                        comfortable space.

  208 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_C51711.indd 208 6/3/09 12:59:35 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:208

                ■ How to Wallcover a Ceiling
                   1                                             2                                              3

                Measure the width of the                      Working in small sections, position            Cut out a small wedge of
                wallcovering strip and subtract ½". Near      the strip against the line. Overlap the        wallcovering in the corner so that the
                a corner, measure this distance away          side wall by ½" and the end wall by 2".        strip will lay flat. Press the wallcovering
                from the wall at several points, marking      Flatten the strip with the smoothing           into the corner with a wallboard knife.
                points on the ceiling with a pencil. Using    brush as you work.
                the marks as guides, draw a line along
                the length of the ceiling with a pencil
                and straightedge. Cut and prepare the
                first wallcovering strip (page 92).

                   4                                                                   5

                Trim the overlap to ½" on all walls that will be covered with       Let the strips stand for 30 minutes, then roll the seams
                wallcovering, using a razor knife and wallboard knife. On walls     lightly with a seam roller.
                that will not be covered, trim the excess to the ceiling by
                holding a wallboard knife against the corner and cutting with a
                sharp razor knife (see inset). Repeat steps 2 through 4, butting
                edges of the wallcovering so the pattern matches.

                                                                                                                                            Ceiling Décor ■ 209

   192-235_11989.indd 209                                                                                                                                   5/22/09 4:24:45 PM

ects 208 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:209

192-235_11989.indd 210 5/22/09 4:25:1 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:210

                                         Cabinets
                                         & Doors
                                         A    dding a decorative stain, creative molding, or
                                              new hardware to doors, cabinets, and drawers
                                         is a quick and easy way to vastly improve the overall
                                         appearance of these home essentials. Kitchen cabinets
                                         contribute massively to kitchen décor, and with a little
                                         creativity, standard cabinets can be transformed with
                                         a luxurious, custom-built appearance. Interior and
                                         closet doors can also easily be renewed—improving
                                         both their appearance and functionality—with many
                                         of the projects in this chapter.
                                              Try applying a faux mahogany finish to cabinets
                                         or repainting doors in an accent color for a dramatic
                                         change. Or, simply replace the knobs on your drawers
                                         or cabinets or install a wineglass rack for a subtle
                                         decorative shift. Consider how your decorative choices
                                         will contribute to the overall tempo of your home and
                                         spend time in preparations and planning, and any of
                                         these projects will complete your overall home décor
                                         with accented detail.

                                         In this chapter:
                                         • Painting Wood Cabinets            • Knobs & Pulls
                                         • Faux Mahogany                     • Prehung Interior Door
                                         • Antique Stained Finish            • Bifold Doors
                                         • Faux Stainless Steel              • Painting Wood Doors
                                         • Cabinet Molding                   • Decorative Door Headers
                                         • Decorative Brackets               • Door Mirror
                                         • Wineglass Rack

                                                                                                                ■ 211

   192-235_11989.indd 211                                                                                       5/22/09 1:31:8 PM

ects 210 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:211

         Painting Wood Cabinets

         P   ainting cabinetry can drastically alter the final
             appearance of a kitchen. Update an outdated color
         scheme or add a clean shine to a new kitchen. Painted
                                                                                Tools & Materials ▸
         cabinets are attractive, easy to clean, and durable,                   Screwdriver                      3" paintbrush, trim
         especially if you use heavy-duty enamel paint.                         Pliers                              brush, tapered
              Although painting cabinetry isn’t difficult, it is a              Sponge and bucket                   sash brush
         time-consuming process. Most cabinets require two                      Latex wood filler                Paint roller and tray
         coats of paint on both sides and all surfaces must be                  Putty knife                      Primer
         lightly sanded between coats. Plan to spend about two                  Sander and sandpaper             Paint
         hours per foot of cabinetry to complete this project.

         Painting wood cabinets is an inexpensive way to give your kitchen an instant face-lift.

  212 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 212 5/22/09 1:31:14 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:212

                ■ How to Paint Wood Cabinets
                   1                                                                2

                First, empty the cabinets, and then remove the shelf pins,        Brush paint onto the interior of the cabinet frames, starting
                shelves, and all hardware. Sand the cabinet frames and use a      with the back wall, then the top, sides, and bottom. Roll the
                damp cloth to remove dust.                                        paint on the outside surfaces, working from top to bottom.

                   3                                                                4

                Fill scratches, dents, or cracks with latex wood filler using     Using a trim brush, paint the inside of each door. Once dry,
                a putty knife as necessary. Let the wood filler dry completely.   paint the other side using a tapered sash brush. Allow the
                Sand all surfaces with an orbital sander and 150-grit             paint to dry and then add a second coat of paint, if needed.
                sandpaper.                                                        Let the doors dry for several days, then replace the hardware
                                                                                  and rehang the doors.

                                                                                                                                     Cabinets & Doors ■ 213

   192-235_C51711.indd 213                                                                                                                                6/3/09 1:05:33 PM

ects 212 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:213

         Faux Mahogany

         M     ahogany is an elegant wood, and this finishing
               technique can replicate the grace and luxury
         of real mahogany on wood surfaces throughout your
         home. Using wood graining, a deep basecoat color, and
         the addition of rich reds to the graining varnish, this
         finish is simple and believable—perfect for tabletops,
         inset side panels, and cabinets.
              Mahogany grain is fine, fairly straight, and without
         knots and whirls. Apply this technique carefully and
         consistently for the best finish. Before you stain, apply
         a coat of a dark, rosy brown latex eggshell paint as your
         base coat, and allow to dry completely.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Eggshell latex paint         UTC, Burnt Umber
                  for base coat             UTC, Raw Umber
               3" latex paintbrush          UTC, Venetian Red
               One pint                     3" and 11⁄2" chip brush
                  measuring cup             T-shirt rags
               Satin oil-based              Flogger brush
                  varnish, clear            Steel wood-
               Paint pail                      graining combs                A mahogany finish adds depth and sophistication to
                                                                             a kitchen.

         ■ How to Apply a Wood-Grain Finish
            1                                            2                                               3

         Repetitive raking creates a realistic        Pull a soft T-shirt rag from top to             Hold the flogger brush parallel to the
         wood grain. After the basecoat has           bottom, jittering the motion slightly to        surface, bristles downward. Slap the
         dried, apply tinted varnish in the           create a vaguely rippled linear pattern.        surface with quick snaps, working from
         direction of the grain using a chip brush.                                                   the top down. Flog the entire surface a
         Rake a comb back and forth quickly,                                                          couple of times until you are satisfied with
         multiple times, from top to bottom until                                                     the look, then allow to dry for 24 hours.
         a grain pattern emerges.                                                                     Top coat with one or two coats of varnish.

  214 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 214 5/22/09 1:31:30 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:214

                ■ How to Create a Faux Mahogany Finish
                   1                                                                 2

                Mix the graining medium. Pour one pint of varnish into             Texture the varnish by lightly pulling a soft T-shirt rag over
                the jar, then drip the UTC colors into the varnish slowly: start   the surface from top to bottom. Jitter the motion slightly
                with three parts Burnt Umber, two parts Raw Umber, and             to create a vaguely rippled linear pattern. Repeat over the
                one-part Venetian Red. Continue to add/mix colors until you        entire surface.
                create a varnish color you’re happy with. You may need to add
                more colorant to make enough solution for large pieces, but
                continue slowly; if too much colorant is added, it will not mix
                and the varnish will never dry. Also, colorant will not dry, so
                wipe up spills immediately. Apply graining varnish with a large
                chip brush using a straight top-to-bottom stroke, then rake
                gently with the wood grain combs (see step 1, opposite page).

                   3                                                                 4

                Hold the flogger brush parallel to the surface, bristles           Dip the tip of the chip brush into the graining varnish.
                downward. Slap the surface with quick snaps, working from          Hold it at a 45° angle to the grain and lay in a dark accent by
                the top down. Flog the entire surface.                             dragging the chisel-edge down the length of the grain. Use this
                                                                                   accent sparingly, perhaps once per side. Allow to dry for 24
                                                                                   hours, and then top coat with one or two coats of varnish.

                                                                                                                                       Cabinets & Doors ■ 215

   192-235_C51711.indd 215                                                                                                                                  6/3/09 1:05:55 PM

ects 214 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:215

         Antique
         Stained Finish

         A    dd extra punch to your cabinets’ stain with this
              easy-to-accomplish antique finish. Use antiqueing
         over a freshly stained surface or enhance previously
         stained cabinetry. When working with an older or
         already stained piece, wash the surface well and allow
         to dry thoroughly before you begin.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Gel stain: golden oak and dark walnut
               1" flat oil paintbrush
               T-shirt rags                                               The soft beauty of an aged finish can add spark and
                                                                          character to a modern kitchen.

         ■ How to Apply an Antique Stain Finish
            1                                                               2

         Dip a rag into the oak stain and apply using a circular          Apply the walnut stain to the edges and corners of the
         motion. Use the small paintbrush to reach into corners or        project surface; leave a clear oval area in the center. Wipe the
         crevices. Wipe the excess stain off with a clean rag. Allow to   stain into the center with a clean rag until the entire surface is
         dry completely.                                                  antiqued. Top coat with one or two coats of varnish.

  216 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 216 5/22/09 1:31:57 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:216

                Faux Stainless Steel

                A    pplying a faux stainless steel finish is a great
                     way to modernize old appliances—such as
                dishwashers, refrigerators, and trash compactors. This
                technique also works well on metal cabinet doors and
                frames. The finish will only successfully replicate
                stainless when used on flat surfaces, however. The
                technique is not effective over pebbly, textured
                appliance fronts or wood grain.
                     Paint color choice is crucial to this technique’s
                success. Choose a latex-based metallic paint close            A faux stainless paint finish is a great way to modernize
                                                                              old appliances.
                to the color of the existing stainless in your kitchen.
                You may need to add a few drops of UTC to tweak
                the color, or you might find that a warm champagne
                metallic mixed with a silver metallic will match the              Tools & Materials ▸
                coloration. Prime the surface with a high-quality
                latex bonding primer tinted to a color close to your              High-quality latex               Metallic latex paint
                metallic. The primer should be applied using the                    bonding primer,                3 or 4" paintbrush
                same technique as your final, metallic coat to help                 tinted to a color              Metal straightedge
                replicate the slight grain in real stainless steel. Use             close to the                   Satin latex
                a slight, linear pattern to your brushwork to aid in                metallic final coat               polyurethane
                this effect.

                ■ How to Create a Faux Stainless Steel Paint Finish
                   1                                                            2

                Apply the metallic paint in a very straight up-and-down       After the first coat of metallic paint has completely dried,
                manner with the paintbrush, after the surface has been        apply a second coat in the same manner. Finish the project
                primed. To keep your strokes straight, place a straightedge   with a clearcoat of durable latex polyurethane.
                onto the surface and use as a guide for your brush.

                                                                                                                                 Cabinets & Doors ■ 217

   192-235_11989.indd 217                                                                                                                             5/22/09 1:32:5 PM

ects 216 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:217

         Cabinet Molding

         I f you love the color or finish of your cabinets,
           but feel like something is missing, try applying
         ornamental molding to your cabinet panels. This
                                                                           Tools & Materials ▸
         raised molding can be stained or painted in a similar             Miter box                       Paint or stain, clear
         or complementary color and can greatly enhance the                  and backsaw                      acrylic finish,
         detail and drama of your kitchen. Use the molding                 Pencil                             and matching
         as an accent on flat cabinets, or apply around                    220-grit sandpaper                 wood putty
         recessed areas for added definition. To further                   Wood glue                       Lumber scraps
         the effect, build moldings in layers, or lay one                  Clamps                          Wool fabric
         within another.
              Use wood glue sparingly for a clean application;
         wood glue holds securely, even when a very small
         amount is used. Also, if your moldings will be                between the strips with wood putty. Bear in mind that
         attached to cabinets with beveled or routed edges, it         there will likely be minute measurement differences
         will be necessary to adjust the angle of the mitered          from one cabinet door to another, so always measure
         cuts somewhat by sanding the edges of the mitered             the panels on each side before cutting the molding to
         molding strips. You may also need to fill in small gaps       ensure an accurate fit.

         Applying molding to kitchen cabinetry adds depth and character to a contemporary kitchen.

  218 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 218 5/22/09 1:32:16 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:218

                ■ How to Apply Cabinet Moldings
                   1                                           2                                                3

                Using a miter box and backsaw, cut           Check the fit of the molding strips             Paint or stain the moldings and
                molding strips at each end according         and sand the corners, using 220-grit            allow to dry completely. Apply wood
                to your measurements and the marked          sandpaper, as necessary for proper fit.         glue sparingly to the underside of
                angle of your cuts. Repeat to cut                                                            the molding.
                remaining strips.

                   4                                                                  5

                Position the molding on the cabinet and clamp it in place.          Remove the clamps when the glue has dried thoroughly.
                Use a scrap of lumber to protect the trim from the clamps. If       Fill any gaps between the molding strips at the corners, using
                there is any excess glue, remove it immediately using a scrap       wood filler if trim is painted; touch up paint. If trim is stained,
                of wool fabric.                                                     fill gaps with putty that matches the stain.

                                                                                                                                        Cabinets & Doors ■ 219

   192-235_C51711.indd 219                                                                                                                                   6/3/09 1:06:29 PM

ects 218 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:219

         Decorative Brackets

         T  ransform your cabinetry from plain to custom-
            fabulous with the easy addition of decorative
         shelf brackets underneath wall cabinets. Shelf
         brackets are affordable, and are available in a
         multitude of shapes and styles—stain or paint them
         to match your cabinetry for nostalgic, old-world
         appeal. Always paint or stain your brackets before
         you install them.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Decorative brackets
               Paint or stain and clear acrylic finish,
                   wood putty to match stain
               4d finish nails
               Nail set
               Drill
               3
                ⁄32" drill bit
               Countersink bit

                                                                          Installing decorative shelf brackets beneath kitchen
                                                                          cabinetry gives your kitchen custom-built detail.

         ■ How to Install Decorative Brackets
            1                                             2                                           3

         Determine the location of the              Cut end strips. Mark the placement             Mark the placement for screws on
         brackets; they may be flush to the         for screws on all the molding strips;          the bottom of the cabinet using molding
         cabinet, protrude slightly beyond the      predrill screw holes through molding           strips as guides; predrill screw holes
         cabinet, or be recessed inboard.           strips using a countersink bit.                using a 3⁄32" bit. Secure the molding
                                                                                                   strips with screws.

  220 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 220 5/22/09 1:32:35 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:220

                Wineglass Rack

                B    ring your stemware out of the cabinet and display
                     it proudly on a wineglass rack beneath your
                cabinets, easing storage space within your cabinetry
                and adding to the elegance of your kitchen. Molding
                designed just for this purpose is sold through specialty
                woodworking stores in predetermined lengths that can
                be cut to fit beneath your cabinetry.
                     If the bottom shelf of your cabinets is recessed,
                add layers of plywood to fill this space before installing
                the molding to ensure that glasses can slide easily in
                and out of the rack without breakage. Position the
                moldings so that the center of one molding is about
                4" from the center of the next to accommodate a wide
                variety of stemware.

                      Tools & Materials ▸
                      Molding for                  8-gauge flathead
                         wineglass rack                wood screws
                      Plywood (if bottom of        Drill
                         cabinet is recessed)      3
                                                    ⁄32" drill bit
                      Screwdriver                  Countersink bit                 Add wineglass moldings to display your stemware and add
                                                                                   to the beauty of your kitchen.

                ■ How to Install a Wineglass Rack
                   1                                          2                                               3

                Plan and mark the placement                 Mark screw hole locations on the               Attach the moldings to the cabinet
                of molding strips, including the end        molding strips and predrill holes using        with screws.
                strips. Cut the end strips to span the      a countersink bit. Mark the position for
                distance from the wall to the front of      screws on the cabinet bottom, using the
                the cabinet.                                molding strips as a guide. Predrill holes
                                                            using a 3⁄32" bit.

                                                                                                                                      Cabinets & Doors ■ 221

   192-235_11989.indd 221                                                                                                                                  5/22/09 1:38:5 PM

ects 220 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:221

         Knobs & Pulls

         S   witching out old drawer or cabinet knobs and pulls
             with updated hardware is a small, inexpensive
         decorating project that can significantly update a
                                                                                Before you select new hardware (especially if
                                                                           shopping for pulls instead of knobs), always measure
                                                                           your existing pulls. If you can avoid filling old holes
         room, or convert an insignificant piece of furniture              and drilling new ones, you will save a significant
         into a one-of-a-kind conversation piece. Like the                 amount of time needed to complete this project. Also,
         perfect piece of jewelry or an exquisite accent color,            for kitchen or bathroom cabinetry, carefully note the
         attractive knobs and pulls can truly transform the                color of the existing hardware in the room and select
         conventional into the exceptional with a touch of                 knobs or pulls that will match or accent your décor,
         sparkle, elegance, and class.                                     faucets, and knobs.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Pulls or knobs                Pencil                     WD-40                                 Sandpaper
               Measuring tape                Cardboard                  Masking tape                          Paint or stain
               Screws                        Scissors                   Wood filler                           Escutcheons (optional)
               Screwdriver                   Drill                      Small putty knife

         Drawer pulls and cabinet knobs serve an important function, but also add a decorative flair to furniture and cabinetry.

  222 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_C51711.indd 222 6/3/09 1:07:36 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:222

                      Hardware Selection Considerations ▸
                      •     Finish: Before you select a finish, consider both the
                            existing faucets and metal work nearby your cabinetry
                            or furniture – and the overall decorative style of the
                            room. If your style is traditional, then brushed finishes,
                            shiny brass, or pewter may be a good choice for you.
                            If more contemporary, look for enameled or high-gloss
                            metals. If you prefer extremely unique hardware, shop
                            around at a local antique store, or scavenge hardware
                            off of second-hand furniture.
                      •     Style: Knobs are available in varying shapes,
                            sizes, and with drop-loops or colorful enameled
                            accents. Drawer pulls do not only vary in length;
                            choose sleek, contemporary D-rings or classic antique
                            bails or drops in a variety of shapes and colors.
                      •     Escutcheon: An escutcheon, or baseplate, may be
                            used behind knobs or pulls to conceal previous holes
                            or to highlight and frame hardware.
                      •     Functionality: If your knob or pull is uncomfortable
                            to use or doesn’t adequately support the weight
                            and/or size of your door or drawer, then it won’t
                            matter how beautiful or unique it is. It’s usually best
                            to gauge the general size required for your project
                            based upon the previous hardware. If selecting
                            hardware for a heavy drawer on a new piece, consult
                            your salesperson for advice on the size, style, and
                            placement that will work best for your piece.

                ■ How to Install Cabinet or Drawer Hardware
                   1                                                 2                                              3

                Measure the thickness of doors or                 Compare the length of the screws               Experiment with the placement
                drawer fronts and count the number                provided with your new hardware to             of knobs or pulls. Generally, pulls are
                of total knobs or pulls needed to finish          the thickness of the doors or drawer           centered side-to-side and top-to-
                your project before you buy hardware.             fronts. The screws should be between           bottom on drawer fronts. If your drawer
                Drawers over 24" wide should have                 1
                                                                   ⁄8 and 1⁄2" longer than the thickness         requires two pulls, divide the length
                two pulls to prevent the drawer from              of the front. If necessary, purchase           of the drawer front by 6 and mark
                twisting when opened.                             screws separately.                             this distance from the outside of your
                                                                                                                 drawer front on both sides. Center your
                                                                                                                 pull upon this mark.
                                                                                                                                                     (continued)

                                                                                                                                            Cabinets & Doors ■ 223

   192-235_11989.indd 223                                                                                                                                       5/22/09 1:38:20 PM

ects 222 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:223

            4                                            5                                              6

         Mark the distance between screw              One at a time, drill holes as marked           Align the new pull with the holes
         holes on a piece of cardboard,               on the doors and drawer fronts. Doors          and drive a screw through the first
         then cut these holes out to make a           can remain in place, but it’s easiest to       hole and into the pull. Drive the second
         template. Hold the template against          remove drawers and place them on a             screw, and then test the pull to make
         doors or drawers and mark the screw          table or workbench.                            sure it’s secure.
         hole placements.

         ■ How to Replace Cabinet or Drawer Hardware
            1                                                                  2

         Remove the screws holding the old hardware in place. If            Measure the distance between holes, center to center. If
         screws are stubborn, spray a little WD-40 and let it sit for a     your measurement matches the width of your new pulls, install
         few minutes before removing. Clean the front and back of the       the new pulls as on page 223.
         drawer or door thoroughly.

  224 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 224 5/22/09 1:38:26 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:224

                                                                                       3

                Variation: If the filled holes are too obvious to cover, attach      Mark and drill screw holes and install hardware as
                escutcheons to camouflage them.                                      instructed on page 224 (top).

                      Covering Holes ▸

                      If your new pulls measure differently than the old,            Sand the filler and touch up the paint, if necessary.
                      place masking tape securely across the front of the            If you intend to repaint the drawer, sand or strip now
                      drawer or door, covering the holes. From the backside          and repaint.
                      of the drawer or door, fill the holes with wood filler using
                      a small putty knife. When the holes are filled evenly and
                      completely, remove the tape and allow the filler to dry.

                                                                                                                                        Cabinets & Doors ■ 225

   192-235_11989.indd 225                                                                                                                                   5/22/09 1:38:34 PM

ects 224 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:225

         Prehung Interior Door

         R   eplacing an old door with a clean, new one can
             instantly update a room’s décor and can help
         coordinate your paint selections with the woodwork
         in the room. When adding a new door, always match
         the finish to any existing trim. If working in new
         construction, install after the framing work is complete
         and the wallboard has been installed. If the rough
         opening for the door has been framed accurately,
         installing a door should take no more than an hour.
              Standard prehung doors have 41⁄2"-wide jambs and
         are sized to fit walls with 2 × 4 construction and 1⁄2"
         wallboard. If you have 2 × 6 construction or thicker
         wall surface material, you can special-order a door to
         match or add jamb extensions to a standard-sized door.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Level                       Prehung interior door
               Hammer                      Wood shims
               Handsaw                     8d casing nails

               Tool Tip ▸

                  1"-thick
                   jamb
                 extension

               If your walls are built with 2 × 6 studs, you’ll need
               to extend the jambs by attaching 1"-thick wood strips
               to the edges of the jamb after the door is installed.
               Use glue and 4d casing nails when attaching jamb
               extensions. Make the strips from the same wood as
               the jamb.                                               Prehung doors are shipped as single units with the door
                                                                       already hung on hinges attached to pre-installed jambs.

  226 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 226 5/22/09 1:38:46 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:226

                ■ How to Install a Prehung Interior Door
                   1                                          2                                              3

                Slide the door unit into the framed         Insert pairs of wood shims driven             Anchor the hinge-side jamb with 8d
                opening so the edges of the jambs           from opposite directions into the gap         casing nails driven through the jamb
                are flush with the wall surface and the     between the framing members and               and shims and into the jack stud.
                hinge-side jamb is plumb.                   the hinge-side jamb, spaced every 12".
                                                            Check the hinge-side jamb to make sure
                                                            it is still plumb and does not bow.

                   4                                                               5

                Insert pairs of shims in the gap between the framing             Cut the shims flush with the wall surface using a handsaw.
                members and the latch-side jamb and top jamb, spaced every       Hold the saw vertically to prevent damage to the door jamb or
                12". With the door closed, adjust the shims so the gap between   wall. Finish the door and install the lockset as directed by the
                door edge and jamb is 1⁄8" wide. Drive 8d casing nails through   manufacturer. See page 129 to install trim around the door.
                the jambs and shims, into the framing members.

                                                                                                                                     Cabinets & Doors ■ 227

   192-235_11989.indd 227                                                                                                                                5/22/09 1:38:52 PM

ects 226 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:227

         Bifold Doors

         B    ifold doors are available in many colors and styles,
              and they provide easy access to a closet without
         requiring much clearance for opening. Most home
                                                                                Tools & Materials ▸
         centers stock kits that include two pairs of prehinged                 Tape measure                  Screwdriver
         doors, a head track, and all the necessary hardware                    Level                         Hacksaw
         and fasteners. Typically, the doors in these kits                      Circular saw                  Prehinged bifold doors
         have predrilled holes for the pivot and guide posts.                   Straightedge                  Head track
         Hardware kits are also sold separately for custom                          (optional)                Mounting hardware
         projects. There are many types of bifold door styles,                  Drill                         Panhead screws
         so be sure to read and follow the manufacturer’s                       Plane                         Flathead screws
         instructions for the product you use.

         A variety of designer bifold doors are available for installation between rooms and closets. They provide the same attractive
         appearance as French doors but require much less floor space.

  228 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 228 5/22/09 1:38:59 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:228

                ■ How to Install Bifold Doors
                   1                                                                 2

                Cut the head track to the width of the opening using a             Measure and mark each side jamb at the floor for the
                hacksaw. Insert the roller mounts into the track, then position    anchor bracket so the center of the bracket aligns exactly with
                the track in the opening. Fasten it to the header using            the center of the head track. Fasten the brackets in place with
                panhead screws.                                                    flathead screws.

                   3                                                                 4

                Check the height of the doors in the opening, and trim             Fold one pair of doors closed and lift it into position,
                if necessary. Insert pivot posts into predrilled holes at the      inserting the pivot and guide posts into the head track. Slip the
                bottoms and tops of the doors. Insert guide posts at the tops of   bottom pivot post into the anchor bracket. Repeat for the other
                the leading doors. Make sure all posts fit snugly.                 pair of doors. Close the doors and check alignment along the
                                                                                   side jambs and down the center. If necessary, adjust the top
                                                                                   and bottom pivots following the manufacturer's instructions.

                                                                                                                                       Cabinets & Doors ■ 229

   192-235_11989.indd 229                                                                                                                                   5/22/09 1:39:5 PM

ects 228 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:229

         Painting Wood Doors

         P   ainting wood doors can add an extra splash of
             color to a new space or help older doors blend
         with updated décor. If you’re working on a raw wood
                                                                          door or repainting an old piece, always take the time
                                                                          to prepare the wood adequately before painting for the
                                                                          best, most lasting result.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Screwdriver      Fine-grit and extra fine-grit sandpaper       3" paintbrush           Clear wood sealer
               Hammer           Lead-testing kit (optional)                   Paint                   Latex wood patch (optional)
               Wood filler      Sawhorses                                     Tack cloth              Drill
               Putty knife

         Painting interior doors can help old doors blend with updated décor or add a punch of accent color.

  230 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_C51711.indd 230 6/3/09 1:08:7 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:230

                ■ How to Paint a Wood Door
                   1                                                                  2

                Remove the door by driving out the lower hinge pin with a           Prepare the door for painting. Apply wood filler to any dents
                screwdriver and hammer. Next, have a helper hold the door           or damaged areas, then sand the surface of the woodwork
                in place while you drive out the middle and then the upper          thoroughly. Start with a fine-grit sandpaper and progress to an
                hinge pins.                                                         extra fine-grit sandpaper, sanding with the grain of the wood.
                                                                                    If painting a door that may have been painted before 1978,
                                                                                    take a sample of the paint and test the paint for lead with a
                                                                                    lead-testing kit before you proceed. If the test indicates the
                                                                                    presence of lead, consult a lead-abatement specialist.

                   3                                                                  4

                Place the door flat on a pair of sawhorses. On paneled              Seal the unpainted edges of the door with clear wood
                doors, use a paintbrush to paint in the following order: 1)         sealer. Allow the sealer and paint to completely dry. Rehang
                recessed panels, 2) horizontal rails, and 3) vertical stiles. Let   the door, using the old screw locations. If the screw holes in
                the paint dry thoroughly. If a second coat is required, sand the    the wall no longer support the screws firmly, fill them with latex
                door lightly and wipe it with a tack cloth before applying it.      wood patch and drill pilot holes before hanging.

                                                                                                                                        Cabinets & Doors ■ 231

   192-235_11989.indd 231                                                                                                                                    5/22/09 1:40:0 PM

ects 230 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:231

         Decorative Door Headers

         A    dding a decorative head casing to a door is a
              tasteful way to dress up your existing trim.
         Although head treatments like this are more common
                                                                              Tools & Materials ▸
         over doors, you can use this technique over windows                  Moldings
         as well. Designing your own decorative molding can be                Wood glue
         creative and fun, but try not to overwhelm the room                  Pencil
         with trim that will detract from the décor.                          Tape measure
              Standard door casings have an outer-edge                        Power miter saw
         thickness of approximately 11⁄16". Build your custom                 Finish nail gun
         header around this thickness. Use it to create a reveal              Brad nail gun
         line to a thinner piece of trim, or build out from the
         edge for a bolder, more substantial appearance.

         Replacing plain head casing on a door or window with a decorative built-up version is a quick and easy way to add
         sophistication to these standard home features.

  232 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_11989.indd 232 5/22/09 1:40:6 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:232

                ■ How to Install a Decorative Door Header
                   1                                                                2

                Measure the width of your door casing and rough cut a             With the molding upside down and sprung against the
                piece of bed or crown molding 6" longer. Use the casing width     fence, cut a 45° outside corner miter angle at each end on the
                dimension to layout cut marks on the bottom edge of the           casing reference marks from step 1. See pages 120 and 122 for
                molding. Start the marks 2" from the end to allow space for       more information on miter-cutting crown molding.
                cutting the mitered ends.

                   3                                          4                                              5

                Cut mitered returns for the molding         Nail the new header in place with             Cut lattice molding 1" longer than the
                using the leftover piece. Set the angle     21⁄2" finish nails driven at an angle         length of the bed molding and nail it in
                of the power miter saw to the opposing      through the bed molding and into the          place with 5⁄8" brad nails so that it has
                45° angle and cut the returns with          framing members of the wall.                  a uniform overhang of 1⁄2". Fill all nail
                the molding upside down and sprung                                                        holes with spackle and sand them with
                against the fence. Dry fit the pieces,                                                    fine-grit sandpaper. Apply the final coat
                recutting them if necessary. Apply glue                                                   of finish.
                to the return pieces and nail them to
                the ends of the head molding with 1"
                brad nails.

                                                                                                                                     Cabinets & Doors ■ 233

   192-235_11989.indd 233                                                                                                                                5/22/09 1:40:11 PM

ects 232 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:233

         Door Mirror

         M     irrors create the illusion of extra space in a
               room, and help move light easily around a
         space. Installing mirrors on the back of bedroom
                                                                     Tools & Materials ▸
         or closet doors is not only an efficient use of the         Tape measure                        Drill
         extra space, it also adds detail and a smart finished       Pencil                              Mirror
         appearance to an area otherwise left neglected              Adhesive-backed hooks
         by decorators.
              Most mirrors will come with all the necessary
         hardware, but if you are purchasing your own, consult   deep enough for the screws you’ve chosen, or that
         the weight loads suitable for the product and ensure    came with the mirror. Some toggle bolts, for example,
         that the screws will support the weight of your         require a radius to flip open that is too large for most
         mirror. Also, measure the door to ensure that it is     prehung doors.

                                                                                     Installing mirrors on doors is both a
                                                                                     functional and an aesthetically pleasing
                                                                                     use of space.

  234 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

192-235_C51711.indd 234 6/3/09 1:08:40 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:234

                ■ How to Attach a Mirror to a Door
                   1                                                             2

                Measure up from the floor to the desired heights at which      Fasten adhesive-backed hooks (or hooks provided by the
                you want the top and the bottom of the mirror to rest on the   manufacturer) along level lines. Here a plastic anchor was
                door. Draw a level line.                                       drilled into the wall and then the screw with plastic fastener
                                                                               was drilled into the anchor. For detailed instructions on self-
                                                                               tapping wall anchor use, see page 179.

                   3                                                                Creative Mirror Decoration ▸
                                                                                    Spraying a stenciled frost to a mirror can add to its
                                                                                    decorative flair. Purchase a can of “frosted glass”
                                                                                    and apply it to the mirror using a stencil for this
                                                                                    contemporary, whimsical effect. When dry, correct
                                                                                    any stencil mistakes or oversprays with a safety razor.
                                                                                    See page 134.

                Place mirror into the hooks and make sure each screw is
                thoroughly and securely driven into the wall.

                                                                                                                                   Cabinets & Doors ■ 235

   192-235_11989.indd 235                                                                                                                              5/22/09 1:40:29 PM

ects 234 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:235

236-259_11989.indd 236 5/22/09 4:03:25 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:236

                                         Flooring
                                         F   loors are one of the largest surface area elements
                                             in each room of your home, and your selection of a
                                         flooring surface is a high-impact decorating decision.
                                         If you’re considering a new decorative finish for your
                                         existing floors or installing new flooring, consider both
                                         the decorative appeal and the durability of any finish
                                         you choose. Floors that are not sealed or maintained
                                         properly will reveal wear more quickly than other
                                         design elements; conversely, some of the most durable
                                         floor surfaces will outlive their design statement and
                                         will become a force to be dealt with in updated or
                                         remodeled homes.
                                              Regardless of the technique you choose, prepare
                                         your existing floor surface completely before beginning
                                         and be bold in your design choices. Use your floors as
                                         an outlet for your creativity—the color or design you
                                         choose can set the tone for any room in your home, so
                                         be confident and get ready to transform your space.

                                         In this chapter:
                                         • Resilient Tile                    • Wood Floors
                                         • Glass Mosaic Tile                 • Custom Floor Mats
                                         • Carpet Squares                    • Sheet Vinyl
                                         • Concrete Floors                   • Stencils

                                                                                                                ■ 237

   236-259_11989.indd 237                                                                                      5/22/09 4:03:36 PM

ects 236 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:237

         Resilient Tile

         R    esilient tile comes in thousands of colors and
              styles and is a dynamic flooring choice for
         kitchens, hallways, and other high-traffic areas.
         Because tiles are inlayed with a pattern, you can
         create a design with the tiles that will have a large
         impact on your overall decor. One way to create a
         design is the quarter-turn method in which each tile is
         placed so its pattern grain runs perpendicular to that
         of adjacent tiles. Or combine complementary tiles in
         different patterns and styles into a pleasing design.
               As with any tile installation, resilient tile requires
         carefully positioned layout lines. Before committing to
         any layout and applying tile with adhesive, conduct a dry
         run to identify potential problems. Also, keep in mind
         the difference between reference lines and layout lines.
         Reference lines mark the center of the room and divide
         it into quadrants. If the tiles don’t lay out symmetrically
         along these lines, you’ll need to adjust them slightly,
         creating layout lines. Once layout lines are established,
         installing the tile is a fairly quick process. Be sure to keep
         joints between the tiles tight and lay the tiles square.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Tape measure               Heat gun
               Chalk line                 Resilient tile
                                                                          Resilient tiles have a pattern layer that is bonded to a vinyl
               Framing square             Flooring adhesive               base and coated with a transparent wear layer. Some come
               Utility knife                 (for dry-back tile)          with adhesive preapplied and covered by a paper backing,
               1
                ⁄16" notched trowel                                       others have dry backs and are designed to be set into
                                                                          flooring adhesive.

               Tips for Laying Out Your Tile ▸
                                                                                          Check for noticeable directional
                                                                                          features, like the grain of the vinyl
                                                                                          particles, to help determine your layout.
                                                                                          Set the tiles in a running pattern, placing
                                                                                          them so the directional grain runs in the
                                                                                          same direction (left), or in a checkerboard
                                                                                          pattern using the quarter-turn method
                                                                                          (right). Always plan the layout of the room
                                                                                          thoroughly before you begin.

  238 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

236-259_11989.indd 238 5/22/09 4:03:42 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:238

                ■ How to Make Reference Lines for Tile Installation
                   1                                                              2

                                                                                                                                                y

                                                  x

                                                                                                                                            x

                Position a reference line (X) by measuring along opposite       Measure and mark the centerpoint of the chalk line.
                sides of the room and marking the center of each side. Snap a   From this point, use a framing square to establish a second
                chalk line between these marks.                                 reference line perpendicular to the first one. Snap the second
                                                                                line (Y) across the room.

                   3                                                              4

                                                                                                                 5'
                                                                                                                                  4'
                                                          y                                    3'

                      x

                Check the reference lines for squareness using the 3-4-5        Measure the distance between the marks. If the
                triangle method. Measure along reference line X and make a      reference lines are perpendicular, the distance will measure
                mark 3 ft. from the centerpoint. Measure from the centerpoint   exactly 5 ft. If not, adjust the reference lines until they’re
                along reference line Y and make a mark at 4 ft.                 exactly perpendicular to each other.

                                                                                                                                                Flooring ■ 239

   236-259_11989.indd 239                                                                                                                               5/22/09 4:03:52 PM

ects 238 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:239

         ■ How to Install Dry-back Resilient Tile
            1                                                                      2

         Snap perpendicular reference lines with a chalk line. Dry-fit           If you shift the tile layout, create a new line that is parallel
         tiles along layout line Y so a joint falls along reference line X. If   to reference line X and runs through a tile joint near line X. The
         necessary, shift the layout to make the layout symmetrical or           new line, X1, is the line you’ll use when installing the tile. Use a
         to reduce the number of tiles that need to be cut.                      different colored chalk to distinguish between lines.

            3                                                                      4

                                                                                                          y

                                                                                                              y1

                                                                                                         x

                                                                                         x1

         Dry-fit tiles along the new line, X1. If necessary, adjust the          If you adjusted the layout along X1, measure and make a
         layout line as in steps 1 and 2.                                        new layout line Y1 that’s parallel to reference line Y and runs
                                                                                 through a tile joint. Y1 will form the second layout line you’ll
                                                                                 use during installation.

  240 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

236-259_11989.indd 240 5/22/09 4:03:59 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:240

                   5                                                                 6

                Apply adhesive around the intersection of the layout lines         Spread adhesive over most of the installation area, covering
                using a trowel with 1⁄16" V-shaped notches. Hold the trowel at a   three quadrants. Allow the adhesive to set according to the
                45° angle and spread adhesive evenly over the surface.             manufacturer’s instructions, then begin to install the tile at the
                                                                                   intersection of the layout lines. You can kneel on installed tiles
                                                                                   to lay additional tiles.

                   7                                                                 8

                                                                                                                                             B

                                                                                                                          A

                When the first three quadrants are completely tiled,               To cut tiles to fit along the walls, place the tile to be cut
                spread adhesive over the remaining quadrant, then finish           (A) face up on top of the last full tile you installed. Position a
                setting the tile.                                                  1
                                                                                    ⁄8"-thick spacer against the wall, then set a marker tile (B) on
                                                                                   top of the tile to be cut. Trace along the edge of the marker tile
                                                                                   to draw a cutting line.

                                                                                                                                                 (continued)

                                                                                                                                                 Flooring ■ 241

   236-259_11989.indd 241                                                                                                                                  5/22/09 4:30:28 PM

ects 240 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:241

               Tool Tip ▸                                                  9

               To mark tiles for cutting around outside corners,
               make a cardboard template to match the space,
               keeping a 1⁄8" gap along the walls. After cutting         Cut the tile to fit using a utility knife and straightedge. Hold
               the template, check to make sure it fits. Place the       the straightedge securely against the cutting line to ensure a
               template on a tile and trace its outline.                 straight cut. Option: You can use a ceramic-tile cutter to make
                                                                         straight cuts in thick vinyl tiles (see inset).

            10                                                             11

         Install cut tiles next to the walls. If you’re precutting all   Continue installing the tile in the remaining quadrants until
         tiles before installing them, measure the distance between      the room is completely covered. Check the entire floor. If you
         the walls and install tiles at various points in case the       find loose areas, press down on the tiles to bond them to the
         distance changes.                                               underlayment. Install metal threshold bars at room borders,
                                                                         where the new floor joins another floor covering.

  242 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

236-259_11989.indd 242 5/22/09 4:30:40 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:242

                ■ How to Install Self-adhesive Resilient Tile
                   1                                                                    2

                Once your reference lines are established, peel off the               Begin installing tiles in the interior area of the quadrant.
                paper backing and install the first tile in one of the corners        Keep the joints tight between tiles..
                formed by the intersecting layout lines. Lay three or more tiles
                along each layout lines in the quadrant. Rub the entire surface
                of each tile to bond the adhesive to the floor underlayment.

                   3                                                                    4

                Finish setting full tiles in the first quadrant, then set the full    Continue installing the tile in the remaining quadrants until
                tiles in an adjacent quadrant. Set the tiles along the layout lines   the room is completely covered. Check the entire floor. If you
                first, then fill in the interior tiles.                               find loose areas, press down on the tiles to bond them to the
                                                                                      underlayment. Install metal threshold bars at room borders,
                                                                                      where the new floor joins another floor covering.

                                                                                                                                                   Flooring ■ 243

   236-259_11989.indd 243                                                                                                                                    5/22/09 4:30:57 PM

ects 242 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:243

         Glass Mosaic Tile

         M     osaic tile is an excellent choice for smaller
               areas and is available in many different colors
         to accent or blend with your décor. Variations in
         color and texture are likely when working with tile,
         so always buy all tile for one project from the same
         lot and batch to ensure a good match. Also, mortar or
         mastic intended for ceramic tile may not work with
         glass mosaic tile—check with your salesperson to
         determine what product will best suit your project.
              Sheets of mosaic tile are held together by a fabric
         mesh backing. This makes them more difficult to hold,
         place, and move. They may not be square with your
         guidelines when you first lay them down. Mosaic tiles
         also require more temporary spacers and much more
         grout, so calculate the materials you’ll need carefully
         before beginning this project.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Carpenter’s square         Notched trowel
               Chalk line                 Recommended
               Cleaning supplies             adhesive
               Coarse sponge              Rubber mallet
               Craft/utility knife        Sanded grout
               Grout sealer               Scrap lumber
                                                                           Mosaic tiles come in sheets (usually 12 × 12") and can
               Marking pen                Straightedge                     be made from ceramic, porcelain, glass, or any number of
                 or pencil                Tile nippers                     designer materials. Normally installed for their appearance,
               Measuring tape             Tile spacers                     mosaics are relatively high maintenance and prone to cracks
                                                                           because of all of the grout lines.

         ■ How to Install Mosaic Tile
            1                                                                2

         Clean and prepare the area and then draw reference lines          Select a sheet of mosaic tile. Place several plastic spacers
         (see page 239). Beginning at the center intersection, apply the   within the grid so that the sheet remains square. Pick up the
         recommended adhesive to one quadrant. Spread it outward           sheet of tiles by diagonally opposite corners. This will help you
         evenly with a notched trowel. Lay down only as much adhesive      hold the edges up so that you don’t trap empty space in the
         as you can cover in 10 to 15 minutes.                             middle of the sheet.

  244 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

236-259_11989.indd 244 5/22/09 4:31:6 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:244

                   3                                                                 4

                Gently press one corner into place on the adhesive. Slowly         When you have placed two or three sheets, lay a scrap
                lower the opposite corner, making sure the sides remain            piece of flat lumber across the tops and tap the wood with a
                square with your reference lines. Massage the sheet into the       rubber mallet to set the fabric mesh in the adhesive and to
                adhesive, being careful not to press too hard or twist the sheet   force out any trapped air.
                out of position. Insert a few spacers in the outside edges of
                the sheet you have just placed. This will help keep the grout
                lines consistent.

                   5                                                                 6

                At the outer edges of your work area, you will probably            After the adhesive has cured, usually 24 to 48 hours, apply
                need to trim one or more rows from the last sheet. If the space    grout. With many more spaces, mosaic tile will require more
                left at the edge is more than the width of a regular grout line,   grout than usual. Follow the manufacturer’s instructions for
                use tile nippers to trim the last row that will fit. Save these    spreading and floating the grout. Wipe a damp grout sponge
                leftover tiles for repairs.                                        diagonally over about 2 sq. ft. of the floor at a time and rinse
                                                                                   the sponge between wipes. Wipe each area only once, to avoid
                                                                                   pulling grout out of the joints. Allow to dry for 4 hours, then
                                                                                   buff with a soft cloth.

                                                                                                                                                Flooring ■ 245

   236-259_11989.indd 245                                                                                                                                 5/22/09 4:31:26 PM

ects 244 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:245

         Carpet Squares

         M     ost carpeting has a single design and is stretched
               from wall to wall. It covers more square feet of
         American homes than any other material. But if you
                                                                           clean, level, dry underlayment or existing floor. If the
                                                                           surface underneath is waxed or varnished, check with
                                                                           the manufacturer before you use any adhesives on it.
         want a soft floor covering that gives you more options,
         carpet squares are an excellent choice.
              Manufacturers have found ways to create                           Tools & Materials ▸
         attractive new carpet using recycled fibers. This not
         only reuses material that would otherwise become                       Adhesive                        Flat-edged trowel
         landfill, it reduces waste in manufacturing as well.                   Aviator’s snips                 Marking pen
         So, instead of adding to problems of resource                          Carpenter’s square                 or pencil
         consumption and pollution, carpet squares made from                    Chalk line                      Measuring tape
         recycled materials help reduce them.                                   Cleaning supplies               Notched trowel
              The squares are attached to each other and to the                 Craft/utility knife             Straightedge
         floor with adhesive dots. They can be installed on most

         Carpet tiles combine the warmth and comfort of carpet with do-it-yourself installation, custom designs, and easy replacement.
         They can be laid wall-to-wall or in an area rug style, as shown above.

  246 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

236-259_11989.indd 246 5/22/09 4:31:47 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:246

                ■ How to Install Carpet Squares
                   1                                                                      2

                Take the squares out of the package. Be sure the room is                Check the requirements for the recommended adhesive.
                well ventilated. Carpet squares should be at room temperature           You can install carpet squares over many other flooring
                for at least 12 hours before you lay them down.                         materials, including hardwood, laminates, and resilient
                                                                                        sheets or tiles. The carpet squares shown here are fastened
                                                                                        with adhesive dots, so almost any existing floor provides a
                                                                                        usable surface.

                   3                                                                      4

                Make sure the existing floor is clean, smooth, stable,                  Snap chalk lines between diagonally opposite corners to find
                and dry. Use floor leveler if necessary to eliminate any hills or       the center point for the room. In rooms with unusual shapes,
                valleys. If any part of the floor is loose, secure it to the subfloor   determine the visual center and mark it. Next, snap chalk lines
                or underlayment before you install the carpet squares. Vacuum           across the center and perpendicular to the walls. This set of
                the surface and wipe it with a damp cloth.                              guidelines will show you where to start.

                                                                                                                                                    (continued)

                                                                                                                                                     Flooring ■ 247

   236-259_11989.indd 247                                                                                                                                       5/22/09 4:32:4 PM

ects 246 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:247

            5                                                                 6

         Lay a base row of carpet squares on each side of the               Check the backs of the squares before you apply any
         two guidelines. When you reach the walls, make note of how         adhesive. They should indicate a direction using arrows
         much you will need to cut. You should have the same amount         or other marks so that the finished pile has a consistent
         to cut on each side. If not, adjust the center point and realign   appearance. If you plan to mix colors, this is the time to
         the squares.                                                       establish your pattern.

            7                                                                 8

         Fasten the base rows in place using the manufacturer’s             When you reach a wall, flip the last square over. Push it
         recommended adhesive. This installation calls for two adhesive     against the wall until it is snug. If you are planning a continuous
         dots per square. As you place each square, make sure it            pattern, align the arrows with the existing squares. If you are
         is aligned with the guidelines and fits tightly against the        creating a parquet pattern, turn the new square 90° before
         next square.                                                       marking it.

  248 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

236-259_11989.indd 248 5/22/09 4:32:16 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:248

                   9                                                              10

                Mark notches or draw a line across the back where the           At a door jamb, place a square face up where it will go. Lean
                new square overlaps the next-to-last one. Using a sharp         the square against the jamb and mark the point where they
                carpet knife, a carpenter’s square, and a tough work surface,   meet. Move the square to find the other cutline, and mark
                cut along this line. The cut square should fit neatly in the    that as well. Flip the square over, mark the two lines using a
                remaining space.                                                carpenter’s square, and cut out the corner.

                   11                                                             12

                Finish all four base rows before you fill in the rest of        Work outward from the center so that you have a known
                the room. As you work, check the alignment of each row. If      reference for keeping rows straight. Save the cut pieces from
                you notice a row going out of line, find the point where the    the ends. They may be useful for patching odd spaces around
                direction changed, then remove squares back to that point and   doorways, heat registers, radiator pipes, and when you reach
                start again.                                                    the corners.

                                                                                                                                             Flooring ■ 249

   236-259_11989.indd 249                                                                                                                              5/22/09 4:32:28 PM

ects 248 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:249

         Concrete Floors

         C    oncrete is a versatile building material. Most
              people are accustomed to thinking of concrete
         primarily as a utilitarian substance, but it can also
                                                                                    in your dining room, it should be sealed. Concrete
                                                                                    is a hard and durable building material, but it is also
                                                                                    porous. Consequently, concrete floors are susceptible
         mimic a variety of flooring types and be a colorful and                    to staining. Many stains can be removed with the
         beautiful addition to any room.                                            proper cleaner, but sealing and painting prevents oil,
              Whether your concrete floor is a practical surface                    grease, and other stains from penetrating the surface
         for the garage or an artistic statement of personal style                  in the first place, thus cleanup is a whole lot easier.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Acid-tolerant pump sprayer               Acid-tolerant bucket            Paintbrush                        High-pressure washer
               Rubber boots                             Sealant                         Extension pole                    Wet vacuum
               Alkaline-base neutralizer                Garden hose                     Respirator                        Rubber gloves
               Acid etcher                              Broom                           Paint roller and tray

                                                                                                           Although concrete is most common in
                                                                                                           garages and basements, it is not limited
                                                                                                           to these parts of the house, especially
                                                                                                           in contemporary design. Pair concrete
                                                                                                           floors with elegant furnishings for modern
                                                                                                           industrial sophistication.

               Acid Etching Safety ▸
              WARNING: Risk of serious injury. Always read manufacturer’s instructions.
                           Acid etching is the process used to open the pores in concrete surfaces, allowing sealers to bond with it. All
              smooth or dense concrete surfaces should be etched before applying stain or sealant. An etched surface should feel gritty
              and be easily penetrated by water. A variety of acid-etching products are available, including citric acid, sulfamic acid,
              phosphoric acid, and muriatic acid.
                      All of these acids are dangerous, so use caution while handling them. It is critical that your room is well ventilated, and
              that you wear protective clothing, including long sleeves and pants, rubber boots and gloves, a respirator, and safety goggles.
                      Also, never add water to acid—only add acid to water.

  250 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

236-259_C51729.indd 250 6/10/09 3:28:53 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51729) #175 Dtp:119 Page:250

                ■ How to Seal a Concrete Floor
                   1                                              2                                              3

                Clean and prepare the surface                  Saturate the surface with clean                Add the acid etching contents to
                by first sweeping up all debris. Next,         water—the surface must be wet before           the water in the acid-tolerant pump
                remove all surface muck: mud, wax, and         acid etching. Check for any areas              sprayer. Follow the directions (and
                grease. Finally, remove existing paints        where water beads up; this indicates           mixing proportions) specified by the
                or coatings.                                   that contaminants still need to be             manufacturer. Use extreme caution
                                                               cleaned off. Test your acid-tolerant           when using these materials.
                                                               pump sprayer with water to make sure
                                                               it releases a wide, even mist. Check
                                                               the manufacturer’s instructions for
                                                               the etching solution and fill the pump
                                                               sprayer with the recommended amount
                                                               of water.

                   4                                                                   5

                Apply the acid solution. Using the acid-tolerant pump spray          Use a stiff-bristle broom or scrubber to work the acid
                unit, evenly apply the diluted acid solution over the concrete       solution into the concrete. Let the acid sit for 5 to 10 minutes,
                floor. Do not allow the acid solution to dry at any time during      or as indicated by the manufacturer’s directions. A mild
                the etching and cleaning process. Etch small areas at a time,        foaming action indicates that the product is working. If no
                10 × 10 ft. or smaller. If there is a slope, begin on the low side   bubbling or fizzing occurs, it means there is still grease, oil, or
                of the slope and work upward.                                        a concrete treatment on the surface that is interfering with the
                                                                                     etching product.
                                                                                                                                                  (continued)

                                                                                                                                                   Flooring ■ 251

   236-259_C51729.indd 251                                                                                                                                    6/10/09 3:29:1 PM

ects 250 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51729) #175 Dtp:119 Page:251

            6                                                                 7

         Once the fizzing has stopped, the acid has finished                Use a garden hose with a pressure nozzle or, ideally, a
         reacting with the alkaline concrete surface and has formed pH-     pressure washer in conjunction with a stiff-bristle broom to
         neutral salts. Neutralize any remaining acid with an alkaline-     thoroughly rinse the concrete surface. Rinse two to three
         base solution. Put a gallon of water in a 5-gallon bucket and      times. Reapply the acid and repeat steps 4, 5, 6, and 7.
         then stir in an alkaline-base neutralizer. Using a stiff-bristle
         broom, make sure the concrete surface is completely covered
         with the solution. Continue to sweep until the fizzing stops.

            8                                                                 9

         If you have any leftover acid you can make it safe for your        Use a wet vacuum to clean up the mess. Check your local
         septic system by mixing more alkaline solution in the 5-gallon     disposal regulations for proper disposal of the neutralized
         bucket and carefully pouring the acid from the spray unit into     spent acid, which may be hazardous to local vegetation or
         the bucket until all of the fizzing stops.                         your drainage system. Check for residue by rubbing a dark
                                                                            cloth over a small area of concrete. If white residue appears
                                                                            (inset), continue the rinsing process.

  252 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

236-259_11989.indd 252 5/22/09 4:37:38 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:252

                   10                                                                    11

                Let the concrete dry for at least 24 hours and sweep up                Create a testing patch with painter’s tape and apply sealer
                dust, dirt, and particles leftover from the etching process. Mix       to this area to ensure desired appearance. Add an antiskid
                the sealer in a bucket with a stir stick.                              additive to aid with traction, especially on stairs.

                   12                                                                    13

                Use wide painter’s tape to protect walls, and then using               Use a long-handled paint roller with at least a 1⁄2" nap to
                a good-quality 4"-wide synthetic bristle paintbrush, coat the          apply an even coat. Work in small sections at a time (about
                perimeter with sealer.                                                 2 × 3 ft.) and work in one orientation. Always maintain a wet
                                                                                       edge to avoid lap marks and do not rework partially dry areas.
                                                                                       Allow the surface to dry according to the manufacturer’s
                                                                                       instructions, usually 8 to 12 hours. Then apply a second coat in
                                                                                       the opposite direction to the first coat.

                      Tip for Painting a Concrete Floor ▸
                      If you decide to paint instead of apply clear or stained sealant, check to make sure that the paint is designed for use on
                      concrete floors. Also, once the paint has dried for a few days, apply two to three coats of water-based polyurethane.

                                                                                                                                                     Flooring ■ 253

   236-259_11989.indd 253                                                                                                                                      5/22/09 4:37:50 PM

ects 252 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:253

         Wood Floors

         I f your wood floors need a lot of work and your room
           is desperate for color, warmth, or a clean finish, then
         painting your floors may be the best decorating solution
                                                                                 Tools & Materials ▸
         for your space. Both formal and informal spaces can                     Paint scraper                    Primer
         benefit from this technique. Unify a space by extending                 Pole sander                      4" paintbrush
         a painted floor through a hallway to a staircase, or add                Medium- or fine-grit             Roller, extension
         a faux antique finish to edges to make a large room feel                   sandpaper                        pole, and tray
         cozy and inviting. Or lay out and paint a checkerboard                  Damp cloth                       Semigloss paint
         pattern, which will draw the eye around the room                        Lacquer thinner                  Polyurethane sealer
         quickly as well as disguise worn spots under darker paint               Hammer                           Painting pad
         colors. When purchasing supplies, always purchase                       Nail set                            and pole
         paints and sealers that are designed specifically for                   Painter’s tape                   Tack cloth
         floors to improve the durability of your finish.

         Rev up a worn-out floor with a bright paint color. Paint can not only disguise flaws, but it can also add warmth and character to
         a room.

  254 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

236-259_11989.indd 254 5/22/09 4:38:1 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:254

                ■ How to Paint Wood Floors
                   1                                         2                                                 3

                Use a paint scraper to smooth rough        When finished sanding, sweep or                  Protect the baseboards with wide
                spots. Use a pole sander to sand with      vacuum. Use a damp cloth to remove               painter’s tape. Press the tape edges
                the grain of the wood. For coarse wood,    fine dust. Use a cloth dampened with             down so paint doesn’t seep underneath.
                use medium-grit sandpaper. Scuff glossy    lacquer thinner for a final cleaning. If
                hardwoods with fine sandpaper (#120)       you see any nails sticking up, tap them
                for good adhesion.                         down with a hammer and nail set.

                   4                                         5                                                 6

                Mix primer well. Use a 4"-wide             Cut in with a 4" brush, then paint               When the paint is dry, apply two or
                brush to apply the primer around the       the rest of the floor using a roller on an       three coats of a matte-finish, water-based
                perimeter of the room. Then paint the      extension pole. Always roll from a dry           polyurethane sealer, using a painting pad
                remaining floor with a roller on an        area to a wet area to minimize lap lines.        on a pole. Allow the sealer to dry. Sand
                extension pole. Allow the primer to dry.   Wait to dry, then apply a second coat.           with a pole sander, using fine sandpaper.
                                                                                                            Clean up the dust with a tack cloth.

                                                                                                                                                 Flooring ■ 255

   236-259_11989.indd 255                                                                                                                                   5/22/09 4:38:4 PM

ects 254 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:255

         Custom Floor Mats

         P    ainting a stenciled design onto your indoor/
              outdoor floor mats is a quick project that adds
         instant custom detail to your home. Showcase your
                                                                               Tools & Materials ▸
         family monogram, stencil a pattern or image, or share                 Rug                             Nonheat-sensitive
         a friendly message with visitors. Add fun and creativity,             Stencil                           full-bodied
         sophistication, or unify a décor scheme with a painted                Ruler                             fabric paint
         motif found elsewhere in the room.                                    Triangle
              To complete this project effectively, select a
                                                                               3
                                                                                ⁄4" medium stiff
         nonheat-sensitive fabric paint (nonheat-sensitive paint                   stencil paintbrush
         does not require heat to set). Explore your craft store               Green tape (will
         for a fuller-bodied paint as opposed to a paint that is                   stick to hard-to-
         very thin. Full-bodied paint will bond to the rug fibers,                 stick surfaces)
         resulting in a lasting design. Apply this technique to
         jute, cotton, or sisal rugs. Always make a mock-up of
         your design to check placement, measurements and
         spacing to spare any surprises once you get started.

         Add a traditional monogram to indoor/outdoor floor mats – or stencil a creative overall design, image or message.

  256 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

236-259_11989.indd 256 5/22/09 4:38:19 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:256

                ■ How to Stencil a Floor Mat
                   1                                                                  2

                Make a mock-up of your design and position it on the                Begin to apply the design one stencil piece at a time. Use
                mat. Set a level line beneath your stencil with green tape. Use     green tape to hold the stencil in place along your guidelines
                a triangle to set a side line, creating a 90° angle where your      and softly pounce the paint on with the stencil brush, starting
                design will begin. If your design will cover the entire mat, skip   in the center and off-loading a bit before moving to the edges.
                this step.                                                          Stencil in all the pieces of your design, one stencil at a time.

                   3                                                                     Stencil Selection ▸
                                                                                         A wide variety of stencils—letters, numbers, and
                                                                                         images—are available at your local craft store. If you’re
                                                                                         a new stenciler, select stencils that are fairly simple,
                                                                                         without many small spaces or intricate details. If you will
                                                                                         be using a stencil with intricate detail, select a stencil
                                                                                         brush in a size that will accommodate your project. For
                                                                                         a truly one-of-a-kind piece, make your own design on
                                                                                         your home computer, print on heavy cardstock and cut
                                                                                         out your stencil with a sharp razor knife.

                Inspect your design, then reposition stencils to add detail or
                correct forms, if necessary. Allow paint to fully dry before use.

                                                                                                                                                  Flooring ■ 257

   236-259_11989.indd 257                                                                                                                                   5/22/09 4:38:31 PM

ects 256 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:257

         Sheet Vinyl

         I f your sheet vinyl flooring is outdated, replacing
           it isn’t your only option. Paint selected areas of
         the floor with updated colors to freshen up the look
         of your room and add detail to a tired, dated floor.
         Remember, always strip off any wax buildup and dirt
         before applying paint.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               1" artist acrylic         White semigloss
                  paintbrush                latex paint
               White latex               Black semigloss
                  bonding primer            latex paint
               Darkly tinted latex       Semigloss latex floor
                  bonding primer            polyurethane                 Paint selected squares of a floor to update the
                                                                         entire surface.

         ■ How to Paint Sheet Vinyl
             1                                                             2

         Prime selected squares with the appropriately tinted primer.    After the primer dries, apply the semigloss paint over the
         The embossing on the linoleum will not be straight—so simply    tinted primer, white over white and black over black. When dry,
         hold the brush flat to the surface and follow the edge around   coat the painted squares with polyurethane primer to seal and
         the squares.                                                    protect your work.

  258 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

236-259_11989.indd 258 5/22/09 4:38:51 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:258

                Floor Stencils

                A    beautiful way to dress up a large slab of cement
                     flooring or other flat surface is with an overall
                stenciled pattern. For the best effect, choose a design
                that is airy and appealing underfoot. Always use the
                same side and directional orientation throughout your
                application, especially with complex stencils like the
                one shown. If you are stenciling over raw cement,
                always seal your floor before adding decorative
                painting (page xx).

                      Tools & Materials ▸
                      Chalk line                    4" foam roller brush
                      Triangle                      Latex enamel
                      Spray adhesive or                floor paint
                         painter’s tape             Hair dryer
                      Large floor stencil                                        A stenciled pattern can transform a dull surface into a
                                                                                 masterful design statement.

                ■ How to Stencil a Floor
                   1                                                               2

                Use chalk lines, snapped from the room’s corners, to             Apply paint to the stencil with the roller, working from
                determine the center of the room. Use a triangle to make         the center out. Force the paint dry with a hair dryer, then
                a square off the center point. Align your first stencil within   reposition your stencil and repeat. For best results, apply a
                this square and affix to the floor with spray adhesive or        clear topcoat when finished. Be careful with the fresh stencil
                painter’s tape.                                                  for the first week, until the paint cures completely.

                                                                                                                                              Flooring ■ 259

   236-259_11989.indd 259                                                                                                                                5/22/09 4:39:4 PM

ects 258 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:259

260-325_C51711.indd 260 6/3/09 1:40:35 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:260

                                          Slipcovers
                                          & Upholstery
                                          U    pholstery projects can be very rewarding; consider
                                               the creative satisfaction of returning a tattered
                                          castoff to its like-new state, or transforming an
                                          extremely well-loved chair to the beauty of its better
                                          years. Similarly, slipcovers can make the old new
                                          again, with careful measurements and a few simple
                                          sewing techniques.
                                               Whether you’re merely adding seat covers to dress
                                          up your dining room or reupholstering an entire garage
                                          sale sofa complete with welting and new cushions, the
                                          projects in this chapter will challenge and inspire you.
                                          Start to imagine your furniture dressed in updated
                                          prints, colorful stripes, or classic florals—and get
                                          started on one of these creative projects, suitable for
                                          all skill and experience levels.

                                          In this chapter:
                                          • Upholstery Basics                 • Re-upholstering a Chair
                                          • Stripping Furniture               • Upholstered Ottoman
                                          • Repairing a Frame                 • Upholstered Headboard
                                          • New Cushions                      • Reversible Seat Covers
                                          • Button-tufted Cushions            • Ottoman Slipcover
                                          • Re-upholstering a                 • Chair Slipcover
                                            Drop-in Seat                      • Futon Slipcover

                                                                                                                 ■ 261

   260-325_C51711.indd 261                                                                                       6/3/09 1:40:48 PM

ects 260 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:261

         Upholstery Basics
                                                                                                            A

         C   ompleting a high-quality upholstery project will
             require a few specialized tools and fabrics. Before
         beginning your first project, familiarize yourself with
                                                                                                                            B

         the materials you’ll need to be successful. If you can,
         speak with a salesperson at an upholstery supply store
         or an experienced upholsterer in your area about your
         project’s specific needs.                                 C

         ■ Stripping                                                                                    D

           & Upholstering Tools
              Tack and Staple Removers (A)
              Small screwdriver (B): Can be used for
         removing staples during the stripping process.
              Upholsterer’s Tack Hammer (C): Has one
         magnetized tip to hold a tack, leaving your other hand
         free to hold fabric.
              Electric Staple Gun (D): Choose a model that
         will accommodate both 3⁄8" and 1⁄2" staples.
              Webbing Stretcher (E): Pulls webbing taut with
         one hand while tacking or stapling with the other.
              Mallet (F): Chose rubber or rawhide for                                                     F

         best results.                                                 E
              Stretching Pliers (G): Made for webbing and
         leather, these can also be used to grasp and stretch
         fabric for stapling.
              Upholstery Regulators (H): One end of these
         8" or 10" metal skewers is used for pleating or forcing           G

         padding into tight corners. The other is used to                                                                                 H
         make holes in fabric by gently separating yarns in the
         weave, which can be closed by coaxing them back
         into position.


                                                                   I
             Measuring, Marking                                                J
             & Cutting Tools
                                                                                                                                L

              Yardstick (I)                                                                       K
              Cloth Tape Measure (J)
              Dustless Chalk Sticks (K): Used for marking
         cutting lines on fabric and tailoring patterns. If you
         already have a fabric-marking pencil or marker, this
         will work as well.
              Cutting Mat & Rotary Cutter (L)
                                                                                                                                M
              Heavy-duty Shears (M)

  262 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_C51711.indd 262 6/3/09 1:45:27 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:262

                ■ Pins & Needles                                                                                    C
                    Curved Needles (A): Used for blind-stitching
                fabric where stapling or tacking are not possible.                           B
                Round-point curved needles are used for fabrics, while
                wedge-point needles are used for leather or vinyl.
                    Button Needles (B): Available in a variety of
                lengths from 6 to 18", these are used to secure buttons                            A
                and stitch through padding.
                    Upholstery Pins (C): Hold fabric in place
                temporarily before tacking or sewing.

                ■ Nails, Tacks, Staples & Zippers
                     Webbing Nails (A): Narrow, with sharp points,            Tack Strip (E): 1⁄2" cardboard stripping used to
                these nails can hold webbing securely without             maintain a straight, sharp line between upholstered
                damaging the frame.                                       fabric pieces.
                     Upholstery Tacks (B): The most commonly used             Tacking Strip (F): Tacks are spaced evenly for
                sizes are #3 and #6. Most upholstery tacks will be sold   securing fabric panels invisibly when tacking is not possible.
                in sterile packaging, as many upholsterers hold them          Flexible Metal Tacking Strip (G): For curved areas.
                in the mouth while working.                                   Metal-toothed Heavy-duty Zipper (H): Length
                     Staples (C)                                          determined by cushion size.
                     Decorative Tacks (D): Available in many sizes,           Nylon-toothed Heavy-duty Zipper Tape (I):
                designs, and finishes to complement fabric and            Can be cut to size and fitted with a zipper pull.
                furniture style.                                              Extra zipper pulls (J)

                                                                                 H

                                         I

                             J

                                                                                               G
                                                                             F

                                                                                                             E

                                             A

                                                                                 D

                                                              C

                                             B

                                                                                                                        Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 263

   260-325_C51711.indd 263                                                                                                                        6/3/09 1:45:49 PM

ects 262 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:263

         ■ Foundation Fabrics
              Cambric (A): Black fabric used to cover the
         bottom of a furniture piece as a dustcover, and to                                               A
                                                                                              B
         finish the piece.
              Burlap (B): Used as a covering over springs or
         webbing to form a support base.
                                                                                                      C
              Denim (C): Strong, thin fabric used to cover the
         deck area of a chair.
              Synthetic Webbing (D): Stronger than jute
         webbing, synthetic webbing will not rot over time due
         to moisture.
              Jute Webbing (E): Used when working
         with antiques to maintain the authenticity of
         the piece.
              Edge Roll (F): Long, firmly stuffed tube used
                                                                                                  D       E
         to cushion a wood or wire edge, keep padding from
                                                                     G                    H
         shifting, and reduce wear on fabric.

         ■ Threads, Twines & Cords
                                                                                              F

             Polyester Thread (G): Strong and thin, used for
                                                                                          I
         machine sewing.                                                                                                             J
             Nylon Thread (H): Fits the eyes of curved
         needles, used for hand sewing.
             Nylon Button Twine (I): Used to fasten buttons,
         hand-stitch edge rolls and nosing seams, and secure
         springs to webbing and burlap.
                                                                                                      K
             Spring Twine (J): Used for tying springs.
             Welt Cording (K)

         ■ Sewing Machine Equipment
             16/100 Needle (A): For lightweight to medium-
         weight fabrics.
             18/110 Needle (B): For heavyweight fabrics.
                                                                             D                F
             Leather/Vinyl Needles (C): Specially designed                                                                    H
         with a wedge-shaped point.                              B
             Welting or Piping Foot (D): Designed to
         accommodate welting and trim up to ¼" thick.
             Zipper Foot (E)
             General Purpose Foot (F)                                                         E
                                                                                                              G
             Straight-stitch Foot (G)                                    A         C

             Walking Foot (H): Prevents layers from shifting
         when sewing unwelted seams upon difficult fabrics,
         such as velvet or satin.

  264 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_C51711.indd 264 6/3/09 1:47:58 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:264

                ■ Padding Materials
                     Foam (A): Used for seat cushions, foam is available
                in many thicknesses and degrees of firmness. Cut foam                                   B
                with an electric foam saw knife or electric kitchen knife.
                Thin foam (less than 1" thick) can be cut with shears.
                     Spray Foam Adhesive (B): Used to secure foam
                to webbing or batting.
                     Bonded Polyester Batting (C)                                                                                       F
                     Cotton Batting (D): Available in different grades
                                                                                                                                       E
                of purity, cotton batting is often torn to size rather                                A
                than cut.                                                                                                       D
                     Deck Pad (E): Stiff padding material, suitable for
                areas that require minimal foundation padding, such
                                                                                                                         C
                as chair decks or thinly padded chair backs or arms.
                     Rubberized Hair (F): Used when a thicker or
                fuller appearance is required.

                ■ Upholstery Fabric Considerations
                     Color and Texture: Carefully select a color and         the pattern or design is railroaded, meaning that the
                pattern that will coordinate with or complement your         pattern runs the lengthwise grain horizontally on the
                existing décor.                                              piece rather than vertically.
                     Fiber Content: Consider the durability, color                Surface Treatment: Most upholstery fabrics
                brilliance, ease of stitching and manipulation, and          are treated with a stain-resistant or crease-resistant
                stability of a fabric’s fibers.                              finish, which greatly increases the durability of
                     Weave Structure: Some fabrics are woven so              the fabric.

                                                                                                                         Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 265

   260-325_C51711.indd 265                                                                                                                          6/3/09 1:48:14 PM

ects 264 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:265

         ■ Measuring & Calculating Fabric
         Before beginning to strip a piece, take careful
         measurements of every section of your project. This
         will help determine how much upholstery fabric to                                               B

         purchase and help you plan your cutting layout. Note                                A
         the measurement of each piece (length times width),
                                                                                                                                                 F
         then add the necessary allowances. Remember that
         the total length of many pieces must include several                                                        E
                                                                                                                                                 G
         inches of fabric that cannot be seen before stripping.
         Include the approximate amount of hidden fabric in                                              J
                                                                                                                                             K
         your measurements as well. Most pieces will be cut                  I
         out as rectangles and trimmed to shape as they are                                                                                  L
                                                                                      H
         attached, so measure each piece at its longest and
                                                                                                                 N                           M
         widest points.
              Last, measure the total length of all welting. Use
         the chart below to help you calculate the amount of
         fabric you’ll need to purchase. Your measurement
         chart may differ, and may include pieces not listed
         on the example chart, such as a skirt, arm boxing, or
         back boxing.

                                                                                                                         D
                                                                                                     C

               Sample Measurement Chart ▸
                      Piece                       Actual Size                    Allowances                                  Cut Size
                                                  (includes hidden fabric)       1
                                                                                   ⁄ 2" seam, 2" pulling

               A      Inside Back (IB)            36 × 32"                       + 4 × 4"                                    = 40 × 36"
               B      Inside Wing (IW)            17 × 9"                        + 4 × 4"                                    = 21 × 13"
               C      Outside Back (OB)           30 × 23"                       + 4 × 4"                                    = 34 × 27"
               D      Outside Wing (OW)           15 × 7"                        + 4 × 4"                                    = 19 × 11"
               E      Inside Arm (IA)             27 × 27"                       + 4 × 4"                                    = 31" × 31"
               F      Front Arm Band (FAB)        18 × 8"                        + 4 × 2½"                                   = 22 × 10½"
               G      Arm Panel (AP)              15½ × 4"                       + 4 × 4"                                    = 19½ × 8"
               H      Outside Arm (OA)            14 × 26"                       + 4 × 4"                                    = 18 × 30"
               I      Welting (W)                 250 × 15⁄8"                    + 16" (for seaming and waste)               = 266 × 15⁄8"
               J      Cushion (C)*                22 × 19"                                                                   = 22 × 19"
               K      Cushion Boxing (CB)*        4 × 63"                                                                    = 4 × 63"
               L      Deck (under cushion)**
               M      Nosing (N)                  6 × 21"                        + 1 × 4"                                    = 7 × 25"
               N      Front Band (FB)             5½ × 21"                       + 2½ × 4"                                   = 8 × 25"

         *The cut size of cushion pieces and cushion boxing are determined after tailoring a pattern for the cushion (page 272).
         **Deck will be covered with other fabrics. Do not include these measurements to calculate amount of
         upholstery fabric needed.

  266 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_C51711.indd 266 6/3/09 1:49:13 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:266

                ■ Cutting Fabric
                Use measurements from the chart to diagram a                               Cut the end of the fabric squarely, either by
                layout of all the pieces on graph paper, as in the                    following a thread in the weave, using a carpenter’s
                examples below. The amount of fabric needed can                       square, or aligning a straightedge to the pattern
                be determined from this diagram. If your fabric has                   repeat markings on the selvages. Transfer the diagram
                a large pattern, plan to center the large motifs on the               to the right side of the fabric, marking the cutting
                exposed areas of prominent pieces, such as cushion                    lines with chalk and measuring from the squared
                tops and bottoms, inside and outside backs, and                       end. Label the wrong side of every piece with its
                inside and outside arms. You will need to purchase                    location as it is cut. It’s also a good idea to draw
                considerably more fabric to lay out your pieces                       a chalk line near the lower edge to indicate the
                this way.                                                             downward direction.

                                                                                                                                         AP             AP
                       CB                                                                OW
                                                                                                        C                C            FAB           FAB
                                          t                                                                                                                      N
                      ZB             el                                                  OW
                                 W
                                                                            IW
                 CB
                                                                                                                                              IB
                                                                                               IA                   IA
                                                                                                                                                             FB
                                               OA        OA            OB
                      ZB
                            IW                                                                        Lengthwise direction of pieces

                Sample Layout (fabric with no pattern, or small pattern). Most upholstery fabrics are 54" wide. Because the pieces are cut as
                rectangles, this layout is suitable for fabric with or without a nap.

                                                                                       AP                                           CB
                                                                                 AP                                                                ZB
                                                                                      Cont.
                      OW    OW                  OA                OA                                                                               ZB

                                                                                                                                                             direction of pieces
                                                                                          FAB FAB           IW               IW

                                                                                                                                                                Lengthwise
                                                                                 AP
                              W

                                                     C        C                         IA                                                    IB
                                 el

                                                                                                      IA                 OB
                                                                                       Cont.
                                     t

                                                                            IA

                                          FB                  N

                Layout for Railroaded Fabric. If the fabric can be railroaded, lay out the pieces so that their length runs on the crosswise grain.
                This is often a more efficient layout.

                                                                                                                                     Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 267

   260-325_11989.indd 267                                                                                                                                             5/22/09 7:26:58 PM

ects 266 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:267

         Stripping Furniture

         R    emoving the old cover from a furniture piece is
              an educational experience—in fact, the detailed
         notes you take during this process will become your
                                                                      1. Remove the skirt, dustcover, and any welting
                                                                         around the lower edge.
                                                                      2. Remove the outside back, outside arms, and
         re-upholstery instructions. Before you begin, sketch or         outside wings.
         photograph any unique details you would like to recreate     3. Loosen the inside back, inside arms, and inside
         in the new cover, such as the pleating arrangement on           wings, leaving them staple-basted in position to
         an arm front or a series of tucks at a nosing corner, and       keep the padding in place.
         make a note of any areas that will need more padding.        4. Remove the deck and nosing.
              Before you remove any pieces, label each fabric
         piece with its name and direction; after the pieces are          As each piece is loosened or removed, record
         removed, they will only be puzzling shapes, so good          the method used to attach it to adjoining pieces or to
         labeling is key to a successful project. Document the        the frame in your notes: machine sewn, hand sewn,
         seams and joints that have welting and measure the           stapled, or attached with a tacking strip. Set the pieces
         total amount of welting used after it has been removed.      aside for reference throughout the upholstery project.
              Loosen or remove pieces in the reverse order from           Strip the padding and foundation only as far as
         that in which they were attached to the frame. For           necessary. Check to see if the frame is sturdy, if the
         example, in reupholstering a wing chair, remove pieces       webbing and springs are secure, and if the padding
         in the following order:                                      needs to be replaced or replenished.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Camera          Tack hammer            Pencil and paper for note taking             Tack lifter or staple remover
               Pliers

                                                                                          Stripping upholstery is messy and
                                                                                          dusty; cover your work area with a tarp.
                                                                                          Discard used tacks, nails, staples, tack
                                                                                          strips, tacking strips, and any musty-
                                                                                          smelling foundation materials.

  268 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_C51711.indd 268 6/3/09 1:53:7 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:268

                ■ How to Remove Tacks, Nails & Staples
                   1                                                                2

                Hold the tack lifter or staple remover at a sharp angle,          Pry the tack, nail, or staple up from the wood.
                with the tip touching the wood at the edge of the tack nail, or
                staple. Strike the end of the handle with the side of the tack
                hammer, wedging the tip under the tack, nail, or staple.

                   3                                                                  Tip ▸
                                                                                      Avoid back strain and sore knees by standing the
                                                                                      project on a raised platform or padded sawhorses
                                                                                      during the stripping process. You can then do
                                                                                      the upholstery work while standing or sitting at a
                                                                                      comfortable height, without repeatedly bending over
                                                                                      or kneeling.

                Grasp the tack, nail, or staple with the pliers; roll the
                pliers in the direction of the wood grain, extracting the tack,
                nail, or staple. (Extracting against the wood grain damages
                and weakens the wood.) Remove all tacks, nails, and staples.
                Pound in any broken points that cannot be removed.

                                                                                                                               Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 269

   260-325_11989.indd 269                                                                                                                                 5/22/09 7:27:8 PM

ects 268 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:269

         Repairing a Frame

         B    efore you can beautify your old furniture with
              new upholstery, spend some time making sure
         your frame is structurally sound. After you remove the
         outer cover, check to see if there are any loose joints
         or cracked rails or posts. Minor repair work can be
         done with minimal carpentry skills. This is also a great
         time to completely refinish any exposed wood, if that
         is a part of your project. However, shallow scratches
         and general dullness can be corrected with a few
         simple techniques.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Touch-up markers           Screwdriver
               Wood polish and            Hot vinegar
                 cleaner with             File
                 lemon oil                Clamps
               Extra fine steel wool      Glue syringe
               Wood glue                  Chisel
               Wood screws                                               Repair minor scratches using touch-up markers in the same
                                                                         color as the stained and finished woodwork.

               Frame Maintenance ▸

               Clean a dull finish by applying wood polish and cleaner   Tighten loose corner blocks by first applying wood
               and gently rubbing with extra-fine steel wool.            glue and then inserting wood screws.

  270 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 270 5/22/09 7:27:16 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:270

                ■ How to Repair Loose Joints
                   1                                                       2

                Scrape away the old glue. To open the joint, apply hot   Apply an ample amount of wood glue to the joint. Close the
                vinegar to the old glue to soften.                       joint; clamp or tie (as shown here) tightly. Allow to dry, following
                                                                         the glue manufacturer’s directions.

                ■ How to Repair a Cracked Rail or Post
                   1                                                       2

                Inject wood glue into the crack, using a glue syringe.   Clamp the rail or post securely. Allow to dry, following the
                                                                         glue manufacturer’s directions.

                                                                                                                       Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 271

   260-325_11989.indd 271                                                                                                                        5/22/09 6:50:18 PM

ects 270 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:271

         New Cushions
                                                                                                                                   Knife-edge

         T   he three most common cushion styles are
             boxed, waterfall, and knife-edge, each of which
         offers a distinct decorative flair to a finished piece.
         All three styles can be fitted flush to the front of                                                                       Waterfall
         the chair or T-shaped, wrapping around the front
         of the chair arms. Boxed cushions are sturdy and
         classic, and can be sewn with or without welting at                                                                          Boxed
         the top and bottom seams. Knife-edge cushions fit
         nicely on older furniture and usually have a welted
         seam around the center seam, where the cushion
         is exposed; hidden sides are then constructed with              Chair and sofa cushions are generally constructed with a
         a boxing strip. Waterfall cushions are a beautiful              zipper closure around the back corners of the cushion, which
                                                                         makes it easy to remove covers for cleaning, if necessary.
         contemporary style, sewn with one continuous piece
         of fabric wrapping over the front from top to bottom.
         Waterfall cushions have a boxing strip around
         the sides and back and are usually constructed                       Tools & Materials ▸
         without welting.
              As a general rule, the finished width of the boxing             Muslin                             Electric knife
         strip should be ¾" narrower than the height of the                   Upholstery fabric                  Marker
         foam. Many waterfall cushions, however, are made                     Welt cording and fabric            Polyester batting
         with narrower boxing strips. The fabric wraps over the               Upholstery zipper or                  and spray foam
         sides from the top and bottom and forms small pleats                   continuous zipper                   adhesive, or
         around the curved front of the boxing strip. To copy                   tape and pull                       button needle
         this type of cushion cover, it is best to make a pattern             Foam                                  and heavy thread
         from the original cushion.

         ■ How to Tailor a Pattern for a Boxed Cushion
            1                                        2                                              3

         Measure the seat opening in both          Mark an outline of the cushion,               Remove the muslin and draw a ½"
         directions at the widest point and add    holding a sharpened stick of chalk            seam allowance outside the marked
         2" to each measurement. Cut muslin        perpendicular to the deck and following       line; cut out the pattern. Fold the pattern
         to this size and mark a centerline        the shape of the inside arms and back         in half on the centerline, checking to see
         from front to back. Center muslin         of the chair. The chalk should brush          that the pattern is symmetrical. If edges
         over the chair deck, turning excess       against but not push into the chair           are off by less than 1", trim uneven
         muslin up along the arms and back.        padding. Mark the cushion front along         edges and unfold the pattern (inset). If
         For a T-cushion, clip muslin around the   the crown of the nosing.                      edges are off by more than 1", adjust the
         curves, allowing it to lie flat.                                                        chair padding and draw a new pattern.

  272 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 272 5/22/09 6:50:32 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:272

                      Boxed Cushion Cover Cutting Guide ▸
                                                  Length                                                                  Width

                      Top/Bottom Pattern (2)      See pattern                                                             See pattern.
                      Fabric Strips for Welting   Cushion Circumference × 2 + 8 to 10"                                    Cording circumference × 2 + 1"
                      Boxing Strip                Front + sides of cushion. Add 1" for each seam, if necessary            Cushion foam + ¼" or width of original strip + 1"
                      Zipper Tape & Pull          Back cushion measurement + 8"
                      Zipper Closure Strips (2)   Length of zipper tape                                                   Boxing strip width ÷ 2 + ¾"

                ■ How to Sew a Boxed Cushion Cover
                                                                                                                          Prepare welting and sew around the
                   1                                                                                                      outer edges of the cushion top and
                                                                                                                          bottom pieces.

                                                                                                                          Press under a ¾" seam allowance on
                   2                                                                                                      one long edge of the zipper strip. Position
                                                                                                                          the pressed edge along the center of the
                                                                                                                          zipper teeth, right sides up. Use a zipper
                                                                                                                          foot to topstitch ¾" from the fold. Repeat
                                                                                                                          on the opposite side, making sure folds
                                                                                                                          meet at the center of the zipper. Attach a
                                                                                                                          pull to the tape if necessary.

                                                                                                                          Center the zipper strip over the back
                   3                                                                                                      of the cushion top and stitch, beginning
                                                                                                                          and ending on sides about 1½" beyond
                                                                                                                          the corners. Clip once into the zipper strip
                                                                                                                          seam allowance at each corner and pivot.

                                                                                                                                                                    (continued)

                                                                                                                                                   Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 273

   260-325_11989.indd 273                                                                                                                                                     5/22/09 6:50:50 PM

ects 272 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:273

            4                                                                    5

         Align the center of the boxing strip to the front center             Stitch boxing strip to cushion top 1⁄2" from the seam,
         of the cushion top, matching print, if necessary; pin-mark the       beginning at the side pin. Match the clip mark to the front
         pieces separately. Smooth strip to the right front corner; mark      corner and pivot stitching. Continue stitching the strip,
         with a 3⁄8" clip into the seam allowance. Smooth strip along         matching center marks. Clip once into the seam allowance at
         the right side of the cushion top and pin about 6" from the          the left front corner; pivot. Stop stitching about 6" from the
         back corner.                                                         back left corner.

            6                                            7                                                 8

         Cut the boxing strip 4" beyond the            Stitch together 2" from the end; pivot           Finger-press the seam allowance
         point where it overlaps the zipper pull       at the zipper tape. Stitch along the outer       toward the boxing strip; finish sewing
         end of the zipper strip. Pin the end of       edge of the zipper tape to within ½" of          the zipper strip and boxing strip to the
         the boxing strip to the end of the zipper     the end; pivot. Place a small scrap of           cushion top. A small pocket will form to
         strip, right sides together, matching all     fabric over the zipper teeth and stitch          hide the zipper pull when closed.
         cut edges.                                    slowly across the teeth to the opposite
                                                       side of the zipper tape; pivot. Stitch
                                                       along the opposite side of the zipper
                                                       tape until 1" from the end; pivot and
                                                       stitch to the edge.

  274 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 274 5/22/09 6:50:59 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:274

                   9                                            10                                                11

                Cut the opposite end of the boxing           Fold the boxing strip straight across             Pin the boxing strip to the cushion
                strip 1" beyond the point where it           at the corner; mark the opposite side             bottom, matching clip marks to the
                overlaps the end of the zipper strip. Pin    of the strip with a 3⁄8" clip into the seam       corners. Stitch. Turn right side out
                the ends together. Stitch ½" from the        allowance. Repeat for all corners, then           through the zipper opening.
                ends, placing a scrap of fabric over the     open the zipper partially.
                zipper teeth. Turn the seam allowance
                toward the boxing strip; finish sewing
                the zipper strip and boxing strip to the
                cushion top.

                ■ How to Tailor a Pattern for a Waterfall Cushion
                   1                                                                    2

                Measure the seat opening in both directions at the widest            Unfold and center one end over the chair deck, aligning
                points. Multiply the depth by 2 and add the cushion height.          the line to the crown of the nosing and turning excess muslin
                Add 4" to the depth and 2" to the width; cut muslin to this          up along the arms and back. For a T-cushion, clip muslin
                size. Mark a centerline through the entire length. Fold fabric       around the curves, allowing it to lie flat. Follow steps 2 to 3
                in half, perpendicular to the centerline; crease. Draw a line        on page 272. Fold under the uncut end of the pattern along
                across the muslin a distance above the fold equal to half the        the crease; cut the lower layer to match the cutting line of the
                cushion height.                                                      upper layer. Mark the lower layer even with the nosing line
                                                                                     (inset); unfold.

                                                                                                                                    Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 275

   260-325_11989.indd 275                                                                                                                                     5/22/09 6:51:11 PM

ects 274 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:275

               Waterfall Cushion Cover Cutting Guide ▸
                                                          Length                                       Width

               Tom/Bottom Piece                           See pattern                                  See pattern
               Side Boxing Strips (2)                     Side of cushion + 1"                         Cushion foam + ¼" or width of original strip + 1"
               Zipper Tape & Pull                         Back of cushion + 8"
               Zipper Closure Strips (2)                  Length of zipper tape                        Boxing strip width ÷ 2 + ¾"

         ■ How to Sew a Waterfall Cushion Cover
            1                                                                       2

         Follow steps 2 and 3 on page 273. Fold the zipper strip                  Mark the center of the front short end of each side of the
         straight across at the corner; mark the opposite edge with a             boxing strip; round the front corners slightly. Mark the outer
         3
          ⁄8" clip into the seam allowance. Repeat for opposite corner.           edges of the top/bottom cushion piece even with the crease
         Pin zipper strip to cushion bottom, matching clip marks to the           marking on the pattern. Staystitch 1⁄2" from the edge, a distance
         corners. Stitch length plus 11⁄2" beyond both corners.                   on either side of the marks equal to the cushion height.

            3                                                                       4

         Clip the seam allowances to staystitching every 1⁄2". Pin                Follow steps 6 through 9 on pages 274 to 275. Finish
         the side boxing strip to the cushion piece, right sides together,        sewing the boxing strip to the cushion bottom on both
         aligning the center marks. Check to see that the corresponding           sides. Turn the cushion cover right side out through the
         points on the top and bottom match up directly across from               zipper opening.
         each other on the boxing strip. Sew a ½" seam, beginning and
         ending 6" from the back corners. Repeat for opposite side.

  276 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_C51711.indd 276 6/3/09 1:53:43 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:276

                ■ How to Tailor a Pattern for a Knife-edge Cushion
                                                                                                        Follow steps 1 and 2 on page 272,
                   1                                                                                    adding the cushion height plus 2" to the
                                                                                                        seat measurements before cutting the
                                                                                                        muslin. Remove the muslin.

                                                                                                        Draw a line along the front of the
                   2                                                                                    cushion pattern a distance from the
                                                                                                        marked line equal to half the finished
                                                                                                        boxing height. For a T-cushion (shown),
                                                                                                        extend the line around the front corners
                                                                                                        to a point even with the line at the back of
                                                                                                        the T; connect the ends of the lines.

                                                                                                        Draw a ½" seam allowance outside
                   3                                                                                    the entire pattern and cut out. Fold the
                                                                                                        pattern in half on the centerline, checking
                                                                                                        for symmetry. Trim edges as in step 3 on
                                                                                                        page 272. Lay the pattern over the original
                                                                                                        cushion, aligning the pattern seam line to
                                                                                                        the midpoint of the cushion height; pin out
                                                                                                        corner tucks (inset). Mark tucks; unfold
                                                                                                        the pattern and transfer marks to the
                                                                                                        opposite corner.

                      Knife-edge Cushion Cover Cutting Guide ▸
                                                      Length                                           Width

                      Top/Bottom Pieces (2)           See pattern                                      See pattern
                      Fabric Strips for Welting       Equal to knife-edge section of cushion           Cording circumference × 2 + 1"
                      Side Boxing Strips (2)          Side of cushion                                  Cushion foam + ¼" or width of original strip + 1"
                      Zipper Tape & Pull              Back of cushion + 8"
                      Zipper Closure Strips (2)       Length of zipper tape                            Boxing strip width ÷ 2 + ¾"

                                                                                                                                 Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 277

   260-325_11989.indd 277                                                                                                                                  5/22/09 6:51:34 PM

ects 276 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:277

         ■ How to Sew a Knife-edge Cushion Cover
            1                                                                2

         Fold out the corner tucks on the cushion top and bottom;          Pin the cushion bottom to the cushion top along the welted
         baste. Sew the welting to the desired edges of the cushion top.   edge, matching the corner tucks. Stitch the seam, crowding
                                                                           the cording. Complete the cushion cover as for the waterfall
                                                                           cushion on page 276, steps 1 to 4.

         ■ How to Prepare & Insert the Cushion
            1                                                                2

         Trace the cutting line of the cushion cover onto the foam         Wrap the polyester batting over the foam from front to
         and cut using an electric knife. Follow the seam line of the      back. Trim the sides and back so that the cut edges overlap
         pattern for high-resiliency foam; follow the cutting line for     about 1" at the center.
         softer foam. Hold the knife blade perpendicular to the foam at
         all times.

  278 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 278 5/22/09 6:51:43 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:278

                   3                                                                4

                Apply spray foam adhesive to the cut edges of the batting         Trim excess batting vertically at the back corners. Fold
                at the back of the cushion; overlap the edges and press firmly    excess batting over the side seams at the front corners and
                to seal, forming a smooth seam. Or whipstitch the edges           apply adhesive. Press together firmly to seal or whipstitch
                together using a button needle and heavy thread. Repeat for       in place.
                the sides.

                   5                                                                6

                Fold the cushion in half from the front to back. Insert into      Turn the seam allowances toward the boxing strip all
                the cover opening, gradually working the cushion toward the       around the cushion. Zip closed, hiding the zipper pull in
                front of the cover. Stretch the cover to fit. Stand the cushion   the pocket.
                on one side and check to see that the cushion is inserted
                symmetrically, with equal fullness on both sides.

                                                                                                                               Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 279

   260-325_11989.indd 279                                                                                                                                5/22/09 6:51:52 PM

ects 278 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:279

         Button-tufted Cushions

         B    utton-tufted cushions can be custom shaped
              to fit chairs, benches, or window seats. They
         have inner cores of batting-wrapped foam and
         can be anchored to the furniture with fabric ties.
         Buttons keep the filling from shifting and accent the
         “stuffed” appearance of the cushion. Since tufted
         cushion covers are not usually removed, zippers
         or other closures are not necessary. Tightly woven
         decorator fabric with a stain-resistant finish, available
         in endless colors and designs, is a great choice for
         this project.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Fabric                     Button and
               1" polyurethane foam          carpet thread
               Polyester upholstery       Long needle
                  batting                    with large eye
               Thread                     Felt-tipped pen
               Buttons to cover                                      Button-tufted cushions can be a cheerful custom addition
                                                                     to chairs in the kitchen and dining room.

         ■ How to Sew a Button-tufted Cushion
            1                                                          2

         Make a paper pattern of the seat to be covered by the       Place the pattern on the right side of the decorator fabric
         cushion, rounding any sharp corners. Simplify the shape     and mark a cutting line 1" from the edge of the pattern. Cut the
         as much as you can. Cut out the pattern and check it for    cushion top out on the marked line, then cut the bottom out,
         symmetry and fit. Mark the placement of ties.               using the top as a pattern. Transfer any marks for ties from the
                                                                     pattern to the wrong side of the cushion front. Use the pattern
                                                                     to cut two pieces of polyester upholstery batting. Trace the
                                                                     pattern on foam using a felt-tipped pen; cut the foam ¼" inside
                                                                     the marked line.

  280 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 280 5/22/09 6:52:2 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:280

                   3                                                                    4

                Cut two 2½" × 16" fabric strips for each tie, following fabric       Stitch along the open edge of each tie. Leave both ends
                grainlines. Press under ¼" on the long edges of each strip, then     of the ties open. Tie a single knot at one end of each tie,
                press them in half lengthwise, wrong sides together, aligning        enclosing the raw edges in the knot.
                the pressed edges. Pin.

                      Velcro Ties ▸                             5                                                6

                      Cut fabric tabs just long
                      enough to go around the chair
                      post plus 1½" for overlap and
                      ½" for seams and twice the
                      finished width plus ½". Cut
                      Velcro tape 1½" long for each
                      tab. Press in ¼" on each edge,
                      then press in half lengthwise
                      and stitch all sides. Attach            Pin the unfinished ends of the ties to          Place the cushion top and bottom
                      Velcro to tabs (inset). Press in        the right side of the cushion front at the      right sides together, aligning the outer
                      half horizontally and attach            marked positions. Stitch the ties in place      edges; pin. Leave an opening for
                      folded end to cushions.                 3
                                                               ⁄8" from the edge, removing the pins as        inserting the cushion.
                                                              you come to them.
                                                                                                                                                  (continued)

                                                                                                                                   Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 281

   260-325_11989.indd 281                                                                                                                                    5/22/09 6:52:33 PM

ects 280 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:281

            7                                                            8

         Place the pieces under the presser foot and stitch ½" from    Press the seam flat. Turn back the top seam allowance and
         the edge. End the seam at the opposite side of the opening.   press. Press back 1⁄2" seam allowance on the cushion cover
         Clip the seam allowances at any curved areas.                 back in the open area. Reach through the opening to turn the
                                                                       cushion cover right side out.

            9                                                            10

         Press lightly, centering the seam around the outer edge.      Place the foam between the layers of upholstery batting.
         Make sure ties are sewn securely into the seam at the         Whipstitch the edges of the batting together, encasing
         correct positions.                                            the foam.

  282 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 282 5/22/09 6:52:44 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:282

                   11                                                                12

                Fold the cushion in half and insert it into the cushion            Mark the button placement on both sides of the cushion.
                cover. Unfold the foam, smoothing the fabric over the batting.     Buttons are usually equally spaced in all directions. Follow the
                Slipstitch the opening closed.                                     manufacturer’s directions for making covered buttons. You will
                                                                                   need two buttons for every tuft.

                   13                                           14                                             15

                Cut two or three 18" strands of              Insert the ends of the thread strands          Thread a second button onto one
                button and carpet thread; insert all the     through the eye of a long needle. Insert       group of threads. Tie a single knot, using
                strands through the button shank and         the needle through the cushion to the          both thread groups; pull the strands
                secure at the middle of the thread with      back side. Remove the strands from the         until the buttons are tight against the
                a double knot.                               needle and divide them into two groups.        cushion, creating an indentation. Wrap
                                                                                                            the thread two to three times around
                                                                                                            the button shank and tie a double knot.
                                                                                                            Trim the thread tails. Repeat steps
                                                                                                            13 to 15 for each tuft, keeping the
                                                                                                            indentations equal.

                                                                                                                                 Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 283

   260-325_11989.indd 283                                                                                                                                  5/22/09 6:52:52 PM

ects 282 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:283

         Reupholstering a Drop-in Seat

         R   eupholstering the seats on dining room or kitchen
             chairs is a great choice for a first-time upholstery
         project. The fabric change can give new life to older
         chairs or can help new chairs better coordinate with
         the room’s décor. Because the seats are easy to remove
         and reupholster, a set of four chairs can easily be
         completed in a day.
              Drop-in seats usually drop into a recess in the
         chair seat; some styles rest directly on the surface
         of the seat and may have welting attached around
         the lower edge. All styles are held in place by screws
         attached from the underside of the seat. Regardless
         of the style, if more than one chair in a set is
         being reupholstered, always return seats to their
         original chairs, assuring proper fit and alignment of
         screw holes.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Screwdriver             2 yd. cambric
                   and tack lifter        (optional)
                   or staple remover   Upholstery fabric
               1"-thick foam
               Foam adhesive
               3 yd. of 27"
                   polyester batting
                   (for four seats)
               Staple gun
                   and 3⁄8" staples
               5
                ⁄32" welt cording
                   (optional)                                                A set of four chairs like this can easily be reupholstered in
                                                                             a day.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                                  Length                                                     Width

               Upholstery Fabric                  Seat + 6"                                                  Seat + 6"
               Foam                               Seat + 1"                                                  Seat + 1"
               Batting                            Seat + 4"                                                  Seat + 4"
               Cambric                            Seat + 2"                                                  Seat + 2"
               Welting                            Circumference of seat + 3 to 5"                            1½"

  284 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_C51711.indd 284 6/3/09 1:54:15 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:284

                ■ How to Upholster a Drop-in Seat
                   1                                                                2

                Remove the screws on the underside of the seat; remove            Apply spray adhesive to one side of the foam; affix foam to
                the seat. Strip off the existing outer fabric using a staple      the top of the seat.
                remover or tack lifter. If the foundation is intact, omit steps
                2 and 3.

                   3                                                                4

                Place upholstery batting on the table; place the seat,            Mark the center of each side on the bottom of the seat.
                foam side down over the batting. Wrap the batting around the      Notch the center of each side of the fabric. Place the fabric
                top and sides of the seat. Trim excess batting even with the      on the table wrong side up. Center the seat upside down over
                bottom edge of the seat.                                          the fabric.

                                                                                                                                              (continued)

                                                                                                                               Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 285

   260-325_11989.indd 285                                                                                                                                5/22/09 6:53:35 PM

ects 284 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:285

            5                                                               6

         Staple the fabric to the bottom of the seat at the center        Apply staples to the back of the seat at 1½" intervals,
         back, matching the center marks. Stretch the fabric from the     working from the center toward the sides, to within 3" of the
         back to front; staple at the center front, matching the center   corners. Pull the fabric taut toward the front of the seat; staple.
         marks. Repeat at the center of each side.                        Repeat for the sides.

            7                                                               8

         Fold the fabric diagonally at the corner; stretch the fabric     Miter fabric at the corner by folding in each side up to the
         taut and staple between the screw hole and the corner. Trim      corner; staple in place. Repeat for the remaining corners. Trim
         excess fabric diagonally across the corner.                      excess fabric, exposing screw holes. If welting is not desired,
                                                                          omit step 9. If cambric is not desired, omit step 10.

  286 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 286 5/22/09 6:53:46 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:286

                   9                                                                    10

                Make and staple welting around the seat at ¾" intervals,              Fold under the raw edges of the cambric; staple to the
                starting at the back of the seat; align the stitching line of the     bottom of the seat at 1" intervals. Puncture cambric at the
                welting to the edge of the seat.                                      screw holes in the chair seat. Screw the upholstered seat to
                                                                                      the chair.

                      Reusing Padding Materials ▸
                      When reupholstering a piece of furniture that was originally    natural materials. When stripping older furniture, it is
                      padded with natural fiber materials, reuse the materials        common to discover padding materials such as curled
                      intact if the foundation is still in very good shape. Most of   hair, moss, tow, and straw. It is possible to reuse these
                      the time, however, it will be necessary to supplement or        materials, though supplementing them will require a
                      replace the padding with cotton or polyester batting.           considerable amount of time and expertise. Often, some
                             If you’d like to retain the authenticity of an antique   additional cotton batting is all that you’ll need to add to
                      piece, but the padding is in poor shape, reupholster with       restore the piece to its original shape and firmness.

                                                                                                      Inspect the original material and
                                                                                                      maintain as much of the original material
                                                                                                      as possible for authenticity, antique resale
                                                                                                      price, and greater sustainability. Make
                                                                                                      sure reused materials are dry and free of
                                                                                                      mold and bugs, though. If the material is
                                                                                                      suspect, replace it.

                                                                                                                                    Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 287

   260-325_C51711.indd 287                                                                                                                                     6/3/09 1:54:53 PM

ects 286 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:287

         Reupholstering a Chair

         R   eupholstering a chair to better match your room
             décor can make an old piece functional in a
         formal room again and can enable you to custom-
                                                                    corners of the arms and back but allowing the lines
                                                                    to remain fairly sharp. Many of the pieces for this
                                                                    chair are sewn together before they are attached to
         blend your furniture with your existing style choices.     the frame. Also, the top arms, front arms and front
         The instructions that follow are a general guide for       band are cut as one piece and sewn with welted
         upholstering a chair, but styles and designs vary          seams to the inside arms, outside arms, and nosing
         greatly from chair to chair. Always refer to the notes,    of the chair.
         sketches, and photos taken while stripping your chair           Begin your project by measuring all chair parts
         to help you reassemble it (see page 268).                  and recording their measurements (page 266). Then,
              This particular style of chair, called a Lawson-      determine the cut sizes of all the parts, diagram the
         style chair, is characterized by its boxed arms, boxed     fabric layout, and cut out the pieces. Strip the chair as
         and buttoned back, and simple lines. The padding           far as necessary. Check the frame for sturdiness and
         in this chair is fairly minimal, cushioning the            make any necessary repairs (page 270).

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Upholstery fabric      #18 nylon thread         Foam adhesive                       Button twine
               Welt cording           Burlap                   Staple gun and staples (3⁄8"        Buttons
               Polyester batting      Edge roll                   and 1⁄2")                        Button needle
               Webbing and            Deck pad                 Lining fabric (such as              Cardboard tack strip
                 webbing stretcher    Denim                       lightweight, inexpensive         Flexible metal tacking strip
               Spring twine           High-resiliency foam        upholstery fabric)               Cambric

            After                                                                           Before

                                                                                         Reupholstering a chair can be a
                                                                                         rewarding project, though it is labor and
                                                                                         time intensive. Plan carefully and take
                                                                                         detailed notes while stripping to ease the
                                                                                         re-upholstery process.

  288 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_C51711.indd 288 6/3/09 1:56:18 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:288

                      Furniture Frame Anatomy ▸
                      Learning the process of furniture upholstery will be
                      easier if you know the correct names of the frame parts.                                                   A

                      Familiarize yourself with the basic frame parts shown                                  B
                      here. Various chair styles have differently shaped frames,
                      but the basic structure will be consistent from piece
                                                                                                         C
                      to piece.                                                                                                              K

                      Frame Parts                                                               D
                      (A) top back rail
                                                                                         E
                      (B)   top wing rail                                                                                                        M
                      (C) front wing post                                                                               J
                      (D) top arm rail                                                          F
                                                                                                             H              I
                      (E)   front arm post
                      (F)   arm stretcher rail                                                                                           L

                      (G) front rail                                                                     G

                      (H) corner block
                      (I)   back rail
                      (J)   back stretcher rail
                      (K)   back stretcher post
                      (L)   side rail
                      (M) back leg post

                ■ How to Upholster a Chair
                   1                                 A                               2

                                                      B

                Stitch welting to the front and top edges of the outside           Lay the deck piece over the seat. Note: your piece will
                arm panel. Stitch boxing to the front and top of the outside       look more complete than the pictured piece, with nosing and
                arm, aligning the lower edge of the front boxing to the lower      arm pieces attached. Fold the nosing back, aligning the seam
                edge of the outside arm. Stitch welting to the remaining           line to the marked line on the deck, matching the center;
                edge of the boxing and front band. Mark seam allowances of         pin on each side of the center. Pull the seam allowance taut
                the boxing directly across from the top front corners of the       under the arm; staple to the top of the side rail. Repeat for the
                opposite arms (A). Clip the seam allowances at the upper           opposite side.
                corners of the band (B). Stitch the inside arm to the boxing,
                aligning the mark to the top front corner of the inside arm.
                Center nosing on the front band. Stitch nosing to the front
                band between clips, backstitching at the clips. Stitch the deck
                to the nosing, matching centers. Mark a placement line for the
                nosing seam on the spring cover; mark the center. Mark the
                center of the nosing seam allowance.
                                                                                                                                                     (continued)

                                                                                                                                 Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 289

   260-325_11989.indd 289                                                                                                                                     5/22/09 6:54:46 PM

ects 288 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:289

            3                                                                4

         Use a 6" curved needle and button twine to attach the             Pull the deck under the back. Insert extra batting between
         seam allowance and spring cover, securing both ends. Take         the deck pad and spring cover to fill in depressions. Pull the
         1" running stitches near the seam line; hook springs in the       deck to the back rail, matching centers. Staple to the top of
         stitches whenever possible.                                       the rail. Continue stapling the deck to the back rail for several
                                                                           inches on each side of the center.

            5                                                                6

         Cut a piece of deck pad ½" narrower than the space                Turn the arm cover inside out; position the front boxing
         between the nosing seam line and the edge roll. Stitch to the     in place over the arm front. Turn the arm cover right side out;
         spring cover in this position. Cover nosing with one layer of     smooth in place over the chair arm, turning the welted seam
         batting. Add a half layer of batting from the nosing seam to      allowances toward the inside and outside arm panels. Repeat
         the lower edge of the front rail. Replace webbing on the inside   for remaining arm. Then cut a straight Y-cut on the side edge
         arm, if necessary. Cover the inside arms with burlap and attach   of the nosing, parallel to the front edge, allowing fabric to
         the burlap to the outside arms, leaving unattached along the      fit around the front arm post; the front point of the Y-cut is
         lower edge and for a short distance at the lower front and        aligned to the nosing seam line.
         back. Supplement or replace arm padding as necessary.

  290 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 290 5/22/09 6:55:0 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:290

                   7                                                                      8

                                                                      B

                                      A                                                                                        A

                Pull the nosing down to the front and side, straddling the              Fold under the cut edge of the inside arm from the corner
                front arm post with the sides of the Y-cut (A and B). Pull taut;        of the nosing to the point of the cut (A); pull the lower edge of
                staple. Finish stapling the nosing and deck to the top of the           the inside arm under the arm stretcher rail.
                side rail. Repeat for the opposite side. Pull the front band taut;
                staple to the underside of the front rail for several inches at the
                center. Cut diagonally into the lower front edge of the inside
                arm, allowing the fabric to fit around the front arm post.

                   9                                              10                                                11
                                                                 B

                                                                                          A

                Cut a Y-cut in the boxing at the back           Pull the lower edge of the inside                Pull the outside arm taut, realigning
                top of the arm, allowing the fabric to          arm taut to the side rail (A), pulling the       the welting along the top of the arm.
                fit around the back post. Cut a second          welting along the upper arm slightly to          Staple the lower edge to the underside
                Y-cut on the back edge of the inside            the inside (B). Staple the lower edge of         of the side rail up to within several
                arm, allowing the fabric to fit around the      the inside arm to the top of the side rail.      inches of the back corner. Staple the
                back stretcher rail. Fold under the edges                                                        back edge to the outside of the back
                of the Y-cut on the boxing. Pull the                                                             post, leaving unattached several inches
                inside arm through to the back of the                                                            from the top and bottom. Finish stapling
                chair. Pull taut; staple to the inner side                                                       the front band to the underside of the
                of the back rail.                                                                                front rail.

                                                                                                                                                     (continued)

                                                                                                                                      Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 291

   260-325_11989.indd 291                                                                                                                                       5/22/09 6:55:48 PM

ects 290 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:291

            12                                                                 13

                           A
                                                            A

         Place the inside back piece over the existing inside back,          Stitch welting to the outer edge of the inside back, avoiding
         cutting shallow relief cuts (A) to fit around the arms; pin. Mark   any welting seams on the top of the back. Stitch the top back
         a seam line around the outer edge using chalk. Cut out the          boxing to the side back boxing pieces using ½" seams; press
         inside back ½" beyond the marked seam line.                         open. Pin boxing to the inside back, right sides together,
                                                                             matching boxing seams to the top corners. Stitch.

            14                                                                 15

                                                                                                        A
                                                                                                                          B

                                                                                                                 C

         Supplement or replace back padding as necessary, then               Cut a horizontal Y-cut in the side boxing, allowing the fabric
         place the back cover, inside out, over the padding. Turn the        to fit around the top arm rail and arm stretcher rail Pull taut,
         cover right side out, fitting the corners snugly: smooth in place   pulling boxing above the top cut to the outside of the back
         over the chair back, turning the welted seam allowances             post (A) and boxing between cuts to the inside of the back post
         toward the inside back. Pull taut; secure to the outside of the     (B); staple over the inside arm fabric (C). Cut the boxing along
         top back rail at the center.                                        welting seams at the lower edge of the inside back, allowing
                                                                             the fabric to straddle the back leg post.

  292 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 292 5/22/09 6:56:3 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:292

                   16                                                                   17

                                           B
                            A

                Pull the welting taut; staple to the top of the side rail (A).        Finish pulling and stapling boxing to the back of the back
                Pull the remaining lower edge taut; staple to the top of the          posts and top rail. Pull the top of the outside arm taut over the
                back rail (B).                                                        inside back; staple to the back of the back post. Finish stapling
                                                                                      the outside arms under the side rails.

                   18                                                                   19

                Pin-mark positions of buttons on the inside back. Cut                 Repeat step 18 for each button. Tighten all knots equally,
                button twine about 25" long for each button. Insert one               checking indentations of the buttons on the inside back.
                end of the twine through the button shank; then insert both           Secure knots with overhand knots. Pull twines taut to the top
                ends through the eye of the button needle. Insert the needle          rail and staple securely. Make any final adjustments necessary
                through the chair back at one pin mark. Pull twine through            in tautness of the outer fabric. Trim excess fabric in areas that
                until the button shank enters the fabric. Separate twines at the      have not yet been trimmed. Make the cushion (page 272).
                back of the chair, straddling a spring, if possible. Tie the twines
                around a wad of batting, using a slipknot.

                                                                                                                                                   (continued)

                                                                                                                                    Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 293

   260-325_11989.indd 293                                                                                                                                     5/22/09 6:56:15 PM

ects 292 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:293

            20                                                                  21

         Attach welting to the outer edges of the back sides and top,         Flip the fabric up over the back of the chair. Align the
         beginning and ending at the bottom of the back rail. Encase          cut edge of the fabric to the cut edge of the upper welting,
         cording at the ends (inset). Attach lining to the back, trimming     matching centers. Place a cardboard tack strip over the 1⁄2"
         even with the cut edge of the welting. Place the outside back        allowance, aligning the outer edge to the welting seam line.
         fabric over the outside back. Trim to size, allowing a 1⁄2" excess   Staple across the top.
         along the top, 1" along the sides and 11⁄2" along the bottom.

            22                                                                  23

         Cut a half layer of batting to fit between the seam lines of         Staple a metal tacking strip to the sides, aligning the outer
         the welting at the top and sides and even with the bottom of         edge of the tacking strip to the welting seam line. Begin at the
         the back rail. Staple baste at the top and side centers.             upper welting seam line; end at the bottom of the back rail,
                                                                              opening the strip as necessary for ease in stapling. Position the
                                                                              stapler so one leg of the staple goes through each hole in the
                                                                              tacking strip.

  294 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 294 5/22/09 6:56:27 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:294

                   24                                                                 25

                Close the tacking strip to about 30°. Wrap batting over the         Tuck the fabric into the tacking strip opening, using a
                edge of the strip to cushion the sharp edge. Pull down the          regulator. Push the tacking strip closed along both sides.
                outside back fabric; staple baste to the bottom of the back rail,   Hammer the tacking strip securely using a mallet or
                matching centers. Trim fabric to ½" along the sides.                tack hammer.

                   26                                                                 27

                Pull the lower edge taut; staple to the underside of the            Cut cambric 3" larger than the measurements of the bottom
                back rail. Attach the welting to the underside of the rails         of the chair between the outer edges of the rails. Fold under
                around the bottom of the chair, joining the ends (inset).           just shy of the outer edge; staple at the center front, back, and
                                                                                    sides. Fold the cambric back at the corner so the fold is even
                                                                                    with the inner corner of the leg. Cut diagonally from the corner
                                                                                    of the fabric to the fold. Repeat for each corner. Fold under
                                                                                    the cut edges so folds are tight against the sides and staple in
                                                                                    place. Continue stapling the front, back, and sides.

                                                                                                                                  Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 295

   260-325_11989.indd 295                                                                                                                                   5/22/09 6:56:40 PM

ects 294 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:295

         Upholstered Ottoman

         Y   ou may never have imagined building your own
             furniture—but it’s easier than you think! For your first
         piece, start with this sturdy tufted ottoman, which will add
                                                                           Construct a simple frame and upholster with your chosen
                                                                           fabric. Before you know it, you’ll have a handy, attractive
                                                                           ottoman at a fraction of the cost you would pay in a
         comfort and complementary colors to your living space.            store—and it’s 100 percent unique, handmade by you.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               1
                ⁄2"-thick plywood           Drill with 3⁄8" bit          Button needle                                 11⁄4 yd. 5⁄32"
               Saber saw                       and 1" spade bit          31⁄2" yd. polyester batting                       welt cording
               1 × 4 lumber, cut in         3" semifirm foam             Fourteen #22 covered buttons                  1 ⁄2 yd. burlap
                                                                                                                        1

                   eight 13" lengths        Electric knife               Nylon button twine                            2 yd. cardboard
               Wood glue                    Approximately                Staple gun and staples                            tack strip
               2" coarse-thread                21⁄2" yd. of                  (3⁄8" and 1⁄2")                           Cambric
                   sheetrock screws            upholstery fabric         Upholstery regulator                          Four chair glides

         An ottoman is a great addition to large rooms or comfortable living areas in your home.

  296 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 296 5/22/09 6:56:57 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:296

                      Fabric Cutting Guide ▸
                                                                  Length                                 Width

                      Polyester Batting                           27"                                    27"
                      Ottoman Top Piece                           45"                                    45"
                      Welting                                     82"                                    1½"
                      Band                                        17"                                    82" (piece as necessary)
                      Cambric                                     27"                                    27"

                ■ How to Make a Tufted Ottoman
                   1                                                                                                                4"

                                                   23 1⁄ 2"

                                                                                                                       15 1⁄ 2"

                From ½" plywood, cut two circles, each 23½" in diameter. On one piece, draw a circle 4" from the outer edge. Drill a hole large
                enough to fit the blade of the saber saw inside the inner circle. Use the saber saw to cut out the inner circle to make the ottoman
                bottom. Draw pencil lines across the second full circle (the top), dividing it into eight equal wedges. Transfer marks to the lower ring.

                   2                                                                     3

                Apply wood glue to the end of one 1 × 4 support. Center                Mark the positions of the tufts on the top of the frame.
                the support over one of the marked lines on the ottoman top,           The example displays a diamond pattern. Drill 3⁄8" holes at
                aligning the narrow edge to the outer edge of the circle. Secure       the marked points. Mark a 24" circle on the foam. Using an
                the support with two screws inserted through the top of the            electric knife with the blade held straight up and down, cut
                circle into the support. Repeat for the remaining supports, then       out the circle. Mark out the same button placement pattern on
                turn the top over and attach the bottom ring to the supports           the foam.
                in the same way. Make sure the supports are straight and
                centered on the marked lines.

                                                                                                                                                     (continued)

                                                                                                                                         Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 297

   260-325_11989.indd 297                                                                                                                                       5/22/09 6:57:6 PM

ects 296 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:297

            4                                                            5

         Using a 1" spade bit and a light touch, slowly drill holes    Place the fabric face up over the batting, aligning the
         straight down through the foam at the marks. Place the        centers and lines. Working on the most central horizontal line
         foam over the ottoman frame top, aligning the holes. Center   of holes, flip back the fabric and cut a small hole in the batting
         upholstery batting over the foam. On the wrong side, mark a   directly over the closest hole to the center. Insert a pin through
         chalk line across the center in both directions.              the fabric and batting at the location of the next hole closest
                                                                       to center to keep the layers from shifting. Turn the fabric back
                                                                       into position. With a finger, push the fabric down through the
                                                                       batting and into the foam hole to the wood. Wiggle a little slack
                                                                       into the fabric, drawing from the outer edge of the fabric while
                                                                       keeping the centerlines aligned.

            6                                                            7

         Thread 24" of nylon button twine through the shank of         On the underside of the ottoman top, staple the twines
         a button. Thread the ends through a button needle. Push the   three times as shown.
         needle through the fabric and through the hole in the wood.
         Pull the twines tight so the button rests against the wood.

  298 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 298 5/22/09 6:57:12 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:298

                   8                                                                9

                Cut a hole in the batting over the next hole closest to           Continue to the next row and apply buttons, working
                center. Push the fabric down into the hole as in step 5. Repeat   from the holes in the center out. Wiggle slack into each hole,
                steps 6 and 7. Continue on and complete the buttons in the        drawing fabric from the outside to prevent pulling the fabric
                line of holes closest to center.                                  too tightly. Apply all buttons in this manner.

                   10                                                               11

                Use a regulator to turn all the pleats between buttons in the     Smooth the fabric over the edge. Beginning at the center
                same direction. The pleats should open out just before they       front, pull the fabric down in a straight line and staple to the
                reach the buttons.                                                edge of the wood circle. Repeat on the opposite side, then on
                                                                                  each side of the horizontal axis. Staple around the ottoman,
                                                                                  pulling the pleats straight out to the sides, then easing in other
                                                                                  fabric fullness between pleats.

                                                                                                                                               (continued)

                                                                                                                                Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 299

   260-325_11989.indd 299                                                                                                                                 5/22/09 6:57:27 PM

ects 298 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:299

            12                                                                  13

         Trim off excess fabric only after you have checked to see            Prepare welting and wrap around the ottoman over the
         that pleat lines are straight and fullness is evenly distributed.    staples. Mark where the ends meet. Sew the welting into a
                                                                              circle. Slide the welting ring back onto the ottoman from the
                                                                              bottom to check the fit and remove. Stitch the welting to the
                                                                              upper edge of the band. Turn the band inside out and with the
                                                                              welting at the bottom pull it over the top of the ottoman until
                                                                              the welting rests just above the top of the wood. Staple in
                                                                              place using ½" staples.

            14                                                                  15

         Wrap burlap around the ottoman and staple in place along             Cut batting 15" × 80" and wrap around the ottoman with 1"
         the edges of the top and bottom circles. Staple the overlapping      extending above the tack strip. Staple the batting along the
         ends to the edge of a support. Place a cardboard tack strip          tack strip and along the lower edge.
         over the welting seam allowance with the upper edge even
         with the stitching line. Staple diagonally through the tack strip.

  300 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 300 5/22/09 6:57:44 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:300

                   16                                                                 17

                Turn the band down and stretch the fabric to the underside          Turn under the edge of cambric and staple to the
                of the ottoman. Staple in place using 3⁄8" staples. Staple at the   underside of the ottoman. Attach four glides to the underside
                four center marks first. Then, work out the excess fullness as      of the ottoman, evenly spaced and 1" from the edge.
                you finish stapling the rest of the band in place.

                      Button Tufting Designs ▸
                      The pattern shown on page 297
                      of this project is only one possible
                      layout for the button tufts on
                      a tufted cushion. Four buttons
                      are often laid out in a square,
                      sometimes with a button in the
                      center, in a five-point star, or
                      sometimes the only tuft is one
                      button in the center. Diagram your
                      button layout on graph paper
                      before you mark button placement
                      on the ottoman frame.

                                                                                                                                 Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 301

   260-325_C51711.indd 301                                                                                                                                  6/3/09 1:55:14 PM

ects 300 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:301

         Upholstered Headboard

         A     n upholstered headboard can help a bedroom
               space feel cozy and inviting, and adds color
         to blank walls. Padded with foam and batting, this
                                                                                              the smaller the bed, the shorter the headboard should
                                                                                              be. Lightly outline where you’d like the headboard
                                                                                              to rest on the wall before you determine your
         headboard also provides comfortable support for                                      final measurements.
         reading or watching television. Choose upholstery
         fabric to blend with the bedroom décor, or to nicely
         complement your comforter or duvet cover. To avoid
         having to piece the center padded section on large
         headboards, choose fabric that can be railroaded.
              This project can be custom fitted for any size bed.
         The headboard attaches to the bed frame, so measure
         the width of the frame and add 2" to allow room for
         drilling bolt holes. To determine the height, measure
         from the bottom of the attachment plate on the frame
         to the desired height above the mattress. The height
         of the headboard is completely up to you. Generally,

               Tools & Materials ▸
               1
                ⁄2"-thick plywood                    Welt cording
               Saw                                   Polyester batting
               Wood glue                             Upholstery fabric
               1" coarse-thread                      1
                                                      ⁄2"-wide cardboard
                   sheetrock screws                      tacking strip
               2"-thick firm foam                    3" curved needle
               Foam glue                                 and #18 nylon
               Staple gun and                            thread                               An upholstered headboard is comfortable to lean against
                   staples (3⁄8" and 1⁄2")           Bolts and nuts                           for reading or watching television in bed, and adds warmth
                                                                                              and softness to a bedroom.

               Fabric Cutting Guide ▸
                                                                          Length                                                     Width

               Central Headboard Foam                                     Headboard frame – length of headboard bottom cover – 2"    Headboard frame – 6"
               (cut to fit curve of headboard frame top)
               Central Headboard Piece                                    Central headboard foam + 3 to 4"                           Central headboard foam + 3 to 4"
               (cut to fit curve of headboard frame top)
               Welting                                                    Outer edge of headboard – 2 × the length of headboard      1½"
                                                                          bottom cover + 6 to 8"
               Border Strip (piece as necessary)                          1½ × welting                                               6½"
               Headboard Bottom Cover                                     Bed frame + box spring + mattress + 1"                     Headboard frame + 6 to 8"
               Headboard Back (cut to fit curve of headboard frame top)   Headboard frame + 1"                                       Headboard frame + 1"

  302 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_C51711.indd 302 6/3/09 1:57:16 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:302

                ■ How to Make an Upholstered Headboard
                   1                           42"
                                                                                      2

                    7"

                                                                            36"

                Cut a rectangle of ½" plywood in the desired width and              Glue, then screw the support pieces to the back of the
                height. Mark a point 7" down from the top corner on each side       headboard. Take care not to insert screws where you will need
                and draw a gentle curve from these points across the top of         to drill bolt holes to attach the headboard to the bed frame.
                the board. Check for symmetry and then saw on the marked            Measure the height of the bed frame, box spring, and mattress.
                line. Cut another rectangle of plywood 8" by the headboard          Mark a line across the front of the headboard at this distance
                width. Shape the upper edge to match the headboard curve.           from the bottom. Draw a line 3" from the edge along the sides
                Cut 3" support strips of plywood for the bottom, sides,             and top, beginning at the first marked line. This marks the
                and center.                                                         width of the gathered border.

                   3                                                                  4

                Cut a piece of foam to fit the center section of the upper          Pull the fabric evenly and staple it to the frame, starting
                headboard, glue it in place, and lay a half layer of batting over   in the centers and working out toward the corners. Trim off
                the foam. Staple it in place. Cut fabric several inches larger      the excess fabric. Measure the outer edge of the headboard,
                than the foam. Mark the center of each side. Mark the center        beginning and ending at the bottom of the padded section.
                of each side of the padded section of the headboard.                Prepare welting slightly longer than this measurement and cut
                                                                                    border strip according to cutting directions. Stitch the welting
                                                                                    to one edge of the border strip.
                                                                                                                                                 (continued)

                                                                                                                                  Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 303

   260-325_11989.indd 303                                                                                                                                   5/23/09 8:05:26 AM

ects 302 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:303

            5                                                             6

         Using 3⁄8" staples, staple the border strip to the headboard   Place the cardboard tack strip over the welting seam
         around the padded section with the welting seam 3" from the    allowance with the upper edge even with the stitching line.
         edge. Use a 3" strip of cardboard tack strip as a gauge.       Staple diagonally through the tack strip using 1⁄2" staples.

            7                                                             8

         Center 8" strips of batting long enough to cover the border    Wrap the border strip to the back of the headboard and
         on the tack strip and staple in place.                         staple it in place using 3⁄8" staples. Don’t pull the fabric too
                                                                        tightly. It should look full and padded. Staple frequently,
                                                                        distributing the fullness evenly.

  304 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 304 5/23/09 8:05:31 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:304

                   9                                                                10

                Mark the centers of the sides of the bottom headboard             Turn down the fabric, wrap it to the back of the headboard
                cover. Place the fabric face-down over the padded section.        and staple in place using 3⁄8" staples. This area is unpadded to
                Staple in place along the bottom of the padded section. Place     allow it to fit closely to the frame, box spring, and mattress.
                a cardboard tack strip over the edge, with the upper edge         Place the headboard back piece wrong side up over the lower
                aligned with the line drawn in step 2. Staple through the         edge and staple in place through the tack strip. Turn under the
                tack strip.                                                       sides even with the sides of the headboard.

                   11                                                                  Attaching the Headboard ▸
                                                                                       Hold the headboard to the head of the bed, aligning
                                                                                       the lower edge to the lower edge of the attachment
                                                                                       plates on the frame. Mark the placement of holes
                                                                                       for bolts. Punch holes in the fabric before drilling to
                                                                                       prevent catching and tearing the fabric. Secure the
                                                                                       headboard to the frame with bolts and nuts.

                                                                                Turn the fabric up, turn under the edges and pin in place.
                                                                                Blindstitch the outside of the headboard using a 3" curved needle
                                                                                and #18 nylon thread.

                                                                                                                                Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 305

   260-325_11989.indd 305                                                                                                                                 5/23/09 8:05:39 AM

ects 304 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:305

         Reversible Seat Covers

         M     aking your own seat covers is a quick way to
               dress up your kitchen or dining room chairs.
         Plus, these covers are made with two coordinating
                                                                              These covers are suitable for armless chairs with
                                                                         straight sides and fronts that are open between the
                                                                         back posts. Make the pattern before you buy fabric
         decorator fabrics so they can quickly be flipped                so you’ll know how much fabric you’ll need. If you’re
         over for an instant décor change. Darts sewn at the             making covers for two or more chairs, be sure to center
         front corners shape the covers to fit the chair seats           the printed motif on each seat cover. Sometimes it
         smoothly. The back corners are held in place with a             helps to bring the pattern with you to the store to
         button tab that wraps around the back of the chair leg.         make sure you buy enough fabric to do this.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Two coordinating           Four buttons for each cover,       ⁄2 yd. grosgrain ribbon 7⁄8" wide,
                                                                             1
                                                                                                                                  Muslin
                 decorator fabrics          7
                                             ⁄8 to 1" in diameter               in a color to match the fabrics

                                                                             Tip ▸
                                                                             Choose reversible dining chair seat cushions. In this
                                                                             way, it’s possible to enjoy two distinct looks—one for
                                                                             the dining room and one for the living room, or one
                                                                             for summer and one for winter—without requiring
                                                                             storage for the extra set of cushions.

         Reversible seat covers are a quick way to transform the
         look of your chairs and are as quick and easy to change as
         your placemats.

  306 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 306 5/23/09 8:05:44 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:306

                ■ How to Sew a Reversible Seat Cover
                   1                                               2                                               3

                Measure the chair seat side to                   Mark a dot at one front corner. Pinch          Mark dots at the back of the seat, at
                side and front to back. Add 10" in               the fabric together from the dot down,         the inside front corners of the back
                each direction. Cut muslin to this size          bringing the front to meet the side.           posts. (If your posts are round, mark
                to make a pattern. Press the muslin              Pin out excess fabric, inserting the           each dot at a point in line with the front
                pattern in half in both directions. Unfold.      pins parallel to the chair leg, forming        and side of the post.) Trace the outline
                Center the pattern on the chair seat,            a dart. Mark lines on both sides of the        of the chair seat on the pattern.
                allowing it to fall down over the front          dart from the dot down to the bottom.
                and sides. At the back, turn the pattern         Repeat on the other front corner.
                up along the posts. If necessary, tape
                the pattern in place.

                   4                                                                      5

                Remove the pattern from the chair; remove the pins. Draw               Place the pattern on the top fabric, aligning the front-to-
                lines 41⁄2" outside the traced seat lines. At the back corners,        back crease with the lengthwise grain and the side-to-side
                draw lines from the dots to the outer lines, forming squares.          crease with the crosswise grain. Position the pattern so that
                (These will be the stitching lines.) Mark pivot points (shown          the intersection of the creases is at the exact center of the
                in blue) on the stitching lines 1⁄2" from the outer edge. Draw         design motif, if you're using a large print. Cut out the seat
                cutting lines (shown in red) 1⁄2" outside the stitching lines at the   cover top. Transfer the pivot points and dart dots to the wrong
                legs and the front darts. Fold the pattern in half to make sure it     side of the fabric. Cut out the remaining seat cover tops using
                is symmetrical, and make any necessary corrections. Cut out            the first piece as a guide.
                the pattern on the outer lines.
                                                                                                                                                    (continued)

                                                                                                                                     Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 307

   260-325_11989.indd 307                                                                                                                                      5/23/09 8:05:50 AM

ects 306 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:307

            6                                                           7

         Place each top piece on the bottom fabric, right sides       Fold the dart on one front corner, right sides together,
         together. Pin near the outer edges. Cut out bottom pieces;   aligning the raw edges; pin. Stitch the dart. Repeat for the
         remove the pins.                                             remaining front corners on the top and bottom pieces.

            8                                                           9

         Press the seam allowances of the darts open.                 Place the top and bottom seat covers right sides together,
                                                                      aligning the raw edges; pin. Align the seams of the front darts.
                                                                      Stitch the layers together 1⁄2" from the edge all around, pivoting
                                                                      at the corners. Leave a 6" opening along one straight edge
                                                                      for turning.

  308 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 308 5/23/09 8:05:57 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:308

                   10                                                               11

                Trim the seam allowances diagonally at the outer corners.        Turn back the top seam allowances and press, applying
                Clip to, but not through, the stitches at the inner corners.     light pressure. In the area of the opening, turn back and press
                                                                                 the seam allowances ½" where they meet. Turn the cover right
                                                                                 side out through the opening. Gently push the pivot points out
                                                                                 to form perfect corners (use a pointed object, like a crochet
                                                                                 needle, to help if necessary). Push the seam out so that it is
                                                                                 centered all around the outer edge; press. Align the folded
                                                                                 edges of the opening and pin them closed.

                   12                                        13                                              14

                Edgestitch around the seat cover,          Mark placement lines for the four              Place the cover on the chair seat.
                stitching the opening closed; pivot at     buttonholes parallel to and 1" above           At the back of one chair leg, measure
                the corners.                               the lower side and back edges. Mark            the distance between buttonholes. Cut
                                                           lines that equal the diameter plus the         ribbon 4" longer than this measurement.
                                                           thickness of the buttons, with one end         Turn under 1" twice on each end of the
                                                           1" from the vertical edges. Attach a           ribbon; press. Stitch across the inner
                                                           buttonhole presser foot or buttonhole          folds, forming double-fold hems. Stitch
                                                           attachment. Stitch the buttonholes over        a button to the center of each hem.
                                                           the marked lines. Cut the buttonholes          Repeat for the other leg. Button the
                                                           open, using a buttonhole cutter or small,      chair seat cover in place.
                                                           sharp scissors.

                                                                                                                               Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 309

   260-325_C51711.indd 309                                                                                                                                6/3/09 1:57:44 PM

ects 308 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:309

         Ottoman Slipcover

         R   ectangular ottomans with attached cushions are
             often used with upholstered chairs and sofas.
         Their styling is so simple that they easily blend with
         various furniture styles, and their shape fits perfectly
         into a fitted slipcover.
              This slipcover features a tailored skirt with
         inverted box pleats at the corners and is suitable for
         an ottoman that has short legs or bun feet (with or
         without a skirt). A hidden lip of fabric that extends
         from the boxing strip under the skirt helps you pull
         the cover firmly in place and secure it to the existing
         upholstery. Twill-tape ties sewn to this lip are tied
         around the legs to keep the slipcover from sliding up.
         The skirt is lined for body and to avoid a noticeable
         hem around the bottom.

               Tools & Materials ▸
                                                                                   Making a slipcover for an ottoman is a quicker project
               Decorator fabric                                                    than reupholstery—with equally classy, polished results.
               Lining
               Welt cording
                                                                                   ■ How to Sew a Slipcover
               Fabric Cutting Guide ▸
                                                                                     1
                                     Length                    Width

               Top                   Ottoman top + 1"          Ottoman top + 1"

               Boxing Strip (2)      ½" Circumference + 1"     Width of existing
                                                               strip + 2"

               Skirt Pieces (4)      Lower seam of boxing strip Side of ottoman
                                     to the floor               top + 16"

               Lining Pieces (4)     Skirt piece - 2"          Skirt Piece width

               Welting               Circumference of       1½"
                                                                                   Make the welting and stitch to the outer edge of the slipcover
                                     ottoman × 2 + 8 to 10"
                                                                                   top, then sew the boxing strip pieces together in ½" seams.
                                                                                   Finish the lower edges with zigzag stitches or serging. Pin the
               Twill-Tape Ties (8)   18"                                           boxing strip to the slipcover top, matching the print on one side, if
                                                                                   necessary. Clip into the boxing strip seam allowance at the corners
                                                                                   to allow the fabric to spread. Stitch the boxing strip to the top.

  310 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_C51711.indd 310 6/3/09 1:58:1 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:310

                   2                                              3                                                4

                Mark a chalk line 1" from the lower            Pin the lower edges of the skirt and             Fold the lining and skirt, wrong
                edge of the boxing strip. Stitch the           lining right side together, matching             sides together, aligning the upper edges.
                welting to the boxing strip, aligning the      seams. Stitch ½" from the edges. Press           Press. Baste the upper edges together.
                raw edges of the welting to the line.          the seam allowances toward the lining.
                Mark the lower edge of the boxing
                strip at the corners, even with the pivot
                points of the stitching on the top edge.
                Then sew the skirt pieces together in
                a big circle using ½" seam allowances.
                Repeat for the lining pieces. Press seam
                allowances open.

                   5                                                                                               6

                At each seam at the upper edge of the skirt, place one pin 1" to the left of the seam,          Place the slipcover on the ottoman,
                one pin 7" to the right of the seam, and one pin 15" to the right of the seam. Fold             pulling on the boxing strip extension to
                each pleat, bringing the outer pin marks to the center pin mark; pin them in place. The         position it snugly in place. Tie the ties
                seams will be hidden in the folds of the pleats. Check the skirt for fit and adjust the         behind the ottoman legs. If the ties are
                pleats if necessary. Baste across the top of each pleat. Pin the upper edge of the skirt        impractical for your ottoman, secure
                over the welting at the lower edge of the boxing strip, right sides together, aligning the      with screw pins through the boxing strip
                raw edges and matching the marks on the boxing strip to the centers of the pleats.              extension into the upholstered sides of
                Stitch. Stitch the ties to the extension of the boxing strip, 2" from each corner.              the ottoman.

                                                                                                                                     Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 311

   260-325_11989.indd 311                                                                                                                                       5/23/09 8:07:9 AM

ects 310 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:311

         Chair Slipcover

         A    custom-fit slipcover is made to fit your chair to a
              T, and covers as beautifully and drapes as nicely
         as a complete reupholstery—without the mess of
         stripping. Slipcovers can be made from a single fabric
         or several coordinating fabrics. For added detail, add
         contrasting welting in the seams. Choose between a
         fully gathered or box-pleated skirt to best complement
         the rest of your furniture.
              Chairs with a concave back design may be
         difficult to slipcover and the cover may not fit well.
         For best results, a concave back should be wrapped or
         covered in a thick upholstery batting before you pin-fit
         your pattern. To help the slipcover stay in place, this
         technique adds a fabric strip pinned to the existing
         upholstery, hidden under the skirt, which keeps the
         cover from pulling out of place. Also, polyurethane
         foam pieces can be tucked along the sides of the deck
         to provide a tight fit. These same instructions can be
         used for sofas or loveseats as well.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Muslin                   Tacks or heavy-
               Decorator fabric            duty stapler
               Welt cording                and staples
               Upholstery batting       Zippers
               Polyurethane foam,          (one for chairs,
                  cut in 2" strips         two for sofas
               T-pins                      and love seats)

         ■ Making Patterns
             for Fitted Slipcovers
         The easiest way to make a slipcover pattern is by pin-
         fitting muslin on the chair you plan to cover. Before you
         start, look carefully at the chair and note the placement
         of all of the seams. Usually the seams in the slipcover
         will be in these same locations, but you may be able
         to add or eliminate some details if it will not affect the
         fit of the cover. For example, cover a waterfall cushion
         with a box cushion cover with welting (page 272). Or a
         chair with a pleated front arm can be slipcovered with       Make your slipcover with a fully gathered skirt (upper) or
         a separate flat front arm piece (page 322).                  box pleats (lower).

  312 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_C51711.indd 312 6/3/09 1:59:13 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:312

                      Pin-fitted Slipcover Pattern Cutting Guide* ▸
                      Cut pieces from muslin, then mark the center line on each piece, following the lengthwise grain.

                                               Length                                                                                               Width

                      Outside Back             Outside back length + 3 to 4"                                                                        Outside back width + 3 to 4"
                      Inside Back              Inside back length + 10" (allows for 6" at the lower edge to tuck into the deck and hold in place)   Inside back width + 15"
                      Outside Arm (2)          Outside arm length + 3"                                                                              Outside arm width + 3"
                      Inside Arm (2)           Deck to upper edge of outside arm + 9"                                                               Inside back to front + 9"
                      Arm Front (2) optional   Arm front length + 2 to 3"                                                                           Arm front length + 2 to 3"
                      Deck                     Front of chair to skirt seam + 9"                                                                    Width at deck front + 15"
                      Skirt                    Length of skirt + 1"                                                                                 Circumference + pleats
                      *Measure existing pieces between seam lines.

                ■ How to Pin-fit the Pattern
                   1                                                                                      2

                Remove cushions and pin outside back piece to the chair,                              Pin the outside back and inside back together along the top
                smoothing fabric. Mark seam lines.                                                    of the piece, matching center lines. Fold out excess fabric on
                                                                                                      the inside back piece at the upper corner, forming a dart. Pin
                                                                                                      muslin snugly, but do not pull tight.

                      Tip ▸
                      Zipper length should be 1 to 2" shorter than the length of the vertical seam at the side of the outside back. Additional
                      zippers will be needed for cushions.

                                                                                                                                                                             (continued)

                                                                                                                                                          Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 313

   260-325_11989.indd 313                                                                                                                                                             5/23/09 8:07:26 AM

ects 312 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:313

            3                                                              4

         Trim excess fabric on sides of the inside back to 2"; clip      Pin an outside arm piece in place with the grain line
         along the arms as necessary for a smooth curve. Push about      perpendicular to the floor and the lower edge extending ½"
         ½" of fabric into crevices on sides and lower edge of the       beyond the seam line at the upper edge of the skirt. Smooth
         inside back, and mark seam lines by pushing a pencil into       fabric upward; pin. Pin the outside arm to the outside back.
         the crevices.                                                   Mark the seam lines.

            5                                                              6

         Pin an inside arm piece in place, with 7" extending at          Pin the inside arm to the outside arm at front; clip and trim
         inside back and grain line straight across the arm, smoothing   fabric at the front lower edge as necessary for a smooth fit.
         fabric up and around the arm.                                   Pleat out fabric for the rolled arm to duplicate pleats in the
                                                                         existing fabric. Mark radiating fold lines of pleats.

  314 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 314 5/23/09 8:07:28 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:314

                   7                                                                8

                Mark tucks on the inside arm at the back of the chair to          Mark the inside arm and inside back with large dots halfway
                fold out excess fabric; clip the inside arm as necessary for a    up the arm. Push about ½" of fabric on the inside arm into
                smooth fit.                                                       crevices at the deck and back.

                      Variation: Pin-fitting an Arm with a Front Section ▸

                      After the inside arm piece has been placed (see             Pin the front arm piece in place. Fold out excess
                      step 5), mark seam line at front edge of the arm and trim   fabric on the inside arm as necessary to fit the front arm
                      away excess fabric not needed for seam allowances.          piece, making two pleats. Mark the seam line for the
                                                                                  curve of the arm, following existing seam line on the chair.
                                                                                  Complete the arm pattern as in steps 7 through 9.

                                                                                                                                               (continued)

                                                                                                                                Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 315

   260-325_11989.indd 315                                                                                                                                 5/23/09 8:07:32 AM

ects 314 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:315

            9                                                                 10

         Mark all seam lines on the muslin, smoothing fabric as             Mark a seam line on the front edge of the deck piece on the
         you go.                                                            straight grain, ½" from the raw edge. Pin the marked line to the
                                                                            welting of the skirt seam, with the center line centered on the
                                                                            skirt. Smooth muslin over the front edge and deck and match
                                                                            center lines of deck and inside back.

            11                                                                12

         Mark the deck and inside arm pieces with large dots at the         Pin the deck to the outside arm piece at the side of the chair;
         point where the deck meets the front of the inside arm. For        mark the seam line. Do not fit the deck snug. Push about ½" of
         furniture with a T-cushion, clip excess fabric to the dots. Fold   fabric into the crevices at the sides and back of the deck; mark
         out excess fabric on the deck at the front corner, forming a       seam lines by pushing a pencil into the crevices.
         dart; pin and mark.

  316 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 316 5/23/09 8:07:37 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:316

                   13                                                                    14

                Place raw edge of the first skirt piece just below the lower           Mark the direction of the upper edge on all muslin pieces;
                edge of the skirt; pin at the upper edge of the skirt, keeping the     label pieces. Check that all seam lines, darts, gathers, and
                muslin straight and even. Pin seams as you come to them; pin           pleats are marked. Mark dots at intersecting seams; label.
                out fullness for pleats or gathers. Pin vertical tucks in the skirt,
                pinning 1⁄8" tuck near back corner on each side of the chair and
                ¼" tuck near each corner on back of the chair; tucks will be
                released in step 16, adding ease to the skirt. Mark seams and
                placement of pleats or gathers.

                   15                                              16                                              17

                Remove the muslin. Add ¼" ease                  Remove the pinned tucks near the                True straight seam lines using a
                to back edge of the outside arm at              back corners of the skirt pieces. Mark          straightedge; true curved seam lines,
                lower corner. Add ½" ease to sides              “fold line” at lower edge of the muslin         drawing smooth curves. Do not mark
                of the outside back at lower corners.           for a self-lined skirt.                         seam lines in pleated areas.
                Taper to the marked seam lines at
                upper corners.

                                                                                                                                                    (continued)

                                                                                                                                     Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 317

   260-325_11989.indd 317                                                                                                                                      5/23/09 8:07:42 AM

ects 316 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:317

            18                                      19                                                20

         Add 4" to the lower edge of the          Mark the lower edge of the inside                Mark the back edge of the inside arm
         inside back and back edge of deck.       arm from a point 4" away from seam               from a point 4" away from the seam
                                                  line at the back edge to ½" from large           line at the lower edge to ½" from the
                                                  dot at front edge; repeat for the sides of       large dot; repeat for the sides of the
                                                  the deck.                                        inside back.

            21                                                              22

         Check lengths of the seam lines for adjoining seams;            Fold pleats on marked lines. Mark seam lines in pleated
         adjust as necessary to ensure that seam lines match.            area; add ½" seam allowances. Trim on the cutting line through
                                                                         all layers of the pleats. Add ½" seam allowances to any
                                                                         remaining seams and cut pieces out on the marked cutting
                                                                         lines. Before cutting, double-check that you cut on the cutting
                                                                         line, not on the seam line.

  318 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 318 5/23/09 8:07:53 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:318

                ■ Making a Quality Slipcover
                •     When laying out the pattern for cutting, center                      •      Although your slipcover may be slightly different
                      large motifs in your fabric on the back, sides,                             from the project shown, familiarize yourself with
                      cushions, and on the top of the arms. On a striped                          the basic construction steps, as the general order
                      fabric, center the prominent stripe on the center                           of assembly will be the same.
                      placement line on the back and cushion pieces.                       •      Stitch small details, such as darts, before
                      Position arm pieces on striped fabric so the stripes                        assembling pieces.
                      will run in the same direction as the skirt.                         •      Use strong thread, such as long-staple polyester, a
                •     Cut the skirt pieces to make a self-lined skirt,                            medium stitch length, and a size 90/14 or 100/16
                      placing the fold line at the lower edge of the pattern                      sewing machine needle.
                      on a crosswise fold. Self-lined skirts generally hang                •      Add welting to any seams that will be subjected
                      better than single-layer skirts with a hem.                                 to stress and wear. Welting can also be added for
                •     Mark names of pieces on wrong side of fabric and                            decorative detail to seams such as around the
                      transfer all markings, including notches and dots.                          outside back and the upper edge of the skirt.

                      Fitted Slipcover Cutting Guide ▸
                                                                           Length                                                                  Width

                      All Slipcover Pieces                                 See pattern                                                             See pattern.
                      Tacking strip (cut on straight grain)                Circumference of chair at upper edge of skirt                           3"

                ■ How to Sew a Fitted Slipcover
                    1                                                                          2

                Stitch darts at the upper corners of the inside back. If                   Stitch darts at the outer front corners of the deck; stop
                welting is desired, apply it to the upper front edges of the               stitching ½" from the raw edges at the inner corner.
                outside arm, pivoting at the corner.

                                                                                                                                                            (continued)

                                                                                                                                             Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 319

   260-325_11989.indd 319                                                                                                                                               5/23/09 8:08:1 AM

ects 318 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:319

            3                                                            4

         Stitch the deck to the front of the arm and the inside arm;   Pin pleats in place at the front and back of the arm. Check
         this can be stitched as two separate seams.                   the fit over the arm of the chair. Baste in place on seam line.

            5                                                            6

                                                                                                                  A
                                                                                    A

                                                                                                         B

         Stitch the horizontal and vertical seams, joining the         Pin the inside arms to inside back on both sides (A). Pin
         outside arm to the inside arm; pivot at corner.               lower edge of the inside back to back edge of the deck (B).
                                                                       Make tucks in seams at the corners, if necessary, so pieces fit
                                                                       together. Stitch seams.

  320 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 320 5/23/09 8:08:3 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:320

                   7                                          8                                               9

                Apply welting around the sides and          Press pleats for the pleated skirt.            Pin the tacking strip to the upper
                upper edge of the slipcover unit; curve     For a gathered skirt, stitch gathering         edge of the skirt on the wrong side.
                ends of the welting into seam allowance     stitches by zigzagging over a cord;            Join the skirt to adjoining pieces; for
                1
                 ⁄2" from the lower edges (arrow). Join     for a skirt with bunched gathers,              a gathered skirt, pull the gathering
                slipcover unit to outside back, leaving     stitch gathering stitches between the          threads together to fit. Insert the zipper
                the seam open for zipper application.       markings.                                      (page 322) and sew cushion covers
                Apply welting to the lower edge. Stitch                                                    (page 272).
                skirt pieces together, leaving the seam
                at the back corner unstitched for the
                zipper; press seams open. Fold the skirt
                in half lengthwise, wrong sides together
                and press.

                   10                                                                11

                Apply the slipcover to the chair. Secure the tacking strip to     Push extra fabric allowance into crevices around the deck
                the chair by pinning into upholstery with T-pins.                 and inside back. Stuff 2" strips of polyurethane foam into
                                                                                  crevices around the deck to keep fabric from pulling out. Insert
                                                                                  the cushions.

                                                                                                                                Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 321

   260-325_11989.indd 321                                                                                                                                 5/23/09 8:08:36 AM

ects 320 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:321

               Sewing a Fitted Slipcover with a Front Arm Piece ▸

               Stitch darts at the upper corners        Stitch the front arm piece to the           Follow steps 2 and 3 on page 319
               of the inside back. Apply welting to     front edge of the inside/outside arm;       to 320. Pin the pleats in place at the
               the upper edge of the inside arm, if     stop stitching 2" from the outer end        back of the arm; baste in place on
               desired. Stitch the horizontal seam,     of the front arm piece.                     the seam line. Complete the vertical
               joining the outside arm to the inside                                                seam at the front edge of the outside
               arm. Pin and baste tucks at the front                                                arm. Finish the slipcover as in steps
               edge of the inside/outside arm.                                                      6 to 11 on page 320 to 321.

         ■ How to Add a Zipper to a Slipcover
            1                                                                  2

         Pull the cording out slightly from the ends of the skirt            Press under the seam allowances on the zipper opening.
         opening; trim off the ends 1". Pull the seam to return the          Place the open zipper on the welted side of the seam, so the
         cording to its original position.                                   welting just covers the zipper teeth and with the zipper tab
                                                                             at the lower edge. Pin in place; fold in the seam allowance
                                                                             at the lower edge of the skirt to miter. Fold up the end of the
                                                                             zipper tape.

  322 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_11989.indd 322 5/23/09 8:08:41 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:322

                   3                                                                  4

                Edgestitch on the skirt using a zipper foot, with the zipper        Close the zipper. Place the remaining side of the zipper
                teeth positioned close to the folded edge. Stitch in the ditch of   under the seam allowance, with the folded edge at the welted
                the welted seam.                                                    seam line. Pin in place; fold in the seam allowance at the lower
                                                                                    edge of the skirt to miter. Fold up the end of the zipper tape.

                   5                                                                    Pleated Skirt ▸

                                                                                        Break the stitching at the upper edge of the skirt.
                                                                                        On the skirt, stitch through the lower layer of the box
                                                                                        pleat; stitch as close as possible to the seam at the
                Open the zipper. Stitch 3⁄8" from the folded edge, pivoting at          upper edge of the skirt.
                the top of the zipper.

                                                                                                                                 Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 323

   260-325_11989.indd 323                                                                                                                                  5/23/09 8:08:45 AM

ects 322 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:323

         Futon Slipcover

         F    utons are wonderfully practical, especially for
              small spaces. With the addition of this simple
         slipcover, your futon can complement your décor
         as well. Use flat cotton sheets or decorator fabric to
         stitch together this practical fitted cover.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Two cotton sheets        Zipper tape
                 the same size as       Zipper pull
                 the mattress, or       3
                                         ⁄4"-wide                                 Futons are a comfortable addition to guest rooms, vacation
                 decorator fabric           transparent tape                      homes, basements, and small spaces. Dress them up with a
                                                                                  slipcover to match your room’s décor.

               Futon Slipcover Cutting Guide ▸
                                         Length                                                                      Width

               Front/Back Piece (2)      Length of futon mattress + 1"                                               Width of futon mattress + 1"
               Boxing Strip              Length of futon mattress + 1"                                               Width of futon mattress + 1"
               Zipper Tab                4"                                                                          Width of boxing strip
               Long Zipper Strip (2)     Length of futon mattress + 1"                                               Width of boxing strip ÷ 2 + 1½"
               Short Zipper Strip (4)    Length of mattress end + 1"                                                 Width of boxing strip ÷ 2 + 1¼"
               Zipper Tape               Length of mattress end × 2 + length of mattress side + 1"

         ■ How to Sew a Futon Cover
                                                                                                              Stitch one short zipper strip to each
            1                                                                                                 end of one long zipper strip, right sides
                                                                                                              together, with ½" seams. Stitch from raw
                                                                                                              edge to ½" from the opposite edge. Finish
                                                                                                              seams,using a zigzag stitch or serging;
                                                                                                              press open. Repeat, using the remaining
                                                                                                              short and long zipper strips.

  324 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

260-325_C51711.indd 324 6/3/09 1:59:46 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:324

                   2                                        3                                                4

                Place the zipper strips right sides       Fold the strip in half, right sides             Press the zipper tab in half, wrong
                together, matching the raw edges and      together, with one seam allowance               sides together. Open the zipper about
                seams. Machine-baste ¾" from the long     extending. Place the closed zipper              2". At the top end of the zipper, place
                edge, where stitching of the end seams    facedown over seam allowances, with             the tap over the zipper strip, right sides
                extends to the raw edge. Finish seams;    the teeth centered on the seamline              up; stitch across the end ½" from the
                press open.                               and the ends of the zipper tape even            raw edges, stitching carefully over the
                                                          with the ends of the strip. Machine-            zipper teeth.
                                                          baste the zipper tape to the extended
                                                          seam allowance. Unfold. Center a strip
                                                          of transparent tape over the seam
                                                          line. Stitch on both sides of the tape,
                                                          securing the zipper. Remove the tape
                                                          and basting stitches.

                   5                                        6                                                7

                Stitch the ends of the boxing strip       Pin the boxing strip to the futon               Open the zipper; turn the futon cover
                to the ends of the zipper strip, right    cover front, right sides together,              right side out. Insert the futon mattress;
                sides together with ½" seams. Start and   matching seams to corners. With                 close the zipper, hiding the zipper pull
                stop ½" from the raw edges. Finish the    the boxing strip face-up, stitch a ½"           under the tab.
                seams and press open.                     seam, pivoting at the corners. Pin the
                                                          opposite side of the boxing strip to the
                                                          futon cover back, right sides together,
                                                          matching seams to corners; stitch.
                                                          Finish remaining seams.

                                                                                                                               Slipcovers & Upholstery ■ 325

   260-325_11989.indd 325                                                                                                                                 5/23/09 8:09:1 AM

ects 324 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:325

326-371_11989.indd 326 5/23/09 9:01:47 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:326

                                         Furniture
                                         Refinishing
                                         R    efinishing furniture pieces not only improves
                                              the appearance and value of rare, well-loved, or
                                         rescued furniture, but it can also be a fun hobby.
                                         The techniques described in this chapter are easy to
                                         master, but will require time, patience, and diligent
                                         attention to detail for a truly excellent end result.
                                         Always spend time stripping, sanding, and preparing
                                         the surface, as well as making any minor repairs,
                                         before you apply the final stain or paint color. If you
                                         spend time preparing your piece, you will not be
                                         disappointed with the final result. A unique furniture
                                         piece with a professional, high-quality surface has
                                         lasting appeal and can add immense character, spark,
                                         and sophistication to your living spaces.

                                         In this chapter:
                                         • Heat Stripping                    • Faux Leather Finish
                                         • Chemical Stripping                • Photo Montage Table
                                         • Surface Prep                      • Spray-painting
                                         • Stain & Top Coat                    Metal Furniture
                                         • Painting Furniture                • Painting Radiators

                                                                                                                ■ 327

   326-371_11989.indd 327                                                                                      5/23/09 9:01:53 AM

ects 326 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:327

         Heat Stripping

         B    efore painting or refinishing, wood should be
              cleaned, repaired, and sanded. If the old paint
         is heavily layered or badly chipped, it should also be
                                                                                Heat-Stripping Tip ▸
         stripped before the wood is repainted. Using heat to
         strip an old finish is safe and effective; heat encourages
         paint to blister and pull away from the wood so it can
         easily be scraped away with a putty knife. You just need
         to use the proper techniques and safety measures.
              An electric heat gun looks much like a hand-
         held hair dryer and forces a stream of hot air against
         the piece. This stripping technique works best when
         stripping multiple layers of paint but can also be
         used on thick layers of varnish, lacquer, and other top
         coats. If you plan to use a chemical stripper, you may
                                                                                A heat shield keeps the heat gun from damaging
         want to heat strip the wood first—you’ll use less of                   or blistering the finish on surrounding areas. For a
         the chemical stripper if you do. Never use a heat gun                  shield, use a piece of sheet metal or cover cardboard
         after using chemical strippers, however. The chemical                  with heavy-duty aluminum foil.
         residue could become vaporized or ignited by the heat.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Heat gun                      Heavy-gauge extension cord                  Goggles                          Aluminum foil
               Putty knife                   Fire extinguisher                           Work gloves                      Cardboard
               Assorted scrapers             Coffee can

         Heat stripping can scorch the wood if applied unevenly—watch the painted surface carefully. If the paint looks gummy, it may be
         becoming overheated.

  328 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_C51711.indd 328 6/3/09 2:09:28 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:328

                ■ How to Heat-strip Paint
                   1                                                                     2

                Scrape off all loose paint flakes using a paint scraper. Hold          Follow the heat gun with a metal scraper. Hold the scraper
                the heat gun about 2" above the surface, and then turn it on,          at about a 30° angle, and move both the scraper and the
                starting at the lowest setting. Move the gun in a circular motion      heat gun at the same speed. (Always move the heat gun in a
                until the paint begins to blister. If the paint doesn’t blister, try   circular motion.) Strip all the large, flat surfaces. Deposit the
                the next higher heat setting.                                          ribbons of paint in a coffee can or other heat-proof container.

                   3                                                                     4

                Heat strip the contoured and uneven areas using                        Dry scrape all wood surfaces to remove any remaining
                specialty scrapers, where needed, to remove the loosened               loosened paint flecks after you are done heat stripping. In most
                paint. Do not overheat or use too much pressure around                 cases, you will need to use chemical solvents or strippers to
                detailed areas—they are more vulnerable to scorching and               remove the rest of the finish.
                gouging than flat areas.

                                                                                                                                       Furniture Refinishing ■ 329

   326-371_11989.indd 329                                                                                                                                       5/23/09 9:02:4 AM

ects 328 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:329

         Chemical Stripping

         C    hemical solvents are fast and thorough. They
              can remove just about any finish material, from
         varnish to polyurethane or paint. Before choosing
         a solvent or stripper, identify the old finish type.
         Remember that most finishes are composed of several
         layers; try to select a chemical that is effective on the
         materials in all of the layers.
              The primary solvents used for stripping are
         mineral spirits, denatured alcohol, and lacquer
         thinner. These chemicals are inexpensive and
         relatively safe, so use them instead of commercial
         strippers whenever possible. Many commercial
         strippers and older strippers contain hazardous
         chemicals, and will require you to wear a respirator
         and other protective equipment when in use. These
         strippers are very effective but always follow the
         recommended precautions and try to use a less
         abrasive product if you can. Newer products without
         hazardous chemicals dissolve most finishes with far
         less risk, although they work somewhat slower than
         their more hazardous counterparts.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Paintbrushes
               Putty knife
               Assorted scrapers
               Safety equipment
               Stripper or solvent
               Medium abrasive pads
               Newspapers and rags
               Sawdust
               Rinsing agent

               Refinishing Safety Tip ▸
               Protect yourself and your home, and help ensure
               good finishing results by using sensible safety,
               cleanup, and disposal methods. Contact your local
               city office or the Environmental Protection Agency
               (page 444) for disposal regulations. Also see "Safety   Chemical stripper dissolves thick finishes so they can be
               Equipment" on page 346.                                 wiped or scraped off easily. Coarse abrasive pads are effective
                                                                       removal tools for contours.

  330 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_C51711.indd 330 6/3/09 2:09:54 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:330

                ■ How to Chemically Strip a Finish
                   1                                        2                                                  3

                Pour some stripper into a small,          Wearing rubbers gloves (and a                     Let the stripper work for the length
                easy-to-use container (no more than       respirator if the label advises you to use        of time suggested by the manufacturer.
                you can use in 15 minutes). Read the      one), apply a thick coat of stripper to the       Remove the sludge with a putty knife
                label and select a brush for applying     workpiece, beginning at the top of the            or stripping knife, and deposit it on old
                the stripper—most brands can be           project and working down from there.              newspapers. Tip: Just before you start
                applied with inexpensive polyester-       Do not overbrush the stripper.                    to scrape away the sludge, sprinkle
                bristle brushes.                                                                            sawdust on the stripper to make it
                                                                                                            easier to remove.

                   4                                        5                                                  6

                Strip the detailed and contoured areas,   Apply a thin coat of stripper to the              Clean the wood with a medium
                using specialty scrapers and abrasive     wood, and then scrub off any remaining            abrasive pad dipped in the rinsing
                pads to remove the sludge. Use light      finish, using a synthetic-bristle stripping       agent recommended by the stripper
                pressure on the scrapers so you do not    brush or medium abrasive pads.                    manufacturer (often denatured alcohol).
                gouge the wood.                                                                             This removes most traces of the finish
                                                                                                            and the stripper.

                                                                                                                                   Furniture Refinishing ■ 331

   326-371_C51711.indd 331                                                                                                                                  6/3/09 2:11:42 PM

ects 330 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:331

         Surface Prep

         S    urface preparation ensures an even, high-quality
              finish. Finish sand with progressively finer grits of
         sandpaper, starting with 150-grit. Generally, hardwood
         requires finer-grit sandpaper than soft wood. To
         speed up the process, use a power sander for the first
         stages of the sanding, then switch to hand sanding to
         complete the process.
               Finish sanding alone creates a smooth surface,
         but because wood absorbs stain at different rates,
         the color can be blotchy and dark. Sealing wood
         with sanding sealer evens out the stain-absorption
         rates and yields a lighter, more even finish. Filling
         the grain creates a finish that feels as smooth as
         it looks.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Fine-grit sandpaper      Putty knife
               Power sander             Grain filler
               Sanding blocks           Plastic scraper               Use sanding sealer or grain filler for a fine finish. Finish
               Rags                     Mineral spirits               sanding alone (left) can leave a blotchy surface, but sanding
               Abrasive pad                                           sealer (center) plus grain filler (right) give progressively
                                                                      finer finishes.

               Using Sanding Sealer ▸
                                                                                     Make your own sanding sealer by
                                                                                     blending one part clear top coat material
                                                                                     (not water based) with one part top coat
                                                                                     solvent. Use the same top coat material
                                                                                     you plan to apply to the project. Wipe on
                                                                                     a heavy coat of the sealer, then wipe off
                                                                                     the excess after a few minutes. When dry,
                                                                                     sand lightly with 200-grit sandpaper.

  332 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 332 5/23/09 9:02:53 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:332

                ■ How to Finish Sand
                   1                                             2                                                 3

                Finish sand all surfaces with 150-grit         Raise the wood grain by dampening                Use sanding blocks to hand sand
                sandpaper, following the direction of          the surface with a wet rag. Let the wood         the entire workpiece with the finest-
                the grain. Use a finishing sander on flat      dry, then skim the surface with a fine           grit paper in the sanding sequence.
                surfaces and specialty sanding blocks          abrasive pad, following the grain.               Sand until all sanding marks are gone
                on contours. When sanding hardwood,                                                             and the surface is smooth. (Use bright
                switch to 180-grit paper and sand again.                                                        sidelighting to check your progress.) If
                                                                                                                using sanding sealer, do that now.

                ■ How to Apply Grain Filler
                   1                                             2                                                 3

                After finish sanding, use a rag or             Remove excess filler by drawing a                Lightly hand sand the surface,
                putty knife to spread a coat of grain filler   plastic scraper across the grain of the          following the direction of the grain, with
                onto the wood surface. With a polishing        wood at a 45° angle. Let the grain filler        320-grit sandpaper. Finally, dampen a
                motion, work the filler into the grain.        dry overnight.                                   clean cloth with mineral spirits and use
                Let the filler dry until it becomes cloudy                                                      it to thoroughly clean the surface.
                (usually about 5 minutes).

                                                                                                                                       Furniture Refinishing ■ 333

   326-371_C51711.indd 333                                                                                                                                       6/3/09 2:12:2 PM

ects 332 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:333

         Stain & Top Coat

         A     pplying stain shows off a fine or distinctive grain
               pattern and creates a beautiful wood tone. Stain
         and penetrating oil, the two most basic coloring
                                                                                  For both the stain and top coat you choose, pay
                                                                              careful attention to drying times, safety advisories,
                                                                              application techniques and cleanup methods on
         agents, also help conceal uneven coloration and can                  the product label, as these aspects vary greatly from
         blend different wood types on the same piece. When                   product to product.
         selecting a coloring agent, consider oil-based stains,
         water-based stains, wipe-on gel stains, penetrating
         oils, and one-step stain-and-sealant products. To sort
         through the options, start by finding a color you like,
         and then read the label to determine if it’s the best                    Tools & Materials ▸
         product for your project and that it is compatible with
         the top coat you’d like to use.                                          Protective gloves               Stiff-bristled brush
              Top coats seal the wood and protect the finish from                 Penetrating oil                 Mineral spirits
         scratches and other wear as they highlight the coloring                  Staining cloths                 Polyurethane
         of the wood. For most projects, a top coat of tung oil,                  Soft buffing cloth              600-grit wet/dry
         polyurethane, or paste wax will protect the wood and                     Fine abrasive pad                  sandpaper
         give it the appearance you want. When choosing the                       Liquid stain                    Paste wax
         best top coat for you, consider durability, sheen, and                   Paintbrush
         compatibility with the stain color you’ve selected.

                                                                                  Masking Discoloration ▸

                                                                                  Evening out the color with dark stain is easier
                                                                                  than trying to sand out discolorations. Because stain
         A well-chosen, properly applied color layer and protective               forms a more opaque color layer than penetrating
         top coat will highlight the natural beauty and prolong the life of       oil, it’s generally a better product for covering
         your furniture. Regularly dust and maintain the furniture and it         wood problems.
         will serve you for life.

  334 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 334 5/23/09 9:03:29 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:334

                ■ How to Use Penetrating Oil
                   1                                              2                                               3

                Apply a heavy coat of penetrating oil           Wipe the surface dry with a clean              Dab a few drops of penetrating oil
                to all prepared surfaces using a staining       cloth, rubbing with the wood grain.            onto a fine abrasive pad, then rub the
                cloth. Wait 15 to 30 minutes, recoating         Apply another coat of oil with a clean         surfaces until smooth. Let the oil dry for
                any areas that begin to dry out. Apply          cloth, then let the oil dry overnight.         at least 72 hours before applying a top
                oil to all surfaces, and let it soak into the   Note: Two coats are sufficient in most         coat. If you do not plan to top coat the
                wood for 30 to 60 minutes.                      cases, since further coats will not            finish, buff with a soft cloth to harden
                                                                darken the finish color.                       the oil finish.

                ■ How to Apply Liquid Stain
                   1                                                                     2

                Stir the stain thoroughly and apply a heavy coat with a               Remove the excess stain with a clean, lint-free cloth. Wipe
                brush or cloth. Stir the stain often as you work. Let the stain       against the grain first, then with the grain. If the color is too
                soak in according to manufacturer’s instructions.                     dark, try scrubbing the surface with water or mineral spirits.
                                                                                      Let the stain dry, then buff with a fine abrasive pad. Repeat
                                                                                      with light coats of stain until the desired color is achieved. Buff
                                                                                      between coats and after the final coat.

                                                                                                                                      Furniture Refinishing ■ 335

   326-371_C51711.indd 335                                                                                                                                      6/3/09 2:14:4 PM

ects 334 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:335

         ■ How to Apply Gel Stain
            1                                                                     2

         Stir the stain, then work it into the surfaces of the workpiece        Let the stain soak in according to manufacturer’s directions,
         with a staining cloth, rubbing in a circular motion. Recoat any        then wipe off excess with a clean rag using a polishing motion.
         areas that dry out as you work and cover as much of the piece          Buff the stained surface with the wood grain using a soft, clean
         as possible. Use a stiff-bristled brush, such as a stencil brush,      cloth. Apply additional coats until the desired color has been
         to apply the gel in hard-to-reach areas (inset).                       achieved; three coats are typically recommended. Let the stain
                                                                                dry, then buff the piece with a fine abrasive pad.

         ■ How to Apply Polyurethane Top Coat
            1                                             2                                                 3

         Seal unstained wood with a 1:1                 Apply a coat of polyurethane,                    Apply the second coat. To keep
         mixture of polyurethane and water or           starting at the top of the project and           the finish from running, always try to
         mineral spirits (check the product label       working your way down. When the                  position the workpiece so the surface
         for its recommendation). Apply the             surface is covered, smooth out the               being top coated is horizontal.
         sealer with a clean cloth or brush and         finish by lightly brushing in one direction
         let it dry. Wipe off excess sealer using       only, parallel to the grain. Let dry, then
         a clean cloth. Note: If you used stain or      sand the surface with 600-grit wet/
         penetrating oil to color your piece, skip      dry sandpaper.
         this step.

  336 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 336 5/23/09 9:03:42 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:336

                ■ How to Apply Paste Wax
                   1                                            2                                                3

                Apply a moderate layer of paste wax           Allow the wax to dry until it becomes           Begin buffing the wax with a soft
                to the wood using a fine abrasive pad or      filmy in spots. Gently wipe off any             cloth using a light, circular motion. Buff
                a cloth. Rub the wax into the wood with       excess, undried wax, and then allow the         the entire surface until the filminess
                a polishing motion.                           remaining wax to dry until filmy (usually       disappears and the wax is clear.
                                                              within 10 to 20 minutes). Note: Do not          Continue buffing the wax until the
                                                              let the wax dry too long or it will harden      surface is hard and shiny. Apply and buff
                                                              and become very difficult to buff.              another coat, then let the wax dry for at
                                                                                                              least 24 hours before applying additional
                                                                                                              coats. Three coats are recommended
                                                                                                              for a fine finish.

                ■ How to Apply Tung Oil
                   1                                                                    2

                Apply a thick coat of tung oil with a cloth or brush. Let the        After 24 hours, buff the tung oil with a clean cloth, and
                tung oil penetrate for 5 to 10 minutes, then rub off the excess      then reapply additional coats as necessary to build the finish.
                with a cloth using a polishing motion.                               (Three coats are generally considered the minimum for a good
                                                                                     finish.) Use a clean cloth to apply each coat.

                                                                                                                                     Furniture Refinishing ■ 337

   326-371_11989.indd 337                                                                                                                                    5/23/09 9:03:54 AM

ects 336 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:337

         Painting Furniture

         T    he key to a beautiful painted finish is detailed
              surface preparation, so spend time sanding your
         piece to a fine finish, making any small repairs, and
                                                                           Tools & Materials ▸
         filling any nicks or dents with wood putty before                 Extra fine-grit
         you begin. For a truly professional finish, sand after               and fine-grit sandpaper
         priming and between coats as well. Use a power sander             Extra fine sanding sponge
         for large surfaces and plan to hand sand detailed areas.          2" paintbrush
               After initial sanding, apply a high-quality primer as       Tack cloth
         your first coat. If you will be painting your piece a bold        Latex primer
         color, ask your retailer about tinting the primer—this            Semigloss latex paint
         may result in fewer coats of your final paint color later         Polyurethane spray
         on. Finally, apply several coats of high-quality paint for
         a shined-up, refreshed, good-as-new piece.

                                                                           Sanding Tip ▸
                                                                           To check a sanded surface for flaws, shine a bright
                                                                           light sideways over the piece and run your hands
                                                                           over the surface, feeling for flaws that can’t be seen.

         A coat of paint can unlock the potential of an old or
         neglected table or chair, transforming it in a matter of hours.

  338 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_C51711.indd 338 6/3/09 2:14:29 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:338

                ■ How to Paint a Furniture Piece
                   1                                            2                                            3

                Sand the piece thoroughly using              Apply the first coat of primer and let       Lightly sand the surface using an
                fine-grit sandpaper. Switch to the extra     it dry overnight.                            extra fine-grit sanding sponge. Wipe the
                fine-grit paper and sand again. Wipe                                                      piece down with a tack cloth and apply
                away the sanding dust with a tack cloth.                                                  a second coat of primer. Let the second
                                                                                                          coat of primer dry overnight.

                   4                                                                5

                Brush the first coat of paint onto the piece and let it dry.      Spray a light coat of polyurethane onto the entire piece
                Sand the piece using the extra fine sandpaper. Wipe away the      and let it dry thoroughly. Add a second coat and let it dry.
                sanding residue with a tack cloth. Apply a second coat of paint
                and let it dry.

                                                                                                                                 Furniture Refinishing ■ 339

   326-371_11989.indd 339                                                                                                                                 5/23/09 9:04:6 AM

ects 338 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:339

         Faux Leather Finish

         E   legant and easy, this finish works well as an inlay
             on large tables or desktops and complements both
         painted and stained surfaces. Leather hides tend to be
                                                                            Tools & Materials ▸
         smaller than 19 × 30", so inlays with dimensions smaller
                                                                            1
                                                                             ⁄2"-wide painter’s tape
         than that most successfully mimic real leather. Color              3" painter’s paper
         variations in tanned leather range from reddish Cordova            Flat oil-based paint, brown
         to a deep brown/black. Experiment with different latex             Flat oil-based paint, golden brown
         paints and mediums to create this finish, but the oil                  (for base coat)
         glaze is an essential component and gives the finish a             Alkyd glazing liquid
         richness that the latex just cannot quite achieve.                 Paint thinner
              Apply the faux leather finish to the entire project           3"-wide flat oil paintbrush
         piece, allowing the tape lines to form panels, or use 3"           Newspaper
         painter’s paper to protect the outer surface to create             90-weight, 24" cheesecloth
         an inlaid look. Use a clear ruler and T-square to keep
         your tape lines straight when planning out your panels.
              To begin, basecoat the project or inlay surface
         with a paint color that is about 50 percent lighter than
         your glaze color. Allow it to dry, then apply tape lines
         where they’d best help to frame your panels.

         Leather colors range from reds to warm black; although the table shown here was painted in brown tones, your choice of
         colors for this finish is quite broad.

  340 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_C51711.indd 340 6/3/09 3:07:55 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:340

                ■ How to Apply a Faux Leather Finish
                   1                                                                   2

                Mix a glaze using one part brown paint, one part glazing             While the glaze is still wet, smoothly lay the sheet of
                liquid, and one part paint thinner. After the basecoat has dried,    newspaper onto the glazed surface. Keep the newspaper
                use a paintbrush to apply glaze to the entire project surface.       flat. Lift the paper, then replace it on the project surface
                                                                                     overlapping the first area slightly and avoiding right angles.
                                                                                     Repeat this process over the entire surface.

                   3                                                                   4

                While the glaze is still wet, soften some of the edge lines          Top coat the surface with one or two coats of wax.
                by patting with the smooth side of a cheesecloth wad. Soften         For greater protection, apply a satin oil-based varnish
                the lines and fold the texture into the finish. Allow the paint to   before waxing.
                dry, then remove the tape.

                                                                                                                                     Furniture Refinishing ■ 341

   326-371_11989.indd 341                                                                                                                                     5/23/09 9:05:4 AM

ects 340 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:341

         Photo Montage Table

         D    isplay your photos proudly as a creative,
              professional-grade finish on a desk or tabletop!
         This technique is not decoupage but a modern
                                                                                    Tools & Materials ▸
         application of paper to a piece of furniture. Whether                      Flat latex paint, black
         following a theme or choosing random much-loved                            Matte finish photo-grade
         photos, your work is sure to be a conversation piece. A                       computer printing paper
         computer, a basic photo-editing program, and a printer                     Wallpaper cutting blade
         will enable you to manipulate the size and color of the                    Metal straightedge or ruler
         images, but photocopies can be used as long as they                        White chalk
         are produced on matte-finsh photo-grade paper.                             Painter’s masking tape
              When working with photographic images, never                          18 × 24" acid-free artist sketchbook pad
         use your originals. Store them in a safe place and use                     Spray adhesive
         reproductions for this project. For best results, print                    Wax paper
         your images on matte-finish photo-grade computer                           Rubber roller
         printing paper, or send them to a professional                             Satin oil-based varnish
         photo printer.

                                                                                                     A photo montage table or chair can be
                                                                                                     the perfect accent to add spice and artistic
                                                                                                     interest to any space in your home.

               Composition Tip ▸
               To help you arrange a pleasing composition on your piece, draw two diagonal lines with chalk to find the center
               intersection of the surface. Work off the center for a balanced composition. Also, determine which photos will be placed
               portrait or landscape, then size and crop photos appropriately before printing.

  342 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 342 5/23/09 9:05:13 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:342

                ■ How to Make a Photo Montage Table
                   1                                                                2

                Basecoat the project surface with the black paint. Trim           Place a number of images on the surface and move them
                the white borders from all images using the cutting blade and     around until you find a pleasing composition, holding images
                a straightedge.                                                   in place temporarily with a small loop of painter’s tape. When
                                                                                  your composition is complete, lift one image and lay it back
                                                                                  side up on a clean sketchbook page. Lightly apply an even coat
                                                                                  of spray adhesive across the entire back. Place the image in its
                                                                                  final position carefully, for you will not be able to reposition it.

                   3                                                                4

                Place a sheet of wax paper over the image. Roll it smooth         Top coat with one or two coats of satin oil-based varnish.
                using the rubber roller and flatten any bubbles or air pockets.   When applying varnish, the photo paper may bubble. Not to
                Smooth with clean fingers, if necessary. Repeat adhering and      worry—just press the image flat with a fingertip once the
                rolling procedure for all images. Allow the surface to dry for    varnish is dry.
                24 hours.

                                                                                                                                  Furniture Refinishing ■ 343

   326-371_C51711.indd 343                                                                                                                                  6/3/09 2:18:7 PM

ects 342 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:343

         Spray-painting Metal Furniture

         S   pray-painting metal furniture can help unmatched
             pieces coordinate and bring new life to old pieces.
         Spray paint is available in a wide variety of colors,
         styles, and finishes, and there’s certainly a color or
         finish perfect for your furniture. As with every other
         painting project, preparation is the most important
         aspect of spray-painting. Spray paint adheres best to
         clean, rough surfaces, so cleaning is the first and most
         important step in this project. For best results, shake
         the can and clean the nozzle often and maintain a
         distance of about 12" to ensure a smooth, even spray.
              Also, it’s important to spray-paint in a well-
         ventilated space. When concentrated, paint fumes are
         both dangerous to breathe and flammable.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Drop cloths                   Mineral spirits
               Spray primer                  Wire brush                       There are many spray paint options for metal furniture—
               Spray paint                   Newspaper                        consider brush-on, crackle, stone, hammered metal, and suede
                                                                              effects in several shades.

               HVLP (High Volume Low Pressure) Sprayers ▸

               Turbine-driven HVLP sprayers            Compressor-driven HVLP sprayers              Gravity feed HVLP spray guns have
               have a self-contained turbine           are supplied by an air compressor,           a small finish cup that’s mounted at
               blower that supplies a large volume     usually at least 3 hp and 20 gal. in size.   the top of the gun so it flows down
               of uncompressed air through the         They function similarly to turbine-          into the nozzle unassisted. Guns with
               sprayer nozzle, atomizing the finish    style models, except the product is          bottom-mounted cups rely on suction
               material and dispensing it in a soft,   not warmed up (which can cause the           created by the sprayer turbine or
               manageable mist.                        finish to dry too quickly).                  comrpessor to siphon the material up
                                                                                                    and into the nozzle.

  344 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 344 5/23/09 9:05:23 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:344

                ■ How to Spray-Paint Metal Furniture
                   1                                                                2

                Remove any hardware and dismantle furniture, then                 Scrape away rust and loose paint with a wire brush. Wipe
                wash thoroughly with a scrub brush and mild detergent. Rinse      down all pieces with mineral spirits and inspect for any surface
                and allow to dry completely.                                      bubbles. Use a putty knife to scrape bubbles away, then brush
                                                                                  the surface for a second time and continue to wipe with
                                                                                  mineral spirits until your rag stops picking up grime.

                   3                                                                4

                Spray a very light coat of primer using a wide-spray nozzle       After the primer has cured, apply the first coat of paint.
                attachment to the can. Bear in mind that the primer is meant      Shake the can well before you start and hold it about 12" away
                to create a rough surface that will be easy for the final coat    while you spray, cleaning the nozzle periodically. Allow the first
                to adhere to. Shake the can and hold about 12" away while         coat to dry, then reapply additional coats as necessary. After
                you spray. Clean the nozzle every few minutes according to        your final coat has dried, reassemble your piece.
                the manufacturer’s directions. Let the primer dry, then apply a
                second coat.

                                                                                                                                  Furniture Refinishing ■ 345

   326-371_C51711.indd 345                                                                                                                                 6/3/09 2:19:45 PM

ects 344 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:345

         Painting Radiators

         P    ainting radiators can help these ornate,
              functional pieces add decorative flair, as well
         as warmth, to your décor. Before you prepare the
         surface, remember that many radiators are old
         enough that they could be coated with lead paint, so
         always test for lead before beginning this project. If
         tests indicate the presence of lead, consult a lead-
         abatement expert, and do not attempt to paint the
         radiator yourself.
              Top-of-the-line interior eggshell, satin finish latex
         paint, or high heat-resistant paint can all be used
         for this project. Before you begin, make sure your
         radiator is clean and grease free and has a slightly
         rough surface. Also, radiators should be warm, rather
         than hot or cold, while being painted, and should be
         allowed to remain cool for 2 to 3 hours after painting.
         Take on this project in late spring or early fall, when
         the heating system in your home won’t be necessary.                A new coat of paint can help coordinate a radiator with the rest
                                                                            of the room, rescue it from shabbiness, or turn it into a showpiece.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Drop cloths                       Tack cloth                  Scrub brush                       Bendable paint pad
               Latex paint                       Lead-testing kit            Painter’s tape                    11⁄2" tapered paintbrush
               Plastic sheeting

               Safety Equipment ▸
                                                                                            Basic safety equipment for the
                                                            Eye wash kit                    work area includes a fully charged fire
                                         Smoke detector
                                                                                            extinguisher rated for type A and B fires,
                                                                                            a smoke detector, a first aid kit, an eye
                                                                                            wash kit, disposable latex gloves, and a
                                                                           Disposable
                                                                             gloves         telephone for emergency use.

                                                                           Telephone
                                           First aid kit

                     Fire extinguisher

  346 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 346 5/23/09 9:05:42 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:346

                ■ How to Paint a Radiator
                   1                                           2                                                3

                Use a lead-testing kit, following the        Wash the radiator using a scrub                 Scrape away loose paint using a wire
                manufacturer’s instructions, to test the     brush and mild detergent. Rinse the             brush. Sand the surface of the radiator,
                paint on the radiator. If test indicates     radiator with clear water and allow it to       paying special attention to areas where
                the presence of lead, stop and consult a     dry completely.                                 the old paint is cracking or peeling. Wipe
                lead-abatement specialist. If lead is not                                                    the surface with a tack cloth to remove
                detected, prepare your work area with                                                        sanding dust and debris.
                drop cloths and plastic sheeting.

                   4

                Turn on the radiator until the surface is slightly warm. Apply      Variation: Heat resistant paint is designed to resist heat as
                paint using long, smooth strokes. Use a bendable painting pad       high as 2,000°. This type of paint comes in spray cans, which
                to reach the back of the radiator fins (inset). Do not run the      makes it easy to apply. Always apply two coats of sprayed
                furnace for 2 to 3 hours after the paint is dry.                    paint for best adherence, cleaning the nozzle regularly and
                                                                                    holding the can about 12" away from surface.

                                                                                                                                    Furniture Refinishing ■ 347

   326-371_11989.indd 347                                                                                                                                   5/23/09 9:05:47 AM

ects 346 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:347

326-371_C51711.indd 348 6/3/09 2:20:25 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:348

                                          Window
                                          Treatments
                                          W      indow treatments can transform a room from
                                                 an architecturally stunning, well-decorated
                                          space to a complete, inviting corner of your home
                                          by softly framing windows, accenting decorating
                                          colors, and reflecting your personality. Hundreds of
                                          window treatment styles are available, and each can
                                          be customized to fit your style. Select coordinating
                                          decorator fabric, add trim and hardware, and mix
                                          and match over- and under-treatments for the best
                                          marriage of form and function in each room.
                                              Protect your privacy, control light, and insulate
                                          rooms from heat and cold while you add a splash of
                                          color, a sweep of elegance, or draped sophistication to
                                          your windows with any of the following projects.

                                          In this chapter:
                                          • Window Treatment Basics           • Loop-tab Curtains
                                          • Window Treatment Styles           • Rod-pocket Curtains
                                          • Blinds & Shades                   • Tent-flap Curtains
                                          • Window Shade Styles               • Tie-top Curtains
                                          • Roller Shades                     • Drapery Styles
                                          • Roller Shade                      • Pinch-pleated Draperies
                                            with Tabbed Hems                  • Drapery Lining
                                          • Coach Shades                      • Valance Styles
                                          • Flat Roman Shades                 • Buttoned Valance
                                          • Butterfly Shades                  • Cloud Valance
                                          • Cloud Shades                      • Upholstered Valance
                                          • Balloon Shades                    • Hanging Shelf Valance
                                          • Curtain Styles                    • Swag Styles
                                          • Hanging Curtains                  • Scarf Swag
                                          • Draped                            • Bias Swag
                                            Window Treatments                 • Rod-pocket Swag
                                          • No-sew Side Panels                • Stained Glass
                                          • Basic Curtains                    • Frosted Glass
                                          • Grommet Curtains                  • Shoji-style Screen

                                                                                                                 ■ 349

   326-371_C51711.indd 349                                                                                       6/3/09 2:20:42 PM

ects 348 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:349

                                                                                                             Top of rod
         Window Treatment
         Basics

         B   efore you design new window treatments, always
             take accurate measurements of the window
         to determine the amount of fabric you’ll need to
                                                                                                                Inside

         purchase. First, choose the style of your treatment, the
         installation type, and determine the type of hardware                                                 Outside

         you’ll need. Then, take careful measurements of your
         window, including space for mounting hardware,
         to estimate the yardage of fabric you’ll need. Once
         you have this basic information gathered, you’ll be
         well prepared to make custom window treatments in

                                                                                                                                             Apron length

                                                                                                                                                            Floor length
                                                                                                                               Sill length
         any style.

         ■ Measuring Windows
         Measure the window to determine the finished length
         and width of the treatment. These measurements will
         help you determine the cut length and width, which
         is the finished measurement plus the amount of
         fabric needed for hems, rod pockets, seams, matching
         repeats, and fullness.
              Finished Length: Top of the heading or rod
         pocket to bottom of the hem.
              Finished Width: Width of the rod plus returns
         and overlap for draperies.
              Curtains and draperies can be sill length, apron
         length, or floor length. For good proportion, valances
         and swags are often one-fifth the length of the
         window or the completed window treatment. Swags
         are usually one- or two-thirds the length of the
                                                                                  Always measure and record the measurements for each
         window. Whatever your desired measurement, avoid                         window you plan to dress, even if windows appear to be the
         dividing any window directly in half with a window                       same size. Use a folding ruler or metal tape for measuring;
         treatment.                                                               cloth tapes may stretch or sag.

               Measuring Tips ▸
               •     For floor-length draperies, allow 1⁄2" clearance between the bottom of the drapery and the floor.
               •     For loosely woven fabrics, allow 1" clearance to allow extra room for stretching.
               •     If you have baseboard heaters, allow 4 to 6" drapery clearance above heaters for safety.
               •     If carpeting has not yet been installed, allow 21⁄2" clearance.
               •     If windows are varying heights in one room, use the highest window as the standard for measuring others.
                     Place all draperies in the room at the same height from the floor, if possible.

  350 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 350 5/23/09 9:06:14 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:350

                ■ Estimating Yardage
                Fabric widths vary, so wait to calculate yardage until
                you have selected your fabric. After you take the         Estimating Yardage ▸
                necessary measurements and determine the finished
                                                                          Cut Length                                               in.
                size of the treatment, calculate the cut length and
                width of the project.                                     For fabrics not requiring pattern match
                     To determine the cut length, add the amount of       1) Finished length
                fabric needed for lower hems, rod pockets, headings,      2) Double-fold bottom hem                                +
                and pattern repeat to the finished length:
                                                                          3) Rod pocket/heading                                    +
                     Lower hems: Because many lower hems are
                doubled, add double the desired finished hem length.      4) Cut length for each width or part width               =
                For medium-weight fabrics, add 8" to make a 4" hem.
                For sheer or lightweight fabrics, add 11 to 12" for a 5   For fabrics requiring pattern match
                to 6" hem. For short curtains or valances, add 2 to 6"    1) Cut length (see above)
                for a 1 to 3" hem.
                                                                          2) Size of pattern repeat (distance between motifs)      ÷
                     Rod pockets and headings: For rod pockets
                                                                          3) Number of repeats needed*                             =
                with no headings, add an amount equal to the
                diameter of the rod plus ½" to turn under and ¼ to        4) Cut length for each width or part width:
                1" ease, depending upon the thickness of the fabric          multiply size of repeat by number of repeats needed
                and the size of the rod. Lightweight fabrics require
                less ease; rod pockets for large rods require more. For   Cut Width
                rod pockets with headings, add twice the depth of the
                                                                          1) Finished width
                heading to the rod pocket measurement.
                                                                          2) Fullness (how many times the finished width)          ×
                     Pattern repeat: Prints must match across the
                width of the panels. Measure the distance between         3) Width times fullness                                  =
                motifs and add that amount to the cut length of           4) Double-fold side hems                                 +
                each panel.                                               5) Total width needed                                    =
                                                                          6) Width of fabric
                To determine the cut width, add the amount
                                                                          7) Number of fabric widths:
                needed for seams, side hems, and fullness to the
                                                                             total width needed divided by width of fabric*
                finished width:
                     Seams: For multiwidth panels, add 1" for each
                seam. If your panel is not wider than the fabric, you     Total Fabric Needed
                will not require extra fabric for seams.                  1) Cut length (see above)
                     Side hems: Add 6" per panel for a 1½" double-        2) Number of fabric widths (see above)                   ×
                fold hem on each side of the panel.
                                                                          3) Total fabric length                                   =
                     Fullness: Fabric weight determines fullness. For
                lace and medium-weight to heavyweight fabrics, use        4) Number of yd. needed:                                 yd.
                2 to 2½ times the finished width of the curtain. For         total fabric length divided by 36"
                sheer and lightweight fabrics, use 2½ to 3 times the
                finished width.                                           For wide sheers, which can be railroaded
                                                                          1) Finished width times 3 (fullness)                     ×
                Make a copy of the chart at right and fill it in to
                                                                          2) Number of yd. needed:                                 yd.
                help determine the yardage needed for your window
                                                                             Total width needed divided by 36"
                treatment project. If you are working on draperies
                (with lining), see pages 402 to 403.
                                                                          * For fabrics requiring pattern match, see page 28.

                                                                                                                              Window Treatments ■ 351

   326-371_11989.indd 351                                                                                                                      5/23/09 9:06:32 AM

ects 350 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:351

         Window Treatment Styles

         W     indow treatments infuse a room with color,
               pattern, and personality. They also provide
         privacy, control light, conserve heat, minimize
                                                                            There are hundreds of variations on each window
                                                                            treatment style, depending on the fabric and
                                                                            combination you choose to best suit your home and
         noise, and obscure or draw attention to a view.                    personal style. Also see pages 361, 379, 401, 411, 425.

                                       Side view

               Rod-pocket curtain at floor length
                                                           Rod-pocket curtain with tiebacks

                                                                                                                   Tab-top curtains

         Curtains are straight fabric panels, usually unlined, that hang on the sides of the window. Change up your curtains by choosing a
         creative heading or layering them over window shades or under a top treatment. Lightweight cottons, cotton/polyester blends, and
         some fashion fabrics are a good choice for curtains.

                         Pinch Pleat                                 Goblet Pleat                                Inverted Box Pleat

         Draperies are long, straight fabric panels with pleated headings that are almost always lined. Draperies are hung from drapery
         hooks, usually on traversing rods, which makes them easy to open and close. Medium-weight to heavyweight cottons and formal
         fabrics, such as damask, toile, antique satin, and brocade work well for draperies.

  352 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 352 5/23/09 9:06:32 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:352

                            Roller shade                  Roman shade                     Balloon shade                         Padded cornice

                Fabric shades are mounted inside or outside the window             Valances are window toppers that hang alone or over
                frame and are used to block or filter light. They can be flat,     curtains, draperies, or shades, cleverly camouflaging mounting
                gathered, or pleated, and they are generally raised from the       hardware. Valances can be made in a variety of styles to best
                bottom by pulling a cord. Use firmly woven cloth for flat shades   match your décor; choose fabric that will work best for the
                and soft, drapable fabric for gathered shades.                     valance style and formality of the room.

                                       Freeform Scarf Swag                                                    Bias Swag

                Swags are pleated or draped to hang across the top of a window, and they are usually lined because both sides are part of the
                design. Soft, drapable fabrics, such as lace, silk, or linen drape beautifully as swags.

                      Window Treatment Hardware ▸

                      Curtain rods work well for rod-pocket window                 Decorative rods are made of a variety of materials and
                      treatments or for any treatment that will cover most of      are often sold in kits that include brackets, finials, and
                      the rod. These rods are functional, not decorative and       rings. These rods are meant to be seen—pair them with
                      don’t allow you to easily open and close curtains.           treatments that will showcase their material and styling.
                                                                                   Hang window treatments from decorative rods with pleat
                                                                                   hooks, fabric tabs, ribbons, grommets, rings, or clips—
                                                                                   depending on the best look for your room.

                                                                                                                                    Window Treatments ■ 353

   326-371_11989.indd 353                                                                                                                                 5/23/09 9:06:37 AM

ects 352 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:353

         Blinds & Shades

         H    orizontal blinds and shades can be opened or closed
              with the push of a button or a tug of a cord. They
         also help control the amount of light that is filtered into
                                                                             Tools & Materials ▸
         a room, and they can help insulate a room against heat              Shade or blind                   Wall anchors
         or cold. The key to easy blind or shade installation is             Tape measure                     Hanger brackets
         careful measurement and good preparation.                           Drill                            Screws
              Blinds or shades can be mounted inside or outside              Stud finder
         of the window frame on the hardware provided with
         the item. Custom shades or blinds are often installed
         on mounting boards, which are covered and custom-
         cut to fit your project.

               Mounting Styles ▸
               First, decide if the new shade or blind will be placed
               inside or outside of the window frame. For an inside
               mount (shown), install the hardware inside the top
               of the window frame so the molding is exposed; this
               is a good choice when you’ve installed decorative
               molding, or if your window treatment fits nicely inside
               the window frame. An outside mount is installed at
               the top of the window frame or on the wall above the
               window; treatments installed on an outside mount
               add height to the window and can let more light into
               the room. Inside or outside mounts can be used for
               either blinds or shades.

                                                                         Horizontal blinds and shades improve energy efficiency
                                                      Inside mount       and provide privacy and light control. Many retailers will cut
                                                                         them to fit while you wait, so always bring your measurements
                                                                         to the store with you.

  354 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 354 5/23/09 9:06:46 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:354

                ■ Blind and Shade Installations to Consider

                Stationary blinds (shutters, here) are installed like other    Inside-mount blinds allow window trim to complement the
                inside-mount blinds only they do not require space above for   décor. Here, a simple matching wood valance was provided
                hardware—they are typically flush with the top window frame,   with the blinds to conceal the hardware along the top edge.
                as shown here.

                Outside-mount shades are often used for window top-to-         Center inside-mount shades are often used if windows on
                floor coverage. Covering the window trim on both sides and     an upper-level floor require privacy only on the lower half of
                the bottom maintains a balanced look.                          the window. Outside-mount curtains complement this scenario
                                                                               well for those times when full light filtration is desired.

                                                                                                                                Window Treatments ■ 355

   326-371_C51711.indd 355                                                                                                                              6/3/09 2:21:8 PM

ects 354 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:355

         ■ How to Install Shades (Inside Mount)
            1                                                             2

         Measure the opening between the side jambs at the              Measure the height of the window frame (between
         top, bottom, and middle of the window frame. Make a            the top and bottom) at each side and in the middle. Add the
         quick diagram of the window and note the smallest of the       largest of these measurements to your diagram. With your
         three measurements.                                            diagram in hand, purchase blinds or shades to fit the window.
                                                                        If possible, have the retailer cut the blinds or shades to your
                                                                        specifications. If that’s not possible, buy the closest size (a bit
                                                                        smaller) to the window opening.

            3                                                             4

         To cut standard roll-up shades to length, remove the slat      Remove the excess cardboard, and then remove the roller
         from the bottom edge and cut through the hem with scissors.    end from the tube. Cut the tube to length with a hacksaw (for
         Carefully tear the material until you reach the roller tube.   metal tubes) or finetooth wood saw (for cardboard tubes).
         Follow the manufacturer’s specific instructions.

  356 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 356 5/23/09 9:06:57 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:356

                   5                                                                  6

                Roll the shade material back up, and then push the roller           Cut the slat (that fits into hems) to length, according to
                end inward and replace the end cap.                                 manufacturer’s instructions. For basic roller shades, you simply
                                                                                    snap the slat apart at the desired location.

                   7                                                                    Dress Up Plain Roller Shades ▸
                                                                                        It's easy to dress up inexpensive roller shades. Simply
                                                                                        add grommets to the lower edge for a designer detail.
                                                                                        Follow the same basic instructions for installing
                                                                                        curtain grommets on page 391.

                Position the first bracket flush with the upper front corner
                of the window frame, and mark its screw holes. Drill a pilot hole
                at each mark, hold the bracket in place, and then drive in the
                screws to secure it. Repeat for the other bracket, making sure
                the two brackets are level. Inset: slide the pin end of the head
                rail into the bracket on one end, and then slide the slatted end
                into the other bracket.

                                                                                                                                     Window Treatments ■ 357

   326-371_11989.indd 357                                                                                                                                   5/23/09 9:07:4 AM

ects 356 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:357

         ■ How to Install Blinds (Outside Mount)
            1                                                                 2

         To mount blinds outside the window frame, measure                  Position the first bracket as indicated by the diagram you
         the width from the outside edges of the window frame and           made in step 1, and mark its screw holes. Use a stud finder to
         the height from 2 to 3" above to 2 to 3" below the frame. If the   locate nearby studs. If a stud is in the bracket area, drill pilot
         window doesn’t have a frame, measure the opening and add a         holes at the marks and attach the bracket to the wall. If no stud
         few inches on each side. Make a diagram of the measurements        is available, use an awl to make a small hole at each mark, and
         and refer to it when purchasing blinds to fit.                     then drive a self-tapping hollow wall anchor into each. Finally,
                                                                            drive a screw into each anchor.

            3                                                                 4

         Shoot a line with a laser level or use a standard level to draw    Lift the blinds into place and install them in the brackets
         a level line across the wall from the top edge of the bracket      on the wall. Follow the manufacturer’s instructions to ensure a
         to the planned position for the second bracket. Position the       secure fit.
         second bracket and fasten it to the wall as described in step 2.

  358 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 358 5/23/09 9:07:12 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:358

                ■ How to Install a Mounting Board (Outside Mount)
                Many valances and simple stationary shades are                     valance is styled to the board. The board size depends
                mounted on boards instead of window hardware.                      on the strength required (based on fabric weight
                The mounting board is covered with fabric; then the                × span).

                   1                                          2                                                3

                Cut window treatment fabric to fit          Miter fabric at the board end corners.          Mark screw holes for the angle irons
                around a 1 × 2 board, adding 3" to the      Finger press and staple miters in place.        on the bottom of the board, positioning
                length and 1" to the width. Center the      Fold under excess fabric at ends and            them within 1" of each end and at 45"
                board on the wrong side of the fabric       staple near the fold.                           intervals or less. Snip a hole in the fabric
                and staple it to the long edge, spacing                                                     at screw positions using scissors, then
                staples about 8" apart. Wrap fabric                                                         predrill screw holes into the board at
                under the board, and then fold under 3⁄8"                                                   marked locations.
                on the long edge and staple.

                   4                                          5

                Hold the board level at the desired         Align the board onto brackets, and              Option: Mounting boards can also be
                placement and mark the screw holes          then secure board with 3⁄4" screws using        installed flat against the wall for Roman
                on the wall. Predrill holes into the wall   a handheld screwdriver or drill.                shades, or secured to the top of the
                studs, and then fasten brackets to the                                                      window frame (inset), if an inside mount
                wall with 1½" flathead screws using a                                                       is preferable.
                handheld screwdriver or drill.

                                                                                                                                     Window Treatments ■ 359

   326-371_C51711.indd 359                                                                                                                                  6/3/09 2:21:35 PM

ects 358 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:359

         Window Shade Styles

         W     indow shades control light, provide privacy, can
               be used alone or with curtains, and are one of
         the most affordable window treatments to make—
                                                                          keep your house cool in the summer and warm in the
                                                                          winter, improving your home’s energy efficiency.
                                                                              Dress up traditional shades with gathers, tabs,
         fabric cost is minimal and hardware is inexpensive.              sophisticated tucks, complex layers, and bold color
         Window shades also fit close to the window and help              and pattern choices.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Drapery pull (optional)      Depending on the              Iron and large                     Graph paper
               Decorator fabric(s)          project you choose,                pressing surface              Round ball finials
               Angle irons with screws      you may also need:            Liquid fray preventer                 or drawer pulls
                   or nuts and bolts        Roller kit (includes               and small paintbrush          Paint and paintbrush
               Drapery lining (optional)      roller, mounting            Decorative trim                    Masking tape
               3
                ⁄8 or 1⁄2" plastic rings      brackets, fusible           Fabric glue                           or vinyl tape
               Staple gun and staples         backing, and                3
                                                                           ⁄8 to 7⁄8" wooden dowel           Adding machine paper
               Mounting board                 hem stick)                  1
                                                                           ⁄2"- or 3⁄8"-wide flat            Self-styling tape
               Screw eyes                   Paper-backed                       metal weight bar,             Adhesive-backed hook
               Shade cord                     fusible adhesive                 cut 1⁄2" shorter than            and loop tape
               White glue                   Carpenter’s square                 the finished width
               Awning cleat                 Awl                                of the shade

         Window shades are a beautiful, formal alternative to blinds. They can be customized with decorator fabric to complement your
         décor and draw attention to your windows.

  360 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_C51711.indd 360 6/3/09 2:21:54 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:360

                ■ Shade Styles to Consider

                Roller shade: This traditional style can be customized with          Roman shade: These shades are raised and lowered by a
                dynamic decorator fabric, tabs and decorative hardware,              system of cords and rings, which also cause them to pleat
                painted designs, tassels and pulls—the options are limitless!        into soft folds when raised. Shown here are tucked (or "flat")
                                                                                     roman shades.

                Hobbled shade: Twice the length of a roman shade, excess             Butterfly shade: When drawn up, folds stack in the
                fabric is taken up in permanent soft folds between each row of       center and flare at the sides in this classic version of the
                rings, giving the shade a bubbled look when lowered.                 Roman shade.

                Cloud shade: Cut two to three times          Balloon shade: Cut two to two and a half          Coach shade: Two fabrics fused
                the width of the window, then shirred        times the width of the window, fullness is        together roll up around a wooden
                across the upper edge to create a            folded into oversized inverted pleats at the      pole at the bottom and flip over the
                soft heading, the lower edge of cloud        heading and lower edge. This shade has            mounting board to form a valance.
                shades fall into gentle poufs.               permanent poufs at the bottom.

                                                                                                                                        Window Treatments ■ 361

   326-371_11989.indd 361                                                                                                                                     5/23/09 9:07:51 AM

ects 360 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:361

         Roller Shades

         R   oller shades are the most common of all shade
             styles—but that’s because they work! Roller shades
         provide total privacy, they’re affordable, and they’re
                                                                            stick, fusible adhesive strips, and fusible backing. Some
                                                                            shades have a pulley system with a cord for raising
                                                                            and lowering the shade; others operate by means of a
         easy to install and operate. This style can be beautifully         spring inside the roller. Use firmly woven, lightweight
         decorative as well, especially when made with the fabric           to medium-weight fabric; avoid glazed, stain-resistant,
         of your choice and designer details, such as a sculpted            or water-repellant fabrics, because these finishes will
         bottom edge, decorative trim, or painted motifs.                   prevent the fabric from bonding well to the fusible
              Roller kits, which are sold in fabric and craft               backing. Before you make your shade, test a scrap of the
         stores, include the roller, mounting hardware, hem                 fabric with the fusible backing to ensure a good bond.

         Add customized details and bold drapery fabric to best complement decorative (and functional!) window shades.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                                    Length                                          Width

               Decorator Fabric                     Finished length + 14"                           Finished width + 2"
               Fusible Backing                      Finished length + 12"                           Finished width + 1"

  362 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 362 5/23/09 9:08:17 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:362

                ■ How to Make a Roller Shade
                   1                                           2                                                3

                Install the mounting brackets and            Turn up the lower edge of the                   Mark the finished width on the
                roller inside or outside the window          fabric 6" from the bottom, wrong sides          shade backing. Square off the upper
                frame (see page 359), and measure            together, and press a crease. Turn the          and lower edges using a carpenter’s
                the roller to determine the finished         lower edge back down, right sides               square. Draw a symmetrically shaped,
                width of the shade. Steam-press the          together 1½" from the first crease,             decorative hem. Cut along the
                fabric thoroughly to prevent shrinkage       forming a pocket. Using a 3⁄8"-wide strip       marked lines.
                during fusing. Cut the fabric and            of fusible adhesive, fuse the upper edge
                use a carpenter’s square to ensure           of the pocket closed. Fuse the backing
                square corners.                              to the wrong side of the fabric, following
                                                             the manufacturer’s instructions. Center
                                                             on the width of the fabric.

                   4                                                                   5

                Apply liquid fray preventer or diluted fabric glue along            Mark a straight line down the center of the roller and attach
                the cut edges using a small paintbrush. Apply decorative trim       the shade to the roller by taping the upper edge in place along
                along the cut edge of the shaped hem using fabric glue, if          the marked line. Trim the hem stick to fit the pocket and slide
                desired (inset).                                                    in. Mount the roller on the brackets.

                                                                                                                                      Window Treatments ■ 363

   326-371_11989.indd 363                                                                                                                                   5/23/09 9:08:19 AM

ects 362 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:363

         Roller Shade with Tabbed Hems

         A   dding a tabbed hem and decorative dowel
             to the bottom of a roller shade increases the
         stability and detail of the standard roller shade
                                                                                                 that are larger than the tab openings to hold the
                                                                                                 shade bottom securely in place. Paint or stain the
                                                                                                 dowel in a color that complements your fabric
         shape. Select a dowel with decorative finials                                           before insertion.

         A tabbed hem and decorative rod at the bottom of a window shade is one creative way to dress up this standard
         window treatment.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                                                                                          Length                                   Width

               Decorator Fabric                                                                           Finished length + 14"                    Finished width + 2"
               Fusible Backing                                                                            Finished length + 12"                    Finished width + 1"
               Tabs (desired number)                                                                      4½"                                      3"
               Facing Strip Note: cut from decorator fabric after it has been fused to backing            2"                                       Finished Width

  364 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 364 5/23/09 9:08:31 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:364

                ■ How to Make a Roller Shade with a Tabbed Hem
                   1                                            2                                                 3

                Cut tabs. Follow steps 1 to 3 on page        Fold the long edges of the tab to                 Fold the tabs in half; pin to the lower
                363, then cut the 2" facing strip from the   the center, wrong sides together; press.          edge of the shade on the right side, with
                lower edge of the fused shade.               Fuse in place using a 3⁄8" strip of fusible       the outer edges of the end tabs even
                                                             web. Repeat for all tabs.                         with the outer edge of the shade and
                                                                                                               spaced evenly. Baste in place. Pin facing
                                                                                                               to the lower edge of the shade, right
                                                                                                               sides together, matching raw edges
                                                                                                               and hemmed ends. Stitch a 3⁄8" seam
                                                                                                               through all layers.

                   4                                                                    5

                Turn facing to the wrong side; fuse in place at the upper            Insert the dowel into the tabs. Attach the finials. Secure
                edge and ends of facing using fusible web. Cut the dowel 1⁄8"        with thumbtacks on the back sides of the first and last tabs.
                shorter than the finished width of the shade. Paint the dowel        Mount and install the roller shade on the brackets.
                and finials, or apply stain and clear finish.

                                                                                                                                        Window Treatments ■ 365

   326-371_C51711.indd 365                                                                                                                                      6/3/09 2:24:6 PM

ects 364 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:365

         Coach Shades

         T   hese shades recall the window coverings on early
             twentieth-century stagecoaches; when installed
         in the home, however, coach shades are quite elegant
         and versatile. Fabric rolls up from the bottom and is
         controlled with loops of cord. Pair the shade with a
         top treatment to hide the mechanism, or make a shade
         and valance all in one.
              In this project, one fabric shows on the face of
         the shade; the other shows on the valance and the
         bottom roll. Two cords, strung through screw eyes
         on the underside of the mounting board, raise and
         lower the shade and wrap around an awning cleat to
         hold the shade at the desired level. Use firmly woven,
         lightweight to medium-weight fabric and avoid glazed
         or treated fabrics, which will not bond well with the
         fusible adhesive. Before you begin, cut, cover, and
         secure the mounting board above the window frame
         using angle irons and nuts and bolts. Measure for the             This coach shade plays a playful role in this aquatic-themed
         finished size of the shade and remove the nuts and                bathroom. Tied only in the center, the shade bends to create a
         bolts that hold the mounting board to the angle irons.            relaxed, casual mood.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                                Length                                                            Width

               Decorator Fabrics                Finished length + 20"                                             Finished width + 1"
               Fusible Backing                  Finished length + 20"                                             Finished width + 1"
               Cord 1                           Finished length × 3 + finished width
               Cord 2                           Finished length × 3

         ■ How to Make a Coach Shade
                                                                                                Fuse the adhesive to the wrong side
            1                                                                                   of one of the fabrics, following the
                                                                                                manufacturer’s instructions. Remove the
                                                                                                paper backing. Fuse the second fabric to
                                                                                                the first, wrong sides together. Allow the
                                                                                                fabric to cool completely.

  366 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_11989.indd 366 5/23/09 9:08:42 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:366

                   2                                                                                             3

                Mark the finished width on the shade. Square off the upper and lower edges,                   Cut the dowel to the shade width,
                using a carpenter’s square. Draw a decorative, symmetrical upper edge (this will              paint if desired, and staple the shade
                become the bottom of the valance). Cut along the marked lines and apply liquid                bottom to the dowel with the back of
                fray preventer or diluted fabric glue along the cut edges. Glue decorative trim to the        the shade facing up. Roll the shade
                valance edge on the side that will face the room. Drill pilot holes and insert three          around the dowel until the shade is the
                screw eyes, centered on the underside of the mounting board. Insert one screw                 desired finished length. Staple along the
                eye 1" from the end on the side of the shade where you want the cords to hang.                back of the dowel.
                Insert the other two screw eyes 3" from each end. Staple the shade over the top of a
                mounting board, allowing the desired length to hang forward for the valance. Pierce
                the fabric with an awl over the mounting holes.

                   4                                            5                                                6

                Tie a small loop in one end of both           Mount the shade on the angle irons,             Wrap the cords under the rolled
                Cords 1 and 2, leaving 6" tails. Staple the   making sure the bolts go through the            dowel, up over the shade front, and
                cords to the top of the mounting board        cord loops. Just before tightening the          through the screw eyes. String Cord 1
                with the loops over the bolt holes.           bolts, secure the loops with two or             also through the opposite screw eye
                                                              three knots.                                    and both cords through the end screw
                                                                                                              eye on the draw side. Knot the cords
                                                                                                              together just outside the last screw eye.
                                                                                                              Attach a small drapery pull to the ends.
                                                                                                              Secure an awning cleat to the edge of
                                                                                                              the window frame or to the wall. Pull
                                                                                                              gently on the cords to raise the shade.
                                                                                                              Wind the cord around the clean to hold
                                                                                                              in position.

                                                                                                                                       Window Treatments ■ 367

   326-371_C51711.indd 367                                                                                                                                    6/3/09 2:24:52 PM

ects 366 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:367

         Flat Roman Shades

         F   lat Roman shades are tailored window treatments
             that are flat and smooth when down. When
         raised, however, Roman shades pleat crisply instead
                                                                              and rows so the shade will fold neatly at regular
                                                                              intervals when raised.
                                                                                   Choose sturdy decorator fabric for a crisp look.
         of roll. The shade design is minimal—lining provides                 Roman shades show off large, allover prints nicely,
         added body, prevents fabric from fading, and creates                 but all patterns and styles work. Mount Roman
         a uniform appearance from the outside. A system of                   shades on a board either inside or outside the window
         evenly spaced rings through which cords are run on                   frame. For the project shown, follow the directions
         the back of the shade make it possible to raise and                  for installing a mounting board on page 359 before
         lower the shade. Rings are spaced in even columns                    you begin.

         With a large pattern and warm, earthy colors, these tailored shades are the perfect solution for these challenging large windows.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                                      Length                                          Width

               Decorator Fabric                       Finished length + 7"                            Finished width + 2"
               Lining Fabric                          Finished length + 3½"                           Finished width

  368 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_C51711.indd 368 6/3/09 2:25:11 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:368

                ■ How to Make a Flat Roman Shade
                   1                                                                           2

                Press under 1" on the sides of the shade. Cut strips of ¾"                  Press under ½" at the lower edge, then press under 3"
                paper-backed fusible adhesive the length of each side. Turn                 to form the hem pocket. Pin the hem in place. Edgestitch
                back the hem and place the strips near the cut edge. Press                  along the top fold of the hem through all layers. On the lining
                over the strips to fuse them to the hem allowance, following                side, draw a line across the top of the shade at the finished
                the manufacturer’s directions. Place the lining over the shade              length. Draw a second line 1½" above it (equal to the board
                fabric, wrong sides together, with the lower edge of the lining             projection). Cut off excess fabric along the top line. Pin the
                3½" above the lower edge of the shade fabric. Tuck the lining               layers together and finish the upper edges with wide zigzag
                under the side hems. Remove the paper backing from the                      stitches or serging.
                fusible adhesive and press to fuse the hems in place.

                   3                                       Finished width of shade - 1½" / 12 =                                         # of spaces between columns
                                                           # of spaces between columns + 1 =                                            # of columns
                                                           Finished length of shade (from top of hem to upper marked line) / 8" =       # of spaces between rows
                                                           Finished length of shade (from top of hem to upper marked line) /            Distance between rows
                                                           # of spaces =

                                                      Diagram the back of the shade on graph paper, indicating the finished length and width.
                                                      Mark the hem 3" from the lower edge. Plan the locations of rings in columns spaced 8 to 12"
                                                      apart, with the outer columns ¾" from the edges of the shade. Space them in even horizontal
                                                      rows 5 to 8" apart, with the bottom row at the top of the hem and the top row on the marked
                                                      line. Mark the placement for the rings on the lining side of the shade, following the diagram.
                                                      Pin horizontally through both layers of fabric at each mark.

                                                                                                                                                            (continued)

                                                                                                                                                 Window Treatments ■ 369

   326-371_11989.indd 369                                                                                                                                               5/23/09 9:09:1 AM

ects 368 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:369

            4                                                                  5

         Stitch a ring at each mark through both layers of fabric,           Insert the flat weight bar into the hem pocket. Slipstitch the
         stitching either by machine or by hand. Reinforce the rings         side openings closed.
         in the bottom row with extra stitches because they carry the
         weight of the shade.

            6                                                                  7

         Staple the shade to the top of the mounting board, aligning         On the side where you want the cords to hang, run
         the marked line to the front edge of the board. Drill pilot holes   cord through the first column of rings, through the top screw
         and insert screw eyes, centered on the underside of the             eye, and at least halfway down the side. Cut the cord at the
         mounting board, aligning them to the columns of rings.              desired length and tie a nonslip knot at the bottom ring. Repeat
                                                                             for each column in order, running the cords also through the
                                                                             previous screw eyes. Apply glue to the knots for security. Install
                                                                             the mounting board.

  370 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

326-371_C51711.indd 370 6/3/09 2:25:29 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:370

                   8

                Adjust the cords with the shade down so the tension on all cords is equal. Tie the cords in a knot just below the first screw eye.
                Braid the cords, insert them through a drapery pull, if desired, and knot and trim the ends. Secure an awning cleat to the edge of
                the window frame or on the wall. Pull gently on the cords to raise the shade and wind the cord around the cleat to hold in position.
                Train the shade by raising it and pulling the excess fabric forward to form gentle rolls. Leave the shade in the raised position for a
                few days to set the folds.

                      Roman Shade Variations ▸

                      Flat roman shades can be customized in countless creative ways. Pair them with matching goblet-pleated draperies
                      (left) or add a beautifully shaped hem with decorative trim or tassels, as in the example at right. Mounted on French
                      doors, these shades sit close to the glass but clear most of it when raised, giving the illusion of added height to the
                      room's centerpiece.

                                                                                                                                       Window Treatments ■ 371

   326-371_C51711.indd 371                                                                                                                                    6/3/09 2:25:54 PM

ects 370 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:371

         Butterfly Shades

         A    butterfly shade has the smoothness of a flat
              Roman shade with draped softness at the lower
         edge. As the shade is drawn up, the folds stack in
         the center and flare at the sides, creating a butterfly
         effect. Choose firmly woven lightweight to medium-
         weight decorator fabric for this project. Butterfly
         shades should be mounted so the finished length from
         the top of the mounting board to the highest point of
         the hem is evenly divisible by six. The swagged fabric
         at the bottom of the shade will hang below the sill.
              Before you begin, cut the mounting board and
         cover it with fabric. Secure angle irons to the bottom
         of the board, near the ends, and in the center, if
         necessary. Mount the board, centered above the
         window frame, as on page 259. Measure for the
         finished size of the shade, and then remove the screws
         that hold the mounting board to the angle irons,
         leaving the angle irons in the wall.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                          Length                     Width

               Decorator Finished length + 26" +     Finished width + 2×
               Fabric    mounting board length       mounting board width + 2"
               Lining     Cut length                Cut width
               Fabric     of decorator fabric + 1¼" of decorator fabric – 3"

         When your view isn’t beautiful, a well-dressed window
         is especially important. This plaid shade is mounted inside
         the deep frame, showing off the decorative wood trim. Bead
         trim along the lower edge of the shade draws attention to the
         dramatic curve of the fabric.

  372 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_C51711.indd 372 6/3/09 2:26:56 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:372

                ■ How to Make a Butterfly Shade
                   1                                             2                                                3

                Mark a line across the wrong side              Tack through the dowel pocket                   Mark placement for two columns of
                of the lining 265⁄8" from the bottom. Fold     at the ends of the dowel to hold the            rings, each positioned one-sixth of the
                the lining, right sides together, along the    dowel in place. Press under ¾" twice            shade width from the sides. Space rings
                marked line; pin. Stitch 5⁄8" from the fold,   on the sides of the shade fabric. Place         6" apart vertically. Place two rings at
                forming the dowel pocket. Press the            the lining on the shade fabric, wrong           the dowel; top rings should be 6" below
                pocket toward the bottom. Insert the           sides together, matching edges; with            the upper marked line. Mark placement
                dowel into the pocket and slide it to the      the lining tucked under the side hems,          for two rings in the center of the lower
                center of the lining.                          pin. Blindstitch side hems. Press up 1" of      hem, at the edge of the side hems.
                                                               the lower edge twice; pin. Stitch. Finish       Space the remaining three rings evenly
                                                               upper edge. Mark a line from the upper          between the dowel pocket ring and the
                                                               edge a distance equal to the projection         bottom ring.
                                                               of the mounting board.

                   4                                                                     5

                Center the shade on top of the mounting board, aligning               Tie the lower five rings of each row together securely. Apply
                the marked line to the top front edge of the board. Staple the        glue to the knots and ends of the cords to prevent them from
                shade to the mounting board; wrap the sides over the ends of          slipping. Reattach the mounting board and finish as in step 8
                the board and staple in place forming squared corners. Drill          on page 371.
                pilot holes and insert screw eyes, centered on the underside
                of the mounting board, aligning them to the columns of rings.
                Install a third screw eye 1" from the end of the board on the
                draw side. Run cords as in step 7 on page 370.

                                                                                                                                        Window Treatments ■ 373

   372-411_C51711.indd 373                                                                                                                                     6/3/09 2:27:21 PM

ects 372 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:373

         Cloud Shades

         A     cloud shade is gathered across the top and
               hangs as a softly shirred, translucent panel when
         lowered full length. When raised, the bottom of
                                                                                                Ring Placement ▸
                                                                                                Width of hemmed panel -            Distance between ring columns
         the shade forms soft, cloudlike poufs. Cloud shade
                                                                                                2" / # of poufs desired =
         headings are gathered or softly pleated using a styling
         tape. Several styles are available; select a style for the                             Length of shade                    # of spaces between rows
         amount of fullness your shade will require. This shade                                 (top of hem to bottom              (round up)
         is also made extra long to create the “cloud” effect.                                  of styling tape) / 8" =
         Space poufs evenly or create one large pouf in the
                                                                                                Length of shade (top of hem to     Distance between rows
         center, framed with smaller poufs. An odd number                                       bottom of styling tap) / # of
         of poufs generally looks more appealing than an even                                   spaces between rows =
         number. Choose lightweight, soft fabric for a cloud
         shade. Lining is not necessary.                                                        Use the table above to determine the placement
              Before you begin, cut and cover the mounting                                      of rings. Mark ring placement on the panel. Stitch a
                                                                                                ring at each mark through both layers of fabric, with
         board, and secure with angle irons above the window
                                                                                                a machine or by hand. Do not stitch rings at the base
         frame. Remove the screws that hold the mounting                                        of the styling tape. Reinforce the rings in the bottom
         board to the angle irons, leaving the angle irons on                                   row with extra stitches.
         the wall.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                  Length                             Width

               Decorator Fabric   Finished length + 15"              Finished width + (2 × projection of the mounting board) × fullness required for styling tape + 4"
               Weight Rod Cover   1" larger than rod circumference   Finished width + 1"

                                                                                                                    The softly gathered, casual appearance
                                                                                                                    of this cloud shade and the tone-on-tone
                                                                                                                    color scheme make for a quiet, relaxing
                                                                                                                    living area.

  374 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_C51711.indd 374 6/3/09 2:27:41 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:374

                ■ How to Make a Cloud Shade
                   1                                                                  2

                Seam panel as necessary using French seams. Press under             Fold the tape and panel to the wrong side, forming a ¼"
                1" twice on the sides and stitch. Press under a 1" double-fold      fold above the upper edge of the tape. Press the fold. Pin
                hem pocket at the lower edge. Stitch along the upper edge           the tape in place and stitch to the panel, stitching next to
                of pocket. Cut styling tape to the width of the hemmed panel        the cords. Stitch all stitching lines in the same directions to
                plus 2". Turn under 1" on the ends, keeping the cords free.         avoid ripples.
                Place the tape right side up on the right side of the panel,
                aligning the lower edge of the tape to the upper edge of the
                panel. Finish the edges together using overcast stitches.

                   3                                                                  4

                Knot the cords together or in pairs at each end of the              Insert the covered rod into the hem pocket, distributing
                styling tape. At one end, pull evenly on the cords to gather        fullness evenly. Stipstitch the hem ends closed. Tack the
                the fabric, adjusting the width of the heading to the finished      hem to the rod cover at the ends and near each ring to hold
                width of the shade, including returns. Knot the cords together      spacing. Cut the hook and loop tape to the finished width of
                to close the shade. Cut off excess cords or wrap them in a          the shade; attach the hook side to the mounting board and the
                circle and safety-pin them behind the heading. Fold the weight      loop side to the upper edge of the styling tape. Follow steps 7
                rod cover strip in half lengthwise, wrong sides together. Stitch    and 8 on pages 370 to 371 to finish. In step 8, leave a long tail
                along the long side; turn the tube right side out. Insert the rod   at each bottom knot. Using the tails, tie together the bottom
                and stitch the ends closed.                                         three rings of each column to secure the bottom poufs.

                                                                                                                                      Window Treatments ■ 375

   372-411_11989.indd 375                                                                                                                                  5/23/09 11:56:55 AM

ects 374 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:375

         Balloon Shades

         T   ailored box pleats meld with luxurious poufs
             to create the ever-popular balloon shade.
         With its split personality, a balloon shade can be
         equally at home in a living room, a breakfast nook,
         or a child’s bedroom. Box pleats give this shade
         controlled fullness when lowered and a billowy, soft
         effect when raised. Evenly spaced pleats should
         be about 12" apart. Lightweight, soft fabrics work
         best for the gentle gathers of this shade. Lining is
         optional. Mount the shade on a mounting board
         outside the window frame. Attach the mounting
         board to the wall, then remove the screws that hold
         the board to the angle irons, leaving the angle irons                                  The gentle swags that form at the bottom of this balloon shade
         on the wall.                                                                           as it is raised accent the structured architecture of the room.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                                 Length                                                      Width

               Decorator Fabric                  Finished length + 12" + projection of mounting board        2 × finished width + 4" (do not cut until step 2)
               Facing Strip                      2"                                                          Finished width + 1"
               Adding Machine Paper                                                                          Decorator fabric cut width

         ■ How to Make a Balloon Shade
            1                                                                                      2
               Length of mounting board / 12 =        # of poufs (round up)
               Cut width of shade – 4"—width          Inches of fabric
               of mounting board /                    that must be folded out
               # of poufs =                           in each pleat.

         Cut the strip of adding machine paper; this will be a                                  Seam fabric widths together. Trim the seam allowances
         pattern to help determine the pleats. Mark a 2" hem allowance                          to ¼", finish them together, and press to one side. Place the
         at each end of the pattern. Mark pleat lines, as determined by                         pattern on the fabric, aligning the seams to points in the
         the chart above. Fold the pattern into pleats and measure to                           pattern where they will be hidden in pleats, and mark the
         check for accuracy.                                                                    fabric at the pattern ends. Cut the fabric to the width of the
                                                                                                pattern. Press under 1" twice on the sides of the panel and
                                                                                                stitch the hems. Place the pattern on the shade at the lower
                                                                                                edge. Mark the pleat fold lines. Repeat at the upper edge.

  376 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 376 5/23/09 11:57:6 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:376

                   3                                                                     4

                Pin the pleats in place along the lower edge; the side hems            Pin the pleats in place along the upper edge. Extend the
                will be hidden under the half-pleats at the sides of the shade.        hemmed edges away from the pleat fold a distance equal to
                Stitch ½" from the lower edge to secure the pleats.                    the projection of the mounting board. Stitch a distance from
                                                                                       the upper edge equal to the projection of the mounting board.
                                                                                       Finish the upper edges together. Pin pleats in place from top to
                                                                                       bottom. The shade will be slightly wide at the top. Press pleats.
                                                                                       Press ½" under on the long edge of the facing strip. Pin the raw
                                                                                       edge to the bottom of the shade, right sides together, with the
                                                                                       ends extending equally. Stitch a ½" seam.

                   5                                            6                                                     7
                                                                  Length of shade       # of spaces
                                                                  (top of the pocket    between rows
                                                                  to stitching line     (round up)
                                                                  at the top) / 6" =
                                                                  Length of shade       Inches between
                                                                  (top of the pocket    rows
                                                                  to stitching line
                                                                  at the top) /
                                                                  # of spaces
                                                                  between rows =

                Press the seam toward the facing.             Mark the placement for the rings                     Finish as in steps 6 to 8 on pages
                Turn the ends over the seam allowance,        in columns at the side hems and at the               370 to 371. In step 6, insert the end
                then turn the facing to the wrong side.       center of each pleat. Mark the bottom                eye screws 1" from the ends of the
                Edgestitch along the fold, forming a          row at the upper edge of the pocket                  mounting board. In step 7, leave a
                weight rod pocket.                            and space rings according to the chart               long tail at each bottom knot. Using
                                                              above. Stitch rings to the shade at the              the tails, tie together the bottom three
                                                              marks, taking care not to catch the                  rings of each column to secure the
                                                              pleat fabric in the stitches. Insert the             bottom poufs.
                                                              weight bar into the pocket. Slipstitch
                                                              the ends closed. Staple the shade to the
                                                              mounting board; wrap the sides over
                                                              the ends and staple in place.

                                                                                                                                            Window Treatments ■ 377

   372-411_11989.indd 377                                                                                                                                        5/23/09 11:57:16 AM

ects 376 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:377

         Curtain Styles

         B    efore you decide what style of curtain will work the
              best for you, consider the functional requirements
         of the room. For example, lined curtains that extend
                                                                              nook to invite light to pour in, while protecting
                                                                              your privacy. Café curtains frame a window without
                                                                              interfering with the sunlight that makes a kitchen so
         above and beyond the window block the most light, and                inviting. Experiment with color, fabric choice, and
         may be the best choice for bedrooms. Use the same                    pairing curtains with blinds, shades, or top treatments
         style with a sheer fabric in a sitting room or breakfast             to best suit the form and function of any space.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Decorator fabric               Curtain hardware,               Optional Materials                  Fusible interfacing
               Lining fabric (optional)         as needed (grommets,          Swinging extender                   Grommet heading tape
               Decorative rod                   decorative hooks, clip-          rod set                          Decorative rod
                  or mounting board             on or sew-on rings)           Safety pins                            with finials or elbows
               Installation hardware          Drapery weights (for            Double-stick                        Tieback holders
               Stapler and staples              floor-length curtains)           carpet tape                         or wooden blocks
               Sewing notions

         Curtain colors and patterns affect a room’s overall feel dramatically. Dark colors absorb light and therefore pull a room in,
         making it feel smaller (left photo). This is a good effect for formal dining areas or spaces you wish to feel cozy or warm. White
         curtains reflect light, making rooms feel bright and therefore more spacious (right photo). This effect is good for areas you would
         like to feel clean, cheerful, social, or contemporary.

  378 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_C51711.indd 378 6/3/09 2:29:41 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:378

                ■ Styles to Consider

                Basic curtains are panels with clip-on      Tab-top curtains are panels of fabric           Rod-pocket curtains are held in place
                or sew-on rings. There are many styles      trimmed with tabs, loops, or ties that          by inserting a curtain rod into a pocket
                of rings and clips. Depending on the        slip over decorative rods. They can be          sewn into the header (the top of the
                rings or clips you pick, the curtains       pulled open and closed, but the tabs            curtain). Although they can be opened
                can hang from a rod or from high-           don’t always slide smoothly. Attach tabs        and closed fairly easily, they are mostly
                tension string.                             to rings or clips to remedy this problem.       considered stationary because it is time
                                                                                                            consuming to arrange and rearrange their
                                                                                                            pleats each time they are moved. Many
                                                                                                            sheers are constructed with rod pockets.

                Café curtains cover only a portion of the window—usually           Stationary curtains don’t close at all and serve no function
                only the lower half. They’re often made of sheer fabric and        beyond decoration. Typically, they consist of one or two
                hung by rings on small metal rods mounted inside or directly       panels—with or without valances—hanging on each side of
                on the window frame. Café curtains create a stylish look but       a window. Stationary curtains are easy to make, easy to hang,
                don’t interfere with the light or view from the window. They       and inexpensive because they use so little fabric.
                can be opened and closed easily, but by design they are not
                handled often.

                                                                                                                                     Window Treatments ■ 379

   372-411_11989.indd 379                                                                                                                                 5/23/09 11:57:51 AM

ects 378 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:379

         Hanging Curtains

         H    anging curtains is a simple project that can
              be finished quickly and cleanly with careful
         measurements and preparations. Before you begin,
                                                                                    Tools & Materials ▸
         decide whether you’d like your curtains to open and                        Curtain rods                         Self-tapping hollow
         close, or if they will be stationary curtains; this will                   Curtain                                 wall anchors
         help determine what kind of hardware you will select.                      Sheer                                Sheer rod hardware
         Also, pay careful attention to the finish and style of                     Decorative curtain clips             Painter’s tape
         decorator hardware to ensure a good match with other                       Decorative curtain rod               Tape measure
         hardware in your room.                                                       hardware                           Drill

         Choose your curtains and hardware carefully to ensure a smooth installation. Here, the rod-pocket curtain rod needed to
         be shorter than the decorative rod so that only the decorative rod is seen in the finished installation. Planning out such details will
         save you time and money.

  380 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_C51711.indd 380 6/3/09 2:30:6 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:380

                ■ How to Hang Curtains
                   1

                Measure the height and width of the window. Make a quick diagram of the window and note the measurements you took.
                Before purchasing curtains or hardware, decide where you want the curtains to start and stop, and indicate those measurements
                on your diagram. Attach the brackets for the sheer rod. Place the sheer rod and check for level. Adjust if necessary.

                   2                                                                3
                                       Curtain rod

                       Sheer rod

                Attach the brackets for the decorative curtain rod a few         Place the curtain over the sheer rod, and then place
                inches outside and above the sheer brackets. Use wall anchors    the rod for the sheer into the mounting plate. Repeat for the
                if the bracket is not located over a stud.                       decorative curtains and rod.

                                                                                                                                   Window Treatments ■ 381

   372-411_11989.indd 381                                                                                                                               5/23/09 11:58:38 AM

ects 380 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:381

         Draped
         Window Treatments

         S   oft, draping window treatments beautify your
             window as they invite light to spill into the room,
         and can be made quickly from sheer or lightweight
         reversible fabrics. These treatments are made
         without side hems or seams, so it’s important to use
         fabrics with neat, narrow selvages. Lace fabrics with
         finished side edges work nicely for this project. The
         number of fabric widths needed vary from window
         to window; experiment with inexpensive fabric to
         determine the number of lengths you’ll need before
         you begin.
              Mount this style of treatment on a decorative
         rod just above the window frame, or tie the fabric
         to decorative knobs or hooks for a unique flair and
         innovative draping style.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Sheer to lightweight                   Mounting brackets,
                 reversible fabric                      or decorative
                 with narrow                            hooks or knobs
                 selvages or lace                     Decorative
                 with finished edges                    tieback holders
               Decorative rod                         Coordinating
                 or pole                                ribbon or cord

                                                                                   Draped window treatments have a casual feel and
                                                                                   simplistic beauty. Add drama by using heavier fabrics or
                                                                                   lush silks.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                                                           Length

               Pole or rod-mounted, to puddle on the floor                 2× desired finished length + 40"
               Pole or rod-mounted, free-hanging straight lower edges      Hang a length of twill tape over the pole to desired length with the lower edges even.
                                                                           Cut fabric 2" longer than tape.
               Hook or knob-mounted, to puddle on the floor                2× desired finished length + 40"
               Hook or knob-mounted, free-hanging uneven lower edges       2× desired finished length + 2"

  382 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 382 5/23/09 11:58:49 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:382

                ■ How to Install a Draped Window Treatment on a Rod or Pole
                   1                                                                 2

                Press cut edge under ½" twice; stitch to make double-              Hang fabric over rod, and then form two panels, with lower
                fold hem. Repeat for opposite cut end, pressing fabric in          edges even and hem allowances facing the window.
                opposite direction.

                ■ How to Install a Draped Window Treatment on Hooks or Knobs
                   1                                                                 2

                Install decorative hooks or knobs on or just above the             Hem the cut edges of fabric, as in step 1, above. Fold the
                window frame; predrill holes to avoid splitting woodwork and       fabric in half, forming two panels, with the lower edges even
                use appropriate anchors if installing hanger bolts into drywall.   and hem allowances facing the window. Grasp the outer
                Position one at each outer edge, with the remaining hooks or       edge at the fold; tie to the hook or knob, 2 to 3" from the fold.
                knobs evenly spaced. Tie a decorative cord or ribbon to each       Repeat at the opposite side and again at the center. Repeat for
                hook or knob, leaving long tails.                                  any additional panels.

                                                                                                                                     Window Treatments ■ 383

   372-411_11989.indd 383                                                                                                                                  5/23/09 11:59:0 AM

ects 382 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:383

         ■ Draped Window Treatment Finishing Styles
          Tiebacks

         Install tieback holders at the desired height, even with       Gather up fabric to the opposite edge at a 45° angle
         outer edge of the window treatment. Grasp the outer edge of    toward the floor. Secure gathered panel to holder. Repeat for
         the front fabric panel even with the holder.                   the opposite side of back panel, if desired. This finished look
                                                                        can be used with draped treatments on knobs or hooks as well.

          Tent Flap Sides

         Grasp the outer edge of the front fabric panel; pull to the    Install the tieback holder or tenter hook; tie the fabric
         opposite side, adjusting position of the pulled-back edge as   edge to the holder using ribbon or cord. Pull back and secure
         desired. Mark the wall for placement of tieback holder or      the opposite edge of the back panel, if desired.
         tenter hook; mark fabric edge with pin.

  384 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 384 5/23/09 11:59:9 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:384

                 Center Knot

                Grasp outer edges of the front fabric panel about 18" below       Tie a knot in the gathered front panel; adjust sides of the
                the desired knot position. Gather up fabric on each side toward   panel above the knot as desired.
                the center, and upward toward the desired knot position.

                 Side Knots

                Install tenter hooks at desired knot height, even with the        Gather up fabric to the opposite edge at a 45° angle
                outer edge of the window treatment. Grasp the outer edge of       from floor. Tie a knot in the panel; secure the knot to a tenter
                the front fabric panel even with the holder.                      hook. Make a side knot for the opposite side of the back panel,
                                                                                  if desired.

                                                                                                                                   Window Treatments ■ 385

   372-411_11989.indd 385                                                                                                                               5/23/09 11:59:17 AM

ects 384 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:385

         No-Sew Side Panels

         F   or a no-sew window treatment with a light,
             unstructured appearance, drape soft, lightweight
         fabric panels over swinging extenders or crane rods,
                                                                                 the window view. Decorative utility crane rods
                                                                                 are available from specialty window hardware
                                                                                 suppliers, through decorators, or sometimes
         to create a deep valance and elegant floor puddles.                     at antique shops or thrift stores. Choose a
         This treatment is suitable for full coverage on narrow                  soft, lightweight, reversible fabric that has an
         windows or as side panels on wider windows.                             attractive or minimal selvage. If the fabric ravels,
              Swinging extender rods are mounted to a                            you may want to finish the lower edge of the
         bracket on one end and can swing out to expose                          drapery panel.

                                                                                                     Side panels like this are a perfect
                                                                                                     project for the decorator with no sewing
                                                                                                     experience and drape beautifully around
                                                                                                     any window that needs dressing up.

               No-sew Side Panels Cutting Guide ▸
                                                 Length                                                         Width

               Decorator Fabric                  Top of rod to the floor + 60"                                  Width of fabric

  386 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 386 5/23/09 11:59:25 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:386

                ■ How to Make Draped Side Panels
                   1                                                                 2

                Cut and apply double-stick tape to the back side of the            Gather fabric loosely about 36" below the rod, using hands;
                rod. Drape the upper edge of fabric over the rod, with about 4"    fold the bottom of the panel up and over the rod, with hand
                folded to the back side; secure fabric to the tape, distributing   gathers at the top of the rod forming an 18" valance.
                fullness evenly.

                   3                                                                 4

                Arrange the valance, distributing the fullness evenly and          Arrange the bottom of the panel on the floor, draping it
                folding in the selvages.                                           loosely and concealing the raw edges and selvages of the fabric.

                                                                                                                                    Window Treatments ■ 387

   372-411_11989.indd 387                                                                                                                                5/23/09 11:59:28 AM

ects 386 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:387

         Basic Curtains

         F   lat-panel curtains are one of the most basic, easy-
             to-make window treatment styles. Surprisingly,
         they are also one of the most versatile. Adjust fullness
                                                                                      gracefully. Sheer, lightweight fabrics swing gracefully
                                                                                      and fall in soft puddles. Choose to line or not line
                                                                                      your panels for privacy and light filtration, depending
         or ring placement for very different looks, from flat to                     upon the needs of your room. Hang curtains from
         neatly folded; from controlled dips to softly swooping                       the rod with clip-on or sew-on curtain rings, which
         curves. Fabric selection also plays a large role in your                     are available in many styles. Whatever your window
         finished look: Firm, medium-weight fabrics create                            treatment needs, many different looks can be achieved
         a simple, tailored look with an upper edge that dips                         with these simple panels.

                                                                                             Fabric Fullness
                                                                                             & Hardware Spacing ▸

                                                                                             For a flatter panel, 1½-times fullness is used (left),
                                                                                             meaning the width of the curtain measures 1½-times
                                                                                             the width of the rod. For a fuller panel, use 2-times
                                                                                             fullness or more (right).

                                                                                             For a controlled look along the top of the curtain,
                                                                                             use more rings and space them closer together
                                                                                             (left). For a soft look, use few rings spaced farther
         For a simple, controlled look, only one and one-half times                          apart (right).
         fullness is used for basic curtains.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                        Length                                                                          Width

               Decorator Fabric         Finished length + 22 to 28" (depending on desired floor puddle)                 Finished width × desired fullness

  388 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 388 5/23/09 11:59:35 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:388

                ■ How to Sew a Curtain Panel
                   1                                                                  2

                Unlined panel. Seam the fabric widths, if more than one            Plan and pin-mark the spacing for the rings or grommets
                width is desired for the panel. Press under 1" twice at the        at the top of the curtain panel. As shown opposite, if fewer
                lower edge of the panel; stitch a double-fold hem. Repeat for a    rings or grommets are used, spaced farther apart, more fabric
                1" double-fold hem at the upper edge, then at the sides.           drapes between them. For a more controlled look, use more
                                                                                   rings or grommets, spaced closer together.

                   3                                            4                                              5

                Check the drape of the panel by              Attach the grommets to the top of              Arrange the fabric to puddle onto the
                securing it at pin marks to the side of      the panel at the markings, following the       floor, if desired.
                an ironing board, with markings spaced       manufacturer’s directions. Insert hooks
                the desired distance apart. Adjust the       into the grommets, or attach sew-on
                number of rings or grommets and the          or clip-on rings. Hang panels from the
                spacing between them, if necessary.          decorative rod.
                Use an even number of grommets if a
                rod will be inserted through them.

                                                                                                                                     Window Treatments ■ 389

   372-411_11989.indd 389                                                                                                                                 5/23/09 11:59:38 AM

ects 388 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:389

         Grommet Curtains

         F   lat curtain panels with grommets in the top hem
             can be hung from a decorative rod with cording
         laced through the grommets or with fancy S-hooks.
                                                                    Cutting Guide ▸
                                                                               Length                   Width
         Grommet curtains with large grommets can be speared
         by the rod, as in the project shown here. In this          Decorator Finished length + lower Grommet tape + 6"
         technique, it’s important to have an even number of        Fabric    hem allowance + 2"
         grommets so both sides of the curtain turn toward the      Grommet    Standard                 Finished width × 2. Measure
         wall. How close or far the grommets are spaced to one      Tape                                this length of tape: you must
         another is completely up to you: wide spacing will allow                                       have an even number of
         the curtain to slouch between grommets, closer spacing                                         grommets and must begin and
         will hold the upper edge in a straighter line, or use                                          end 2" beyond a space tab on
         grommet tape, which determines the grommet spacing                                             each edge.
         for you. Use medium-weight fabric for this project.

                                                                                       These grommet curtains combine
                                                                                       sheers and sun-blocking panels for a
                                                                                       multipurpose window treatment. The
                                                                                       casual puddling on the floor adds to the
                                                                                       carefree attitude.

  390 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 390 5/23/09 11:59:51 AM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:390

                ■ How to Make Grommet Curtains
                   1                                                                  2

                Seam the fabric widths together for each panel. Finish              Turn under the upper edge 2" and press, then pin the
                the seams together and press toward the side of the panel. Lay      grommet tape tabs up, on the wrong side of the panel, aligning
                out grommet tape along the upper edge. Adjust placement so          the cut ends to the inner folds of the side hems, with the
                the seams fall between pairs of grommets. Mark the curtain          upper edge of the tape 1½" from the upper pressed fold. Stitch
                panel 3" beyond the ends of the tape and trim excess fabric         close to the top and bottom edges of the tape. Insert a drapery
                evenly down the sides. Press under the lower edge the full          weight between the layers of the lower hem and tack in place.
                amount of the hem allowance. Unfold and turn the cut edge           Stitch side hems, using a blindstitch or straight stitch. Straight
                back to the fold line. Press. For floor-length curtains with more   stitch the hems over the grommet tape, keeping the spacer
                than one width, tack a drapery weight at the base of each           tabs free.
                seam. Refold lower edge and stitch. Press under 3" on each
                side, then unfold and turn the cut edge to the fold line. Press
                outer fold and repeat on the other side. Unfold side hems.

                   3                                             4                                              5

                Trim away the fabric from inside the          Working on a flat surface, clip the            Hook the plastic spacers together
                grommet openings.                             decorative rings over the grommet              to ripple-fold the curtain. Insert the rod
                                                              openings, encasing the raw edges of            through the grommets and hang.
                                                              the fabric.

                                                                                                                                      Window Treatments ■ 391

   372-411_11989.indd 391                                                                                                                                  5/23/09 12:26:21 PM

ects 390 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:391

         Loop-tab Curtains

         T   ab curtains draw the eye upward with the no-frill
             appeal of fabric tabs, loops, or ties that hold this
         style of curtain to the rod. Tab curtains effortlessly
         blend form and function and are easy to make and
         install. This style is not intended to be opened and
         closed repeatedly, as the friction would put too
         much strain on the tabs; usually, tab curtains are
         stationary panels on the side or are drawn to one side
         on a tieback to let light into the room. Tab curtains
         can be lined or unlined, depending on the fabric
         selection and the degree of light control and privacy
         required. Medium-weight fabrics will keep the
         upper edge of the curtain in a tailored line, whereas
         lightweight or sheer fabrics will drape elegantly                           Earth tones of cream, brown, and yellow create a calm and
         between tabs.                                                               inviting space. Add button accents for understated detail.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                                Length                                                                  Width

               Decorator Fabric                 Finished length + bottom hem allowance + 3"                             Finished width × 2
               Tabs                             Desired length (see step 2, below)                                      Desired tab width × 2 + 1"
               Facing strip                     3"                                                                      Cut width of curtain panel

         ■ How to Make Loop-tab Curtains
            1                                                                          2

         On the facing strip, press under ½" on the long side and                    Determine the tab length by pinning a strip of fabric over
         each short end. Press double-fold lower and side hems of                    the rod and marking the desired length with a pin. Add ½" for
         curtain. Stitch lower hem only.                                             seam allowance. Cut tabs to the measured length and two
                                                                                     times the desired width plus 1".

  392 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 392 5/23/09 12:26:51 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:392

                   3                                                               4

                Fold each tab in half lengthwise, right sides together.          Fold each tab in half so the raw edges are aligned. Pin or
                Stitch ½" seam along cut edge; sew from one tab to the next,     baste tabs in place on the right side of the curtain, aligning raw
                using continuous stitching. Cut tabs apart and turn right side   edges of tabs with upper edge of curtain. Place end tabs even
                out. Center the seam in back of each tab; press.                 with side hem fold line of curtain.

                   5                                                               6

                Pin facing to the upper edge of the curtain, right sides         Press facing to the wrong side of the curtain so tabs
                together, so the raw edges are aligned and the tabs are          extend upward. Fold curtain side hems under facing, covering
                sandwiched between the facing and the curtain. Stitch a ½"       the seam allowance. Stitch the side hems. Slipstitch facing to
                seam with the curtain side hems extended.                        the curtain. Insert the curtain rod through tabs and hang.

                                                                                                                                   Window Treatments ■ 393

   372-411_C51734.indd 393                                                                                                                              6/11/09 12:18:22 PM

ects 392 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51734) #175 Dtp:119 Page:393

         Rod-pocket Curtains

         R   od-pocket curtains are often chosen for a stationary
             window treatment that is understated and easy to
         sew. With ample fullness and a deep, ruffly heading,
                                                                                  top and bottom of the rod-pocket keep the rod
                                                                                  in place. Rod-pocket curtains are extremely
                                                                                  versatile and work with a wide variety of fabrics
         classic rod-pocket curtains take on a feminine, romantic                 and rod styles. Use a rod with elbows to create
         appearance. With less fullness and a shorter heading,                    returns, where the sides of the curtain wrap
         the look becomes tailored and robust. Or eliminate the                   around the panel toward the wall. Or use a rod
         heading ruffle altogether for relaxed curtains that fit                  with finials for a decorative finish. Sheers or
         snugly over the rod with a sleek, streamlined appearance.                medium-weight fabrics drape and ruffle very
              The rod-pocket is the “tunnel” where the                            differently, and lining can be added for light control
         rod or pole is inserted; stitching lines at the                          and privacy.

         Add a ruffle to the sides of panels for a romantic, airy flair.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                                Length                                                   Width

               Decorator Fabric                 Finished length + lower hem allowance +                  Finished width × desired fullness
                                                depth of heading and rod pocket + ½"

  394 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_C51711.indd 394 6/3/09 2:30:52 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:394

                ■ How to Make Rod-pocket Curtains
                   1                                                                   2

                Seam fabric widths together. Finish the seam allowances              Press under 3" on one side, then unfold the pressed edge
                together, then press toward the side of the panel. Press the         and turn the cut edge back, aligning it to the fold. Press.
                lower edge the full amount of the hem allowance; unfold              Tack a drapery weight between the layers of the lower hem.
                pressed edge and turn cut edge back, aligning it to the fold         Refold the edge. Blindstitch. Repeat for each curtain panel
                line. Press. If making floor-length curtains with more than one      side. Press under ½" on the upper edge. Then press under an
                width, tack a drapery weight to the upper layer of fabric at         amount equal to the rod-pocket depth plus the heading depth.
                the base of each seam. Refold the lower edge, encasing the           Measure the distance from the wall to the center of the rod.
                weights. Pin. Stitch.                                                Unfold the upper edge of the curtain on the return side of the
                                                                                     panel. Measure from the side of the curtain a distance equal
                                                                                     to this measurement; mark the center of the rod pocket on the
                                                                                     right side.

                   3                                                                   4

                Cut a 1 ft. strip of fusible interfacing, 1" longer than the         Stitch close to the first fold; stitch again at the depth of
                depth of the rod pocket. Fuse the strip to the wrong side of         the heading using tape on the bed of the sewing machine as a
                the curtain panel, centering it directly under the mark made in      stitching guide.
                step 2. On the right side of the panel, stitch a buttonhole at the
                mark, from the top to the bottom of the rod pocket. Refold the
                upper edge of the panel along the pressed lines; pin.

                                                                                                                                      Window Treatments ■ 395

   372-411_11989.indd 395                                                                                                                                  5/23/09 12:27:35 PM

ects 394 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:395

         Tent-flap Curtains

         T   rim, tailored tent-flap curtains are great for
             bedrooms, bathrooms, or home theaters, where
         you want optimum light control and privacy. These flat
                                                                                   grommet, or metal ring over a button or small wall hook.
                                                                                   Choose medium-weight, firmly woven decorator fabrics
                                                                                   for both the front and the lining. If you choose two print
         panels are lined with decorative fabric because both                      fabrics, layer them and hold them up to the light to see
         sides show when the flaps are open, and are a great                       if the pattern from the back fabric shows through. You
         way to use two coordinating prints!                                       may need to interline the two layers with drapery lining
              Tent flaps can be drawn back in a variety of ways                    or blackout lining to minimize this issue. Install tent-
         and are typically secured by slipping a buttonhole,                       flap curtains on a mounting board and angle irons.

         The simple styling and decorative drapery holdback dress up this window with a deep ledge.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                          Length                                                               Width

               Decorator Fabric           Top of mounting board to desired finished length +                   Mounting board / 2 + return + 2"
                                          mounting board projection + ½"

  396 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 396 5/23/09 12:27:57 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:396

                ■ How to Make Tent-flap Curtains
                   1                                                                  2

                Pin face fabric to lining, right sides together, and stitch three   Mark finished length across the top of the panels, making
                sides in ½" seam, leaving the upper edge open. Press one            sure that both panels are exactly even and that the end is at a
                seam allowance back to make it easier to turn a crisp, sharp        perfect right angle to sides.
                edge. Trim the seam allowance across corners, turn panels
                right side out, and press.

                   3                                                                  4

                Align panel length marking with the front edge of the               Mount the board with angle irons positioned at the edge
                mounting board. Staple panel to board, starting at return. At       of window frame.
                the corner, make a diagonal fold to form a miter. Panels overlap
                about 1" at the center.

                   5                                                                  6

                Fold the front edges of the panels back to the side edges           Hand-tack two layers together and finish with decorative
                and adjust the opening. Measure to be sure they are even on         or covered button. Or hand-tack ties at the front edge and
                both sides.                                                         sides. To maintain projection at the sides, attach the panel to
                                                                                    the a tieback holder or wooden block attached to the window
                                                                                    frame behind the ties.

                                                                                                                                     Window Treatments ■ 397

   372-411_11989.indd 397                                                                                                                                  5/23/09 12:28:4 PM

ects 396 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:397

         Tie-top Curtains

         T   ie-tops are a refreshing, casual way to dress up a
             window heading; they draw the eye up to highlight
         crown molding or decorative trim and highlight your color
                                                                                    mind that opening and closing frequently will wear quickly
                                                                                    on the ties. Use lightweight to medium-weight fabrics for
                                                                                    best results, and add a lining for more light control.
         and fabric choices. Choose matching or coordinating                             Determine the number of ties needed by placing
         fabric for ties, or save time by using 1½- to 2"-wide ribbon               one pair at each end of the curtain panel, one pair in the
         instead. Tie-top curtains slide open easily, but bear in                   center, and spacing the remaining pairs every 6 to 8".

                                                                                                          These tie-top sheers have a casual, soft
                                                                                                          look that is perfect for bedrooms.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                       Length                                                              Width

               Decorator Fabric        Finished length + 6½" (for 3" double hem at lower edge)             1½ to 2 × Finished width + double side hems
               Facing                  4"                                                                  Finished width
               Ties                    4"                                                                  10" to 18"

  398 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_C51711.indd 398 6/3/09 2:31:22 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:398

                ■ How to Make a Tie-top Curtain Heading
                   1                                             2                                                  3

                Fold strip lengthwise, right sides             Pin pairs of ties to right side of the            Turn facing to wrong side, so ties are
                together, and stitch across one short          curtain with raw edges even. Overlock             free at the upper edge. Fold raw edges
                end and along long edge with 1⁄2" seam         one long edge of facing, or hem with              of facing under 1⁄2" on each side. Fuse
                allowance; or overlock. Use continuous         narrow hem. Pin facing strip over ties,           side and lower edges to curtain with
                stitching. Trim corner, turn right side out,   with right sides of facing and curtain            fusible web.
                and press.                                     together. Stitch 1⁄2" seam at top of facing.

                      Making Tiebacks ▸

                                                                                                                    A

                                                                                                                                         B

                      Tiebacks are a decorative, sleek          Center fusible interfacing on                  Hand-tack a ring on the back
                      way to hold curtains open. They are       the wrong side and fuse. Press                 seamline at each end, ¼" from edge
                      usually 2 to 6" wide; experiment with     short ends under ½" fold in half               (a), or press corners diagonally to the
                      the best length by pinning fabric         lengthwise, right sides together.              inside to form a point; slipstitch or
                      around curtains before cutting.           Stitch ½" seam, leaving short ends             fuse in place and attach a ring (b).
                                                                open. Press open. Turn tiebacks right
                                                                side out. Center seam down back
                                                                and press. Turn pressed ends inside
                                                                and slipstitch closed.

                                                                                                                                          Window Treatments ■ 399

   372-411_11989.indd 399                                                                                                                                      5/23/09 12:28:27 PM

ects 398 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:399

         Drapery Styles                                                      Tip ▸
                                                                                                            The secret to an
                                                                                                            opulent look in curtains

         D    raperies are one of the most functional,
              durable window treatments available. This
         traditional style does require more advanced
                                                                                                            or draperies is a flannel
                                                                                                            interlining. A must with
                                                                                                            decorator silks, which
         sewing techniques, but the end result is an                                                        would look limp and
         elegant, refined treatment that will stand the test                                                skimpy otherwise,
                                                                                                            interlining can also give
         of time. Attach draperies to a decorative rod and
                                                                                                            other fabrics a body-
         use elegant tiebacks and tailored details for a final                                              building boost. Stitch
         treatment that is effectively functional and refined,                                              interlining between the
         especially on tall windows or doors. Use medium-                                                   decorator fabric and lining
         weight to heavyweight fabrics with or without                                                      to boost the volume of
                                                                                                            any window treatment.
         lining for a classic look, and choose from a wide
         variety of pleating styles to best complement your
         existing décor.

         Experiment with multiple fabrics when constructing your drapery panels. These color-blocked panels in red and taupe provide
         a colorful solution for this family room patio door.

  400 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 400 5/23/09 12:28:47 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:400

                ■ Styles to Consider

                Pinch pleats: The most common                Goblet pleats: Open tubes that are              Inverted box pleats: Most often
                drapery style, pinch pleats gather neatly    pinched into pleats at the bottom               used for valances, dust ruffles, or skirts
                at the top of a window when closed and       resemble wine glasses—thus the name             on upholstered furniture, box pleats
                remain gathered in pleats when open          goblet pleats—and add a dressed-up              are also a beautifully tailored accent
                for a professionally tailored look.          finish. Detail the base of each goblet          for full-length draperies, especially in
                                                             with a tassel or covered button.                rooms with a clean, modern style. In
                                                                                                             the inverted style, fullness is folded out
                                                                                                             to the back of the heading, creating a
                                                                                                             smooth line on the front.

                Cartridge pleats: Stitch the heading         Attached valances: Add depth and                Banded panels: Banding helps define
                into cylinders to create soft, rounded       layers to your drapes by sewing a               the edges of a curtain or drapery. A
                folds throughout the panel. Cleverly         valance to the heading of your panels.          solid-color band can accent a patterned
                placed wide fringe trim calls attention to   This style is an easy way to add detail,        panel, adding visual weight to the sides
                the heading and transforms the drapery       such as trim or tassels, or to incorporate      and anchoring the lower edge. In the
                from a quiet backdrop to an energizing       complementary fabric without building           treatment shown, the dark-colored
                accent to the room’s warm décor.             an extra treatment.                             banding frames the box pleats as the
                                                                                                             dark wood frames on the furniture
                                                                                                             pieces complement their clean,
                                                                                                             neutral fabrics.

                                                                                                                                      Window Treatments ■ 401

   372-411_11989.indd 401                                                                                                                                  5/23/09 12:29:18 PM

ects 400 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:401

         Pinch-pleated Draperies

         C    lassic pleated draperies are the ultimate window
              treatment for versatility and style. Installed
         on traverse rods, they easily open to reveal the full
                                                                         Estimating Drapery Yardage ▸
                                                                         Drapery Length
         window view. When closed, they offer privacy, light
         control, and insulation from the weather.                       1) Desired length as measured from rod
              When designing the treatment, allow for the                2) 8" for heading                                               +
         stacking space at the sides of the window, so the               3) 8" for double hem                                            +
         draperies will clear the window when they are open.             4) Cut drapery length                                           =
         The actual stacking space varies, depending on the
                                                                         Drapery Width
         weight of the fabric, the fullness of the draperies, and
         whether or not they are lined—but a typical stacking            1) Rod width (from end bracket to end bracket on conventional
         space is about one-third of the width of the windows,              rods; from end ring to end ring on decorative rods)
         divided evenly between the two sides. A wide variety            2) Returns                                                      +
         of fabrics, from sheers to medium-weight, can be                3) Overlap [standard is 31⁄2"]                                  +
         used. Most common is 21⁄2-times fullness, but for very          4) Finished drapery width                                       =
         light fabrics or sheers, 3-times fullness may be best.
                                                                         Drapery widths per panel

                                                                         1) Finished width times 2, 21⁄2, or 3 (fullness)
                                                                         2) Width of fabric                                              ÷
               Tools & Materials ▸
                                                                         3) Fabric widths needed: round up or down whole width           =
               Decorator fabric         Decorative traverse rod          4) Divide widths by 2                                           ÷
               Lining (optional)        4"-wide buckram                  5) Number of widths per panel                                   =
                                                                         Total Drapery Fabric Needed

                                                                         1) Cut drapery length (figured above)
                                                                         2) Fabric widths needed (figured above)                         ×
                                                                         3) Total fabric length                                          =
                                                                         4) Number of yd. needed:
                                                                            total fabric length divided by 36"                               yd.
                                                                         Lining Length

                                                                         1) Finished length of drapery (from top of heading to hem)
                                                                         2) 4" for double hems                                           +
                                                                         3) Cut lining length                                            =
                                                                         Lining Width

                                                                         1) Number of widths per panel
                                                                            (figure as for drapery widths per panel, above)
                                                                         2) Multiply widths by 2                                         ×
                                                                         3) Total fabric widths                                          =
                                                                         Total Lining Fabric Needed

                                                                         1) Cut length (figured above)
                                                                         2) Fabric widths (figured above)                                ×
         The different styles and sizes of doors and windows in          3) Total fabric length                                          =
         this bedroom posed a decorating problem solved by the
         pinch-pleated, traversing draperies. Choosing a lighter color   4) Number of yd. needed:
         drapery than the wall draws the eye around the room’s clean,       total fabric length divided by 36"                               yd.
         inviting décor.

  402 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 402 5/23/09 12:29:59 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:402

                ■ Calculating Drapery Pleats
                After fabric panels have been seamed and hemmed,                 between pleats should be 3½ to 4". If your calculations
                use the table to determine the number and size of                result in pleats larger than 6" or spaces smaller than
                pleats and spaces per panel; the recommended amount              3½", adjust the number of pleats to ensure that your
                of fabric required for each pleat is 4 to 6", and space          measurements are within the recommended range.

                      Pleats Worksheet ▸
                      Finished Panel Width                                       Pleat Allowance

                      1) Finished drapery width (figured left)                   1) Flat width of hemmed panel
                      2) divided by 2                                        ÷   2) Finished panel width (figured above)                              −
                      3) Finished panel width                                =   3) Pleat allowance                                                   =
                      Space between Pleats                                       Pleat Size

                      1) Number of widths per panel (figured left)               1) Pleat allowance (figured above)
                      2) Times number of pleats per width*                   ×   2) Number of pleats in panel                                         ÷
                      3) Number of pleats per panel                          =   3) Pleat size                                                        =
                      4) Number of spaces per panel (one less than pleats)       * Figure five pleats per width of 48" fabric, 6 pleats per width of 54" fabric.
                      5) Finished panel width (figured above)                      If you have a half width of fabric, figure 2 or 3 pleats in that half width.
                                                                                   For example, for 48" fabric, 21⁄2 widths per panel = 12 pleats.
                      6) Overlap and returns (figured left)                  −
                      7) Width to be pleated                                 =
                      8) Number of spaces per panel (figured above)          ÷
                      9) Space between pleats                                =

                ■ How to Sew Pinch-pleated Draperies
                   1                                                                2

                Seam widths together as necessary. (Remove selvages to           Cut 4"-wide buckram 6" shorter than the width of panel. On
                prevent puckering.) Use French or serged seams. Turn under       wrong side of drapery panel, place buckram even with the top
                and blindstitch or straight stitch double 4" bottom hems.        edge and 3" from the sides.

                                                                                                                                                          (continued)

                                                                                                                                           Window Treatments ■ 403

   372-411_11989.indd 403                                                                                                                                          5/23/09 12:30:22 PM

ects 402 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:403

            3                                                                      4

         Fold heading over twice, encasing buckram in fabric. Press;             Turn under and blindstitch or straight stitch double 11⁄2"
         pin or hand baste in place.                                             side hems. Determine size of pleat and space between pleats
                                                                                 from worksheet (page 403).

            5
                           pleat            pleat              pleat                pleat                pleat                   pleat
                                   space             space               space               space                  space

                                                                                                                                                overlap
                          seam

                           pleat           pleat             pleat               pleat             pleat                 pleat
                                   space            space              space             space                space                space
                 return

                                                                                                                                         seam

         Mark the returns and overlaps on each panel; then mark the pleats and spaces. Mark a pleat just before the return and another
         next to the overlap. Mark pleats next to any seams on the opposite side of the panel from the return. Bear in mind that pleat size
         can vary slightly within each fabric width. Spaces between pleats must stay uniform. Spaces between pleats should be 3½ to 4".

  404 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 404 5/23/09 12:30:28 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:404

                   6                                         7                                                8

                Fold individual pleats by bringing two     Stitch on pleat line from top of                Divide into three even pleats.
                pleat lines together and pinning. Crease   heading to 1⁄2" below heading; backstitch       Crease the fold of the pleat with
                buckram on the fold.                       to secure.                                      one hand while opening the pleat
                                                                                                           at the top of the heading. Press the
                                                                                                           fold straight down to meet the pleat
                                                                                                           stitching line. Two pleats form at the
                                                                                                           sides. Pinch outer folds up to meet the
                                                                                                           center fold (inset). Finger press three
                                                                                                           pleats together, making sure they are
                                                                                                           all even.

                   9                                         10
                                                                                                                             A

                                                                                                       B

                                                                  C

                Tack pleats with machine bar tack          Insert drapery hooks. On a conventional traverse rod (a), top of hook is 13⁄4" from
                in center of pleat, ½" from bottom of      the upper edge of drapery. On a ringless decorator traverse rod (b), the hook is 3⁄4" to
                buckram. Set machine for widest stitch     1" from the upper edge. On a wood pole set (c), hook is 1⁄2" from upper edge.
                and stitch four to five times.

                                                                                                                                    Window Treatments ■ 405

   372-411_C51711.indd 405                                                                                                                                 6/3/09 2:31:50 PM

ects 404 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:405

         Drapery Lining

         L  ining adds body and weight to curtains to help
            them hang nicely. A lining also adds opaqueness,
         prevents fading and sun damage to decorative fabric,
                                                                          and provides some insulation. For lined curtains with a
                                                                          2" double-fold hem, cut lining the finished length plus
                                                                          2½" and the finished width minus 6".

         ■ How to Line Curtains
            1                                                               2

         Turn, press, and stitch 2" double-fold hem in lining. Turn and   Place lining on curtain right sides together so the lining is
         press double-fold hem in curtain. Tack weights inside fold of    11⁄2" above curtain hem. Pin and stitch 1⁄2" seams on sides.
         curtain hems at seams and stitch curtain hems.

            3                                                               4

         Turn curtain right site out. Center lining so side hems are      Press 1⁄2" seam allowance across the upper edge of the
         equal width. Press side hem with seam allowance toward the       curtain. Fold the upper edge of the curtain down an amount equal
         center. Continue to the top edge of the curtain.                 to the depth of the casing and heading. Lining ends at fold line.

  406 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 406 5/23/09 12:30:48 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:406

                   5                                                              6

                Stitch close to the folded edge to form casing. For             Hand-tack weights along lower edge of the curtain inside
                curtains with headings, stitch the heading the desired depth.   side hems.

                   7                                                              8

                Turn side hems back diagonally below lining to form a           Make French tacks about 12" apart between hem and
                miter. Slipstitch miter in place.                               lining using double thread. Take two stitches near the top
                                                                                of the hem and directly across the lining, leaving 1" slack in
                                                                                thread. Make blanket stitch over thread; secure with knot
                                                                                in lining.

                                                                                                                                  Window Treatments ■ 407

   372-411_11989.indd 407                                                                                                                              5/23/09 12:30:56 PM

ects 406 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:407

               Using Pleater Tape ▸

               Prepleat pleater tape to finished width of drapery            Position the pleater tape on installed traverse rod
               panel. Leave space unpleated at one end of tape for           and adjust pleats if necessary. Fold ends under 1⁄2".
               overlap and at other end for return.                          Remove hooks. Cut drapery panels using pleater tape as
                                                                             a guide.

               After double-fold hem on lower edge and side hems             Insert hooks. Push prongs all the way up into pleats.
               are finished, pin the upper edge of pleater tape, pocket      Adjust folds between hooks.
               side up, ½" from the upper edge on the right side of the
               drapery (so the pleater tape overlaps ½"). Stitch ¼" from
               the edge of the pleater tape. Fold to inside of drapery and
               press. Stitch lower edge and both sides.

  408 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 408 5/23/09 12:31:5 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:408

                ■ How to Sew Lined Pleated Draperies
                   1                                                                 2

                Stitch drapery fabric as on page 403. Repeat for lining,           Mark lining panel 8" from upper edge of drapery panel. Trim
                pressing under 2" double-fold hem. Place drapery panel on          on marked line. Cut buckram the width of each panel. Place
                large flat surface, then lay lining panel on top, wrong sides      buckram even with upper edge of panel on wrong side. Fold
                together, with the lower edge of lining 1" above the lower edge    heading and buckram to wrong side; press.
                of the panel; raw edges will be even at sides.

                   3                                                                   Dressing Draperies ▸
                                                                                                                       When draperies are
                                                                                                                       finished, draw into
                                                                                                                       stacked position and
                                                                                                                       guide pleats into soft
                                                                                                                       folds. Staple paper around
                                                                                                                       drapes at the hemline
                                                                                                                       and halfway between the
                                                                                                                       hem and the rod to hold
                                                                                                                       draperies in place; leave
                                                                                                                       them to hang straight
                                                                                                                       from the rod in this
                                                                                                                       fashion for five to seven
                                                                                                                       days. The humidity will
                                                                                                                       encourage the setting
                                                                                                                       process, so the soft folds
                                                                                                                       will continue to hang
                                                                                                                       nicely in the future.
                Fold again, encasing the buckram, and then press. Pin or
                hand baste in place. Press under 1½" twice on sides, folding
                lining and drapery panels as one fabric. Stitch double-fold side
                hems. Finish draperies as on page 405.

                                                                                                                                    Window Treatments ■ 409

   372-411_11989.indd 409                                                                                                                                5/23/09 12:31:18 PM

ects 408 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:409

         Valance Styles                                                        Tip ▸

         A    window valance is a top treatment that can be
              used alone or paired with curtains, blinds, or
         draperies. Window valances have traditionally been
         used as an attractive covering for window hardware,
         but today are often primarily a decorative accent
         that can draws together complementary fabrics used
         throughout the room. Valances are also a great outlet
                                                                               Modify the technique of making the balloon shade
         for your creativity—whether you prefer tailored pleats                (page 376) to make this stationary valance, which
         or softly draping clouds of fabric, complete your                     adds an attractive focal point to the sunny décor of
         window treatment with one of these popular styles, or                 this bathroom.
         a variation of your own.

         A single inverted box pleat at the middle of a deep, banded valance makes a strong statement in this formal area. While
         centering the attention on the window, the valance also hides the hardware for the draperies and roman shade.

  410 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

372-411_11989.indd 410 5/23/09 12:31:26 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:410

                ■ Styles to Consider

                Rectangle Valance: Lined Rectangle          Rod-pocket Valance: Use the                    Buttoned Valance: These box-pleated
                Valances are simply a length of fabric      technique employed in rod-pocket               valances are tailored and simple;
                lined to the edge with the same or          curtains to create these attractive top        however, fold the lower corners back
                contrasting fabric. Multiple looks can be   treatments; choose to shape the bottom         in this decorative style to highlight the
                achieved by changing the dimensions of      edge to complement your window                 contrasting fabric of the pleat inserts for
                the rectangle or the way the valance is     (shown) or leave the bottom edge in a          stylistic flair.
                hung, either clipped to a decorative rod    straight line for a classic look.
                or stapled to a mounting board.

                Cloud Valance: Feminine, romantic,          Upholstered Valance: This formal,              Shelf Valance: Think creatively, and
                and eye catching, a cloud valance is a      tailored top treatment is made by              add a shelf to the top of your window
                great way to draw attention to a well-      covering a wooden frame with fabric.           instead of a fabric valance. Placed in the
                dressed window. This style is gathered      First, cover the frame with batting to         window’s light, these shelves are a great
                across the top, either by making a rod      round the corners, then cover with             place for an herb garden, flowering
                pocket and mounting on a curtain rod or     decorator fabric. For added detail,            plants, or soft pieces, such as children’s
                by gathering the top with shirring tape     apply welting to define the upper and          stuffed toys.
                and securing it to a mounting board.        lower edges.

                                                                                                                                    Window Treatments ■ 411

   372-411_C51711.indd 411                                                                                                                                  6/3/09 2:32:7 PM

ects 410 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:411

         Buttoned Valance

         T   he lower corners of the box-pleated valances
             are buttoned back in this project, revealing the
         contrasting fabric of the pleat inserts. These valances
                                                                                   pleats and spacing. You may want to repeat a large
                                                                                   motif in each space between the pleats, or perhaps a
                                                                                   series of stripes. In general, a solid-colored fabric, or
         are self-lined, eliminating the need for a lower hem.                     a fabric with a small print, can be divided into smaller
         If the valance or insert fabric is patterned, it’s best to                spaces than a fabric with a large print.
         interline the valance with lining fabric to prevent the
         pattern from showing through in the sunlight.
              Unless the projection of the mounting board is
         less than 5", pleats should always be positioned and                          Tools & Materials ▸
         buttoned back at the outer front corners. The number
         of remaining pleats and spaces between them will vary,                        Decorator fabric(s)                    Mounting board
         depending upon the design that will best suit your                            Lining fabric                          Angle irons
         window and room. In some cases, it may be desirable                           Covered buttons                           and screws
         to align pleats with existing divisions in the window                            or decorative                       Staple gun
         space created by moldings. It’s also smart to consider                           buttons                                and staples
         the fabric you’re using when planning the number of

                                                                                                           Fold back your pleats in large diagonal
                                                                                                           strokes, or in small corner flaps (above)
                                                                                                           for varied shape and design. You may
                                                                                                           also choose to align pleats with window
                                                                                                           molding to add to the overall consistency
                                                                                                           of the window treatment.

               Cutting Guide ▸
                                                        Length                         Width

               Main Valance Fabric Sections             Finished length × 2 + 3"       Width of each space between pleats + 1"
               Valance Returns (2)                      Finished length × 2 + 3"       Projection of mounting board + 1"
               Pleat Inserts (Contrasting Fabric)       Finished length × 2 + 3"       If mounting board projection is 5" or more: All pleat inserts = 21"
                                                                                       If mounting board projection is less than 5"
                                                                                       Corner Inserts: Mounting board projection × 2 + 11"
                                                                                       Remaining Inserts: 21"
               Interlining (optional)                   Finished length + 1½"          Finished width of valance

  412 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 412 5/23/09 2:00:52 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:412

                      Calculating the Spaces & Pleats ▸
                      To calculate the spaces between pleats, diagram the window treatment, including any undertreatments. Label the
                      finished length and width of the valance, then determine where you would like pleats (if aligning with window molding) or
                      the number of pleats that will work best for your design. Always place the first and last pleats on the outside corners. The
                      size of the spaces between pleats can either align with the window molding or can be divided evenly across the width of
                      the valance. To do this, first determine the approximate spacing between pleats, and divide into the width of the valance,
                      rounding up or down to the nearest whole number. This is the number of spaces between pleats. Remember, there should
                      always be one more pleat than the number of spaces. Divide this number into the valance width to determine the exact
                      measurement of each space.

                ■ How to Sew a Valance with Buttoned Pleats
                   1                                                                     2

                Pin the pleat insert for left end of the valance over the left        Pin a space section to the pleat insert, right sides
                return section, right sides together; stitch 1⁄2" seam.               together; stitch 1⁄2" seam. Continue to join sections, alternating
                                                                                      pleat inserts and space sections end with the right pleat insert
                                                                                      and the right return section. Press seams open.

                   3                                                                     4

                Fold the end of the valance in half lengthwise, right                 Press valance in half, matching raw edges and seams.
                sides together. Sew 1⁄2" seam on outer edge of returns; turn          Machine baste layers together, 1⁄2" from raw edges at the top of
                valance right side out, and press. Repeat for the opposite end        the valance.
                of valance.
                                                                                                                                                   (continued)

                                                                                                                                        Window Treatments ■ 413

   412-448_11989.indd 413                                                                                                                                     5/23/09 2:00:55 PM

ects 412 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:413

            5                                                              6

         Mark center of each pleat insert along upper and lower          Fold under pleats at all seamlines; press. Bring the
         edges. If return is less than 5", measure from inner seam of    pressed seams together to pin marks; pin pleats in place along
         return a distance equal to twice the return; pin-mark.          upper and lower edges.

            7                                                              8

         Press folded edges of all pleats, turning valance back and      Stitch pleats in place across the valance, 11⁄2" from upper
         pressing only on the pleat to avoid imprinting edges to right   edge. Finish the upper edge, using overlock or zigzag stitch.
         side of valance.

  414 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 414 5/23/09 2:00:58 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:414

                   9                                              10                                                11

                Fold back lower corners of pleats at            Determine button placement. Sew                  Cover mounting board. Position the
                desired angle to expose pleat insert. Pin       the buttons in place through all layers.         valance on the mounting board using
                in place; press, if desired.                    For shank-style buttons, cut a small slit        stitching line as guide to extend upper
                                                                in the fabric, through corner layers only.       edge 11⁄2" onto top of board; position
                                                                Insert the shank through the slit; sew           end pleats at the front corners of
                                                                button through remaining layers.                 board. Clip fabric at corner pleats close
                                                                                                                 to stitching line. Staple the valance in
                                                                                                                 place, beginning with returns; ease or
                                                                                                                 stretch valance slightly to fit the board,
                                                                                                                 if necessary. Mount the valance.

                ■ How to Sew an Interlined Valance with Buttoned Pleats
                   1                                                                      2

                Follow steps 1 and 2, page 413; measure the width of                    Complete valance as in steps 3 to 11, pages 413 to
                seamed valance. For interlining, cut the lining fabric to this          414. The lower edge of interlining extends to the lower fold
                measurement, seaming widths together as necessary. Pin                  of valance.
                interlining to wrong side of valance, matching upper edges
                and ends.

                                                                                                                                          Window Treatments ■ 415

   412-448_11989.indd 415                                                                                                                                        5/23/09 2:01:3 PM

ects 414 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:415

         Cloud Valance

         C     loud valances are soft and feminine and draw the
               eye to window treatment details. The headings
         of cloud valances are typically gathered, either using
                                                                               Tools & Materials ▸
         a rod pocket and decorative rod or shirring tape, and                 Decorator fabric
         the lower edge is raised into soft billows by sewing in a             Lining fabric (optional)
         column of rings and tying them together.                              Plastic rings
              The pouf sizes can be all the same, or they can                  Shade cord
         vary in width and length, depending on the needs of                   Two utility curtain rods of equal projections
         your window. Columns of ring should be placed at                      Installation hardware and tools
         seams between fabric widths and then 18 to 24" apart.
         Depending on the width of your treatment, there will
         be two to three poufs per width. Lightweight fabrics
         and soft, medium-weight fabrics work best for cloud
         valances. Depending on your fabric and desired look
         21⁄2-times or 3-times fullness can be used.

         An extra-wide pocket rod creates a grand top for this sheer cloud valance. Three graceful swags of different depths are created
         by tying the two inner columns of rings tighter than the outer columns.

  416 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 416 5/23/09 2:01:9 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:416

                      Cutting Guide ▸
                                              Length                                        Width

                      Each Valance Section    Finished length + (rod pocket depth × 2)      Full valance: rod length + (projection of rod × 2) × desired fullness
                                              + (Heading height × 2) + 18"                  Valance section: divide full valance width by number of valance sections,
                                                                                            round to nearest whole number
                      Lining                  Finished length + (rod pocket depth × 2)      Full valance: rod length + (projection of rod × 2) × desired fullness
                                              + (Heading height × 2) + 18"                  Valance section: divide full valance width by number of valance sections,
                                                                                            round to nearest whole number

                ■ How to Sew a Cloud Valance
                   1                                                                       2

                                                                                                                                6"

                Seam fabric widths together. Repeat for the lining, if                   Lay the valance face-down. Mark positions for rings in
                necessary. Pin valance and lining wrong sides together, aligning         columns at the side hems and at each seam, placing the
                edges. Trim any excess, turn under and stitch 1" double-fold             bottom marks at the top of the bottom hem. Space one or two
                side hems, handling pieces as one fabric. Press under ½" on              additional columns of marks between seams. Place four marks
                the upper edge. Then, press under an amount equal to the rod-            in each column, spaced 6" apart.
                pocket depth plus the heading depth. Stitch close to the first
                fold; stitch again at the depth of the heading. Turn under and
                stitch a 1" double-fold hem at the bottom.

                   3                                                4                                                       Seaming Fabric
                                                                                                                            Widths ▸
                                                                                                                            Use only full and half widths.
                                                                                                                            Add half widths at the sides. If
                                                                                                                            an even number of full widths
                                                                                                                            are needed, divide one in half
                                                                                                                            and add a half width to each
                                                                                                                            side of the center full width to
                Stitch a ring at each mark, stitching            Thread a length of shade cord                              avoid a seam in the center of
                through the lining and valance fabric.           through the rings of the first column and                  the valance.
                                                                 tie the rings together. Leave long tails
                                                                 of cord. Repeat for each column. Insert
                                                                 the curtain rod in the upper rod pocket
                                                                 and mount the valance. Adjust fullness
                                                                 evenly. Mount a second rod under the
                                                                 valance, even with the clusters of tied
                                                                 rings. Tie the cording tails to the rod to
                                                                 keep the poufs in position.

                                                                                                                                                 Window Treatments ■ 417

   412-448_C51711.indd 417                                                                                                                                              6/3/09 3:13:17 PM

ects 416 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:417

         Upholstered Valance

         A     n upholstered valance is a style of cornice: a
               formal, tailored top treatment made by covering
         a wooden frame with fabric. The frame, which is a
                                                                                 Tools & Materials ▸
         box with an open back and bottom, is first padded                       Decorator fabric                Polyester upholstery
         with foam or batting to round the corners for a soft,                   Lining fabric                      batting or 1⁄2"-thick
         upholstered look. Fabric-covered or cord welting can                    Welting cord                       polyurethane foam
         also be used to define the edges of the valance.                            and fabric                  Cardboard upholstery
               Building the valance frame takes only very basic
                                                                                 1
                                                                                  ⁄2"-thick plywood                 stripping
         carpentry skills—and any imperfections will be covered                      or pine boards              Spray foam adhesive
         with the padding and decorator fabric. Design your                      Carpenter’s glue                Installation hardware
         cornice to clear the curtain or drapery hardware by 2 to                Finishing nails                    and tools
         3" and extend at least 2" beyond the end of the drapery                 Stapler and staples
         or window frame on each side. Medium-weight, firmly
         woven decorator fabrics and upholstery fabrics are suitable
         for this project; railroad the fabric to eliminate seams or
         place the seams inconspicuously, never in the center.              the frame and attach them to the wall at your marks.
               To mount the cornice to the wall, remember to                Finally, reattach the frame to the angle irons. Following
         first attach the angle irons to the frame and mark their           these instructions will ensure that you don’t get in to a
         positions on the wall. Then, remove the angle irons from           sticky spot trying to screw a narrow frame to the wall.

         These dramatic arched valances are a grand focal point for this formal dining area. Apply antique details to the finished cornice,
         such as the metal medallions in the corners here, for added character.

  418 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 418 5/23/09 2:01:34 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:418

                      Cutting Guide ▸
                                                                  Length                                                           Width

                      Face Piece                                  Height of frame + 3"                                             Front + sides of frame + 6"
                      Inner Lining Strip                          4"                                                               Front + sides of frame + 6"
                      Lining Strip                                Height of frame – 2"                                             Front + sides of frame + 6"
                      Dustcover                                   Top of frame + 1"                                                Width of frame top
                      Batting or foam                             Height of frame                                                  Front + sides of frame
                      Welting                                     Length of all welting edges + 6-8"                               1½"

                ■ How to Make an Upholstered Valance
                   1                                                                            2

                Measure and cut the cornice top. Cut the front the same                      Stitch welting to the lower edge of the face piece with
                width and the desired finished height. Shape the lower edges,                a ½" seam, then sew the lower (welted) edge to the inner
                if desired. Cut sides pieces the same height as the cornice                  lining strip, right sides together. Sew the free edge of the inner
                front plus the depth of the top piece, plus the thickness of                 strip to the lining strip. Press seam allowances toward the
                the wood. Glue the top to the front board and nail to secure.                lining. Mark the center at the top and bottom on both the face
                Attach the sides, first gluing in place, then securing with nails.           piece and the frame. Place the wrong side of the fabric on
                Allow glue to set.                                                           the outside of the cornice, with the lower (welted) seam on
                                                                                             the lower front edge of the frame, matching center markings.
                                                                                             Staple in place at the center.

                   3                                                                            4

                Pull the seam allowances taut to the corners of the                          Place cardboard stripping tight against the lower (welted)
                cornice and staple in place. Staple every 4" from the center to              seam. Staple every 1 to 1½". Cut and overlap the stripping at
                the ends, keeping the lower (welted) seam aligned to the front               the corners. Fold lining to the inside. Fold under the raw edge
                edge of the frame.                                                           and staple at the inside of the box where the top and face
                                                                                             meet. At the lower corners, miter the fabric and staple close to
                                                                                             the corner. Tuck excess fabric into the upper corners and staple.
                                                                                                                                                            (continued)

                                                                                                                                               Window Treatments ■ 419

   412-448_11989.indd 419                                                                                                                                            5/23/09 2:01:43 PM

ects 418 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:419

            5                                                                 6

         Open the welting seam back to the edge of the frame.               Staple face fabric to the frame top at the center and ends.
         Trim welting to 1". Trim out the cording even with the cornice     Starting at the center, turn under the raw edge and staple
         back edge to reduce bulk. Staple the lining to the back edge       it to the cornice top. Smoothing the fabric as you go, work
         of frame; trim excess lining. Staple the welting end to the        first toward one end and then the other, placing staples 1½"
         back edge of the frame. Turn cornice face up and apply spray       apart. Pull fabric around the frame end to the top back corner,
         adhesive to the front and sides. Place padding over the glued      removing any slack; staple. Fold side fabric to the back edge;
         surface and smooth it taut over the front and sides. Allow         staple. Trim excess fabric at the back edge.
         glue to set, then fold face fabric over the padded front. Gently
         smooth toward the top, keeping the padding tucked snugly
         into the corners and lower edge.

            7                                                                 8

         Fold the fabric diagonally at the corners to form miters.          Staple welting to the sides and front of the cornice top,
         Staple at the corners and across the ends.                         with the welting stitching line along the front and side edges.
                                                                            Place dustcover over the welting on cornice front, with right
                                                                            sides together and raw edges event. Staple cardboard stripping
                                                                            at the front. Fold under the sides of the dustcover even with
                                                                            the sides of the frame. Insert cardboard stripping into the folds.
                                                                            Staple dustcover to the top of the frame, close to the folds.
                                                                            Fold the back edge under and staple in place.

  420 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 420 5/23/09 2:01:45 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:420

                      Cornice Variations ▸
                      If you love the look of upholstered valances but are intimidated by the frame construction and upholstery techniques,
                      don’t fret! You can achieve the look and feel of upholstered cornices without building a frame by using one of these
                      clever techniques.

                      Soft cornices are mounted on a board with side extensions instead of a full frame and result in a similar shape with a
                      lighter look. Soft cornices can be made as either a single panel of fabric with a shaped lower edge or with overlapping
                      panels. Welting defines the lower edge of the soft cornice and can also trim the upper edge.

                      Rod-pocket mock cornices are mounted on flat curtain rods that are 4½" wide. Fusible fleece applied inside the rod
                      pocket gives the treatment a padded look. The top and bottom of the rod pocket are accented with welting to add to the
                      illusion. Add a pleated or gathered skirt below the rod pocket for extra length.

                                                                                                                                       Window Treatments ■ 421

   412-448_C51711.indd 421                                                                                                                                    6/3/09 2:36:29 PM

ects 420 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:421

         Hanging Shelf Valance

         T   hink creatively about your window treatments,
             and replace a traditional valance with a
         hanging shelf to house collectibles, toys, or plants.
                                                                                       Tools & Materials ▸
         This functional piece can also be a delightful                                1 × 6 board for                   180-grit or 220-grit
         decorative addition to kitchens, bathrooms, and                                  each shelf, cut to                 sandpaper
         bedrooms. Hang a single shelf near the top of a                                  the width of the               Pole brackets with
         window as a valance, or hang multiple shelves for                                window frame                       4 to 6" projection
         additional privacy.                                                           Two 7"-lengths of                 Latex paint or wood
              The shelves in this project are made from 1 × 6                             parting stop for                   stain and clear
         stock lumber, braced with parting stop at each end,                              each shelf                         acrylic finish
         and suspended with a rope from a wooden pole. If                              Sponge applicator                 3
                                                                                                                          ⁄16" nylon or
         mounting a shelf over a window that is more than 36"                          Drill with 5⁄16" drill                polyester rope
         wide or if you will be displaying heavy items, add an                            bit and 3⁄32"                      (cut twice as long
         additional brace and rope to the center, along with a                            combination                        as the distance
         center support bracket for the pole. Ropes are knotted                           drill and                          from the pole
         just below the pole and under each brace to keep the                             countersink bit                    to the bottom
         shelf hanging level.                                                          1" flat head screws                   of the last shelf,
                                                                                          13⁄8" wood pole                    plus 6 to 10" for
                                                                                          with finials                       each knot)

         ■ How to Make a Hanging Window Shelf
            1                                               2                                                  3

         Mark placement of holes for rope                 Mark lines on underside of shelf 2"               Adjust 3⁄32" combination drill and
         on the wide side of braces ½" from               from each end. On wide side of braces,            countersink bit so head of drywall screw
         each end; drill holes using a 5⁄16" drill bit.   mark placement for screws, 11⁄2" from             will be recessed below the surface of
         Sand all wood surfaces using 180-grit            ends. Place braces, wide side up on               wood when inserted into drilled hole,
         or 220-grit sandpaper; round corners of          shelf with outer edges along lines and            then predrill screw holes, holding the
         the shelves and braces slightly.                 ends extending equally on each side of            brace firmly in place as positioned. Drill
                                                          shelf. Position a third brace, if needed at       through brace and into underside of
                                                          center of board. Repeat for braces on             shelf, up to point on drill bit indicated by
                                                          any additional shelves.                           the white line. Insert screw and repeat
                                                                                                            for remaining braces.

  422 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_C51711.indd 422 6/3/09 2:48:43 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:422

                   4                                           5                                                6

                Paint the shelves, if desired, or stain     Fold the ropes in half. Tie each folded          Thread the rope down through the
                shelves and apply clear acrylic finish.     rope together in an overhand knot near           holes in the braces of the shelf until
                                                            the folded end, leaving a 2½" loop; tie all      the pencil marks are below the braces.
                                                            knots in the same direction so they look         Tie a figure-eight knot at each location,
                                                            the same. Measure from the overhand              just under the mark. Repeat for any
                                                            knots to the desired location for the first      additional shelves, measuring from
                                                            set of shelf support knots, allowing 1¼"         previous knots.
                                                            for the thickness of the shelf and braces
                                                            and mark the ropes.

                   7                                                                  8

                Mount brackets for wood pole on or just outside the                 Slide the pole through loops in the rope, and attach finials
                window frame. If a center support bracket is needed, mount it       to ends; mount the pole on brackets. Check to see that shelves
                with one side of the bracket at center.                             are level and resting on knots; adjust the knots if necessary.
                                                                                    Trim excess rope under the knots for the bottom shelf.

                                                                                                                                      Window Treatments ■ 423

   412-448_C51711.indd 423                                                                                                                                   6/3/09 2:48:56 PM

ects 422 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:423

         Swag Styles

         S   wags are elegant and versatile and are easily
             employed by decorators of all skill levels. As a
         top treatment, they are the perfect way to introduce
         an accent color or pattern to your window décor.
         Consider adding a swag in a complementary color
         to your curtains or draperies to tie together various
         elements of your room’s color scheme.
              For a polished designer look, be sure to take
         proper measurements and style the fabric over the
         window throughout the process. Avoid directional
         prints, such as birds or flowers that only look right in
         one direction: you don’t want to have upside down
         tulips on one side of your window. Consider semisheer
         decorator fabric for a soft, airy look. For a more formal,
         traditional look use medium-weight decorator fabric
         and consider trimming the edges with bullion fringe.
         Bias swags made from striped or plaid fabric can add
         interest, tie the window treatments in with other
         patterns and colors in the room, or just add a fun focal
         point with a burst of pattern or color.

               Tip ▸

                                                                      Making a decorator window treatment is easier than you
                                                                      may have thought! Here a white semisheer freeform swag
                                                                      cascades to the floor for formal, yet fresh softness.

                                                                          Tools & Materials ▸
                                                                          Decorative rod and              Paper for
                                                                            mounting hardware                pattern making
                                                                          Long cord or string             Drapery lining
                                                                          Tape measure                    Fringe
                                                                          Decorator fabric                Clip-on or sew-on
               For a reversible option or to tie in a prominent
                                                                          Depending on the                   drapery rings
               color or scheme in the room, consider lining the           project you choose,                (ten per 36")
               backside of the fabric.                                    you may also need:              Twill tape or ribbon

  424 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 424 5/23/09 2:02:18 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:424

                ■ Swag Styles to Consider

                Freeform scarf: This swag style                Bias: Cut with the true bias running           Tapered: Floral print is draped through
                is classic and uninhibited, draping            through the center of the swag, bias-cut       scarf rings to form this easy single
                effortlessly across a window frame.            swags drape in smooth, graceful folds.         swoop treatment. There are hidden
                Made of a full-width, unshaped length of                                                      seams at the points where the swag
                fabric, this style can be sewn and draped                                                     goes through the rings, so a directional
                in minutes. Add trim or decorative swag                                                       print like this can run upward on
                holders to accent the fabric                                                                  both tails.

                Tailored: The tailored version is             Rod pocket: This softly gathered swag           Multiple swoops: Shape your swag
                more structured has a formal, pleated         is versatile and can be tailored multiple       with multiple swag holders to unify
                look. This swag style is not formed           ways. Add fringe or decorative trim             windows of multiple heights, accent a
                at the window, but rather created             for a formal finish, or add a ruffle for        vaulted ceiling, or to add variety to a
                with a muslin pattern to fit the              country charm.                                  large bay window.
                window perfectly.

                Shirred: This lined swag is adorned with multicolored rope           Butterfly: A stationary treatment, the butterfly swag can be
                trim and is created with jabots, or side panels. The trim simply     made in any length. Its fan-folded fabric is held in place with
                drapes through the swag and hangs over the jabots on                 decorative straps, which helps the fabric to swag in the center
                each side.                                                           and flare at the sides.

                                                                                                                                       Window Treatments ■ 425

   412-448_11989.indd 425                                                                                                                                    5/23/09 2:02:24 PM

ects 424 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:425

         Scarf Swag

         T   his elegant top treatment is versatile and requires
             very little sewing; in fact, a scarf swag is simply
         a long length of fabric that is hemmed at the ends.
                                                                           the swag. You will use the entire width of a decorator
                                                                           fabric, running the lengthwise grain up one side,
                                                                           draping across the rod, and down the opposite side.
         If the selvages are neat and unpuckered, they can                 Avoid directional prints when creating swags in
         be left intact as finished edges for the long sides of            this style.

         ■ How to Make a Scarf Swag
            1                                                                2

         Mount the rod above the window frame, with the outer              Fold and press 1" from the outside edge of swag end, and
         brackets beyond the frame sides. Drape a cord in the path you     then unfold it. Turn the cut edge back, aligning it to the first
         want the lower edge of the swag to follow. Cut fabric 2" longer   foldline (shown), and press.
         than this length.

            3                                                                4

         Refold along the pressed 1" foldline to create a double-          Align the selvage edge under the presser foot, with the
         fold hem. Pin the hem as shown. No-sew alternative: fuse or       needle aligned just inside the inner fold. Straight stitch the
         glue the final hem instead of pinning it.                         entire length of the swag edge, removing pins as you go. Be
                                                                           sure to backstitch at the start and finish. Repeat for the hem at
                                                                           the opposite end.

  426 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 426 5/23/09 2:02:48 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:426

                   5                                                                   6

                Fanfold the entire finished panel into gentle pleats of              Drape the folded fabric over the rod, remove the ties, and
                consistent depth, keeping the right side facing out on the first     arrange the folds. Tug gently at the center of the lower folds to
                and last folds. Tie the folded fabric at regular intervals using     shape the swag into a gradual curve.
                ribbon or twill tape.

                ■ Variation: Freeform Swag with a Knot
                   1                                             2                                               3

                Measure and mark the point in which            Hang the swag over the rod.                    Tie the fabric between bundles into
                the swag will fold together near pole          Secure the upper edge to the rod with          a large, loose knot over the rod. Pin
                ends. If you want an exact placement           double-sided carpet tape so that it            the bundles together inside the knot. If
                for the fold, use a fabric pencil. Fan         doesn’t move.                                  you’d like to use multiple knots, begin
                fold the swag along the marked lines,                                                         in the center and work out toward
                keeping the number and depth of folds                                                         each side.
                consistent. Secure with a Velcro strap or
                twill tape.

                                                                                                                                       Window Treatments ■ 427

   412-448_C51711.indd 427                                                                                                                                    6/3/09 2:49:31 PM

ects 426 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:427

         Bias Swag

         T   his style of swag is cut with the true bias of the
             fabric running through the center of the piece,
         which enables the swag to drape in smooth, graceful
                                                                               semisheer fabric, or formal and refined when made
                                                                               with medium-weight fabric and decorative trim. Drape
                                                                               one bias swag per window, or make multiple swags to
         folds. Bias swags can be light and airy when made in                  overlap as you mount them.

                                                                                                    The striped fabric in these swags
                                                                                                    hides the gap between the top of the
                                                                                                    window and the decorative rod. The
                                                                                                    stripes echoed in the upholstered chair
                                                                                                    cushions pull the overall design together.

         ■ How to Make a Bias Swag
            1                                                                    2

         Measure your window to determine how much fabric you                  Mark the folded edge 5" from the upper point. Draw a line
         need. Take a square measurement based on the farthest edges           from the mark to the opposite edge (as shown) and cut along
         top to bottom and right to left (typical size is 42"). Cut a square   the line. Use this template for the swag and the lining.
         piece of paper to match your desired measurement. Fold the
         square diagonally from corner to corner. Using a string and
         pencil, draw an arc between the square corner and the fold,
         marking the lower edge of the swag. Cut along the marked line.

  428 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 428 5/23/09 2:02:58 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:428

                   3                                                                 4

                Fold under 2" on the long straight edges. Trim the lower           With right sides together, align and stitch the fabric and
                area that is folded under, following the curve. Unfold the         lining together at the curved edge with a 1⁄2" seam. Turn the
                pattern. This pattern can be used for the lining and swag. Test    swag right side out.
                it out by hanging it in place on the rod.

                   5                                                                 6

                Press under 1" twice on the long straight sides, folding           Attach drapery rings to the upper straight edges of the
                the decorator fabric and lining together. Stitch close the inner   swag as shown. Hang the rings on the decorator pole. Arrange
                fold. Repeat at the upper edge.                                    the swag as desired (inset).

                                                                                                                                     Window Treatments ■ 429

   412-448_11989.indd 429                                                                                                                                   5/23/09 2:03:5 PM

ects 428 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:429

         Rod-pocket Swag

         M     odeled after traditional rod-pocket curtains
               (page 394), this swag style is simple to make
         and can be detailed to match many décor styles. Style
         the swag to fall in one deep, graceful half-circle, or in
         multiple swags of equal depths. Or divide the swag
         further to create a deeper swag in the center, framed
         by smaller swags on the sides. Lightweight, sheer
         or medium-weight decorator fabrics all work well
         rod-pocket swags.
              Whatever your styling, this top treatment will
         always be constructed from a half-circle of fabric.
         Surprisingly, the straight edge of the half-circle will
         become the lower curved edge of the valance to
         which the ruffle or fringe is attached. Before you
         begin, install the rod and drape a piece of string
         or twill tape from the rod to simulate the final
         appearance of the swag(s). Mark the swags on the                 This rod-pocket swag has been gathered along the pocket
         string and use this piece to help determine your                 and the top portion is folded over, resulting in a cloud-like
         final measurements.                                              fullness at the top.

         ■ How to Make a Rod-pocket Swag
            1                                                               2

         Determine the depth of the heading and rod pocket.               Mark ½" seam allowance and the depths of heading and
         Fold the decorator fabric in half crosswise. Mark an arc using   rod pocket on the wrong side of the valance fabric (arrows), at
         a straightedge and pencil, measuring from the outer edge at      each end of the straight edge. Pin valance to lining, right sides
         the fold, a distance equal to ½ the measured length of the       together, matching raw edges.
         lower edge of the valance plus the depth of the heading and
         rod pocket plus ½" for seams. Cut on marked line through both
         layers. Cut lining to this same size.

  430 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_C51711.indd 430 6/3/09 3:11:9 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects (06-AC51711) #175 Dtp:119 Page:430

                   3                                                                   4

                Stitch valance to lining in 1⁄2" seam, stitching with valance       Press the lining seam allowance toward the lining. Trim the
                face up. Leave an opening for the rod pocket at each end            corners diagonally.
                of the straight edge, and an opening near the center of the
                straight edge for turning.

                   5                                            6

                Turn valance right side out; press           Insert the curtain rod or pole into             Variation: To gather swag, follow steps
                seamed edges. Stitch the center              the rod pocket, gathering fabric evenly.        1 through 5 then mark gathers on the
                opening closed. Mark chalk lines for         Install rod on brackets. Adjust folds of        wrong side of the fabric. Zig-zag stitch
                depth of heading and depth of rod            valance as desired. Note: Swag shown            over a length of cord down one side of
                pocket on curved edge of valance. Pin        has a ruffle attached to the straight           the line. When you reach the end, pivot
                layers together. Stitch on marked lines.     edge. Attach ruffle to long straight edge       and continue stitching over cord on the
                                                             before beginning project, if desired.           opposite side of the line and secure
                                                                                                             at the end. After mounting swag,
                                                                                                             draw up cords to gather swag to the
                                                                                                             desired height, then tie cords together
                                                                                                             and trim.

                                                                                                                                      Window Treatments ■ 431

   412-448_11989.indd 431                                                                                                                                   5/23/09 2:03:33 PM

ects 430 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:431

         Stained Glass

         H    anging stained glass panels in a window is a
              dramatic way to add color to the brightest places
         in your home. Custom order a new panel or search
                                                                                 Tools & Materials ▸
         for a unique find at an antique store or salvage yard.                  Hooks and chains                 Finishing compound
         If you are refurbishing an older panel, follow these                    Mineral spirits                     or furniture polish
         simple tips to make sure it looks its best. Or, if you                  Paintbrush                       Painter’s tape
         can’t afford (or can’t find) the perfect panel for your                 Vinegar                          Spray stained glass
         window—make an imitation panel yourself! Use this                       Razor blade                      Felt-tip marker
         simple painting technique to add a colorful, removable                  0000 steel wool                  Paper
         design to your window glass.                                            Glass cleaner                    Liquid leading

         To hang a stained glass panel, secure hooks to the top of the panel frame and to the top of the window frame, predrilling
         holes. Hang from chains secured to the hooks. Ask for help selecting hardware that will be strong enough to support the weight of
         your piece.

  432 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 432 5/23/09 2:03:37 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:432

                ■ Refurbishing Stained Glass Panels
                   1                                          2                                               3

                Remove old paint by applying mineral        Clean dirty lead by rubbing 0000 steel         Clean glass using a commercial-grade
                spirits to the area covered with paint      wool over it, taking care not to scratch       glass cleaner and polish with finishing
                using a paintbrush; wait a moment and       the glass; then wipe the lead with a           compound. Wipe the polish on, allow it
                scrape away paint with a razor blade.       dampened cloth.                                to dry and buff the surface. You can also
                Remove putty or glazing compound                                                           use furniture polish to shine the glass.
                using vinegar and a razor blade.                                                           Either kind of polish will protect the
                                                                                                           glass with a wax coating.

                ■ How to Make Imitation Stained Glass
                   1                                                                 2

                Plan your design on a piece of paper, then place your             When all colors have been applied and have dried, apply
                drawing behind the glass panel and trace over your guidelines     liquid leading materials following your marker lines.
                with a marker on the front of the glass. Mask off your first
                color, and apply Spray Stained Glass in short sweeping
                motions. Repeat for each color.

                                                                                                                                    Window Treatments ■ 433

   412-448_11989.indd 433                                                                                                                                 5/23/09 2:03:39 PM

ects 432 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:433

         Frosted Glass

         F   rosted glass spray paint provides a durable finish
             that cuts the glare of strong sunlight and provides
         privacy for windows in bathrooms or entrances. Spray
         paint over a masking stencil of self-adhesive vinyl
         to leave spaces of clear glass in a decorative shape.
         Or, reverse the stenciling process and apply frosted
         glass in a decorative pattern to imitate etched glass
         detailing. Unlike true frosted glass, however, frosted
         glass spray paint can be removed, using a razor blade
         or lacquer thinner.

               Tools & Materials ▸
               Frosted glass                Graphite paper
                  spray paint                  or pre-cut stencil
               Self-adhesive                Masking tape
                  vinyl, such as            Paper
                  Con-Tact®                 Glass cleaner
               Mat knife                    Lint-free cloth

         Frosted glass can add privacy to doorway windows or
         bathrooms along with decorative flair. Or, apply frosted glass to
         small stenciled areas to imitate etched glass (above).

  434 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 434 5/23/09 2:03:45 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:434

                ■ How to Apply a Frosted Glass Finish with a Clear Design
                                                                                                                                                         A
                   1                                                                 2

                                                                                                                                                         B

                Clean the window thoroughly using glass cleaner and                Position design on window, with carbon or graphite paper
                a soft, lint-free cloth. Cut self-adhesive vinyl 2" larger than    under design, tape in place. Trace design onto vinyl (A). Or tape
                design. Remove paper backing; affix vinyl to window in the         precut stencil to vinyl in desired position; trace design areas
                desired location, pressing out any air bubbles. If more than one   with pencil (B).
                width of vinyl is needed overlap the edges slightly.

                   3                                                                 4

                Cut around the design areas using a mat knife, applying            Remove vinyl surrounding design areas using tip of mat
                just enough pressure to cut through the vinyl. Overcut corners     knife to lift edge of vinyl.
                or curves into surrounding areas, if necessary, but do not cut
                into design areas.

                                                                                                                                                (continued)

                                                                                                                                     Window Treatments ■ 435

   412-448_11989.indd 435                                                                                                                                    5/23/09 2:03:49 PM

ects 434 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:435

            5                                                                 6

         Press firmly on all areas of the design; rub away any              Mask off the woodwork around window and surrounding
         traces of adhesive left on glass, using glass cleaner and soft,    wall area using masking tape and paper to protect from
         lint-free cloth.                                                   overspray of the paint.

            7                                                                 8

         Check to be sure the glass surface is free of dust. Follow         Remove vinyl in design areas using tip of matt knife to lift
         the manufacturer’s instructions for applying paint. Spray paint    edge of vinyl. Gently rub away any traces of adhesive left on
         onto the window in sweeping motion, holding can 10 to 12"          the glass, using a soft cloth dipped in glass cleaner.
         away from glass, lightly respraying surface several times in one
         application. Allow to dry for 15 minutes. Repeat two or three
         times for good coverage.

  436 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 436 5/23/09 2:03:55 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:436

                ■ How to Apply a Frosted Design with Surrounding Clear Glass
                   1                                                                   2

                Follow steps 1 and 2 on page 435. Cut around the design              Remove vinyl in design areas to be frosted using tip of mat
                areas to be frosted using a mat knife, applying just enough          knife to lift edge of vinyl.
                pressure to cut through the vinyl. At the corners, do not cut past
                point of the intersecting lines, onto the area surrounding design.

                   3                                                                   4

                Follow step 5, opposite. Mask off woodwork, walls, or any            Follow step 7, opposite, spraying over design area. Remove
                areas of the glass not protected by the stencil using masking        vinyl, masking tape, and paper. Gently rub away any traces
                tape and paper.                                                      of adhesive left on glass using a soft, lint-free cloth dipped in
                                                                                     glass cleaner.

                                                                                                                                       Window Treatments ■ 437

   412-448_11989.indd 437                                                                                                                                    5/23/09 2:03:59 PM

ects 436 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:437

         Shoji-style Screen

         T   raditional Japanese screens, called shoji, are made
             with an intricate wooden lattice framework backed
         with rice paper. Shoji-style screens filter muted
         light through the transparent paper backing, adding
         sophisticated elegance and an aura of tranquility to
         any room. Shoji-style screens are especially suited for
         windows that cannot be opened and closed and that
         have a less-than-perfect view.
              These shoji-style screens are made from parting
         stop and rice or decorative paper. Parting stop
         measures ½" × ¾" and can be painted or stained, if
         desired. Paper backing can be applied in one sheet
         or in multiple sheets. Mount the screen inside or in
         front of your window frame. Careful measuring and
         cutting is important, especially if you plan an inside-
         mount. Make your screen 1⁄4" narrower and shorter
         than the inside of the frame. Take accurate, detailed
         measurements of the window and draw a full-size
         pattern of the screen framework before cutting any of
         the wood pieces.                                          Japanese shoji-style screens are timeless, and filter light
                                                                   softly in to any room for simple, classic elegance.

               Tools & Materials ▸                                     Anatomy of a Shoji ▸
               Parting stop
               Rice paper or decorative paper
               Double-stick transfer tape                                                       B         C
               15⁄8" drywall screws
               Wood filler
               Wood glue
               Sandpaper                                                                                             A
               Paint, or stain and clear acrylic finish                                         D
                   (optional)
               Mat knife
               1
                ⁄8"-thick self-adhesive bumper pads                                  A
                   (for inside mount)
               Two shoulder hooks and screw eyes
                   (for outside mount)
                                                                                                B
               Spring clamps
               Drill with 1⁄8" combination drill
                   and countersink bit
               Small miter box and backsaw
                                                                       Shoji-style framework has an inner frame,
                                                                       consisting of two vertical stiles (a) and top and
                                                                       bottom rails (b), a slightly offset outer frame (c), and
                                                                       interior lattice strips (d).

  438 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 438 5/23/09 2:04:4 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:438

                ■ How to Make a Shoji-Style Screen
                    1                                               2                                                3

                Measure window frame; determine                  Draw the outer frame of screen 1⁄2"              Draw stiles and rails 1⁄2" wide, inside
                outer measurements of screen (1⁄4"               wide; sides run full length of frame, with       outer frame; stiles run the full length
                narrower and shorter than window                 top and bottom sections abutting sides           between top and bottom sections of
                frame). Draw outline of screen on                at inner edges.                                  outer frame, with rails abutting stiles at
                large sheet of paper; use accurate                                                                inner edges.
                measurements and square corners.

                    4                                                                      5

                Draw inner lattice of screen as desired; draw all sections              Tape the finished pattern to the window frame,
                1
                 ⁄2" wide, abutting the ends of lattice sections to inner edges of      checking for accuracy. Measure pattern for the length of each
                stiles, rails, or other lattice sections. Sections should abut each     wood section, including the stiles, rails, lattice, and outer frame
                other at right angles. To allow for the insertion of screws, stagger    sections. Keeping the ½" side of the parting stop face up, mark
                placement of ends that abut opposite sides of the same section.         and cut for each section; cut on the outside of the line using
                It is helpful to plan the design of the lattice by sketching it on      a miter box and backsaw, leaving each section slightly longer
                another piece of paper before drawing it on the pattern.                than the desired finished length.

                                                                                                                                                      (continued)

                                                                                                                                           Window Treatments ■ 439

   412-448_11989.indd 439                                                                                                                                         5/23/09 2:04:6 PM

ects 438 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:439

            6                                                                      7

         Check the lengths of outer frame sections by placing                    Remove left stile from pattern and place it face up near
         sections of parting stop over pattern. Sand the ends of                 the edge of a flat work surface. Abut bottom rail to stile, face
         sections until they fit the pattern exactly. Reposition on the          up, with lower edges even; clamp. Mark placement for screw
         pattern. Repeat for stiles, rails, and all lattice sections until the   on outside of stile in line with the center of the rail.
         entire framework is laid out (inset).

            8                                                                      9

         Adjust 1⁄8" combination drill and countersink bit so head               Repeat steps 7 and 8 for top rail. Attach right stile to the
         of drywall screw will be recessed below surface of wood                 opposite end of rails, abutting ends of rails to side of stile;
         when inserted into drilled hole, then predrill screw hole, drilling     countersink holes and insert screws.
         through the side of the stile and into the center of the end rail.
         Countersink the hole up to point on bit indicated by white line.
         Insert drywall screw.

  440 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 440 5/23/09 2:04:13 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:440

                   10                                                                  11

                Position the stiles and rails over the lattice pieces on             Join sections of lattice, working from center outward and
                pattern. Align all pieces for perfect fit. Make small pencil lines   aligning penciled markings. Keep lattice flat on work surface,
                at every abutting location.                                          and predrill holes in line with center of section being joined;
                                                                                     insert screws.

                   12                                                                  13

                Fit lattice inside the framework of stiles and rails.                Apply wood glue to upper side of top rail and top ends
                Join the stiles and rails to lattice, countersinking holes and       of stiles. Place the framework face up on flat surface; place
                inserting screws.                                                    straightedge of about 1⁄8" thickness next to top rail. Rest the top
                                                                                     section of outer frame on straightedge to offset it slightly; glue
                                                                                     to the top rail, aligning ends. Clamp in place. Repeat for bottom
                                                                                     section. Then, glue side sections of outer frame to stiles.

                                                                                                                                                  (continued)

                                                                                                                                       Window Treatments ■ 441

   412-448_11989.indd 441                                                                                                                                    5/23/09 2:10:16 PM

ects 440 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:441

            14                                                                 15

         Cover exposed screw heads in lattice with wood filler, if           Cut paper 1" longer and wider than outer frame. Apply
         desired. Allow to dry. Sand filled areas until flush with wood      double-stick transfer tape to all stiles, rails, and lattices.
         surface. Sand any rough areas of the screen. If desired, paint or
         stain framework.

            16                                                                 17

         Center piece of paper, right side down, and affix center of         Fold back the excess paper at the edges of inner frame;
         each side to frame. Pull paper taut and affix sides of paper to     crease. Trim using mat knife.
         stiles and rails. Then, affix paper to all lattice sections.

  442 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

412-448_11989.indd 442 5/23/09 2:10:19 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:442

                      Attaching Paper Using Multiple Sheets ▸

                      Divide original screen pattern into areas that can be        Affix paper to frame using double-stick transfer tape,
                      covered with one piece of paper. Trace each area onto        one area at a time. Always apply to outer edges first, and
                      tracing paper, planning for paper pieces to overlap each     then to any lattice strips. Center paper over the area and
                      other on the back of the lattice sections, hiding seams.     affix to frame as in step 16. Trim, using mat knife, and
                      Cut each piece of paper using the traced patterns. Add 1"    move on to the next section, overlapping pieces on the
                      margin on each side.                                         back of any adjoining lattice strips (inset).

                ■ Mounting a Shoji-Style Screen

                Inside Mount: Adhere self-adhesive bumper pads to outside          Outside Mount: Attach screw eyes to the top of the outer
                edge of outer frame, 2" from each corner, and then every 18 to     frame, 2" from the corners. Hold screen in place and mark
                24", around the entire frame. Push the screen into place inside    placement for shoulder hooks. Attach shoulder hooks to
                the window frame until the front of the screen is flush with the   window frame and hang the screen, hooking the screw eyes
                front of the window frame. Stack additional pads, if necessary.    over the shoulder hooks.

                                                                                                                                    Window Treatments ■ 443

   412-448_11989.indd 443                                                                                                                                 5/23/09 2:10:20 PM

ects 442 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:443

         Reference Charts
         Metric Conversions
         To Convert:                 To:                          Multiply by:                To Convert:               To:                          Multiply by:
         Inches                      Millimeters                  25.4                        Millimeters               Inches                       0.039
         Inches                      Centimeters                  2.54                        Centimeters               Inches                       0.394
         Feet                        Meters                       0.305                       Meters                    Feet                         3.28
         Yards                       Meters                       0.914                       Meters                    Yards                        1.09
         Square inches               Square centimeters           6.45                        Square centimeters        Square inches                0.155
         Square feet                 Square meters                0.093                       Square meters             Square feet                  10.8
         Square yards                Square meters                0.836                       Square meters             Square yards                 1.2
         Ounces                      Milliliters                  30.0                        Milliliters               Ounces                       .033
         Pints (U.S.)                Liters                       0.473 (lmp. 0.568)          Liters                    Pints (U.S.)                 2.114 (lmp. 1.76)
         Quarts (U.S.)               Liters                       0.946 (lmp. 1.136)          Liters                    Quarts (U.S.)                1.057 (lmp. 0.88)
                Gallons (U.S.)       Liters                       3.785 (lmp. 4.546)          Liters                    Gallons (U.S.)               0.264 (lmp. 0.22)
         Ounces                      Grams                        28.4                        Grams                     Ounces                       0.035
         Pounds                      Kilograms                    0.454                       Kilograms                 Pounds                       2.2

         Converting Temperatures                                                              Lumber Dimensions
         Convert degrees Fahrenheit (F) to degrees Celsius (C) by following this simple         Nominal - U.S.          Actual - U.S. (in inches)                 Metric
         formula: Subtract 32 from the Fahrenheit temperature reading. Then, multiply that             1×2                         3
                                                                                                                                      ⁄ 4 × 1 1⁄ 2            19 × 38 mm
         number by 5⁄9. For example, 77°F - 32 = 45. 45 × 5⁄9 = 25°C.                                  1×3                          3
                                                                                                                                      ⁄ 4 × 2 1⁄ 2            19 × 64 mm
                                                                                                       1×4                          3
                                                                                                                                      ⁄ 4 × 3 1⁄ 2            19 × 89 mm
         To convert degrees Celsius to degrees Fahrenheit, multiply the Celsius temperature            1×5                          3
                                                                                                                                      ⁄ 4 × 4 1⁄ 2            19 × 114 mm
         reading by 9⁄5. Then, add 32. For example, 25°C × 9⁄5 = 45. 45 + 32 = 77°F.                   1×6                          3
                                                                                                                                      ⁄ 4 × 5 1⁄ 2            19 × 140 mm
                                                                                                       1×7                          3
                                                                                                                                      ⁄ 4 × 6 1⁄ 4            19 × 159 mm
                Fahrenheit                                   Celsius                                   1×8                          3
                                                                                                                                      ⁄ 4 × 7 1⁄ 4            19 × 184 mm
                55°                                                        15°                        1 × 10                        3
                                                                                                                                      ⁄ 4 × 9 1⁄ 4            19 × 235 mm
                50°                                                        10°                        1 × 12                       3
                                                                                                                                     ⁄4 × 111⁄4               19 × 286 mm
                45°
                40°                                                         5°                        1 1⁄ 4 × 4                     1 × 3 1⁄ 2               25 × 89 mm
                35°
                                         Freezing
                                                                                                      1 1⁄ 4 × 6                     1 × 5 1⁄ 2               25 × 140 mm
                30°                                                         0°
                25°
                                                                                                      1 1⁄ 4 × 8                      1 × 7 1⁄ 4              25 × 184 mm
                                                                            -5°
                20°                                                                                  11⁄4 × 10                        1 × 9 1⁄ 4              25 × 235 mm
                15°                                                       -10°
                10°
                                                                                                     11⁄4 × 12                     1 × 111⁄4                  25 × 286 mm
                5°                                                        -15°                       1 1⁄ 2 × 4                   1 1⁄ 4 × 3 1⁄ 2             32 × 89 mm

                                                                                                     1 1⁄ 2 × 6                   1 1⁄ 4 × 5 1⁄ 2             32 × 140 mm
                                                                                                     1 1⁄ 2 × 8                    1 1⁄ 4 × 7 1⁄ 4            32 × 184 mm
                                                                                                     11⁄2 × 10                     1 1⁄ 4 × 9 1⁄ 4            32 × 235 mm
                                                                                                     11⁄2 × 12                    11⁄4 × 111⁄4                32 × 286 mm
         Metric Plywood Panels
                                                                                                       2×4                        1 1⁄ 2 × 3 1⁄ 2             38 × 89 mm
         Metric plywood panels are commonly available in two sizes: 1,200 mm × 2,400
                                                                                                       2×6                        1 1⁄ 2 × 5 1⁄ 2             38 × 140 mm
         mm and 1,220 mm × 2,400 mm, which is roughly equivalent to a 4 × 8-ft. sheet.
                                                                                                       2×8                        1 1⁄ 2 × 7 1⁄ 4             38 × 184 mm
         Standard and Select sheathing panels come in standard thicknesses, while Sanded
                                                                                                      2 × 10                      1 1⁄ 2 × 9 1⁄ 4             38 × 235 mm
         grade panels are available in special thicknesses.
                                                                                                      2 × 12                      11⁄2 × 111⁄4                38 × 286 mm
          Standard Sheathing Grade                          Sanded Grade
                                                                                                       3×6                        2 1⁄ 2 × 5 1⁄ 2             64 × 140 mm
              7.5 mm               ( ⁄16 in.)
                                     5
                                                           6 mm              (4⁄17 in.)
                                                                                                       4×4                        3 1⁄ 2 × 3 1⁄ 2             89 × 89 mm
              9.5 mm                (3⁄8 in.)              8 mm              (5⁄16 in.)
                                                                                                       4×6                        3 1⁄ 2 × 5 1⁄ 2             89 × 140 mm
              12.5 mm               (1⁄2 in.)             11 mm              (7⁄16 in.)
              15.5 mm               (5⁄8 in.)             14 mm              (9⁄16 in.)
              18.5 mm               (3⁄4 in.)             17 mm               (2⁄3 in.)       Liquid Measurement Equivalents
              20.5 mm              (13⁄16 in.)            19 mm               (3⁄4 in.)       1 Pint                    = 16 Fluid Ounces            = 2 Cups
              22.5 mm               (7⁄8 in.)             21 mm              (13⁄16 in.)      1 Quart                   = 32 Fluid Ounces            = 2 Pints
              25.5 mm               (1 in.)               24 mm              (15⁄16 in.)      1 Gallon                  = 128 Fluid Ounces           = 4 Quarts

  444 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

444-448_C51711.indd 444 6/3/09 3:42:57 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:444

                Resources
                American Society of Interior Designers (ASID)                                            National Association of Remodeling Industry (NARI)
                202 546 3480                                                                             847 298 9200
                www.asid.org                                                                             www.nari.org

                The Bradley Collection Limited                                                           Room and Board
                44 (0) 845 118 7224                                                                      800 301 9720
                info@bradleycollection.co.uk                                                             www.roomandboard.com
                www.bradleycollection.co.uk
                                                                                                         Wallcovering (paper) Resources
                Color Association of US                                                                  www.creativewallcovering.com (919 384 1994)
                www.colorassociation.com                                                                 www.jocelynwarner.com
                                                                                                         www.madisonandgrow.com
                Encyclopedia of Fabrications                                                             www.mardero.com
                by Ethel Mahon                                                                           www.pottokprints.com
                see WCAA entry                                                                           www.tracykendall.com (info@tracykendall.com)
                                                                                                         www.wallpaperstore.com (406 541 2091)
                US Environmental Protection Agency (EPA)
                202 272 0167                                                                             WCAA | Window Coverings Association of America
                www.epa.gov                                                                              Window coverings & home furnishings standards.
                                                                                                         Publications, certification programs, and training to maintain quality
                Esteban Interiors                                                                           standards, definitions of industry terms, and standardization of
                7605 Girard Avenue                                                                          window treatments.
                La Jolla, CA 92037                                                                       Publisher and distributor of the Encyclopedia of Fabrications by Ethel
                858 729 0045                                                                                Mahon.
                www.estebaninteriors.com                                                                 2646 Hwy 109, Ste. 205
                                                                                                         Grover, MO 63040
                IKEA Home Furnishings                                                                    636 273 4090
                610 834 0180                                                                             www.wcaa.org
                www.Ikea-USA.com

                International Furnishings and Design Assoc. (IFDA)
                610 535 6422
                www.ifda.com

                International Interior Designers Association
                888 799 4432
                www.iida.org

                National Kitchen & Bath Association (NKBA)
                800 THE NKBA
                www.nkba.org

                Photo Credits
                Photo Credits                                            p. 24 (top) Room & Board, (lower) Photolibrary                p. 132 (top), 141, 146 (top), 147 (lower) iStockphoto
                p. 3 Tony Giammarino/Giammarino & Dworkin                p. 25 (top) Photolibrary, (lower) Louvolite                   p. 166 Esteban Interiors
                p. 4 iStockphoto                                         p. 59 Shutterstock                                            p. 175, 176 iStockphoto
                p. 7 iStockphoto                                         p. 62 Shelley Metcalf                                         p. 180 (top) Photolibrary
                p. 8 FLOR                                                p. 68 iStockphoto                                             p. 181 (top) Modern Seed
                p. 9 (both) Room & Board                                 p. 74 Shelley Metcalf                                         p. 182 (top) Bratt Décor
                p. 10 (middle left) iStockphoto, (middle right & lower   p. 78 (top) Photolibrary                                      p. 187 (lower left) Brian Vanden Brink, (lower right)
                    right) Room & Board, (lower left) Jocelyn Warner     p. 83 (top two) Ceramic Tiles of Italy, (lower left)              Fireclay Tile, Inc.
                p. 11 (top) Room & Board                                     Oceanside Glass Tile, (lower right) Eric Roth             p. 193 and 198 Armstrong
                p. 12 (top left & right) Jocelyn Warner, (lower left)    p. 87 iStockphoto                                             p. 201 Brian Greer's Tin Ceilings
                    Photolibrary, (lower right) Shelley Metcalf          p. 90 IKEA                                                    p. 204 (top) Corbis
                p. 13 (top left) Tony Giammarino, (top right) Pottok,    p. 91 (top two, lower left & right) Jocelyn Warner, (lower    p. 206 Gilded Planet
                    (lower left & right) Jocelyn Warner                      middle) Pottok                                            p. 207 (top left) Gilded Planet
                p. 18 Room & Board                                       p. 92 (top) Jocelyn Warner                                    p. 208 Madison & Grow
                p. 19 (top left) Esteban Interiors, (top right) Ted      p. 100 (top) iStockphoto                                      p. 211 SieMatic Corp.
                    Yarwood/design Kimberley Seldon Design Group,        p. 105 iStockphoto                                            p. 218 Corbis
                    (lower right & left) Corbis                          p. 124 Deron E. Meranda                                       p. 222 IKEA
                p. 20 (top) iStockphoto, (lower) Armstrong               p. 128 Marvin Windows and Doors                               p. 228 Woodharbor

                                                                                                                                                                           Photo Credits ■ 445

   444-448_C51711.indd 445                                                                                                                                                                     6/3/09 3:42:59 PM

ects 444 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:445

         p. 230 Naill McDiarmi/Alamy                                 Brian Greer's Tin Ceilings, Walls and unique metal                David Duncan Livingston, photographer/
         p. 234 Beateworks Inc./Alamy                                work/www.tinceiling.com                                           www.davidduncanlivingston.com
         p. 237 Armstrong                                            p. 201                                                            p. 374, 416, 421 (top right)
         p. 238 (top) Armstrong
         p. 250 Room & Board                                         Ceramic Tiles of Italy/www.italytile.com                          Louvolite, Window blind systems and fabrics/
         p. 261 Shelley Metcalf                                      p. 83 (top two)                                                   www.louvolite.com
         p. 301 (lower) iStockphoto                                                                                                    p. 25 (lower), 357 (lower right inset), 361 (top two,
         p. 338 (left) Brian Vanden Brink                            Chrisicos Interiors/www.chrisicos.com/617 699 9462                middle left), 362, 368
         p. 349 Eric Roth                                            p. 371 (lower left) photo/design Kathie Chrisicos
         p. 355 (top left, lower right) iStockphoto, (top right,                                                                       Madison & Grow, LLC/www.madisonandgrow.com
             lower left) Hunter Douglas                              Color Association of US/www.colorassociation.com                  Eco-friendly designer wallcoverings: Modern, chic,
         p. 357 (lower right) Louvolite                              p. 379 (top left)                                                 sustainable, green, handmade.
         p. 360 IKEA                                                                                                                   p. 208 (Elizabeth design)
         p. 361 (top two, middle left) Louvolite, (middle right,     Conso Company/www.conso.com
             lower left) Tony Giammarino, (lower middle) ADO         p. 396                                                            Marvin Windows and Doors/www.marvin.com
             USA, (lower right) Waverly                                                                                                p. 128
         p. 362 Louvolite                                            Corbis Corporation/http://pro.corbis.com
         p. 366 (top) Photolibrary                                   p. 19 (lower two), 204 (top), 218                                 Deron E. Meranda/http://deron.meranda.us
         p. 368 Louvolite                                                                                                              p. 124
         p. 371 (lower left) photo/design Kathie Chrisicos, (lower   Esteban Interiors/www.estebaninteriors.com/
             right) Marcia Wright/design Carol Stearns               858 729 0045/info@estebaninteriors.com                            Shelley Metcalf, photographer/tele. 619-281-0049,
         p. 372 Tony Giammarino                                      p.19 (top left), 166 James Hiebling, Esteban López                email Shelley.Metcalf@cox.net
         p. 374 David Duncan Livingston                                                                                                p. 12 (lower right), 62, 74
         p. 376 (top) ADO USAi                                       Fireclay Tile, Inc./www.fireclaytile.com
         p. 378 (left, right) IKEA                                   p. 187 (lower right)                                              Modern Seed/www.modernseed.com
         p. 379 (top left & top middle ), (top middle) IKEA, (top                                                                      p. 181 (top)
             right) ADO USA, (lower right) Interiors by Decorating   FLOR, Modular carpet squares/www.flor.com
             Den and D. Randolph Foulds/design Adrian Halprin        p. 8, 246 to 249 carpet squares courtesy of FLOR                  Oceanside Glass Tile/www.glasstile.com
         p. 382 iStockphoto                                                                                                            p. 83 (lower left)
         p. 388 (left) IKEA                                          GetDecorating.com
         p. 390 ADO USA                                              p. 418, 425 (middle right)                                        Photolibrary/www.photolibrary.com
         p. 392 (top) IKEA                                                                                                             p. 12 (lower left), 24 (lower), 25 (top), 78 (top), 180
         p. 394 Jessie Walker                                        Tony Giammarino, photographer/                                    (top), 366 (top)
         p. 396 Conso Company                                        www.tonygiammarino.com
         p. 398 Shutterstock                                         p. 3 (Giammarino & Dworkin), 13 (top left), 361 (middle           Pottok, Wallpaper artist prints and patterns/
         p. 400 (lower) Interiors by Decorating Den/design Sally     right, lower left), 372, 401 (top left)                           www.pottokprints.com
             Giar, (top) iStockphoto                                                                                                   p. 13 (top right), 91 (lower middle)
         p. 401 (top left) Color Association of US, (top             Gilded Planet/www.gildedplanet.com
             middle) Jessie Walker, (top right) Interiors by         Gold leaf, copper leaf, silver leafing & gilding supplies.        Eric Roth, photographer/www.ericrothphoto.com
             Decorating Den and D. Randolph Foulds/design            p. 206, 207 (top left)                                            p. 83 (lower right), 349
             Connie Thompson, (lower left) Carol Stearns/
             design Barbara Tabak, (lower middle) Interiors by       Hakatai/www.hakatai.com/888 667 2429                              Room & Board, Modern furniture and accessories/
             Decorating Den and Doug Barnett/design Janet            p. 244 glass mosaic tiles courtesy of Hakatai                     www.roomandboard.com
             White, (lower right) Interiors by Decorating Den and                                                                      p. 9 (both), 10 (middle & lower right), 11 (top), 18, 24
             Doug Barnett/design Marisa Lupo                         Hunter Douglas, Window fashions/                                  (top), 250
         p. 402 Interiors by Decorating Den/Casa Fiora               www.hunterdouglas.com
         p. 410 (top) Richard Leo Johnson/design Carlette            p. 355 (top right, lower left), 410 (lower), 425 (top left)       Shutterstock/www.shutterstock.com
             Cormier/CC's Designs, (lower) Hunter Douglas                                                                              p. 59, 261, 398
         p. 411 (top left) iStockphoto, (top middle) design T.       IKEA Home Furnishings/www.ikea.com
             Comer, (lower left) Jamie Gibbs & Associates,           p. 90, 222, 360, 378 (both), 379 (top middle), 388,               SieMatic Corp., High-end kitchen features/
             (lower middle) design Cheryl McLean                     392 (top)                                                         www.siematic.com
         p. 416 David Duncan Livingston                                                                                                p. 211
         p. 418 GetDecorating.com                                    Interiors by Decorating Den/www.decoratingden.com
         p. 421 (top left) Carol Stearns/design Connie               p. 379 (lower right) D. Randolph Foulds/design Adrian             Carol Stearns/www.decoratingden.com
             Thompson, (top right) David Duncan Livingston           Halprin, 400 design Sally Giar, 401 (top right) design            p. 371 (lower right) design Marcia Wright, 401 (lower
         p. 425 (top left) Hunter Douglas, (middle left) Interiors   Connie Thompson, 401 (lower middle) design Janet                  leftdesign Barbara Tabak, 421 (top left) design
             by Decorating Den/design M. Anquetil, (middle           White, 401 (lower right) design Marisa Lupo, 402 Casa             Connie Thompson
             right) Getdecorating.com, (lower right) Interiors by    Fiora, 411 (top middle) design T. Comer, 411 (lower
             Decorating Den/design Rebecca Shearn                    middle) design Cheryl McLean, 425 (middle left) design            Brian Vanden Brink, architectural photographer/
         428 (top) Interiors by Decorating Den/design                M. Anquetil, 425 (lower right) design Rebecca Shearn,             www.brianvandenbrink.com
             Beverly Barrett                                         428 (top) design Beverly Barrett                                  p. 187 (lower left), 338 (left)

         Photography Resources                                       iStockphoto/www.istockphoto.com                                   Jessie Walker, photographer/www.jessiewalker.com
         ADO USA, Fine fabrics/www.ado-usa.com/                      p. 5, 7, 20 (top), 68, 87, 100 (top), 105, 132 (top), 141,        p. 394, 401 (top middle)
         888 766 5895                                                146 (top), 147 (lower), 175, 176, 301 (lower), 355 (top
         p. 361 (lower middle), 376 (top), 379 (top right), 390      left, lower right), 411 (top left)                                Waverly, Fabrics, wallcoverings, window treatments,
                                                                                                                                       paint, and more/www.waverly.com
         Alamy/www.alamy.com                                         Jamie Gibbs & Associates, Interior designers and                  p. 361 (lower right)
         p. 230 Naill Mcdiarmid/Alamy; 234 Beateworks Inc./          landscape architects/www.jamiegibbsassociates.com
         Alamy                                                       p. 411 (lower left)                                               Woodharbor, doors and cabinetry/
                                                                                                                                       www.woodharbor.com
         Armstrong, Flooring, ceiling, cabinets/                     Jocelyn Warner, Wallpaper, lighting, rugs/www.                    p. 228
         www.armstrong.com                                           jocelynwarner.com
         p. 20 (lower), 193, 198, 237, 238 (top)                     p. 10 (lower left), 12 (top left & right), 13 (lower left &       Ted Yarwood, photographer/www.tedyarwood.com
                                                                     right), 91 (top two, lower right & left), 92 (top)                p. 19 (top right), design Kimberley Seldon Design Group
         The Bradley Collection Limited/www.bradleycollection.
         co.uk/info@bradleycollection.co.uk/                         Richard Leo Johnson
         44 (0) 845 118 7224                                         p. 410 (top) design Carlette Cormier/CC's Designs
         p. 23 All window rods courtesy of Bradley
                                                                     Kimberley Seldon Design Group/
         Bratt Décor, Baby cribs and children furnishings/           www.kimberleyseldon.com
         www.brattdecor.com                                          p. 19 (top right) photo Ted Yarwood
         p. 182 (top)

  446 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

444-448_C51711.indd 446 6/3/09 3:42:59 PM (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:446

                Index
                A                                                 D                                                     G
                Acoustical tiles, installing ceiling, 198-200     Doors/doorways                                        Gel stains, applying, 335
                Aluminum leaf gilding, applying, 206-207             attaching mirrors to, 234-235                      Glass mosaic tiles, installing floor, 244-245
                Antique stained finishes, applying, 216              installing                                         Glass shelving, installing, 184-185
                Appliances, faux stainless steel, 217                  Arts and Crafts casing, 130-131                  Grommet curtains, making, 390-391
                Attic ceilings, paneling, 197                          bifold, 228-229
                                                                       decorative door headers, 232-233                 H
                B                                                      mitered casing, 129                              Heat stripping, 328-329
                Backsplashes, installing tile, 78-81                   prehung interior, 226-227                        Hems, sewing, 30
                Balloon shades, making, 376-377                        trim molding around, 116-119
                Bamboo, about, 65                                      wallcovering around, 95
                                                                                                                        K
                Bias swags, 428-429                                  painting wood, 230-231
                                                                                                                        Knobs, installing on cabinets, 222-225
                Blended color-bands, painting, 154-155               upholstering wall around, 103
                Blueboard, about, 170                             Double welting, making, 103
                                                                  Draped window treatments                              L
                Built-up base molding, installing, 108-109
                                                                     finishing styles, 384-385                          Laminate paneling, about, 65
                Butterfly shades, making, 372-373
                                                                     installing, 383                                    Loop-tab curtains, making, 392-393
                Buttoned valances, 411, 412-415
                                                                     no-sew side panels, 286-287
                                                                  Draperies                                             M
                C
                                                                     making lined, 406-409                              Metal anchors, using self-drilling, 56
                Cabinets
                                                                     making pinch-pleated, 401, 402-405                 Metal tile ceilings, installing, 201-203
                   applying antique stained finishes, 216
                                                                     styles, 252, 400-401                               Mirrors
                   applying decorative brackets, 220
                                                                                                                           attaching to doors, 234-235
                   applying trim moldings, 218-219
                                                                  F                                                        framing, 186-187
                   installing hardware, 222-225
                                                                  Fabrics                                                  hanging, 176-179
                   painting faux mahogany finish, 214-215
                                                                     covering receptacles with, 100                        stenciling, 235
                   painting wood, 212-213
                                                                     estimating amount to purchase, 32-33, 351          Mitered returns, making, 46
                Carpet squares, installing, 246-249
                                                                     hanging, 180                                       Moldings. See Trim moldings
                Casement windows, painting casings and
                   sashes, 132-133                                   preparing, 26
                Casings, sewing, 30                                  selecting, 14-15                                   O
                Caulked designs for walls, 168-169                   sewing basics, 27-31                               One-piece base molding, installing, 106-107
                Ceilings                                          Faux upholstered valances, 421                        Ottomans, making slipcovers, 310-311
                   adding decorative wallboard tiers to, 62-63    Fireplace, installing tile surround, 190-191          Ottomans, making upholstered, 296-301
                   applying aluminum leaf gilding, 206-207        Flat Roman shades, making, 368-371
                   applying wallcovering to, 208-209              Floor mats, stenciling, 256-257                       P
                   creating illusion of higher, 17, 91            Floors                                                Paint
                   installing acoustical tiles, 198-200              installing carpet squares, 246-249                    color consistency, 37
                   installing metal tile, 201-203                    installing glass mosaic tiles, 244-245                estimating amount to purchase, 16
                   painting, 204-205                                 installing resilient tiles                            selecting, 16
                   paneling, 194-197                                   dry-back, 240-242                                   stripping from wood chemically, 330-331
                Chair rails, installing, 112-115                       preparation, 238-239, 242                           stripping from wood using heat, 328-329
                Chairs, upholstering                                   self-adhesive, 243                               Painting
                   redoing, 268-269                                  painting                                              ceilings, 204-205
                   slipcovers, 312                                     concrete, 250-253                                   concrete floors, 253
                   Cloud shades, making, 374-375                       sheet vinyl, 258                                    essentials tools and materials, 48, 49, 54-55
                Cloud valances, 411, 416-417                           wood, 254-255                                       metal furniture, 344-345
                Color meshing, painting, 144-145                     stenciling, 259                                       radiators, 346-347
                Color wash finish, painting, 158-159              Frameless cornices, 421                                  sheet vinyl flooring, 258
                Concrete block walls, painting, 142-143           Frosted glass, making, 434-437                           stenciling floor mats, 256-257
                Concrete floors, 250-253                          FRP (fiberglass reinforced) paneling, about, 65          walls
                Coped cuts, making, 45                            Furniture                                                  applying meshed color, 144-145
                Corners, mitering, 29                                frames                                                  basic techniques, 35-37
                Cornices, 124-127, 421                                 anatomy, 289                                          blended color-bands, 156-157
                Cove moldings, installing, 67, 77                      repairing, 270-271                                    color wash finish, 158-159
                Crown molding, installing, 120-123                   painting, 338-339                                       concrete block, 142-143
                Curtains                                               refinishing                                           faux grasscloth, 166-167
                   hanging, 380-381                                    applying stain & top coat, 334-337                    faux serpentine finish, 164-165
                   lining, 406-407                                     chemically stripping, 330-331                         pebbly, mottled finish, 150-151
                   making                                              heat stripping, 328                                   polka dots, 148-149
                     grommet, 390-391                                  surface preparation, 332-333                          rag-rolled texture technique, 152-153
                     loop-tab, 392-393                               upholstering                                            scumbled designs, 162-163
                     panels, 388-389                                   chair slipcovers, 312                                 sponge technique, 150-151, 159
                     rod-pocket, 394-395                               futon slipcovers, 324-325                             stamped mosaics, 160-161
                     tent-flap, 396-397                                headboards, 302-305                                   stripes, 146-147
                     tie-top, 398-399                                  ottomans, 296-301                                     terra-cotta finish, 154-155
                   styles, 352, 378-379                                ottoman slipcovers, 310-311                         wood
                Cushions, making, 272                                  redoing chair, 268-269                                cabinets, 212-213
                   boxed cushion covers, 272-275                       reversible seat covers, 306-309                       crown molding, 123
                   button-tufted, 280-283                         Futon slipcovers, making, 324-325                          faux leather finish, 340-341
                   knife-edge cushion covers, 277-279                                                                        faux mahogany finish, 214-215
                   reupholstered drop-in seats, 284-287                                                                      floors, 254-255
                   waterfall cushions, 275-276

                                                                                                                                                                   Index ■ 447

   444-448_C51711.indd 447                                                                                                                                              6/3/09 3:42:59 PM

ects 446 (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to Home Decorating Projects #175 Dtp:119 Page:447

              furniture, 338-339                                  with pleated skirt, 323                                making
              interior doors, 230-231                             sewing, 319-321                                          chair slipcovers, 312
              trim moldings, 38-42                                sewing fitted with front arm piece, 322                  futon slipcovers, 324-325
              window casings and sashes, 132-133                futon, 324-325                                             headboards, 302-305
         Paneling ceilings, 194-197                             ottoman, 310-311                                           ottomans, 296-301
         Paneling types, 65                                  Sponge painting                                               ottoman slipcovers, 310-311
         Paste waxes, applying, 337                             color wash finish, 158                                     redoing chairs, 288-295
         Photo montage tables, making, 342-343                  pebbly, mottled finish, 150-151                            reversible seat covers, 306-309
         Picture rails, 110-111, 125                         Spray-painting metal furniture, 344-345                       stripping, 268-269
         Pictures, hanging, 176-179                          Stained glass panels, 432-433                                 valances, 411, 418-421
         Pinch-pleated draperies, making, 401, 402-405       Stainless steel, painting faux, 217                         tools & equipment, 262-263, 264
         Plaster, applying veneer, 170-173                   Stains, applying, 334-337                                   on walls, 100-103
         Polka dots, painting, 148-149                       Stamped mosaic, painting, 160-161
         Polymer crown molding, installing, 122-123          Sticker art, applying, 181                              V
         Polyurethane top coats, applying, 336               Stripes, painting, 146-147                              Valances
         Pulls, installing on drawers, 222-225               Swags                                                      buttoned, 412-415
                                                                bias, 428-429                                           cloud, 416-417
         R                                                      rod-pocket, 430-431                                     styles, 401, 410-411
         Radiators, painting, 346-347                           scarf, 426-427                                          upholstered, 418-421
         Rag-rolled texture painting, 152-153                   styles, 353, 424-425                                 Veneer plaster, applying, 170-173
         Rails, installing                                                                                           Victorian-style built-up cornices, 125
            chair, 112-115                                   T
            picture, 110-111                                 Tables                                                  W
         Receptacles                                             making photo montage, 342-343                       Wainscoting, installing
            covering with fabric, 100                            painting faux leather finish, 340-341                 frames, 74-77
            paneling around, 72                              Tent-flap curtains, making, 396-397                       sheet panels, 64-67
         Rectangle valances, 411                             Terra-cotta finish, painting, 154-155                     tongue-and-groove, 68-73
         Resilient tiles, installing                         Textiles, hanging, 180                                  Wallcovering
            dry-back, 240-242                                Tie-top curtains, making, 398-399                         applying to ceilings, 208-209
            preparation for, 238-239, 242                    Tile backsplashes, installing, 78-81                      creating panels, 98-99
            self-adhesive, 243                               Tileboard, about, 65                                      hanging
         Reversible seat covers, making, 306-309             Tiles                                                       around doors & windows, 95
         Ribbon, applying to fabric, 28                          drilling into, 189                                      around pipes, 96
         Rod-pocket curtains, making, 394-395                    embellishing walls with, 82-85                          around wall-mounted sinks, 96
         Rod-pocket swags, making, 430-431                       framing mirrors with, 186-187                           borders, 97
         Rod-pocket valances, 411                                installing                                              mitering corners, 97
         Roller shades, 361, 362-363                               acoustical ceiling, 198-200                           preparation, 90, 92-93
         Roller shades with tabbed hems, 364-365                   fireplace surround, 190-191                           on walls, 93-94
         Roman shades, making, 368-371                             floor glass mosaic, 244-245                         selecting, 87, 90-91, 96
         Ruffles, sewing, 28                                       metal tile on ceilings, 201-203                     stripping old, 88-89
                                                                   resilient floor                                   Walls
         S                                                            dry-back, 240-242                                applying caulked designs, 168-169
         Sanding wood, 332-333, 338                                   preparation, 238-239, 242                        applying veneer plaster, 170-173
         Scarf joints, making, 47                                     self-adhesive, 243                               decorating with
         Scarf swags, 426-427                                    painting faux, 160-161                                  pictures & mirrors, 176-179, 186-187
         Screens, making shoji-style, 438-443                Top coats, applying, 334, 336                               shelving, 182-185
         Scumbled wall designs, painting, 162-163            Trim moldings                                               sticker art, 181
         Sealers, 332                                            for basement windows, 136-139                           textiles, 180
         Seams, sewing, 31                                       installing, 44-47                                     installing
         Seat covers, making reversible, 306-309                   around openings, 116-119                              chair rails on, 112-115
         Shades and blinds                                         built-up base, 108-109                                decorative panels, 60-63, 72
             installing                                            built-up chair rails, 114-115                         molding around openings, 116-119
               inside mount, 356-357                               built-up cornices, 124-127                            picture rails on, 110-111
               mounting options, 354-355                           on cabinets, 218-219                                  tile backsplashes, 78-81
               outside mount, 358-359                              chair rails, 112-113                                  tiles for embellishment, 82-85
             making                                                cove, 67                                            upholstering, 100-103
               balloon shades, 376-377                             decorative door headers, 232-233                  Welting, sewing, 31
               butterfly shades, 372-373                           one-piece base, 106-107                           Windows
               cloud shades, 374-375                               picture rails, 110-111                              building
               coach shades, 366-367                               polymer crown, 122-123                                shelves, 134-135
               flat Roman shades, 368-371                          wood crown, 120-122                                   trim for basement, 136-139
               roller shades, 362-363                            painting, 38-42                                       hanging wallcovering around, 95
               roller shades with tabbed hems, 364-365           removing old, 43                                      installing
             styles, 353, 360-361                                selecting, 17                                           Arts and Crafts casing, 130-131
         Sheet paneling, installing, 66-67                                                                               mitered casing, 129
         Sheet vinyl flooring, painting, 258                 U                                                           tongue-and-groove wainscoting around, 73
         Shelf valances, 411, 422-423                        Upholstery                                                  trim molding around, 116-119
         Shelves                                               cushions, 272                                           painting casings and sashes, 132-133
             building window, 134-135                            making boxed cushion covers, 272-275                  upholstering wall around, 103
             installing on walls                                 making button-tufted, 280-283                       Window treatments
               glass, 184-185                                    making knife-edge cushion covers, 277-279             estimating amount of fabric to purchase, 351
               wood, 182-183                                     making waterfall cushions, 275-276                    hardware for, 353
         Shoji-style screens, making, 438-443                    reupholstering drop-in seats, 284-287                 preparation, 350
         Slipcovers, making                                    fabrics and padding materials                           styles, 352-353
             chair, 312                                          cutting, 267                                        Wineglass racks, installing, 221
               adding zipper, 322-323                            estimating amount to purchase, 266                  Wood crown molding, installing, 120-122
               pin-fitting, 313-315                              reusing padding, 287                                Wood paneling, about, 65
               pin-fitting arm with front section, 315-318       types, 264, 265                                     Wood shelving, installing, 182-183

  448 ■ THE COMPLETE PHOTO GUIDE TO HOME DECORATING PROJECTS

444-448_C52215.indd 444-448_C51711.indd 448 6/26/09 5:08:41 PM 6/3/09 3:42:59 (Ray) (Ray) Text Job:05-11989 Job:05-11989 Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide Title:CPI-Complete Photo Guide to to Home Home Decorating (06-AC52215) #175 Decorating Projects Projects Dtp:119 Page:448 #175 Dtp:119 Page:448

                                 Beautify Your Home

      P        erfect for both new homeowners and seasoned home improvers, this hands-on, how-to manual will
               inspire your creativity and guide your handiwork to help you add the perfect finishing touch to your home.

      Break out your tools to:
          Install tongue-and-groove wainscoting and a decorative built-up chair rail

                                                                                                                                                                     D
          Add style to your walls by adding decorative molding
          Add a luxurious tiled surround to your fireplace or a bathroom mirror

                                                                                                                                           Photo Guide to
                                                                                                                                           The Complete
      Or, get crafty and think like a designer:
           Transform any room by using creative painting techniques for ceilings, walls and furniture
           Reinvent a well-loved chair from the inside-out with updated upholstery
           Play up your room’s strengths by creating decorative window treatments

      Driven by practical considerations but inspired by professional designers, the time-tested and innovative

                                                                                                                                          HOME DECORATING PROJECTS
      techniques included here will let you accomplish complex and simple décor projects with ease.

                                                                                         ISBN – 1 3 : 9 7 8 - 1 - 5 8 9 2 3 - 4 8 4 - 0
       CATEGORY: HOME DÉCOR                                                              ISBN – 1 0 : 1 - 5 8 9 2 3 - 4 8 4 - 7

                                  $35.00 US
                                                                                          EAN
         UPC

                                  £24.99 UK
                                  $43.99 CAN

                                                         www.creativepub.com
                                                         1-800-328-0590 opt.2
                                                                                                                                                                     D

PLC_C52210.indd 1

                                                 (Ray)

Rather have me do it?

Painting takes time and precision. I do both.